Skip to main content

Full text of "The history and doctrine of Budhism, popularly illustrated : with notices of the Kappooism, or demon worship, and of the Bali, or planetary incantations of Ceylon"

See other formats


tfjt  £hrnlnyjra/ 


PRINCETON.  N J 


Division 


Section 


Wm  f v 

-vV  v < 


mm 


um** 


(IWbY  ":V 


.K 


'wm. 


i 


* 

/0%6 


/ 


•A 


t 

» *. 


HISTORY 


01 


T *t 

V 


ii  i;  i>  ii  i s m/ 

. -». 

^opularls  EUusnatcti : 


**5«’ 


WITH  NOTICES  OK 


THE  KAPPOOISM,  .OR  DEMON  WORSHIP, 

ITT 


AND  OF 


THE  BALI,  OR  PLANETARY  INCANTATIONS, 

A.  • 7 


CEYLON. 


ft 


i 


BY  EDWARD  TJPHAM,  M.R.A.S. 


WITH  FORTY-THREE  LITHOGRAPHIC  PRINTS  FROM  ORIGINAL  SINGALESE  DESIGNS. 


LONDON : 

PRINTED  FOR  R.  ACKERMA NJf,  STRAND, 

J.  UPHAM,  BATH;  C.  UPHAM,  EXETER; 

AND  DONDEY-DUPRE,  LIBRAIRIE  ORIENTALE,  RUE  RICHELIEU,  PARIS. 

. • 1829. 


* 


k 


€ 


TO 


SIR  ALEXANDER  JOHNSTON, 

LATE 

€/ 

PRESIDENT  OF  HIS  MAJESTY’S  COUNCIL, 


CHIEF  JUSTICE  OF  THE  ISLAND  OF  CEYLON, 

FROM  WHOSE  IMPORTANT  COLLECTION  OF 


H*anu0crtpt0  attU  SOratoutgjs, 


ELUCIDATORY  OF 

THE  BUDHIST  DOCTRINE  AND  HISTORY, 


C 

SUBJECTS  OF  THE  FOLLOWING  ENGRAVINGS 


THEIR  ILLUSTRATION  WERE  CHIEFLY  DERIVED, 

THIS  WORK 

IS  RESPECTFULLY  INSCRIBED  BY 

THE  AUTHOR. 


16,  Berners  Street, 
February,  1829. 


V 


CONTENTS 


Page 

Preface  ............  v 

Introduction  ..........  1 

Idols  of  the  Budha  ..........  16 

o 

The  Transmigration  of  Souls,  and  the  J utakas  of  the  Budha  . . .25 

The  Earth  and  Atmospheric  Region  . . . . .44 

The  Dewa  Loka,  or  Six  Heavens  . . . .54 

The  Brahma  Loka,  or  Sixteen  Heavens,  and  Nirwana  . . .73 

The  Sackwalle  ...........  77 

The  Chakkraia,  and  the  four  Zodiacs  . . . .84 

The  Hells  102 

The  Bali 112 

The  Demons  ...........  126 


LIST  OF  THE  PLATES  AND  SUBJECTS. 


The  Jutakayas 


The  Pattinee 
Deities 

The  Dewa  Loka 
Heavens 


$ 

l 


l 


Bambadat  Raja  .... 
Useeratanam  Raja,  part  1,  2,  . 

King Wessantara,  parti,  2, 

The  Pattinee-dewa  .... 
The  Pattinee-dewa  Wiebesana 
The  Pattinee-dewa  Samana 
The  Pattinee-dewa  Wisme-karma  . 
The  Dewa  Loka  .... 
The  Dewa  Loka  ... 

The  Sackwalle  .... 
Four  Zodiacs  .... 
The  nine  Planets  .... 
The  Chakkraia 
The  twenty-seven  Nekates 
The  four  great  Hells  . • 4 

The  nine  planets  for  the  Mangale  Bali 
The  Hieroglyphic  of  the  Day  . 

The  Mangale  Bali  . 

The  ten  Bali  ..... 
The  ten  Bali  . 

The  devils  or  demons 
The  devils  or  demons 


Plate 

Page 

) 

34 

t 2,  3, 

35 

* 4,  5, 

39 

22, 

50 

23, 

• 

50 

24, 

52 

25, 

52 

6, 

67 

7,  8, 

. 

68 

21, 

76 

9,  10, 

11, 

12,  . . . 

88 

19, 

90 

20, 

. 

95 

15,  16, 

17, 

18,  . . . 

98 

26,  27, 

110 

14, 

118 

13, 

119 

28, 

. 

120 

29,  30, 

31, 

122 

32,  33, 

34, 

35,  36,  37,  38,  . 

124 

39,  40, 

131 

41,  42, 

43, 

132 

. 


' 


PREFACE. 


lHE  fe,th  °f  the  is,a"d  °f  has  fo'-  ***  been  that  of  the  Budha,  the  chief  object  of 

reverence  among  a large  portion  of  the  inhabitants  of  the  East;  but  the  fortunes  of  the  Budhist 

systen,  ot  religion  and  morals  cannot  be  completely  traced,  for  its  origin  is  obscured  by  its 
remote  antiquity,  and  by  the  vast  mass  of  traditions  and  fables  'which  have  accumulated  as 
well  from  the  long  course  of  ages,  as  from  the  changes  of  country  and  climate  in  which  it  has 
flourished.  Budhism  may  be  traced  back  to  a veiy  early  period  in  Hindustan,  where,  for  a long 
time,  ,t  exercised  supreme  control.  After  ages  of  sanguinary  wars,  it  was  finally  expelled  and 
rooted  out  ot  India;  and  its  vanquished  followers  tied  in  all  directions  from  their  relentless 
persecutors,  the  Hindfi  Braminists ; many  taking  refuge  in  the  north  and  east  among  the 
impervious  recesses  of  the  Ilimmaleh  mountains,  while  vast  numbers  migrated  to  the  fine  and 
fertile  island  of  Ceylon.  Protected  by  its  position,  the  fugitives  there  found  security.  They 
carried  thither  their  arts,  and  preserved,  with*  their  sacred  books,  the  faith  of  which  these 

formed  the  depository ; and  Budhism  seems  to  have  struck  deep  root,  and  to  have  flourished 
ever  since  in  its  insular  retreat. 


Not  only  is  Budhism  the  established  religion  of  Ceylon,  but  the  mountains  of  that  island 
possess  the  most  celebrated  Budhist  temples  of  the  East,  and  its  priests  the  highest  character 
for  knowledge  of  the  truths  of  pure  Budhism.  So  extensive  indeed  is  the  predominance  of  the 
faith  as  to  render  an  acquaintance  with  its  precepts,  its  deities,  and  its  agencies,  an  object  of  no 
ordinary  interest,  especially  as  even  at  present  it  is  the  faith  of  not  merely  the  island  of  Ceylon, 
but  the  principles  of  its  doctrines  exercise  a paramount  influence  over  probably  not  fewer  than 
three  hundred  millions  ot  the  human  race ; for  we  must  reckon  as  Budliists  the  bulk  of  the 
population  of  the  vast  regions  eastward  of  the  Ganges,  together  with  a large  proportion  of  the 
inhabitants  ot  the  Indian  isles;  in  addition  to  whom  we  may  number  among  its  votaries  the 
great  mass  ot  the  Chinese,  as  well  as  the  majority  of  the  tribes  of  north-eastern  Tartary  and 
Tibet,  where  resides  the  Lama,  the  living  representative  of  the  Budha. 


VI 


PREFACE. 


The  subjects  of  the  collection  of  designs  here  presented  to  the  public  embrace  a multiplicity 
of  wholly  new  details,  relating  exclusively  to  Budhism,  and  illustrative  ot  its  tenets  and 
doctrines  concerning  the  heavens  and  their  inhabitants,  the  properties  of  the  divine  persons,  and 
their  agency  on  human  affairs,  the  system  of  the  universe,  and  also  the  deeply-rooted  worship  of 
devils  or  demons,  and  charms  or  planetary  influences.  Many  of  the  notions  entertained  on  these 
points  may  be  discovered  in  the  dark  sorcery  of  the  northern  tribes,  and  many  in  Africa;  in 
short,  Budhism  will  be  found  to  exhibit  some  analogies  of  .practice  and  doctrine  with  almost 
every  system  of  Paganism.  The  coincidences  and  the  deductions  to  which  the  study  of  this 
celebrated  taitl,  leads  are  highly  important.  They  seem  to  point  to  a period  when  the  great 
family  of  Man  formed  but  one  community,  cherished  the  same  belief,  and  observed  the  same 
rites  ■ while  the  grand  convulsion  which  overthrew  this  state  of  things,  and  scattered  its 
fragments  thus  widely  abroad,  is  completely  lost  in  the  mist  of  time.  Hitherto  we  have  been 
unable  to  draw  from  the  chief  source  of  knowledge,  the  priesthood  of  Ceylon,  the  information 
which  could  alone  afford  us  a satisfactory  insight  into  the  doctrine  and  principles  of  the  Budlia  : 
no  source,  however,  can,  it  is  presumed,  be  less  exceptionable  than  original  pictorial 
representations,  combined  wit'll  their  explanatory  precepts,  as  employed  for  this  purpose  by  the 
priests  of  that  celebrated  island-a  class  of  persons  whose  sanctity  is  revered,  and  whose 
knowledge  on  this  very  point  is  recognised  by  all  followers  of  the  Bmlha.  For  these  plates,  and 
for  much  valuable  information  inserted  in  the  following  pages,  the  author  is  greatly  indebted 
to  the  communications  of  Sir  Alexander  Johnston,  who  filled  for  many  years  with  distinguished 
zeal  the  honourable  office  of  Chief  Justice  and  First  in  Council  in  Ceylon;  and  in  his  actions 
and  intentions  the  members  of  the  sacerdotal  class  in  that  island  appear  to  have  reposed 
implicit  confidence,  since,  through  their  friendship  and  assistance,  he  obtained  a collection  of 
manuscripts  on  the  most  important  points  of Budhist  literature,  sacred  and  historical*  The 
plates  are  lithographic  copies  from  the  drawings  in  Sir  Alexander  Johnston’s  possession. 
Their  worth  must  not  be  estimated  by  the  seeming  absurdities  or  singularities  ot  their 
appearance  and  execution  : as  productions  of  art  they  are  in  truth  below  mediocrity;  but  while 
they  prompt  research,  and  offer  points  of  useful  association,  they  furnish  m their  representations 
of  habits,  implements,  ornaments,  and  minute  emblems,  a mass  of  elucidatory  materials,  the 
value  of  which  will’ be  the  more  highly  appreciated  the  more  they  are  studied  and  compared 
with  the  accounts  of  the  Budhist  faith  already  presented  to  the  public  by  M.  Jomville, 
Dr.  Leyden,  Dr.  Buchanan,  and  others,  in  the  Asiatic  Researches. 


• In  one  signal  instance  Sir  Alexander  Johnston  enjoyed  an  opportunity  of  employing  this  feeling  for  ends  far  more 
important  than  even  the  interests  of  literature,  as  it  was  entirely  owing  to  his  powerful  influence  with  the  c ue  masters  o 
slaves  in  the  island,  that  they  were  led  to  the  humane  declaration,  by  a public  act,  that  all  children  born  o t ur  s a\es  a er 
the  12th  of  August,  1816,  should  be  free.  It  cannot  be  too  ardently  wished  that  this  arrangement  may  be  soon  universally 
adopted. 


PREFACE. 


Vll 


As  far  as  concerns  tlie  philosophy  of  the  books  and  the  language  of  Budhism,  the  author 
disclaims  all  pretension  to  the  philological  knowledge  and  local  information  requisite  to  render 
discussion  useful,  and  illustration  pertinent.  This  ancient  faith  requires  a master-hand  to  open 
the  abstruse  phraseology  and  figurative  language  under  which  its  philosophical  doctrines  he 
concealed.  The  patient  and  anxious  inquirer  into  these  points  cannot  derive  from  any  source 
so  much  improvement,  as  from  the  truly  philosophical  and  erudite  observations  of  Mr. 
Colebrooke,  whose  writings  are  so  marked  by  learning  and  an  intimate  knowledge  of  then- 

subjects,  as  to  compel  us  to  regret  that  ill  health,  or  any  other  obstacle,  should  impede  their 

* 

progress. 


The  author  can  only  regret,  that  his  best  efforts  and  most  assiduous  attention  to  these 
abstruse  and  difficult  subjects  cannot  furnish  more  palpable  results  : such  as  they  are,  however, 
he  flatters  himself  that  the  candid  and  patient  reader  may  yet  gather  some  little  fruit  from  Ins 
toil  ; and  that  every  point  of  the  moral  and  religious  code  of  Budhism,  as  exhibited  m its 
books,  and  exemplified  in  the  actions  of  its  followers,  will  demonstrate  the  paramount  duty  we 
owe  to  the  Supreme  Being,  to  endeavour  to  become  the  humble  •instruments  of  spreading  h.s 
sacred  word,  and  diffusing  the  light  of  his  truth  in  substitution  for  the  dreams  and  delusions  ot 

such  a system. 


Since  the  foregoing  preliminary  remarks  were  written  there  has  appeared,  in  the  first 
part  of  the  second  volume  of  the  Asiatic  Transactions,  a paper  ot  the  greatest  merit  as 
explanatory  of  the  Budhism  of  the  Nepaulese.  The  interesting  district  which  they  inhabit 
seems  to  have  been  particularly  the  asylum  and  retreat  of  the  Budhists  when  flying  to  the 
shelter  of  the  Himmaleh  mountains.  The  publication  of  this  valuable  sketch  was  unto,  tuna  e y 
too  late  to  allow  the  author  an  opportunity  of  deriving  any  benefit  from  its  information ; but 
the  doctrine  of  Nepaul  seems  perfectly  to  accord  with  that  of  the  Smgalese  upon  all  the 
leading  points  of  the  metempsychosis,  the  heavens,  and  the  divine  agencies. 


16,  Berners  Street , 
January  y 1829- 


p«lirn  lu 


THE 


DOCTRINE  OF  BUDHISM. 


CHAPTER  I. 

INTRODUCTION. 


“ Mundus  nunquam  est,  moritur  semper  et  nascitur." 


Ceylon  has  been  described  by  all  writers  as  the  most  beautiful  and  celebrated  of  the  Indian  islands,  the 
seat  of  a powerful  monarchy,  and  the  chief  depository  of  the  Budhist  faith.  It  is  in  the  latter  relation 
chiefly  that  this  favoured  spot  will  be  considered  in  the  following  pages.  As,  however,  the  interest 
which  we  feel  is  usually  increased  by  an  acquaintance  with  the  subject  matter  of  our  research,  so  we  may 
follow  the  intricate  details  of  the  religion  and  worship  of  the  Budha  with  the  more  pleasure  after  briefly 
sketching  the  history  and  character  of  that  island,  which  the  Budha  Gaudma,  the  distinguished  teacher 
and  divinity  of  the  eastern  world,  has  chosen  to  make  the  scene  of  his  birth,  and  the  chief  theatre  of  his 
acts  and  miracles. 

We  find  different  names  assigned  to  this  important  island  at  different  periods,  and  by  different 
writers.  Malte  Brun  informs  us  that  the  appellative  Selan,  whence  is  derived  Ceylon,  is  fbund  in  Cosmas, 
in  the  sixth  century,  under  that  of  Sielen  Diva,  or  the  island  of  Sielen ; but,  as  Ammianus  Marcellinus 
calls  the  inhabitants  Serandives,  and  the  Arabian  name,  Serendib,  is  only  a corruption  of  Selan-div,  the 
latter  term  may  be  referred  to  a more  ancient  epoch,  and  is  probably  the  same  with  the  Simunda,  or 
Silunda,  of  Ptolemy.  Another  Indian  name,  Salabha,  “the  Rich  Island,”  may  be  recognised  in  the  Saliki 
of  the  same  geographer:  but  the  ancients  knew  nothing  of  its  Sanscrit  name,  Lanca,  or  of  Singala, 
Chingala,  or  Sinhela,  “ the  Isle  of  Lions,”  which  was  more  generally  used. 

The  length  of  the  island  is  about  one  hundred  leagues,  and  its  extreme  breadth  varies  from  ten  to 
thirty  leagues.  The  interior  contains  many  lofty  and  rocky  mountains,  and  among  others  the  celebrated 
Adam’s  Peak,  so  termed  by  the  Christians  of  St.  Thomas  and  the  Mahometans,  but  which  in  Singalese 


B 


Q 


INTRODUCTION. 


bears  the  name  of  Himaleh,  and  in  Sanscrit  that  of  Salmalla.  Its  summit  is  visible  at  the  distance  of 
more  than  thirty  leagues,  and  it  is  celebrated  for  possessing  the  print  of  the  Budha’s  foot,  left  on  the  spot 
whence  he  ascended  to  the  Dewa  Loka  heavens.  The  island  is  intersected  by  a chain  of  hills,  which 
divide  it  into  two  parts,  and  which  influence  the  seasons  in  the  same  manner  as  the  Ghauts  in  the 
Dekkan.  Although  the  island  is  so  near  the  equator,  its  climate  is  temperate,  and  it  never  suffers  from 
the  violent  heat  and  drought  which  affect  the  opposite  coast  of  Coromandel. 

The  descriptions  of  ancient  and  modem  writers  represent  Ceylon  as  the  fairest  island  of  the  East ; it 
has  been  termed  the  site  of  Paradise,  the  rich  and  magnificent  land,  the  stones  of  which  are  rubies  and 
sapphires;  where  the  almond-tree  perfumes  the  low  lands  and^wamps;  where  the  cinnamon  scents  the 
forests ; where  the  most  common  plants  breathe  fragrance ; and  where  the  very  gales  which  blow  from  its 
shores  are  proverbially  redolent  of  balmy  sweetness.  Such  is  the  figurative  language  in  which  this 
beautiful  island  is  described.  Its  chief  produce  is  cinnamon ; that  of  the  finest  quality  is  monopolized  by 
the  East  India  Company,  and  this  spice  constitutes  nearly  a moiety  of  the  revenue  of  the  country. 
Another  article  which  may  be  mentioned  as  being  connected  with  the  faitli  of  which  I am  about  to  treat, 
is  the  chank,  a shell  of  a spiral  form,  belonging  to  the  class  buccinium.  These  shells  are  used  in  libations, 
and  they  are  among  the  characteristic  accompaniments  of  the  Budha. 

The  population  of  Ceylon  is  estimated  at  about  one  million  six-hundred  thousand  souls ; the  races 
are  Singalese,  Moormen,  Malabars,  Hindus,  Malays,  and  Europeans.  In  the  interior  there  is  also  a rem- 
nant of  a very  singular  race,  termed  Bedas,  or  Vedas;  they  inhabit  the  woods,  subsisting,  as  hunters,  on 
game  and  the  produce  of  the  forest.  In  their  intercourse  with  the  sovereigns  and  the  inhabitants  of  the 
cities  they  have  ever  preserved  a peculiar  vein  of  lofty  and  untamed  independence ; and  they  arc 
probably  the  relics  of  the  original  inhabitants. 

Ceylon  exhibits  many  remains  of  former  grandeur  and  opulence,  which  attest  the  splendour  of  other 
times,  and  the  successful  cultivation  of  the  arts  and  sciences.  The  northern  frontier  of  the  district  of 
Kandy  is  distinguished  by  enormous  blocks  of  stone  and  colonnades  of  marble,  as  well  as  inscriptions  on 
rocks,  and  bridges,  the  solidity  and  grandeur  of  which  bespeak  a very  advanced  stage  of  the  arts  at  the 
time  of  their  construction.  To  what  era  they  are  to  be  referred,  we  may,  perhaps,  yet  learn,  when  we 
have  acquired  a more  intimate  knowledge  of  the  sacred  books  of  Budhist  literature.  We  will  now  pro- 
ceed to  consider  the  doctrines  and  history,  as  well  as  the  personal  character,  of  the  Budha,  with  whose 
faith  this  island  has  for  so  many  ages  been  associated. 

The  character  of  the  doctrine  of  Budhism,  as  well  as  the  portions  of  its  history,  which  may  be 
gathered  from  t^,e  sacred  books,  so  far  as  they  are  yet  communicated  to  us,  tend  to  involve  the  annals  of 
this  ancient  faith  in  great  obscurity.  It  is  charged  with  excluding  altogether  a Creator  and  Governor  from 
its  system ; but,  if  it  be  capable  of  positive  proof  that  this  is  the  true  meaning  of  the  doctrine,  still 
it  admits,  on  the  other  hand,  the  operation  of  Fate  (called  Damata ),  whereby  much  of  the  necessary 
process  of  conservation,  or  government,  is  infused  into  the  system.  It  is  philosophically  described  as  a 
circle ; for  the  universe  proceeds  upon  the  precise  ideas  developed  in  Ovid : it  arises  in  beauty  and 
excellence,  and  enjoys  a golden  age  of  rectitude  and  peace;  it  deteriorates,  as  it  passes  through  a 
determinate  series  of  changes,  from  its  brightness  and  glory  ; the  stature*  of  its  inhabitants  diminishes, 

" Hence  the  Budhists  are  so  prone  to  represent  their  deities  of  colossal  size,  as  this  very  quality  imports  their  great  or  superlative 
excellence  and  dignity. 


INTRODUCTION. 


3 


and  the  perfection  of  its  fruits  and  every  other  natural  quality  become  proportionably  lessened  and 
impoverished,  by  stated  degrees,  until  the  arrival  of  the  period  of  their  destruction,  for  which  three  agents 
are  periodically  assigned,  namely,  fire,  water,  and  wind.  Each  of  these  causes  has  its  exact  limits ; the 
last  is  the  final  and  grand  cataclysm  which  sweeps  the  whole  system  into  general  destruction.  Such  is 
the  eternally  revolving  circle  of  the  Budhist  scheme,  which,  containing  germs  of  self-existence,  even  after 
this  catastrophe,  exhibits  them  as  again  developed  by  necessity  or  fate,  rolling  spontaneously  onwards,  as 
before,  in  eternally  revolving  changes. 

This  doctrine,  however,  which  appears  clearly  to  be  the  scope  and  tenor  of  Budhism,  is  impugned  in 
some  degree  by  a very  extraordinary  v<ein  of  exhortation,  running  throughout  the  doctrine  of  Gaudma, 
the  present  Budha,  which  manifestly  belongs  to  a later  period,  and  materially  interferes  with  the 
necessarian  portion  of  the  creed.  According  to  the  bana,  or  sermons,  of  the  teacher  Gaudma,  the  moral 
actions  of  his  followers  can  completely  arrest  the  progression  of  the  universe  towards  a periodical 
destruction  ; their  meritorious  deeds  can  occasion  an  increase  of  brightness,  improve  the  state  of  the 
earth’s  products,  and  even  fill  the  heavens,  Dewa  Loka,  with  happy  souls,  on  their  course  through  the 
heavens  of  probation  to  Nirwana.  Such  is  the  scope  of  the  exhortations  of  the  various  portions  of 
doctrine  contained  in  the  most  authentic  manuscripts,  as  well  as  in  those  passages  already  published  in 
the  Asiatic  Researches.  What  then  becomes  of  the  tenet  of  fate,  always  presenting  the  same  worlds  and 
the  same  results  ? and  of  each  system  following  the  exact  prototype  exhibited  in  its  like,  which,  in 
some  portion  of  time,  went  before  it ; and  which,  according  to  Pythagoras,  made  him  a sentient  being, 
capable,  by  the  gift  of  prescience,  of  knowing  his  former  existence  in  a former  state?  These  two 
brandies  of  doctrine,  therefore,  seem  clearly  to  belong  to  two  systems,  and  greatly  to  strengthen  the 
conclusion,  which  a familiarity  with  the  statements  of  this  ancient  faith  has  tended  to  form — that  there 
exists  a striking  mixture  of  primitive  and  modern  doctrine  in  Budhism. 

If  we  pass  from  these  subjects  to  the  Budhist  conceptions  of  their  gods,  we  see  that  these  partake 
of  the  same  imperfect  character:  they  are  great  in  dignity,  and  feeble  in  act;  busied  and  interested  in  the 

9 

affairs  of  men,  without  any  control  over  the  inferior  agencies  of  the  heavens  or  of  the  earth  ; their  parts 
in  the  system,  from  the  very  highest  to  the  lowest,  the  Budha,  the  Maha-bralnna,  the  Sekkraia,  the 
Dewa,  the  Koombandeo,  or  inferior  deities,  and  the  Asuras,  down  to  man,  alike  exhibit  an  imbecility,  a 
want  of  a directive  or  remedial  energy,  in  the  doctrine  of  the  Budha.  When  we  see  the  lavish  care  with 
which  every  portion  of  the  system  is  filled  up  with  agents  and  a machinery  of  animated  intelligences, 
and  the  very  interesting  scheme  of  its  moral  duties,  it  seems  irresistibly  forced  upon  our  minds  that 
Budhism,  as  now  existing,  is,  in  fact,  two  systems  of  different  eras,  wrought  into  each  other  at  some 
period  of  the  revival  of  the  faith  by  an  ambitious  or  zealous  teacher,  who  has  endeavoured  to  supply 
the  lack  of  a supreme  Creator  and  Governor  by  a new  table  of  duties  and  motives,  drawn  from  the 
conscience,  and  acting  upon  man  through  the  hopes  and  fears  of  that  divine  monitor.  Hence  the  gods 
(if  any  such  beings  there  literally  are  in  the  system)  are  converted  into  a species  of  deified  mortals,  or 
demon-gods,  the  bodies  of  eminently  pious  men,  exalted  for  their  good  deeds  to  the  Dewa  Loka,  or  stars; 
and  such  are  the  oldest  ideas  of  Greek  philosophy,  as  transmitted  to  us  in  the  Theogony  of  Hesiod : — 
“ When  the  mortal  remains  of  those  who  flourished  during  the  golden  age  were  hidden  beneath  the  earth, 
their  souls  became  beneficent  demons,  still  hovering  over  the  world  which  they  had  once  inhabited,  and 
still  watching  as  guardians  over  the  affairs  of  men.  These,  clothed  in  thin  air,  and  rapidly  flitting 

B 2 


4 


INTRODUCTION. 


through  every  region  of  the  earth,  possess  the  royal  privilege  of  conferring  riches  and  of  administering 
justice.”* 

In  conformity  with  this  quotation  is  the  meaning  of  the  term  God , when  used  in  Budhist  doctrine; 
as  the  word,  which  has  been  usually  translated  gods,  means  therein  only  “ those  who  enjoy  happiness,” 
who  have  acquired  the  privileged  bliss  of  the  heavens,  and  proceeded  from  man  to  the  higher  state,  but 
yet  possess  many  senses  in  common  with  man,  however  exalted  in  lustre  and  expanded  in  magnitude. 
Their  increase  of  dignity  is,  indeed,  invariably  indicated  by  a # more  splendid  form  and  a more  gigantic 
stature;  and  hence  the  colossal  bulk  of  not  only  the  images  of  Gaudma,  but  the  more  ancient  colossal 
figures,  the  Budhist  forms  of  Egypt,  as  embodied  in  the  Memnonian  statues  of  the  plain  of  Thebes. 

In  treating  of  Budhism  therefore,  it  is  not  to  be  wondered  at,  if  there  should  be  found  a demonstra- 
tion of  conflicting  doctrines,  because  it  is  grounded  upon  the  records  of  a faith,  which  exhibits,  in  its 
material  scheme  of  the  universe,  periodical  cycles  of  vast  series  of  ages  filled  with  events,  and  treats  of 
historical  epochs  when  its  system  was  presided  over  by  former  Budhas,  both  of  them  referring  to  a totally 
distinct  class  of  subjects  from  what  we  have  now  before  us  to  treat  of,  namely,  the  universe,  the  deities, 
and  the  events  belonging  to  the  Budha  Gaudma  of  the  present  system,  which  scheme  comprises  the 
comparatively  modern  period  from  about  550  years  before  Christ  to  the  present  time,  or  a space  of  about 
2370  years.  As  the  changes  which  have  taken  place  in  Budhism  are  evidently  not  such  as  have 
been  silently  brought  about  by  time,  or  the  introduction  of  more  enlightened  views,  but  the  results 
of  persecution  and  exile,  it  follows,  that  whatever  has  been  grafted  upon  it,  in  the  modern  or  later 
periods,  is  often  of  a very  motley  and  heterogeneous  quality,  preserved  more  for  some  point  of 
superstitious  reverence,  than  as  benefiting  the  general  edifice  of  modern  Budhism.  In  the  accounts  which 
are  extant  of  the  three  Budhas  who  have  preceded  Gaudma,  we  may  observe  many  coincidences,  which 
strengthen  the  supposition  that  these  doctrines  were  borrowed  from,  and  grounded  on,  older  traditions, 
carrying  back  the  mind  into  the  earliest  periods  of  the  history  of  the  human  race. 

The  books  which  contain  these  details  declare  that  there  are  three  kinds  of  Budhas ; the  Laotouras, 

« 

or  supreme,  the  Passes,  and  Arihats.  There  is  nothing  in  the  world  superior  to  the  Laotouras.  A calpe, 
or  age,  is  blessed,  according  to  the  Laotoura  Budhas,  who  in  the  course  of  it  visit  the  earth  ; and  as  the 
number  is  limited  to  five,  we  are  in  a favoured  period,  for  already  four  Budhas,  namely,  Maha-devanam, 
Poorana  Goutama,  Deepankara,  and  Gaudma,  are  arrived  at  Nirwana.  The  fifth  Budha  will  appear 
at  the  expiration  of  the  five  thousand  years  which  are  assigned  to  the  present  Budha-verouse.f  The 
annals  of  Budhism  also  make  mention  of  twenty-two  Laotoura  Budhas,  who  are  supreme  in  the  system, 
but  of  whose  timos  no  trace  has  been  found  in  history.  The  Passi  Budhas,  and  the  Arihats  or  Rahatoons, 
are  deified  disciples  or  followers : such  are  the  recognised  and  privileged  individuals,  who,  in  this 
doctrine,  rank  among  the  Budhas.  To  show  how  much  Budhism  borrows  from  the  materials  of 
patriarchal  events,  the  following  transcript  is  given  verbatim  from  a literal  translation  of  a portion  of  the 
Maha-vansi,  one  of  the  most  revered  of  their  sacred  books,  and  held  by  them  to  contain  the  purest 
doctrines.  It  exhibits  a very  important  portion  of  the  history  which  we  can  trace  of  the  faith,  and  is  of 
consequence,  as  it  states  the  descents  to  the  Raja  Wessantara,  who  is  a manifestation  of  Gaudma. 


• Op.  et  Dies,  lib.  i.  120,  125. 

+ Gaudma  is  he  by  whose  laws  the  world  is  governed,  and  will  be  governed  for  2057  years,  from  the  1st  of  May,  1001,  of  the 
Christian  era.  It  is  2344  years  since  the  Budha  became  Nirwana:  this  era  is  called  Budha- verouse. 


INTRODUCTION. 


5 


“ In  the  former  tirae  our  Sracious  Budlla.  who  overcame  the  five  deadly  sins,  having  seen  the  Budha 
Deepankara,  expressed  a wish  to  attain  the  state  of  Budha,  to  save  living  beings,  as  twenty-four 
preceding  Budhas  had  done.  Having  obtained  their  assent,  and  having  performed  charities  of  various 
kinds,  he  became  sanctified  and  omniscient.  He  is  the  Budha,  the  most  high  Lord  Goutama,  who 
redeemed  living  beings  from  all  their  miseries.  This  personage,  during  his  existence  as  Wessa’ntara, 
continued  in  his  usual  charitable  and  pious  condition ; and  at  length  removed  to  the  life  in  the  Dewa 
Loka,  called  Toisite  Pura,  where  he  enjoyed  happiness. 

“ Whereas  our  Budlla  is  suPerior  to  Agazika-muni,  Annagarika-muni,  Seka-muni,  Asseka-muni, 
Aragatta-muni,  and  Pratyeka-muni,  1*  is  called  Maha-muni.  He  descended  from  the  royal  family  of 
Maha-sammata;  the  genealogy  is  as  follows  :-In  the  time  called  the  first  antagkcdpa  of  Maha-baddra 
there  was  a king  called  Maha-sammata,  the  son  of  the  Sun,  who  came  into  the  world  by  the  operation 
named  opapatika;  he  was  chosen  king  by  the  general  voice  of  the  people;  he  had  the  power  of  going 
through  the  air;  a smell  of  sandal  wood  proceeded  from  his  person,  which  reached  to  the  distance  of 
four  gows;  from  his  mouth  issued  the  odour  of  the  flower  mahanel,  which  reached  to  the  distance  of 
one  yodoon.  * * * 

“ This  king  ruled  over  the  large  portion  of  the  earth  called  Damba  Dewa  in  prosperity,  peace,  and 
happiness,  during  the  space  of  an  assankaya*  of  years.  At  that  time  all  beings  lived  an  assanlcaya  of 
years;  no  sin  was  there  in  the  world:  the  immense  duration  of  their  life  caused  men  to  forget  their  birth 
and  to  be  unmindful  of  death ; they  knew  not  the  infirmities  of  life , nor  the  miseries  of  the  world.  They 
derided  the  very  deities , as  these  were  not  the  fortunate  partakers  of  such  a length  of  days;  so  that  at  that 
time  the  life  of  mankind  in  this  world  outlasted  the  existence  of  the  gods.  Irrational  animals  had  also  their 
kings  in  those  days;  the  narration  of  these  facts  appears  in  the  ancient  histories. 

“ After  the  King  Maha-sammata,  his  son  Rojanam-raja  reigned  also  during  an  assankaya  of  years ; 
his  son  Wararojanam-raja  also  reigned  for  the  same  number  of  years;  his  son  Maha-mandatoo  Chackra- 
warty-raja  was  a great  and  potent  monarch. 

“ He  struck  with  his  right  hand  on  the  ground,  saying — ‘ Behold  the  heavens !’  and  exclaimed,  ‘ O ! 
ye  gods  ! I am  not  satisfied  with  the  happiness  of  the  world  granted  to  mankind  ; give  me  the  happiness 
of  the  gods,  if  I deserve  it.’  Upon  which  the  gods  caused  gold  to  fall  like  rain  within  the  circum- 
ference of  thirty-six  ijodoons  to  the  height  of  the  knee ; and  this  king,  having  enjoyed  great  happiness 
in  the  world  of  mankind,  ascended  in  that  state  of  life  to  the  world  of  the  gods,  where,  having  enjoyed 
the  happiness  of  the  gods  for  the  space  of  129  kale,  and  6,000,000  years,  he  descended  to  the  world  of 
mankind,  and  reigned  altogether  an  assankaya  of  years. 

“ His  son  W aramandatanam-raja  reigned  an  assankaya  of  years.  His  son  Charanam-raja  reigned 
also  an  assankaya  of  years.  His  son  Upacharanam-raja  also  reigned  an  assankaya  of  years.  His  son 
Chatiyanam-raja  also  reigned  an  assankaya  of  years.  This  king  resolved  to  appoint  the  Bramin  Corakam- 
bakanam-bamoona,  who  was  bred  up  at  the  same  school  with  him,  to  the  situation  of  the  king’s  supreme 
adviser,  deceiving  him  by  a falsehood  as  being  senior  to  the  king’s  adviser  Capilanam-puro-hitayan ; 
which  resolution  being  spread  through  the  realm,  the  inhabitants  crowded  from  all  quarters,  saying — 

‘ We  will  see  this  day  what  falsehood  is,  whether  it  is  white,  black,  red,  or  blue.*  On  this  occasion  the 

• A sanka,  or  assanka , is  a number  of  yea&  amounting  to  a unit  with  sixty-three  ciphers  after  it ; all  immensely  long  periods 
are  termed  assanka. 


INTRODUCTION. 


6 

Seer  Capilanam-maha-irshan  interfered  to  prevent  the  execution  of  the  king’s  resolution,  but  it  was  in 
vain.  So  falsehood  came  into  the  world ; the  king  and  his  city  were  swallowed  up  by  the  earth. 

“ This  king  had  five  sons,  and,  by  the  power  of  Capilanam-Irshan,  one  of  them  reigned  in  the  region 
Hastipooraya,  one  in  Aswapooraya,  one  in  Sinhapooraya,  one  in  Daddarapooraya,  and  the  others  in 
Panchalanoowaraya.  Their  history  appears  in  the  book  called  Chatiya-ja-takaya ; and  know  ye  that  at 
this  period,  from  the  aforesaid  wickedness,  falsehood  came  first  into  the  world,  and  since  that  time  the 
kincrs  have  forfeited  the  divine  assistance. 

“ Moowalanam-raja,  the  eldest  son  of  the  King  Chatiya-raja,  who  succeeded  his  father,  being  terrified 
with  the  misfortune  of  his  father,  reigned  for  the  public  welfare  and  prosperity,  so  that  his  reign  was 
an  assanhaya  of  years.  His  son  Mooclialindanam-raja  reigned  also  an  assanhaya  of  years.  His  son 
Sagaranam-raja  reigned  an  assanhaya  of  years ; he  had  about  sixty  thousand  sons,  who  having  divided 
Jambu-dweepa  among  themselves,  each  of  them  reigned  in  separate  cities ; and,  after  a great  number  of 
years,  their  descendants  became  unknown  to  each  other,  by  which  arose  various  royal  families  from  their 
descendants,  but  in  the  beginning  all  the  kings  were  of  the  royal  class  called  Maha-sammata. 

“ The  King  Sagara,  who  was  the  eldest  amongst  the  sixty  thousand  kings,  reigned  an  assanhaya  of 
years ; his  son  King  B'harata  reigned  also  an  assanhaya  of  years ; his  son  Bageerata  reigned  the  same 
number  of  years ; his  son  itoochy  reigned  the  same  number  of  years ; his  son  Soroochy  reigned  the 
same  number  of  years;  his  son  Purtapa  reigned  the  same  number  of  years;  his  son  Maha-purtapa 
reigned  the  same  number  of  years.  This  king  ordered  his  own  son,  Prince  Dampal,  to  be  slain  at  the 
age  of  seven  months,  because  the  queen,  having  the  child  on  her  lap,  did  not  rise  from  her  seat  when 
the  king  came  in ; and  immediately  after  the  earth  opened,  and  the  king  was  swallowed  up,  and  was 
cast  into  hell ; and  since  that  period  the  crime  of  murder  has  prevailed  in  the  world ; and  as  crimes  so 
produced  were  always  avoided  by  the  kings,  they  did  not  lessen  their  term  of  life,  but  they  lost  their 
bodily  beauty.” 

We  have  then  details  of  a succession  of  twenty-eight  kings  to  Asmat,  when  the  history 
proceeds : — 

“ The  following  kings  by  degrees  decrease  in  age  and  beauty. 

“ The  sons  and  grandsons  of  the  last-mentioned  King  Asmat  did  not  attain  the  age  of  an  assanhaya , 
but  did  to  the  hale. 

“ The  first  gray  hair  appeared  upon  him,  and  on  seeing  it  he  resigned  his  throne  to  his  son 
Mak’ha-dewa,  and  retired  to  a hermitage,  and  thence  he  transmigrated  into  the  heaven  called  Brahma 
Loka ; and  since^  that  time  the  royal  title  of  Maha-sammata  has  been  changed  into  the  title  of 
Mak’ha-dewa. 

“ With  this  title  of  Mak’ha-dewa  there  were  84,000  kings  from  the  descendants  of  each  other,  all  of 
whom,  on  seeing  the  gray  hair,  retired  to  a hermitage,  in  pursuance  of  the  practice  of  the  former  kings, 
and  afterward  transmigrated  into  the  heaven  Brahma  Loka ; but  the  succeeding  kings  did  not  retire  to 
the  hermitage,  though  they  felt  the  infirmity  of  old  age  in  a greater  degree,  and  the  title  of  Mak’ha- 
dewa  was  changed  into  the  title  of  Assoka ; and  the  son  of  the  last  King  Calaranja-naka  was  Assoka : 
his  son  bore  the  title  of  Okkaka,  since  which  time  the  royal  generation  was  called  the  Okkaka  tribe. 

“ The  first  king  of  this  tribe  was  our  gracious  Budha,  in  his  former  existence  as  King  Cusa;  after 
him  100,000  kings  of  this  tribe  named  Dilipaya,  Bagooya,  Anjaya,  Assarat’haya,  Ramaya,  &c.  kc. 


INTRODUCTION. 


7 


reigned  by  that  title,  some  50,000  years,  some  40,000  years,  some  30,000  years,  and  so  on  in  a de- 
creasing ratio. 

“ In  succession  to  these  kings  came  to  reign  King  Biteesadakkaka ; his  successors  from  time  to  time 
were  100,000  kings  named  Udayab’haddaya,  Dananjaya,  Corawyaya,  Wedageya,  Sanjaya,  Wessantara, 
Singhawahanaye,  &c.  &c.  Their  age  was  10,000  years  and  downward,”  kc.  kc.* 

The  length  of  the  preceding  extract  will,  it  is  presumed,  be  amply  compensated  by  the  important 
facts  which  it  establishes,  that  the  sacretj  books  enter  into  very  material  points  of  the  early  history  of  the 
human  race.  The  lengthened  period  of  men's  lives , the  non-existence  of  sin , the  rationality  of  the  animal 
tribes,  the  extraordinary  ascension  of  flfaha-mandatoo  Chaclcrawarty-raja  in  a living  state  to  the  heavens, 
or  Dewa  Loka,  and  the  introduction  of  falsehood  and  murder  into  the  world,  as  well  also  as  the  rebellion 
of  men  against  the  gods,  proceeding,  as  the  Budhist  writings  declare,  from  their  pride  and  reliance  on  their 
longevity,  are  clearly  events  which  stand  recorded  in  antediluvian  history. 

If  in  the  foregoing  quotations  we  may  trace  such  interesting  allusions  to  the  narratives,  which  are 
among  the  earliest  and  most  important  traditions  of  our  race,  in  the  incidents  of  the  life  of  W essantara- 
raja,  and  other  exemplars  of  the  Budha,  we  have  also  precise  and  valuable  information  conveyed  upon  the 
opinions  which  their  doctrine  inculcated  respecting  such  abstruse  questions,  as  the  doctrine  of  emanation, 
refusion,  the  eternity  of  matter,  the  quality  of  non-resistance,  non-action,  and  the  other  subtle 
tenets  of  their  refined  ratiocinations,  by  which  the  origin  of  ascetic  habits,  and  their  value  and  tendency 
in  the  scale  of  spiritual  attainments,  may  be  deduced  with  a clearness  which  no  existing  proofs  have 
hitherto  established.  “ The  votaries  of  Hinduism,”  as  Mr.  Ward  admirably  illustrates  it,  “ believe  there 
is  one  God,  so  emphatically  abstracted  in  his  own  essence,  that  he  is  ‘The  Unknown,’  and  is  con- 
sequently neither  the  object  of  worship,  of  hope,  nor  of  love,  nor  of  fear ; — that  he  is  even  destitute  of 
intelligence,  and  remains  in  a state  of  profound  repose ; — that  at  times  he  assumes  what  is  called  his 
energy,  and  creates  worlds; — that  this  being  is  individuated , and  takes  possession  of  every  form  in 
matter ; — and  that  the  largest  partakers  of  the  sacred  energy  are  the  gods,  the  giants,  the  Brahmins,  and 
devout  ascetics.” 

This  short  statement,  as  Mr.  Ward  justly  observes,  contains  the  lineaments  of  all  the  pagan 
doctrines  of  the  East,  and  it  will  be  found  to  coincide  exactly  witli  the  subsequent  narrations. 

To  possess  a large  share  of  the  divine  energy  is  the  prominent  claim  of  every  sect,  and  the  great 
bulk  of  the  worshippers  of  a god  revealed  under  such  chilling  and  impervious  attributes  most  eagerh 
court  the  notion  of  some  tangible  shape,  in  which  the  benefits  they  hope  for,  and  the  fa\our  and 
protection  which  they  are  aware  that  they  need,  may  be  showered  upon  them ; hence  ascetics,  who, 
through  the  rigour  and  austerities  of  a life  of  penance,  pretend  to  have  annihilated  mortal  corruption, 
and  won  for  themselves  a corresponding  influx  of  the  divine  nature,  become  naturally  objects  of  particular 
adoration.  Neither  the  Budha  nor  any  other  founder  of  a sect  would  have  impressed  his  followers  with 
an  adequate  idea  of  his  holiness,  without  this  notion,  and  without  having  become  a hermit,  and  practised 

• According  to  the  information  prefixed  in  a manuscript  note  by  the  translator,  Raja-pakse,  a well-known  intelligent  native  of  Ceylon, 
the  Maha-vansi,  from  which  the  above  passage  is  extracted,  is  one  of  the  most  esteemed  of  all  the  sacred  books  of  his  countrymen,  and 
has  the  character  of  being  among  the  oldest  of  their  writings,  being  throughout  composed  in  Palee,  the  sacred  Budhist  language.  This 
work  has  been  so  carefully  preserved,  that  but  slight  differences  are  observable  between  the  most  ancient  and  most  modern  copies  ; it 
does  not  appear  at  what  period  it  was  composed,  but  it  has  been  in  existence  from  the  period  that  the  books  of  Ceylon  were  originally 
written,  and  it  contains  “ the  doctrine,  race,  and  lineage  of  Budha,”  and  is,  in  fact,  the  religion  and  history  of  Budhism. 


8 


INTRODUCTION. 


the  habits  of  ascetic  life,  to  which  such  persons  owe  their  success  while  living,  and  their  deification. 
Foremost  among  the  pretensions  of  every  aspirant  to  the  dignity  of  the  Budhaship  is  the  faculty  of 
working  miracles,  and  conferring  spiritual  privileges,  as  the  test  of  a divine  mission ; and,  consequently, 
the  records  of  every  Budha  enter  largely  into  this  necessary  claim.  But  there  is  also  in  Budhisin  a not 
less  curious  and  interesting  intermixture  of  doctrine,  respecting  the  passive  qualities  manifested  in  the 
penances  and  sufferings  of  the  ascetics,  who  thereby  appropriate  to  themselves  a participation  in,  or 
conformity  with,  the  divine  energy,  in  an  inert  state  of  abstraction  and  repose.  A supposition  that  such 
energy  slumbers  in  a state  of  weakened  intellect  is  the  ground  of  the  respect  paid  throughout  the  East  to 
idiots  and  to  the  imbecile,  while  any  glimmering  of  meaning  in  their  incoherent  sentences  is  caught  up 
as  the  flashing  forth  of  some  communicated  divine  emanation. 

Having  briefly  touched  on  these  portions  of  the  doctrines,  which  may  be  considered  to  bear  a 
reference  to  the  earliest  traditions,  it  will  be  desirable  in  the  next  place  to  state  what  are  the  dates  and 
facts  concerning  the  origin  of  the  system  of  Budhism  subsisting  at  this  time;  and  the  doctrine  of 
Gaudma,  as  a compendium  of  a later  system,  combining  much  of  history  with  its  fables,  will  reward  our 
attention,  by  exhibiting  established  facts  which  demonstrate  them  to  be  partly  histories,  whence,  by 
investigation,  it  may  confidently  be  hoped,  that  assistance  may  be  derived  for  the  rectification  of  the 
historical  epochs  of  southern  India,*  with  which  country  Budhism  has  evidently  been  closely  and 
politically  united. 

Ceylon  is  the  theatre  of  Gaudma’s  actions  and  existence.  The  security  of  its  insular  position,  its 
having  been  the  chosen  scene  of  the  Budha’s  preaching  and  miracles,  its  also  becoming  a retreat  and 
asylum  for  the  persecuted  Budhists  when  they  were  driven  from  the  peninsula ; all  these  data  point  to 
this  celebrated  island  as  the  precise  region  whence  we  may  hope  to  derive  the  fullest  details  of  its  system 
of  history  and  doctrine.  There  are  several  epochs  in  Budhist  history  ; the  first  stage  is  the  Budhism 
anterior  to  the  Budhas  of  the  present  calpe , the  second  is  the  present  era. 

The  annals  of  historic  record,  which  are  preserved  in  Ceylon,  while  they  dwell  in  detail  upon  the 
events  and  history  appertaining  to  the  era  of  the  Budha  Gaudma,  the  chief  object  of  Singalese 
veneration,  and  the  subject  of  the  present  work,  clearly  refer  also  to  three  anterior  and  distinctly  separate 
periods  of  time,  when  the  ancient  Budhist  faith  exercised  an  extensive  sway — 1st,  under  Maha-devanam 
Budha ; 2ndly,  Poorana  Goutama  Budha ; 3dly,  Deepankara  Budha : to  these  succeeded  Gaudma 
Budha,  the  ruler  and  teacher  of  the  era  now  in  progress,  which  he  predicted  should  last  for  5000  years 
from  the  period  in  which  he  left  the  world ; at  the  expiration  of  which  time  a divine  being,  now  reposing, 
as  the  previous  Budhas  had  done,  anterior  to  their  exaltation  in  the  heaven  Toisite,  the  Budha  Maitri, 
will  be  born  into  the  world,  and  give  a new  doctrine  and  a new  era. 


* This  remark  is  indeed  converted  into  reality  by  the  appearance,  in  the  fifteenth  volume  of  the  Asiatic  Researches,  of  the  first 
historical  work  of  India,  hitherto  submitted  to  the  notice  of  European  research.  May  this  most  interesting  record  be  the  precursor  of  a 
series  of  similar  notices,  as  certainly  our  actual  knowledge  is  more  advanced  by  one  positively  original  document  of  this  nature,  than  by 
any  other  source  of  Eastern  study.  Mr.  Wilson’s  elaborate  and  useful  elucidations  merit  the  closest  investigation,  as  they  open 
coincidences  of  history  and  geography  which  become  highly  valuable  ; and  the  more  so,  as  in  the  very  interesting  reference  which  the 
Cashmir  manuscript  makes  to  the  Sangayanas,  or  missions  for  the  propagation  of  the  Budha  faith,  as  well  as  its  establishment  in 
Cashmir,  it  is  completely  in  accordance  with  other  historical  works,  of  far  more  extended  detail,  and  more  copious  materials  of 
illustration ; namely,  the  original  histories  of  Ceylon.  The  Maha-vansi  contains  a chapter  on  the  Sangayana,  or  mission  to  Cashmir, 
with  the  name  of  the  Budha  Rabat,  who  accomplished  the  establishment  of  their  faith,  not  only  in  Cashmir,  but  in  Candahar,  and  other 
adjacent  parts. 


INTRODUCTION. 


i) 


The  history  of  Budlusm,  of  which  we  have  to  treat,  thus  resolves  itself  into  two  heads,  namely— 1st 
ancient  portion,  which  comprehends  the  eras  of  the  three  Budhas  preceding  Gaudma,  or  the  time  of 
comparatively  modern  history;  Sndly.  The  latter,  or  comparatively  modern  period,  from  1000  years 
before  Christ  (at  which  time  the  appearance  of  Sakia  Sinha  is  supposed  to  have  taken  place),  to  th 
establishment  of  the  present  faith  of  Ceylon,  the  work  of  the  Gaudma  Budlia,  who  existed  nearly  45  0 
years  later,  or  about  550  years  before  Christ.  About  100  years  later  arose  in  Ceylon,  Wijya  Sinha,  who 
seated  himself  on  the  throne  as  an  incarnation  of  the  Budha,  and  with  whom  the  histories  commence 
the  line  of  kings.  A further  point  of  material  importance  to  the  history  of  this  faith  is,  to  suggest  a 
probable  solution  of  the  great  and  inextinguishable  hatred  of  the  Brahminists  against  the  Budhists, 
which  influenced  the  fortunes  of  India,  and  commenced  an  enmity  that  neither  time  nor  circumstance  can 
heal.  The  object  of  the  following  remarks  will  therefore  be  to  present,  as  briefly  as  the  subject  will 
permit,  and  as  clearly  as  the  scattered  fragments  of  history  will  warrant,  the  most  authentic  facts  and 
reasonings  upon  these  matters.  Of  the  times  of  the  three  most  ancient  Budhas  nothing  can  be  said 
beyond  the  few  hints  which  the  reader  may  select  from  the  papers  of  Dr.  Buchanan  in  the  Asiatic 
Researches;  all  that  is  known  of  their  history  refers  to  their  approval  and  recognition  of  Gaudma  as 
their  successor  in  the  Budhaship.  Many  interesting  references  and  allusions#to  ancient  practices,  such  as 
levelling  the  roads  at  their  approach,  strewing  the  earth  with  white  sand  and  with  flowers  in  their 
honour,  arise  to  notice  in  the  following  pages.  There  is  certainly  ground  to  hope  that  the  Budhist  books, 
as  we  become  better  acquainted  with  them,  may  add  to  our  knowledge  of  the  history  of  these  very 
remote  times,  seeing  that  the  foregoing  extracts  exhibit  such  striking  traces  of  patriarchal  history. 

Whether  Budlusm  preceded  the  system  of  Brahminism  in  India,  or,  in  other  words,  which  was  the 
parent  stock  of  the  two  systems,  it  would  be  very  improper  to  presume  to  decide,  considering  how 
imperfectly  we  are  acquainted  with  the  Budhist  writings,  which  claim  a high  antiquity,  and  which,  if 
we  may  judge  from  the  extracts  of  the  Maha-vansi,  possess  a simplicity  of  reference  to  early  events 
indicative  of  genuine  history.  On  the  subject  of  estimating  the  pretensions  of  these  two  faiths  from  their 
writings,  there  are  some  remarks  of  INI.  Joinville’s,  so  judicious,  that  I cannot  refrain  from  presenting  them 
briefly  to  the  reader “ We  find  the  religion  of  the  Budha  in  ancient  times,  extending  from  the  north  of 
Tartary  to  Ceylon,  and  from  the  Indies  to  Siam;  in  the  same  manner  we  see  that  of  Brahma  followed 
in  the  same  countries,  and  for  as  long  a space  of  time.  It  is,  therefore,  not  in  history , but  in  the  precepts 
of  the  two  religions,  that  are  to  be  found  the  data  by  which  to  decide  this  question.  In  the  opinion  of  the 
Budhists  there  has  been  no  creation ; Maha-brahma,  all  the  Sekkraia  and  Brahmas,  have  existed  from 
all  time,  and  so  have  the  worlds,  the  gods,  the  human  race,  and  all  the  animated  beingf.  The  Brahmins 
calculate  the  antiquity  of  the  world  beyond  what  can  be  conceived  by  the  most  extravagant  mind ; but 
these  calculations  are  supported  by  astronomical  periods,  ingeniously  combined  together.  As  the  world 
never  was  created,  in  the  opinion  of  the  Budhists,  their  calculations  only  relate  to  the  immense  number 
of  transmigrations  of  Gaudma,  from  the  time  he  first  thought  of  becoming  Budha,  till  that  when  he 
attained  Nirwana ; and  this  period  they  compute  at  a unit  followed  by  sixty-three  ciphers,  being  the 
result  of  some  combinations,  so  intricate,  that  it  may  be  easily  imagined  that  very  few  of  their  wise 
men  understand  them.  There  are  traces,  however,  of  the  Braliminic  calculations  to  be  found  in  those 
of  the  Budhists.  The  Brahmins  and  Budhists  are  equally  bigoted  and  extravagant,  with  this 
difference,  that  in  the  former  religion  are  found  very  deep  ideas  of  astronomy,  in  the  latter,  none.  I 


1 


10 


INTRODUCTION. 


have,  till  now,  searched  in  vain  for  an  instructive  work  in  Singalese,  relative  to  the  heavenly  bodies,  and 
have  found  only  uninteresting  speculations  on  the  influence  of  the  stars  upon  the  affairs  of  the  world. 
The  Brahmins  respect  fire,  the  Budhists  do  not.  The  former  eat  of  no  animal,  the  latter  are  restricted 
only  to  the  not  partaking  of  the  flesh  of  nine,  of  which  the  ox  is  the  principal.  1 am  rather  of  opinion, 
upon  a comparison  of  the  two  religions,  that  that  of  Budha  is  the  more  ancient,  for  the  following 
reasons : — The  religion  of  Budha  having  extended  itself,  in  very  remote  times,  through  every  part  of 
India,  was  in  many  respects  monstrous  and  unformed.  An  uncreated  world,  and  mortal  souls,  are  ideas 
to  be  held  only  in  an  infant  state  of  society,  and  as  society  advances,  such  ideas  must  vanish.  A fortiori , 
they  cannot  be  established  in  opposition  to  a religion  already  prevailing  in  a country,  the  fundamental 
articles  of  which  are,  the  creation  of  the  world,  and  the  immortality  of  the  soul.  Ideas  in  opposition  to 
all  religion  cannot  gain  ground,  at  least  cannot  make  head,  when  there  is  already  an  established  faith ; 
whence  it  is  fair  to  infer,  that  if  Budhism  could  not  have  established  itself  among  the  Brahmins,  and  if 
it  has  been  established  in  their  country,  it  must  be  the  more  ancient  of  the  two.  In  looking  into  the 
Singalese  hooks,  we  find  several  striking  resemblances  between  their  astronomical  system,  and  that  of 
the  Brahmins;  for  instance,  we  see  the  number  432,  followed  by  any  number  (no  matter  how  great)  of 
ciphers,  which,  among  the  Indians,  is  the  result  of  certain  combinations  in  the  movements  of  the 
heavenly  bodies — combinations  which  agree  almost  exactly  with  the  calculations  founded  on  Newton’s 
system.  This  same  number  432,  among  the  Budhists,  is  no  longer  the  result  of  astronomical  combina- 
tions, but  of  arithmetical  ones,  arranged  expressly  to  obtain  it.  The  Budhists  have  only  a mechanical 
knowledge  of  it,  and  generally  attach  sixty  ciphers  to  it ; whereas,  the  Brahmins  put  but  three  or  four. 
Had  the  former  received  it  from  the  latter,  they  would  have  either  kept  it  entirely,  or  changed  it 
entirely,  in  its  mystico-numeric  details,  so  that  the  number  432  would  either  have  been  kept  in  its 
original  purity,  or  entirely  lost ; but  if,  on  the  contrary,  they  transmitted  the  science  to  the  Brahmins, 
as  in  the  unfortunate  wars  which  they  must  have  suffered  in  the  reformation  by  the  Brahmins,  they 
were  driven  from  their  country,  and  their  effects,  books,  observatories,  and  astronomical  tables,  were 
lost — they  could  preserve  only  a loose  remembrance  of  their  former  science ; for  they  were  obliged  to 
wander  a long  time  before  they  could  unite  in  a body,  either  in  Ceylon  or  Siam.  Hence,  is  it  not 
evident  that  the  Budhists  were  possessed  of  astronomy  before  the  Brahmins  ? and  as  both  religion  and 
astronomy  are  united,  is  it  not  probable  that  the  religion  of  the  Budhists  is  the  more  ancient  ?” 

For  these,  and  other  ingenious  reasons,  to  demonstrate  that  the  Budhists  were  possessed  of  astronomy 
before  the  Brahminists,  and  that  the  latter  were  the  reformers,  and  consequently  the  later  sect,  the 
Asiatic  Researched  * may  be  usefully  consulted.  It  is  manifest  that  the  most  important  portion  of  the 
history  of  Budhism,  next  to  its  rise,  is  the  period  of  its  supremacy  over  southern  India,  at  the  very 
distant  period  of  time  when  the  empire  of  Magadha,  and  other  independent  states,  flourished.  An 
authentic  history  of  this  interesting  epoch  would  enlighten  us  as  to  the  true  cause  of  that  fierce  and 
inextinguishable  hatred  on  the  part  of  the  Brahmins  towards  the  Budhists,  which,  after  ages  of  wars, 
finally  drove  the  latter  from  India,  and  extirpated  them  from  the  Peninsula,  which  hatred,  moreover, 
still  remains  unchanged.  As  the  solution  of  this  antipathy  would  greatly  promote  a better  knowledge 
of  the  connexion  between  the  periods  of  history  of  ancient  and  modern  Budhism,  the  subject  will 


Asiatic  Researches,  vii.  400,  et  seq. 


INTRODUCTION. 


11 


be  adverted  to,  after  a brief  sketch  has  been  exhibited  of  the  three  most  celebrated  characters  of 
this  sect,  which  are  referred  to  in  comparatively  modern  times.  These  are  Sakia  or  Xaca  Sinlia, 
about  1000  years  before  Christ;  Gaudma  Budha,  about  550  years  before  Christ;  and  Wijya  Sinlia* 
in  the  year  succeeding  the  death  of  Gaudma.  The  doctrines  of  a faith  which  treats  all  souls  as  immortal, 
and  teaches  that  they  animate  successively  different  forms  upon  the  theatre  of  the  world  throughout  its 
progressive  stages  of  history  ; which  also  declares  that  it  is  from  the  state  of  man  only  that  a Budha  can 
arise;  open  such  a field  of  enterprise  to  any  follower  of  sufficient  daring,  that  it  will  excite  no  wonder 
that  it  should  appear  to  have  been  the  practice  of  ambitious  spirits,  both  in  former  and  in  modern  times, f 
to  claim  for  themselves  the  attributes  of  a Budha,  and  to  apply  them  successfully  to  the  purposes  of 
personal  aggrandisement.  Of  Sakia  Sinha,  and  of  Wijya  Sinlia,  we  know  comparatively  little.  The 
Budha  Gaudma  may,  however,  be  reckoned  among  the  most  distinguished  founders  of  a faith,  for  he 
succeeded  in  engrafting  his  doctrine  upon  the  ancient  system  of  Budhism  with  the  most  signal  success, 
and  in  establishing  the  predominant  influence  of  his  code  and  name  wherever  the  patronymic  Budha  was 
revered  throughout  the  East. 

The  most  important  particulars  that  we  can  trace  of  Sakia,  or  Xaca,  and  his  successors,  we  owe  to 
LI.  Abel  Remusat,  who  has  presented  us,  in  the  Melanges  Asiatiques  (tome  i.  p.  113),  with  an  interesting 
piece  of  history,  connecting  a successive  series  of  thirty-two  patriarchs  or  feachers  of  Budhist  doctrine, 
and  occupying  the  space  of  time  from  1000  years  before  Christ  to  the  year  713  of  the  Christian  era, 
which  may  furnish  some  of  the  most  useful  approximations  towards  verifying  the  history  of  Budhism  as 
we  become  more  fully  acquainted  with  its  statements. 

Sakia  Sinha  was  manifestly  a warrior,  and  probably  a Tartar,  or  native  of  the  northern  regions,  the 
Scythia  of  the  ancients,  where  the  Budha  was  reverenced ; and  as  other  sources  of  history  appear  to 
intimate  that  a great  change  or  revolution  was  taking  place  about  this  time,  Sakia  could  pursue  no  surer 
way  to  success  than  by  arrogating  to  himself  the  rank  and  honour  of  a Budha.  In  unison  with  this  era 
given  by  the  Mongolian,  Chinese,  and  Tibetian  histories,  may  be  cited  the  following  dates,  which  present 
a striking  conformity  among  different  nations  for  fixing  the  era  of  this  warrior. 


Years  before  Cbrisl 

The  Chinese  place  their  Sakia,  or  Xaca  Sinha,  at 1029 

According  to  the  Sanscrit  inscription  at  Budha  Gaya,  and  Sir  William  Jones,  a Budha  was  born 1014 

According  to  the  Mongolian  historians,  by  de  Guignes  1036 

According  to  M.  Bailly's  calculations 1031 

According  to  the  Tibetian  accounts  949 

According  to  the  commencement  of  the  Kale  Yoog 1000 

In  the  Annals  of  the  Magadhan  princes,  in  the  9th  volume  of  the  Asiatic  Researches,  a change  ofidynasty, 

commonly  associated  with  religious  changes,  took  place  at  1000 


The  era  of  Gaudma  Budha  seems  clearly  established  by  the  various  historical  books  of  his  doctrine 
at  543  years  before  Christ,  a period  of  time  generally  concurred  in — the  Singalese  placing  it  in  543,  the 

* Wijya  Sinha  lived  about  one  hundred  years  after  the  death  of  Gaudma,  and  was  evidently  a successful  competitor  for  the  throne. 
A Singalese  history,  the  Raja-ratnacari,  which  was  written  by  a priest  of  the  Pansila,  called  Abeja-raja-piriwana,  of  the  temple  Walgan- 
pawya-was,  a work  scarcely  less  esteemed  than  the  Maha-vansi  itself,  records  the  erection  of  temples,  and  the  history  of  the  kings,  from 
the  first  king  Wijya,  whose  reign  is  computed  at  2369  years  ago. 

t It  will  be  shown  in  the  course  of  these  pages  that  Alaoung  Praw  successfully  used  this  engine  of  influence  to  establish  the  present 
power  of  the  Birman  empire. 

c 2 


12 


INTRODUCTION. 


Birmans  in  544,  and  the  Siamese  in  546.  What  the  state  of  the  Eastern  world  might  he  at  the 
appearance  of  this  distinguished  character  we  have  no  means  of  knowing;  it  is  mamfest  that  a powerful 
Budhist  monarchy  was  established  on  the  banks  of  the  Ganges  at  a much  earlier  epoch,  as  the  accounts 
of  the  Magadhan  empire  record  that  a powerful  kingdom  existed  at  Hastinapoor  at  the  very  remote  period 
of  1900  years  antecedent  to  the  Christian  era.  The  principal  actions  of  the  Budha  Gaudma  are  icco.  cc 
as  takhm  place  in  Ceylon,  which  island,  we  shall  see  ample  proofs  in  the  Budhist  legends  was  then 
addicted  to  the  worship  of  «««*.  or  serpents,  and  of  demons,  towards  the  suppression  of  which  the  most 
strenuous  efforts  of  Gaudma  were  directed;  and  here  was  his  chief  abode.  What  part  he  ought  have 
performed  on  the  larger  and  more  important  theatre  of  the  Indian  empire  we  cannot  at  present  trace,  but 
that  the  tenets  of  his  doctrine  were  then  the  established  creed  of  the  Magadha  sovereignty,  or  became  so 
shortly  after  the  promulgation  of  his  doctrine,  may  be  safely  inferred  from  the  details  of  Strabo  relative 
to  the  celebrated  advance  of  Alexander  to  the  Indus,  and  also  from  the  account  given  subsequently  by 
Mecrasthenes,  who  visited  Palibothra.  The  singularly  subtle  replies  of  the  Samaneans,  or  Brahmin 
philosophers,  in  their  interview  with  this  conqueror*  will  be  found  to  contain  the  spirit  of  the  Budhist 
doctrine-  and  this  coincidence  seems  fully  to  establish  the  prevalence  of  the  Budhist  faith  m southern 
India  or  Magadha,  at  315  years  before  Christ,  or  about  200  years  after  the  death  of  Gaudma.  It  may, 
therefore,  be  inferred,  that  aV  this  period,  as  at  present,  the  Budhist  doctrine  was  calculated  to  operate 
upon  the  minds  of  its  followers  by  its  moral  code,  enforced  by  the  punishments  of  the  metempsychosis,  as 
a judicial  process,  or  series  of  purifying  changes,  performing  ultimately  the  lustration  of  the  soul,  and 
qualifying  it  for  Nirwana,  or  eternal  bliss ; but  the  more  we  examine  the  features  of  this  doctrine  anterior 
to  the  time  of  Gaudma,  the  more  we  shall  feel  ourselves  interested  in  the  endeavour  to  discover  wherein 
could  exist  the  dogma  or  principle  which  could  excite  such  an  implacable  and  sanguinary  persecution  as 
we  know,  from  history,  was  maintained  for  centuries  against  the  native  Budhists,  by  the  Brahmins  and 
the  followers  of  Siva.  This  fierce  proscription  did  not  take  place  from  any  obnoxious  tenet  in  ancient 
Budhism;  it  is  in  the  exposition  of  its  modem  doctrine  that  we  must  trace  this  point:  for  the  earliest 
Budhist  writings  are  portions  of  history  of  the  highest  antiquity,  from  the  character  of  their  expressions, 
symbols,  and  distribution  of  parts,  and  tend  to  weaken  the  charge  preferred  against  the  system  of  wanting 
a Supreme  Being,  or  of  inculcating  the  doctrine  of  annihilation ; the  originators  and  the  chief  supporters 
of  which  are  the  mortal  enemies  of  the  Budhists,  and  therefore  their  testimony  should  be  received  with 
extreme  caution ; moreover  the  character  of  the  first  charge  is,  in  some  measure,  met  by  the  mention  in 
the  doctrine  of  Damata,  or  Fate,  who  regulates  the  scheme  of  the  world  by  necessitating  or  propelling  an 
eternal  progression^  events.  An  acquaintance  with  the  import  of  pagan  doctrine  will  teach  us  that  the 
Damata  and  the  Budha  of  Budhism,  are  as  good  and  competent  governors  of  the  world,  as  the  Fate  and 
Jupiter  of  Grecian  mythology,  and  that,  in  fact,  the  Jove  of  the  sky  (that  is  the  Empyrean),  and  the 
Jove  of  Olympus,  directing  the  Trojan  war,  are  two  portions  of  separate  myths  blended  in  one  divine 
and  historical  personage,  precisely  as  the  Sakia  Sinha,  or  the  Lion  of  the  Moon.f  becomes  the  active 

energy,  and  is  identified  with  the  Budha  of  the  Nirwana. 

The  great  schism  which  divided  the  Eastern  world,  and  made  the  disunion  irreconcileable,  seems  in 

+ of ^the" other  Greek  writer,,  Ratio  Sinha,  the  Lion  of  Sakia,  or  the  Moon,  is  another  of  the  surnames 

of  Budha  throughout  the  whole  of  Eastern  Asia."— Creuzer,  on  the  Religions  of  Antiquity. 


INTRODUCTION. 


13 


fact  to  have  originated  in  the  period  wherein  the  munis,  or  teachers  of  the  Budhist  doctrine,  either  from  a 
reforming  principle,  or  a love  of  power,  or  a combination  of  both,  proceeded  to  have  their  own  theories 
and  sacred  books,  not  explanatory  of,  but  in  direct  opposition  to,  the  Vedas  ;*  teaching  their  followers 
that  they  alone  were  true  believers  of  the  saving  faith,  throwing  down  the  barriers  of  caste,  and  elevating 
the  dogmas  of  the  faith  above  the  sacerdotal  class,  and  admitting  every  one  who  felt  an  inward  desire  to 
the  ministry  and  preaching  of  their  religion.  A system  thus  associating  itself  with  the  habits,  feelings, 
and  personal  advantages  of  its  disciples,  could  not  fail  to  make  rapid  progress  wherever  it  was  contrasted 
with  the  fenced-in  privileges,  immutable  dogmas,  and  haughty  pretensions  of  the  sacerdotal  class  of  the 
Brahmins.  What  were  the  political  motives  of  either  sect,  and  how  the  latter  class  contrived  to  link 
their  interest  with  the  Rajahs  of  India,  so  as  to  turn  their  arms  against  the  Budhists  as  a dangerous  sect, 
who  menaced  the  overthrow  of  their  power  and  influence,  we  have  not  at  present  the  means  of  tracing ; 
certain  it  is,  that  after  centimes  of  bloodshed,  the  Brahminists  extirpated  Budhism  from  India;  they 
anathematized  the  Budha  as  a heretic,  and  they  designated  the  doctrine  as  atheistical;  but  some 
unknown,  yet  potent  necessity,  compelled  them  still  to  class  the  Budha  of  ancient  times  as  an  avatar 
of  Vishnil,  the  preserver,  and  as  the  ruler  of  the  planet  Mercury  ;f  an  unwilling  and  reluctant  testimony 
of  the  antiquity  and  former  power  of  its  doctrine.  That  the  substitution  of  sacred  codes  of  their  own, 
and  the  erection  of  a hierarchy  in  opposition  to  the  Brahmins,  were  deemed  a promulgation  of  doctrine 
subversive  of  the  chief  points  of  Brahminical  tenets  and  practice,  seems  clearly  inferred  from  a comparison 
of  the  Vedanta  philosophical  codes,  part  of  which  are  cited  as  pure  doctrine,  and  part  are  held  to  be 
heterodox.  Here  begins  the  broad  line  of  separation,  the  fountain  whence  welled  forth  those  waters  of 
bitterness  which  have  caused  such  wars  and  revolutions. 

“ The  Vedanta  philosophers  of  Capila,”  says  Creuzer,  “ make  the  supreme  good  to  consist  in  the 
contemplative,  or  interior  life,  and  discommend  all  practice ; in  this  they  are  opposed  in  principle  to  the 
earliest,  the  first  Mimansa  after  the  Vedas,  which  recommends  ‘ a life  of  active  works  and  practice:’  the 
Bhagavat  Gita  seems  to  aim  throughout  at  a reconciliation  of  these  two  extremes,  while  it  highly  extols 
the  Sankhya  doctrine.” 

The  Jutaka  of  the  Budha,  as  King  Wessantara,  is  the  most  perfect  exemplar  of  the  contemplative  or 


• As  the  Vedas  are  necessarily  so  often  referred  to,  a short  analysis  may  be  useful,  as  a mere  sketch  of  Indian  literature,  which 
M.  Schlegel  divides  into  four  periods.  In  the  first  he  ranks  the  Vedas  and  the  laws  of  Mend ; in  the  second  nearly  all  the  philosophical 
systems  anterior  to  the  Vedanta  philosophy,  such  as  the  Sankhya  philosophy  and  others;  then  the  Ramayana  j the  third,  comprises  all  the 
works  attributed  to  Vyasa,  that  is  to  say,  the  eighteen  Puranas,  the  Mahabarat,  and  the  Vedanta  philosophy:  the  fourth  is  a class  where 
Kalidasa  and  a cloud  of  other  poets  avail  themselves  of  ancient  traditions  (heretofore  the  property  of  the  priests),  for  dramatic  and  poetical 
purposes.  “ The  primitive  myths,  which  clothed  the  first  interpretations  of  nature,”  says  M.  Goerres,  “ formed  by  little  and  little  the 
Vedas,  whence,  in  process  of  time,  flowed  the  Puranas,  a collection  of  romantic  myths,  the  produce  of  the  fertile  imaginations  of 
Vyasa  and  his  cotemporaries;  historic  poetry  developed  itself  in  the  Ramayana  and  the  Mahabarat ; morals  took  its  rank  in  the  Dherma 
Sastra,  or  laws  of  Menu ; lastly,  in  the  six  theistic  treatises,  namely,  the  two  Nyaya,  the  two  Mimansa,  and  the  two  Sankhya  (the  last 
two  philosophical  treatises  now  suspected  of  heterodoxy),  is  comprised  the  orthodox  philosophy  of  the  Hindus.” 

In  the  laws  of  Menu,  the  most  ancient  and  purest  system  of  Brahminism,  no  works  are  quoted  but  the  six  Vedas,  the  Nyaya  and 
Mimansa  philosophy,  and  only  the  author  of  the  Sankhya,  called  Capila,  the  Manava  Sastras,  and  the  Puranas. 

The  Puranas,  the  Nyaya,  the  Mimansa,  and  the  Dherma  Sastra,  are  still  called  the  four  Oupangas ; and  there  are  also  four  Oupa 
Vedas,  which  treat  of  medicine,  music,  the  military  art,  and  architecture,  to  which  are  allied  all  the  mechanical  arts — Creuzer.- 

+ “ The  Brahmins  still  agree  in  reckoning  Budha  among  the  incarnations  of  Vishnu;  they  make  him  the  ninth;  but  in  the  same 
manner  as  they  have  attached  the  blame  of  a certain  pernicious  influence  to  the  Budha  planet,  so,  at  the  same  time  that  they  admit  the 
Budha  Vatara,  they  either  observe  an  absolute  silence  respecting  him ; or,  if  they  break  silence,  it  is  to  mingle  a vague  reproach  with  the 
homage  which  they  cannot  help  paying  him.  In  this  there  is  some  great  historical  enigma,  of  which  it  will  be  long  before  we  discover 
the  complete  solution.” — Creuzer. 


14 


INTRODUCTION. 


ascetic  life,  and  its  whole  vein  of  incident  and  doctrine  identifies  him  with  the  books  which  the  Budhists 
most  probably  placed  above  the  Vedas  when  they  rejected  their  authority  as  scripture.  In  the  Budhist 
patriarchs,  or  teachers,  a list  of  whom  is  presented  to  our  view,  by  the  valuable  researches  of  M.  Remusat, 
we  trace  a line  of  preachers  or  munis,  wielding  the  metempsychosis  as  a principle  of  power,  and  exhibiting 
themselves  to  us  as  the  Samaneans  (those  who  had  vanquished  their  passions)  of  Classic  writers,  and  as 
the  Gymnosophists  of  Clement  and  Porphyry ; and  from  the  date  of  these  doctrines,  we  may  trace  the 
period  of  the  dissensions  of  the  two  classes,  arising  out  of  the  substitution  by  the  Budhists  of  the  interpret- 
ation and  authority  of  their  own  sacred  books,  and  their  adoption  of  a totally  different  rule  of  practice  for 
their  hierarchy.  The  Brahmins  spread  over  all  India  enjoyed  then,  and  still  enjoy  as  a body,  distinguished 
privileges,  but  properly  speaking  they  have  no  supreme  head  or  common  centre,  and  in  fact  they  are  no 
hierarchy;  they  formed  no  spiritual  monarchy  by  the  side,  or  under  the  shadow  of  the  throne;  but 
the  Budhist  priests  form  themselves  into  communities,  in  cloisters,  each  having  for  its  head  a spiritual 
superior  invested  with  the  highest  attributes,  inviolable  and  sacred.  Most  of  their  minor  habits  also  are 
equally  inimical  to  the  spirit  of  Brahminism,  such  as  the  profession  of  celibacy,  and  many  other  striking 
points. 

The  sum  of  these  remarks  amounts  to  this — that  Budhism  is  in  itself  a primitive  doctrine,  of  parallel 
pretension  with  Brahminism*;  that  the  later  faith  recognises  its  earlier  doctrine,  and  incorporates  its 
author  with  its  philosophy ; that  the  fatal  wars  which  drove  Budhism  from  India  originated  in  the 
principles  which  wre  trace  in  the  revival  of  the  present  system  of  doctrine  of  the  Budha ; and  that  the 
most  important  link  therein  is  manifestly  the  doctrine  of  the  metempsychosis ; a principle,  alike  sub- 
sisting both  in  the  anterior  eras,  and  in  the  present  Budha-verouse,  or  law  of  Gaudma. 

Admitting  then  the  faith  of  Budhism  to  have  originally  spread  over  India  as  a centre,  and,  to  use 
the  beautiful  language  of  Sir  William  Jones — “ Turning  your  eyes  in  idea  to  the  north,  you  have  on  your 
right  many  important  kingdoms  in  the  Eastern  peninsula : the  ancient  and  wonderful  empire  of  China, 
with  all  her  Tartarian  dependencies ; and  that  of  Japan,  with  the  cluster  of  precious  islands,  in  which 
so  many  singular  curiosities  have  too  long  been*  concealed.  Before  you  lies  that  prodigious  chain  of 
mountains,  which  formerly,  perhaps,  were  a barrier  against  the  violence  of  the  sea ; and  beyond  them 
the  very  interesting  country  of  Tibet,  and  the  vast  regions  of  Tartary.”  Nor  is  this  immense  space, 
with  its  unknown  population,  the  full  extent  of  its  influence,  for  we  may  add  to  it  the  Ultra-Gangetic 
kingdoms  of  Birmah,  Siam,  Cambodia,  and  Cochin-China,  comprising  the  space  between  the  Ganges,  the 
Indian  Ocean,  and  China.  Throughout  all  these  vast  regions  of  the  East,  the  Budha  Gaudma  is  the 
object  of  the  highest  veneration  ; he  presides  over  their  universe ; he  is  superior  to  all  the  gods  ; he  is  a 
worker  of  miracles,  and  a muni,  or  divine  teacher ; and  he  conceived  and  accomplished  his  desire  of 
becoming  a Budha  (or  an  omniscient  teacher  and  saint)  in  the  Manoepeloka,  or  earth.  This  sublime  act, 
as  they  deem  it,  is  the  grand  excellency  of  the  Budha,  as  thereby  he  procured,  according  to  Budhist 
doctrine,  salvation,  or  Nirwana,  for  mankind;  and  hence  our  earth  is  termed,  in  reference  to  this  peculiar 
and  remarkable  distinction,  the  Ford  of  Nirwana , or  the  road  to  the  supreme  state  of  felicity,  which  the 
inhabitants  of  the  three  other  islands  or  continents  are  incapable  of  acquiring  or  aspiring  to ; and  the 
Budhist  writings  lay  a particular  stress  on  this  high  and  remarkable  privilege  of  man,  for  the  entire  scope 
and  force  of  the  doctrine  of  Budhism  is  in  no  point  more  distinctive  and  strongly  marked,  than  in  its 
ruling  and  vital  principle,  that  “ the  ascent  to  divinity  is  only  to  be  acquired  from  the  state  of  man.” 


INTRODUCTION. 


15 


• We  have  now  before  us  a map  of  that  vast  portion  of  the  human  race,  who  derive  their  opinions 
and  faith  from  Budhist  doctrine,  who  profess  to  regulate  their  hope  and  notions  of  future  bliss  wholly  by 
its  moral  instructions  and  rules.  These  important  and  striking  considerations  (for  so  every  cause 
operating  on  many  millions  of  human  beings  may  justly  be  deemed)  will  convert  into  matters  of  deep 
interest  the  most  minute  details,  and  secure  patient  attention  to  the  astrological  puerilities  of  their 
demon  worship,  and  to  their  opinions  on  the  character  of  infernal  punishments.  All  these  matters  supply 
traits,  without  which  the  picture  would  be  imperfect ; and  it  may  be  considered  a very  useful  lesson  to 
set  before  the  pride  of  man,  that,  in  reference  to  the  most  important  of  subjects,  the  state  and  quality  of 
a future  existence,  the  most  refined  Greek  philosophers,  and  the  darkest  and  most  ignorant  of  the 
followers  of  the  Budha,  were  much  on  a par  as  to  external  religious  observances,  and  any  advantageous 
views  of  what  becomes  of  the  soul  after  death.  It  seems,  therefore,  to  warn  us  that,  on  these  great 
subjects,  very  little  advantage  can  be  gathered  from  the  utmost  stretch  of  the  human  understanding ; the 
teacher  must  he  divine.  However  high  his  intellectual  attainment,  philosophy  could  not  lift  her  greatest 
follower4,  at  his  death,  above  the  standard  of  the  humblest  disciple  of  the  Budha,  whom,  sacrificing  a cock 
to  the  Bali,  or  planetary  influences,  as  he  lay  languishing  under  sickness  amid  the  woods  of  Ceylon,  we 
see  under  the  same  vow,  and  offering  the  same  tribute  to  the  Deity,  as  marked  the  last  hours  of  Socrates. 
“ Uncovering  his  head,  for  his  head  was  covered,  that  nothing  might  trouble  him,  * Crito,’  says  Socrates 
(these  were  his  last  words),  ‘ we  owe  a cock  to  Esculapius,  discharge  this  vow  for  me,  and  do  not  forget 
it.*  ” A midnight  scene,  which  was  witnessed  in  the  forests  of  Ceylon,  wherein  a magical  practitioner 
was  addressing  the  sparkling  host  of  heaven,  “ the  Bali,”  in  behalf  of  an  unfortunate  individual 
languishing  under  sickness,*  will  demonstrate  how  precisely  this  last  act  of  the  greatest  philosopher  of 
the  Athenian  school  sprung  from  the  same  root  of  doctrine  as  that  of  the  sick  Singalese. 


• The  narrative  of  this  interesting  rencontre,  at  midnight,  in  the  woods  of  Ceylon,  will  be  found  under  the  head  of  the  Bali. 


CHAPTER  II. 


IDOLS  OF  THE  BUDHA.* 


•<  Mercury  (Budha  Gaudma),  a messenger  of  the  gods  with  the  Greeks;  a planet  with  the  Chaldeans— Loth  which  call  the  planets 
gods ; and  with  the  Magi,  who  understood  him,  one  of  the  seven  metals.” 


In  entering  upon  a description  of  the  different  statues  of  the  chief  teacher,  it  is  due  to  the  station 
which  Gaudma  now  occupied  in  the  Budhist  system  of  doctrine,  prevailing  throughout  the  East,  to 
commence  with  his  era  and  person ; nevertheless,  it  is  of  great  use  to  bear  in  remembrance,  that  the 
world  now  in  existence,  according  to  the  principles  of  the  faith  of  its  followers,  has  been  visited  at 
distinct  periods  by  three  preceding  Budhas,  each  of  whom  has  governed  and  taught  a series  of  time  of 
immense  duration,  and  each  of  whom  is  noticed  in  the  writings,  by  properties,  distinct  and  apart  from  the 
others,  leading  to  the  conclusion,  that  the  further  notices  which  may  be  given  of  them  in  the  sacred  # 
books  may  present  their  identities  of  person  and  character  as  distinctively  to  our  view,  as  history 
and  tradition  now  display  those  of  the  Budha  Gaudma.  By  bearing  in  mind  the  circumstance,  that 
there  are  f<5ur  principal  Budhas  operating  upon  the  destinies  of  the  present  mundane  period,  we  shall 
find  many  statues  of  the  Budha  exhibiting  physiognomic  traits  of  different  races  of  beings,  plainly 
referable  to  thgir  own  periods  of  time,  and  to  other  varieties  of  the  human  species  than  the  Tartar  or 
Caucasian  tribes ; such  specimens  present  themselves  in  several  of  the  idols  of  the  Budha,  preserved  in 
the  museum  of  the  Royal  Asiatic  Society  of  Great  Britain.  The  principal  idol  of  the  Budha  Gaudma, 
in  Europe,  may  certainly  be  deemed  that  which  now  stands  in  the  vestibule  of  the  British  Museum. 
Captain  Marryatt,  who  so  skilfully  directed  the  naval  warfare,  brought  it  from  Rangoon,  and  deposited 
it  in  our  national  collection  as  a trophy  of  British  valour  in  these  regions  of  the  furthest  East.  Colonel 
Symes,  when  narrating  the  rapid  successes  of  the  celebrated  Alaoung  Praw,  after  he  has  given  the  history 
of  the  overthrow  of  the  Talien  monarchy,  and  the  entire  conquest  of  Pegu,  speaks  of  this  conqueror  as 

* His  names  in  different  countries  are  most  numerous,  from  which  will  at  present  be  selected  only  those  titulars  connected  with  their 
doctrine.  By  the  Japanese  and  Chinese  he  is  termed  Xaca-Sacya,  also  Abbutto  and  Buto.  His  special  name  Boodh,  or  Budhu,  or 
Budha,  is  often  called  Boudh,  Bod,  Bot,  and  by  the  arbitrary  substitution  of  the  B and  P to  the  F,  Fo  or  Fho,  arising  from  the 
changes  in  the  cognate  letters  of  B,  P,  T,  and  D ; the  Siamese  call  him  Saman,  Samana,  Somon,  whence  the  Samaneans,  a strictly 
Budhist  sect,  described  by  Clemens  Alexandrinus,  and  strictly  practising  the  ascetic  austerities,  so  constantly  commended  in  the 
doctrine.  Gaudma  is  the  derivative  of  Godam,  or  Codam.  In  the  celebrated  inscription  found  at  Gaya  Bahar,  Budha  is  addressed  as 
Sacya,  and  the  Thacur.  Amaracosha,  the  philologist,  and  supposed  author  of  this  inscription,  has  eighteen  names  for  Budha:— Mum, 
Sastri,  Dherma  Raja,  Sacya  Sinha,  Saudhodhana,  Gaudma  Arka  Banda,  Kinsman  of  the  Sun,  &c.  Jaya  Deva,  in  the  Gita  Govinda,  terms 
him  Heri,  Lord  of  the  Universe. — Moors  Hindu  Pantheon,  234. 


IDOLS  OF  THE  BUDHA. 


17 


bein'g  struck  with  the  advantageous  site  for  commerce,  which  the  harbour  of  Rangoon  presented,  and 
of  Ins  resolve  to  rebuild  the  temple  of  Dagun:  from  that  temple  the  idol  was  taken.  The  edifice 
stands  apart  from  the  town  on  a commanding  eminence  about  two  miles  distant,  and  covers  a very  large 
area  with  its  motley  domes  and  spires,  all  glittering  with  gold  and  bright  colours,  and  containing 
innumerable  Budhas.  The  chief  piasath,  or  grand  central  spire,  has  a gilded  tee,  or  open  basket-work, 
around  its  summit,  which  ornament  is  indispensable  for  its  consecration  ; around  the  basket  are  suspended 
a number  of  bells,  set  in  motion  so  as  to  produce  a jingling  noise  by  every  current  of  air.  The  various 
courts  are  curiously  and  strongly  paved  with  bricks  laid  transversely;  they  are  usually  surrounded 
with  small  viharis,  or  places  for  votive  offerings  on  the  part  of  the  dead,  to  the  gods  of  the  Dewa  Loka 
heavens,  who  are  supposed  to  be  pleased  with  the  sound  of  the  bells,  whence  it  is  that  they  are  so 
common  around  the  temples.  In  front  of  the  building  may  be  seen  the  great  statue  of  Gaudma ; in 
whose  colossal  form,  as  well  as  in  the  whole  scenery  of  the  spot,  there  is  something  both  striking  and 
imposing,  as  well  as  wild  and  highly  characteristic.  Such  was  the  shrine  of  this  figure  of  the  Budha 
Gaudma,  which  may  be  deemed  an  exemplar  of  the  national  idol,  and  the  most  popular  representation 
of  the  Budha.  The  statue  is  nearly  five  feet  in  height,  and  exhibits  the  form  of  a young  man,  in  a 
contemplative  attitude ; the  features  are  placid,  and  on  a cursory  view  they  might  be  deemed  vacant ; 
but  it  should  be  observed,  that  the  point  of  development,  invariably  aimed  at  by  the  Budhists, 
seems  to  be  the  idea  of  abstract  thought  or  absorption : it  forms  their  beau  ideal,  and  is  the  main 
tenet  of  Budhism.  This  air  of  calmness,  serenity,  indifference,  or  whatever  it  may  be  defined,  is 
accompanied  with  a cold  smile ; the  expression  indeed  rarely  pleases,  but  it  may  be  fairly  assumed,  that 
few  persons  could  long  regard  the  features  without  their  gaining  at  length,  in  a certain  degree,  on  the 
attention,  and  calling  forth  reflection.  This,  perhaps,  is  the  very  impression  which  the  Indian,  as  well  as 
the  Egyptian  sculpture,  aimed  at  producing,  for  M.  Denon  has  illustrated  this  point  with  equal  felicity 
and  strength  of  sentiment,  in  his  remarks  on  the  colossi  of  Gournou,  and  on  the  sphynx,  and  it  may  not 
perhaps  be  thought  irrelevant  to  observe,  that  the  Memnon  and  Horus  in  the  British  Museum,  as  well  as 
the  most  ancient  Greek  statues,  the  Eginetan  forms,  are  all  impressed  with  the  characteristic  smile  of  the 
Budha  Gaudma.  The  hair  is  crisped  or  curled;  it  has  no  resemblance  to  the  flowing  character;  and 
whether  indicative  of  an  Ethiopic  origin*  or  not,  at  all  events  it  manifestly  differs  from  the  locks  of  the 
natives,  which  are  long  and  lank ; and,  moreover,  in  its  close  shorn  character,  it  is  altogether  at  variance 


* There  can  be  no  question,  that  not  only  the  Mongolian  authorities,  but  also  the  elaborate  articles  of  M.  Abel  Remusat 
on  the  subject,  establish  the  fact,  that  the  Budha  Gaudnia’s  person  is  described  in  the  Budhist  writings  as  that  of  an  Asiatic,  and 
in  expressions  borrowed  entirely  from  the  doctrine:  but  these  writings  hitherto  have  applied  only  to  on?  stage  of  the  Budha’s 
varied  existence,  and,  moreover,  only  to  one  of  the  four  sovereign  Budhas  of  the  present  calpe ; whereas  the  idols  in  existence 
refer  to  every  state  wherein  he  is  supposed  to  have  existed,  whether  in  the  Dewa  Loka,  in  the  Brahma  Loka,  or  Nirwana  states. 
Idols  of  other  Budhas,  older  and  anterior  to  Gaudma,  are  also  extant ; such  representations  are  in  the  museum  of  the  Asiatic  Society, 
and  they  have  not  only  the  hair,  but  the  thick  lips  and  the  features,  of  an  African  negro.  The  doctrine  of  the  Budha  is  often  very 
figurative  and  florid,  and  in  no  particular  more  so,  than  in  its  ascriptive  qualities  and  sketches  of  the  person  of  Gaudma,  which  assuredly 
would,  in  few  particulars,  tally  with  the  idols.  So  far  the  poetry  of  philosophy  outstrips  the  sculptor’s  skill  in  the  representation  ; and 
upon  this  subject,  moreover,  there  is  a remark  in  the  Journal  of  the  late  Bishop  Heber  deserving  our  notice,  and  quite  in  point : it 
contains  several  very  interesting  observations  on  complexional  varieties  of  the  human  race ; and  alluding  to  Indian  idols,  made  for  side 
and  hawked  about  the  streets  of  Calcutta,  the  writer  observes — “ I thought  it  remarkable,  that  though  most  of  the  male  deities  are  re- 
presented of  a deej^  brown  colour,  like  the  natives  of  the  country,  the  females  are  usually  no  less  red  and  while  than  our  porcelain 
beauties,  as  exhibited  in  England ; but  it  is  evident,  from  the  expressions  of  the  Indians  themselves,  from  the  style  of  their  amatory 
poetry,  and  other  circumstances,  that  they  consider  fairness  as  apart  of  beauty,  and  a proof  of  noble  blood ; they  do  not  like  to  be 
called  black.” 


D 


18 


IDOLS  OF  THE  BUDHA. 


with  their  mode  of  wearing  their  hair  long  and  flowing,  since  they  esteem  it  a mark  of  freedom  to 
have  it  hanging  over  their  shoulders,  while  short  or  cropped  hair  is  held  to  be  a badge  of  subjection.  The 
African  trait  exhibited  in  the  curled  or  crisped  hair  the  Budhists  strive  to  explain  away  by  a tale  of  the 
Budha  having  cut  off  his  hair  at  a sacrifice.  That  the  Gaudma  Budha  was  an  Indian,  and,  moreover,  an 
historical  personage,  there  can  be  no  doubt ; the  legends  are  precise  as  to  this  point ; they  all  rest  upon 
Indian  machinery,  and  all  converge  to  one  centre,  the  Budhist  sovereignty  of  Magadha. 

It  may  not  be  improper  at  this  place  to  introduce  a brief  .sketch  of  the  Indian  legend  of  doctrine, 
as  it  will  exhibit  several  points  of  coincidence  with  the  purer  and  more  simple  details  of  the  faith  in  the 
following  pages.  According  to  an  inscription  in  the  Maga  language,  communicated  by  Lord  Teign- 
mouth,  “ Budha  was  born  of  Maha-maya,  the  wife  of  Suddhadana,  Ilaja  of  Cailas.  As  soon  as  he  saw 
the  light,  he  was  placed  by  Brahma  in  a golden  vessel , and  delivered  to  a female  attendant,  but  the  child 
alighting,  walked  seven  steps  without  her  assistance.  A sage,  who,  on  the  news  of  his  birth,  repaired 
to  the  palace,  wept  and  laughed  alternately  as  soon  as  he  beheld  the  wonderful  child,  because  he  divined 
appearances  both  of  good  and  of  bad  import.  From  marks  of  a wheel  on  his  arms,  three  pundits 
declared  that  he  would  become  a Raja  Chackrawarty,  and  a fourth  that  he  would  arrive  at  the  dignity  of 
an  avatar.  The  boy  was  now  named  Sacya , and  at  sixteen  espoused  the  daughter  of  the  Raja 
Chuhidan.  Certain  mysteries  being  revealed  to  him , he  renounced  the  world,  and  became  an  ascetic, 
and  clothed  himself  in  Zalmoxis’  garments,  which  he  discovered  in  one  of  the  five  flowers  that  appeared 
at  the  creation  of  the  world.  A traveller  passed  by  and  presented  to  him  eight  bundles  of  grass ; 
Sacya  accepted  the  offering  and  reposed  upon  it.  Suddenly  a golden  temple  appeared,  on  the  summit 
thereof  Brahma  alighted  to  hold  a canopy  over  Sacya.  Indea  Naya,  and  the  four  tutelary  deities  of 
the  earth,  attended  to  do  him  homage.  At  the  same  time  the  chief  rebel  Asoor,  with  all  his  forces, 
came  to  give  battle  to  Sacya,  upon  which  Brahma  Indea  and  the  other  deities  fled.  Sacya,  perceiving 
that  he  was  left  alone,  invoked  the  assistance  of  the  Earth,  who  suddenly  brought  on  a mighty  deluge, 
which  compelled  the  Asoors  to  retire.  Then^  the  holy  scriptures  descended  from  above,  and  Sacya 
became  the  Budha  Avatar.”* 

Much  difference  of  opinion  has  taken  place  as  to  the  character  of  physiognomy,  and  the  race  to 
which  the  principal  statues  of  the  Budha  belong.  Some  of  them  certainly  exhibit  the  Ethiopian,  or  negro 
marks ; nor  can  it  be  wondered  at,  that  a personage  so  universally  reverenced  throughout  the  East  should 
be  presented  to  us  under  the  forms  of  his  respective  followers ; whether  the  African  model  may  not  have 
superseded  the  Indian,  we  cannot  in  our  present  stage  of  knowledge  of  the  faith  determine.  In  point 
of  fact,  the  Budha  Gaudma  in  the  British  Museum  does  not  furnish  a resemblance  of  the  Indo-Chinese: 
they  are  a race  of  a short  squat  athletic  make,  while  the  figure  of  the  idol  is  slender,  and  the  hair  totally 
different:  the  eye  certainly  resembles  theirs,  for  it  partakes  of  the  elongated  form,  which  is  peculiar 
to  the  Tartar  tribes  ; it  is  almost  closed,  and  the  whole  attitude  is  that  of  thought  and  repose. 

* Asiatic  Researches,  vol.  ii.383 — 386. — In  Budhism  the  god  Sekkraia  performs  the  same  office  as  the  Brahma,  officiating  at  the 
birth  of  the  Budha,  to  receive  him  in  a golden  sieve.  The  marks  of  wheels  are,  most  probably,  the  mystic  rings  seen  on  the  figures  of 
Vishnu,  and  designate  the  Chackrawarty  character,  as  in  the  account  of  Maha-mandatoo-raja,  in  the  extract  from  the  Maha-vansi.  The 
change  of  garments  is  that  to  the  initiatory  garment  in  the  legend  of  Zalmoxis,  while  the  Budha  becoming  an  ascetic,  is  paralleled  by  the 
same  incident  in  the  Jutaka  of  King  Wessantara.  The  other  incidents  are  similar  to  those  in  the  legend  of  the  Budha,  set  off  by  Indian 
colouring,  such  as  the  bundles  of  grass  presented  by  a traveller,  meaning  his  acceptance  of  the  Koosatana  grain,  his  last  act  before  he 
puts  off  his  human  nature,  and  attains  the  Budhaship.  The  transformation  of  the  Bogaya-hu  into  a pillar  of  silver,  and  the  assault  of 
the  Wassawarty-raja,  are  the  same  incidents  as  the  Golden  Temple  and  the  enmity  of  the  Asoors. 


IDOLS  OF  THE  BUDHA. 


19 


The  Budha  is  usually  represented  on  a throne  or  seat,  exhibiting  the  three  perfections  of  his 
character,  as  he  is  in  relation  to  one  or  other  of  the  states  of  the  Dewa  Loka,  the  Brahma  Loka,  or 
Nirwana ; the  position  of  the  hands,  the  aspect  of  the  eyes,  and  the  folds  of  the  dress,  are  the  indications 
of  the  state  wherein  the  Budha  is  exhibited,  when  in  the  Brahma  Loka.  He  is  spoken  of  in  the  codes  of 
doctrine  as  looking  down  through  all  the  worlds,  and  participating  in  the  progress  and  lustre  of  his 
religion ; but  the  state  Nirwana  is  indicative  of  the  entire  abstraction  and  repose,  which  is  the  end  and 
consummate  bliss  of  Budhism  ; the  eyes  closed,  and  hand  and  open  palm  resting  perfectly  Hat,  betokening 
the  apathetic  calm  and  absorption  of  the  final  rest  of  the  system.  The  throne,  or  seat  of  the  Budha,  is 
another  prominent  subject  in  this  doctrine,  and  marks  the  superior  wisdom  and  exaltation  of  the  teacher ; 
its  true  name  is  minny  phalange , or  the  seat  of  knowledge ; and,  in  a contest  with  the  rebel  Asuras,  it 
was  supplied  by  the  earth  producing  from  its  bosom  a square  stone,  on  which  Gaudma,  having  seated 
himself,  became  a Budha,  and  from  the  struggles  and  wars  for  its  possession,  as  well  as  the  sanctity 
invariably  attached  to  it,  his  followers  clearly  believe  this  distinguished  seat  to  be  the  medium  of 
conferring  great  gifts  upon  his  disciples  and  worshippers,  the  doctrine  expressing  that  it  imbibed  its 
virtues  from  the  thoughts  and  desires  of  Gaudma  when  he  assumed  the  Budhaship.  The  repeated 
references  in  the  Budha’s  life  to  the  importance  of  this  seat  seem  to  show  that  both  this  and  the  cubic 
seats  of  the  Egyptian  deities  were  seats  of  power ; they  are  manifestly  of  the  same  class  as  the  Campsa 
chests,*  which  had  so  large  a share  in  the  processions  and  mysteries  of  the  ancients,  which  were  likewise 
considered  as  oracular,  and  furnishing  responses. 

The  temples  in  which  the  figures  of  the  Budha  are  kept  are  various,  and  of  different  character. 
The  gorgeous  temple  of  Dagun  at  Rangoon  has  already  been  described.  As  these  edifices  are  of  various 
characters,  they  may  be  classed  under  the  following  heads,  according  to  their  titles  and  purposes : — 

The  Pagoda,  or  temple,  with  a dagobah,  or  mausoleum,  adjoining; 

The  Vihari,  a temple,  and  also  the  residence  of  the  Rhahaans ; 

The  Bodhistanee,  or  Siddistane,  which  are. temples  ; 

The  Pansila,  or  houses  of  leaves. 

The  first  is  usually  the  temple  dedicated  to  the  Budha,  which  always  has  a dagobah , or  small 
temple,  of  a globular  shape,  wherein  is  kept  a bone,  or  hair,  or  some  relic  of  Gaudma. 

The  term  Vihari  is  sometimes  applied  to  sacred  buildings  for  the  service  of  the  Budha,  although  it 
more  appropriately  means  “ the  lodgings  of  the  priests.” 

The  Prachida  are  smaller  buildings  of  all  shapes  and  sizes,  arranged  around  the  courts  of  the  chief 
temples,  and  sacred  to  votive  offerings  to  the  dead.f  The  word  prachida  signifies  “ sacred  repose,”  or 
the  bliss  of  Nirwana. 

The  following,  although  named  in  Budhist  tracts,  appertain  to  the  deeply-rooted  demon  worship, 
which,  with  that  of  the  serpent,  was  the  primitive  idolatry  of  Ceylon  : 

• Apuleius  mentions  these  chests,  saying  that  they  contained  sacred  symbols  used  in  the  mysteries.  Plutarch  also  speaks  often  of 
them  in  his  Treatise  on  Isis  and  Osiris,  as  also  Herodotus,  in  Euterpe  and  Diodorus,  lib.  1. 

t The  dedicators  of  these  relics  attach  the  greatest  interest  to  their  repositories  of  the  dead.  The  fortune  of  war  has  stripped  many 
a dark  and  silent  prachida  of  its  relics.  These  frequently  form  a group  of  eight  or  sixteen  figures,  representing  Ruhats,  disciples  and 
favourites  of  the  Budha,  the  Pattinee  deities,  the  Dewa  Loka  or  Nat  gods,  and  Gaudma,  in  different  stages.  Another  species  of  idol 
is  formed  of  such  remnants  of  the  bones  of  the  corpse,  as  may  be  gleaned  from  the  ashes  of  the  funereal  fire.  These  half-consumed 
bones  are  wetted  and  moulded  into  a paste,  whereof  a figure  is  made,  which  is  consecrated,  and,  after  the  rite,  regarded  as  having  passed 
into  Nirwana,  and  become  a Budha  invested  with  a ray  of  divine  sanctity. 


20 


IDOLS  or  THE  BUDHA. 


The  Dewales,  always  four  in  number,  which  are  buildings  dedicated  expressly  to  the  honour  of  the 
four  Pattinees,  gods  of  healing. 

The  Ko  wiles,  or  smaller  chapels,  situate  near  hamlets  and  villages,  wherein  the  gods  Pattinee  Dewa 
are  worshipped. 

The  Pansilas , or  literally  “ houses  of  leaves,”  in  allusion  to  their  site  on  the  skirts  or  in  the  recesses 
of  forests,  covered  with  their  leafy  shelter.  They  are  used  by  the  Budhist  teachers  for  their 
exhortations  and  teachings  in  the  morning,  for  which  purposa  they  have  a bell  to  call  their  followers 
together. 

The  Kiaungs , or  colleges  for  the  residence  of  the  Rhahaans,  which,  being  situated  in  agreeable 
shady  groves  near  the  main  rivers,  built  of  stone,  and  splendidly  painted  and  gilt,  are  in  fact  the  most 
respectable  buildings  of  the  country. 

A beautiful  delineation  of  a globular  temple  is  furnished  in  the  fourth  part  of  Captain  Grindlay’s 
Views ; but  the  grand  display  of  Budhist  temples  is  unquestionably  to  be  sought  for  amid  the  ruins  of 
the  ancient  city  of  Pali-gahn,  which  extended  six  or  seven  miles  along  the  banks  of  the  Irrawady.  The 
form  of  the  chief  temple  strongly  resembles  the  obtuse  pyramid  of  Meidun,  near  Memphis,  and  most  of 
these  edifices  have  much  of  a pyramidal  character  in  their  elevation  and  general  construction,  displaying 
many  architectural  coincidences  between  their  style  and  that  of  the  buildings  of  Egypt. 

In  the  records  of  Gaudma,  next  to  the  figure  of  him  in  Nirwana,  the  impress  of  his  foot  is  an  object 
of  the  highest  estimation.  Colonel  Symes  says : — “ In  the  course  of  our  walks,  not  the  least  curious 
object  that  presented  itself  was  a flat  stone,  of  a coarse  gray  granite,  laid  horizontally  on  a pedestal  of 
masonry,  six  feet  in  length  and  three  wide.  This  stone,  like  that  at  Ponoodang,  was  said  to  bear  the 
genuine  print  of  the  foot  of  Gaudma.  On  the  plane  of  the  foot  upwards  of  one  hundred  emblematical 
figures  are  engraven  in  separate  compartments;  two  convoluted  serpents  are  pressed  beneath  the  heel, 
and  five  conch  shells,  with  the  involutions  to  the  right,  form  the  toes.*  It  was  explained  to  me  as  a 
type  of  the  creation,  and  was  held  in  profound  reverence.”  Colonel  Symes  then  adds,  in  a note — 
“ Annexed  is  the  plate  of  the  impression,  to  enable  the  learned  antiquary  to  compare  this  curious 
symbolic  representation  with  the  sacred  hieroglyphics  of  the  ancient  Egyptians.” 

The  stone  bearing  the  impress  of  Budha’s  footstep f in  the  British  Museum,  although  nearly 
resembling  the  print  given  by  Colonel  Symes,  has  not  certainly  any  symbols  on  it  accordant  with  the 


* M.  Joinville  observes,  ‘'whether  the  print  of  Budha  was  his  right  or  his  left  foot  I have  not  been  able  to  ascertain;  they  are 
all  so  awkwardly  made  that  there  is  no  distinguishing  the  little  from  the  great  toe.  Of  the  print  in  Siam  it  is  equally  uncertain  whether 
it  is  his  right  or  his  left;  it  suffices  to  know, that  it  is  the  mark  of  Budha." — Asiatic  Researches,  vii.  414.  Although  not  a very  material 
point,  it  may  be  elucidated  by  their  desire  of  possessing  chank  shells  with  the  right  whirl  or  twist,  that  being  in  fact  the  symbol  of 
the  toes,  and  therefore  it  may  be  presumed  the  right  foot  is  also  indicated  by  the  hieroglyphic  symbols. 

In  the  neighbourhood  of  Manaar  a chank  fishery  is  carried  on,  and  proves  a valuable  source  of  revenue  to  the  government.  The 
shells  are  obtained  by  divers  at  the  depth  of  about  two  fathoms,  but  not  after  the  same  manner  as  the  pearl  fishery.  When  the  weather 
is  calm  the  chunks  may  be  seen  from  the  boat,  moving  in  the  bottom  of  the  sea ; and  the  diver  often  follows  a single  one  with  his  eye  for 
a considerable  space,  when  he  is  always  sure  of  being  conducted  to  a richly-covered  bank,  where  he  can  fish  with  advantage.  These 
shells,  which  are  of  a spiral  form,  are  chiefiy  exported  to  Bengal,  where  they  are  sawed  into  rings  of  various  sizes,  and  worn  on  the 
arms,  legs,  fingers,  and  toes  of  the  Hindus,  both  male  and  female.  They  are  likewise  used  whole  to  sound  as  a horn  at  funerals,  and  arc 
employed  for  other  purposes  in  religious  ceremonies.  A chank,  opening  towards  the  right  hand,  is  highly  valued  by  the  natives  in  India, 
and  being  rarely  found,  always  sells  for  its  weight  in  gold. — Harvard’s  Narrative,  Preface,  xi. 

+ Herodotus,  lib.  iv.  chap.  02,  tells  us  of  the  ancient  Scythians  showing  an  impression  of  the  foot  of  Hercules  near  Tyras,  on  the 
river  Dniester,  and  again  also,  in  his  account  of  Egypt,  he  names  a temple  of  Perseus  at  Chemmis,  where  the  priests  pretended  to  have 
his  slipper,  or  the  mark  of  his  foot,  two  cubits  in  length. 


IDOLS  OF  THE  BUDHA. 


21 


Egyptian  characters,  but  rather  exhibits  a conformity  with  the  figures  of  the  Birniah  constellations,  for 
the  elephant  is  entirely  unknown  in  any  Egyptian  sculpture ; a plain  proof  that  the  ancient  Egyptians 
were  themselves  ignorant  of  the  existence  of  this  noble  animal,  for  it  is  impossible  to  suppose  that  the 
deep  sagacity  and  other  remarkable  qualities  which  he  possesses  would  have  been  overlooked  in  their 
eager  adaptation  of  animal  traits  to  their  hieroglyphic  alphabet.  The  shells  or  conchs  finish  the  foot  in 
the  manner  described  by  Colonel  Symes,  and,  being  a sacred  mark,  most  probably  they  are  every  where 
graven  in  a precisely  similar  mode.  This  jnythologic  stone  stood  at  Ponoodang,  a station  midway  on  the 
Paulang  Meet,  an  auxiliary  branch,  communicating  between  the  river  at  Rangoon  and  the  main  stream 
of  the  Irrawady.  „ 

The  books  inculcate  the  belief  of  each  Budha  having  an  aggra , or  second  self,  or,  as  it  is  expressed 
in  the  Mithratic  doctrine,  a ferwer.  In  this  particular,  the  exact  coincidence  of  character  with  the  doctrines 
of  Zoroaster  is  too  striking  to  be  overlooked.  The  Budha  has  an  aggra  priest  who  will  know  his 
thoughts,  and  this  curious  point  of  doctrine  is  thus  illustrated  in  an  ancient  manuscript.  In  reply  to  the 
question  : — “ Who  was  Annanda-maha-teroonnasay  ?”  this  answer  is  given  : — “That  each  of  the  Budhas 
has  a high  priest,  who  will  infallibly  know  his  thoughts , which  priests  are  called  aggra-oopastayeka 
and  thus  the  aggra-oopastayeka  of  our  Budha  was  he  who  also  is  called  Annanda-maha-teroonnasay,  who, 
with  the  same  hopes  to  become  a Budha,  wrought  good  works  for  one  lac  of  calpes , and  who  is  the  son  of 
the  Budha’s  uncle,  the  younger  brother  of  his  father,  and  is  a king,  called  Dowtuw-dewa-saka-maha- 
raja,  who  was  so  capable  as  to  learn  by  heart  all  the  doctrines  of  eighty-four  thousand  heaps  of  books 
(the  eighty-four  thousand  banas  ascribed  to  the  Budha),  after  the  same  had  been  only  once  preached  by 
the  Budlui  in  very  high  Palee ; and  the  said  king  is  mightier  than  the  five  following  skilful  people, 
namely,  those  who  have  perfect  memory ; those  who  bear  knowledge  so  as  to  understand  things ; those 
who  are  experienced  by  questioning  upon  many  things;  those  who  are  skilled  in  the  tenets  of  the 
Budha ; and  those  who  are  called  oopastayeka.”  * 

Every  European,  on  visiting  the  temples,  is  astonished  to  see  the  confused  crowd  of  idols  of  all 


* On  comparing  this  curious  and  interesting  passage  with  the  Desatir,  a Persian  doctrine,  we  trace  a manifest  accordance  in  its 
philosophy  and  principles  with  these  Budhist  tenets. 

“ When  the  sphere  began  to  revolve  by  the  light  of  Mezdam  (Ormuzd),  four  elements  and  three  children  were  produced,  and  these 
three  children  are  dependent  on  the  four  mothers ; they  on  the  sphere,  that  on  the  soul,  that  on  intelligence,  that  on  Mezdam. 

“ Whatever  is  on  earth  is  the  resemblance  and  shadow  of  something  that  is  in  the  sphere,  while  that  resplendent  thing  (the  prototype 
that  is  in  the  sphere)  remaineth  in  good  condition,  it  is  T^ell  also  with  its  shadow.  When  that  resplendent  object  removeth  far  from  its 
shadow,  life  removeth  to  a distance. 

Again: — “That  light  is  the  shadow  of  something  more  resplendent  than  itself,  and  so  on  up  to  me  (the  divinity,  or  the  Budha). 
who  am  the  light  of  lights.  Look,  therefore,  to  Mezdam,  who  causeth  the  shadow  to  fall  in  the  name  of  Mezdam.  — Desatir,  the  boo 
of  Shet,  verse  33  to  41. 

“ Thus  also  in  the  doctrine  of  the  Budha  the  elements,  or  the  gods  Dewa  Loka,  are  inferior  to  Malm-brahma,  and  they  answer  to 
the  light  here  named  as  having  its  shadow  on  earth,  or  in  fact  the  metempsychosis,  which  endured  in  the  shadow  or  form  given  it  on 
earth,  and  has  its  principle  or  substance  in  the  heavens,  Dewa  Loka.  The  Brahma  Loka  contain  that  substance  after  the  changes  are  over 
but  the  Budha  (as  is  declared  of  Mezdam)  can  be  present  in  the  ninth  heaven,  Brahma-kayi-kamam,  where  Brahma  keeps  h.s 
court,  and  is  also  in  brightness  and  lustre  much  more  magnificent  than  Maha-brahma.” 

The  aggra  of  the  Budha  ranks  in  this  system  as  the  same  personage  with  the  ferwer  of  the  Zendavesta,  which  is  said  to  hover 
near  its  object,  and  is  represented  by  the  winged  figure  in  the  air,  in  the  celebrated  Mithratic  sculptures  of  Persia,  and  especially  in  i ie 
rock-tombs  of  Nakshi-Roustam,  and  other  Persian  sculptures  in  the  vicinity  of  Persepolis. — Sec  Kerr  Porters  Persia,  vol.  i.  plate.'  17 
and  41.  If  in  the  legends  of  a gigantic  footstep  we  trace  a coincidence  between  the  features  and  character  exhibited  of  the  Budh  . 
and  similar  traditions  of  Egypt  and  the  Grecian  Hercules,  so  likewise  is  one  portion  of  his  doctrine  precisely  identified  with  the  Mithratic 
sculptures  of  Persia. 


22 


IDOLS  OF  TIIE  BUDHA. 


shapes  and  dimensions,  which  often  produce  in  the  courts  a most  ludicrous  effect ; but  the  motive  for  this 
practice  grows  out  of  a portion  of  doctrine  of  all  others  the  most  efficacious  for  exciting  the  zeal  of  the 
Budha’s  disciples ; namely,  a promise  that,  on  dedicating  an  image,  they  shall  be  exempted  from  the  pains 
of  the  metempsychosis.  We  are  told  that  “ While  the  Budha  remained  in  a certain  city  called 
Sewas,  in  the  pagoda  Jate-wanni  Maha-vihari,  he  surveyed  the  whole  world  to  make  men  happy, 
and  went  to  them  from  that  pagoda;  and  exactly  on  that  day  the  king  of  the  place,  called  Kosel, 
came  with  great  treasure  to  make  an  offering,  but  not  meeting  the  Budha,  he  thought  that  the 
pagod  was  abandoned,  and  that  he  who  was  so  favourable  to  men  was  notv  lost , at  which  he  grieved  much. 
The  next  day  the  King  Kosel,  taking  with  him  much  people  and  treasure  into  the  pagoda,  and  seeing 
there  the  Budha,  falling  at  his  feet,  lie  described  his  former  visit,  and  his  grief  for  fear  of  his  loss,  and 
asked  leave  to  cause  an  image  to  be  made  like  him  for  the  comfort  of  mankind ; whereat,  the 
Budha  being  very  glad,  gave  him  permission;  whereon  the  king  worshipped  him,  asking  him  how  the 
image  was  to  be  made.  He  answered,  according  to  his  pleasure,  of  wood,  stone,  earth,  iron,  copper, 
silver,  gold,  or  precious  stones ; saying  that,  “ although  any  person  had  the  ability  to  fill  this  world,  which 
is  ten  thousand  juzana  large,  with  small  grains,  and  afterwards  to  count  them  one  by  one,  yet  the  hap- 
piness of  those  who  make  such  images  cannot  be  counted.”  The  king,  on  returning  to  his  palace,  caused 
a piece  of  red  sandal-wood  to  be  taken  from  his  treasury,  of  which  he  made  an  image  in  the  likeness  of 
the  Budha,  and  dressed  the  same  with  a yellow  garment,  and  built  a splendid  hall,  adorned  with  gold  and 
precious  stones,  and  erected  an  altar  on  the  south  side,  and  placed  the  image  there.  Then  he  caused  the 
roads  to  be  cleaned  to  the  pagoda,  the  highways  levelled,  white  sand  to  be  strewed,  and  fine  cloth  spread 
thereupon.  The  Budha  came  to  the  temple,  resplendent  as  the  sun,  with  five  hundred  rahatoons,  treading 
upon  flowers,  which,  through  the  force  of  his  providence  and  happiness,  sprung  up  under  his  feet ; 
enjoying  the  honour  shown  him  by  all  the  gods.  When  the  Budha  went  into  the  said  hall,  the  image 
of  red  sandal-wood  made  some  motions  upon  the  altar,  as  if  it  thought  it  not  fitting,  when  the  Budha  was 
there,  to  sit  in  such  a high  place,  and  wished  to  come  down  ;*  but  the  Budha  perceiving  it,  with  his  right 
hand  towards  it,  said — “ That  as  in  a short  time  he  intended  to  go  to  Nirwana  for  five  thousand  years, 
his  name  would  be  thought  of  on  account  of  that  image,  and  that  for  this  space  of  time,  all  gods  and  men 
should  make  sacrifice  out  of  love  ;”  he  then  took  eight  handfuls  of  flowers  and  offered.  The  king,  having 
seated  the  Budha  in  the  golden  hall,  upon  a throne  expressly  made  for  him,  and  feasted  there  for  seven 
days,  prayed  to  know  of  the  Budha  “ the  benefits  to  be  derived  by  those  who  made  his  images  ?”  and 
the  priest,  Anne-dema-hateroe-wahanse  asked,  “ What  good  a person  who  writes  his  bana  (sermons)  can 
expect?”  To  which  the  Budha  said — “ That  he  was  glad  of  the  questions,  and  would  answer  them : — 

“ 1st. — That  they  shall  never  be  born  (transmigrate)  in  the  hell. 

“ 2nd. — That  they  shall  not  be  born  out  of  the  circumference  of  the  world,  but  in  the  same. 

“3rd. — That  they  shall  not  be  born  of  a slave,  but  of  a respectable  family,  and  shall  faithfully 
maintain  the  laws  of  the  Budha. 

* Father  Boori,  a Portuguese  missionary,  who  visited  Cochin  China  in  the  sixteenth  century,  protests  in  despair,  in  his  narrative, 
that  “ there  is  not  a dress,  office,  or  ceremony  in  the  church  of  Rome,  to  which  the  devil  has  not  here  provided  some  counterpart.  Even 
when  he  began  inveighing  against  the  idols,  he  was  answered,  that  these  were  the  images  of  departed  great  men.  whom  they  worshipped 
exactly  on  the  same  principle,  and  in  the  same  manner,  as  the  Catholics  did  the  images  of  the  Apostles  and  Martyrs." — Murray's  History 
of  Discoveries  in  Asia,  iii.  249.  What  would  Father  Boori  have  said  to  this  notable  miracle  of  the  Budha’s  image,  so  perfectly  in 
character  with  Romish  legends  of  similar  import? 


IDOLS  OF  THE  BUDHA. 


23 

4t^- — That  they  shall  not  be  born  a female,  or  be  subject  to  the  falling-sickness,  frenzy,  want 
of  speech,  deafness,  deformity,  or  to  eruptions  or  other  complaints*  but  be  made  like  a golden  image 
with  tiger’s  teeth. 

“ 5th. — That  they  shall  not  be  frightened  by  tigers,  bears,  &cc.,  or  undergo  any  injustice  at  any  time, 
but  be  born  of  a respectable  (high)  family,  and  obtain  wealth ; and  be  born  in  the  heaven,  and,  with 
a thousand  heavenly  wives,  live  in  an  unspeakably  splendid  habitation,  and  in  every  thing  obtain  their 
wish,  and  enter  the  glory  of  Nirwana.”  “ And  since  that  time  the  making  of  images  and  the  writing  of 
bana  have  been  introduced  into  the  world,  first  by  the  King  Darma-soka,  by  whom  temples  were 
erected,  and  sacrifices  of  joy  made ; and  by  the  King  Devine-petisse,  who,  in  the  809th  yearf  after  the 
Budha’s  death,  caused  the  pagoda  of  Moellegirri-galle  to  be  erected,  which  is  situated  within  the 
Gierewadoloosdaliaspattoo.” 

There  are  few  parts  of  the  Budhist  writings  more  interesting  than  this  extract,  which  is  taken  from 
a Singalese  manuscript,  and  the  account  of  the  proceedings  of  the  King  Kosel,  upon  inaugurating  the 
image  of  Gaudma,  is  a valuable  record  of  these  ancient  observances.  The  first  and  most  meritorious 
work,  and  which  invariably  precedes  the  solemn  inauguration  of  a new  Budha  at  the  great  festival  of  the 
sacred  pallol  tree,  in  the  Tavateinza  heaven,  is  to  level  the  road  to  the  sacred  spot,  to  fill  up  the  valleys 
and  lower  the  hills,  and  to  spread  the  path  with  fine  white  sand  ; in  fact,  it  i*s  still  the  universal  practice 
of  the  East,  to  pay  this  sort  of  homage  to  sovereignty.:):  In  perfect  conformity  with  these  ideas,  the 

Budhas  commence  that  festival  which  establishes  their  divinity,  and  introduces  their  doctrine:  thus 
Gaudma  is  represented  as  rendering  this  meritorious  service  and  homage  to  his  predecessor,  the  Budha 
Deepankara,  who  thereupon  blesses  him,  and  prophesies  his  future  advancement  to  the  Budhaship.  In 
the  above-mentioned  festival  of  the  gods,  another  mark  of  the  divine  power  is,  that  his  path  and  highways 
are  spontaneously  covered  knee-deep  with  fragrant  never-fading  flowers  from  the  trees  which  border  the 
road : in  short,  the  whole  ceremony  accords  with  the  feasts  of  the  inebriating  tree  of  the  Dewa  Loka,  a 
portion  of  the  Budhist  doctrine,  involving  coincidences  with  the  most  sacred  of  the  Grecian  mysteries. 
The  movement  of  the  idol  curiously  reminds  us  of  the  Romish  legends  and  miracles ; and  the  replies  to 
the  important  questions  put  to  the  Budha,  respecting  the  blessings  attaching  to  the  offerers  of  images, 
contain  the  whole  philosophy  of  the  metempsychosis,  as  from  the  negations  we  may  gather  precisely 
wherein  its  punishments  consisted,  the  meed  thereby  granted  being  article  by  article  an  exemption  from 
some  law  of  the  metempsychosis  operating  upon  the  uninitiated : first — As  such,  they  would  transmigrate 


• The  following  judicious  remarks  furnish  a precise  parallel  to  the  series  of  maladies  ascribed  in  the  Bali,  as  well  as  in  Budhist 
doctrine,  to  demons.  “ It  is  deserving  our  particular  notice,  to  examine  the  tenor  of  Scripture  in  the  Pentateuch  and  historic  books 
before  the  Babylonian  captivity,  and  that  portion  which  was  written  after.  In  the  former,  the  punishments  indicted  upon  mankind 
for  their  sins,  are  invariably  represented  as  proceeding  immediately  from  the  hand  of  God ; whereas,  in  the  latter,  the  sufferings  entailed 
upon  humanity  are  described  in  general  as  visitations  of  the  evil  one — almost  every  disease  was  the  work  of  a demon.  St.  Luke  speaks 
of  a person  who  had  a spirit  of  infirmity,  and  whom  Satan  had  bound  for  eighteen  years;  and  a great  variety  of  cases  are  given  by  the 
Evangelists,  wherein  the  same  malignant  spirit  had  exerted  his  power  to  deprive  unhappy  patients  of  health,  reason,  and  even  the  use  of 
their  bodily  organs." — Russell's  Connexion  of  Sacred  and  Profane  Hislori/,  i.  27 1. 
t The  809th  year  of  the  Budha  is  the  266th  year  of  the  Christian  era. 

+ What  reader  can  here  avoid  calling  to  mind  the  sublime  apostrophe  of  the  Prophet  Isaiah — “Prepare  ye  the  way  of  the  Lord,  make 
straight  in  the  desert  a highway  for  our  God  ; every  valley  shall  be  exalted,  and  every  mountain  and  hill  shall  be  made  low  ; and  the 
crooked  shall  be  made  straight,  and  the  rough  places  smooth.”  It  will  be  obvious  from  more  than  one  reference,  that  the  idolatry  of 
the  East,  in  the  earliest  ages,  and  especially  the  Budhist  writings,  partake  largely  of  patriarchal  history,  whence  they  derive  their 
incidents,  and  on  which  they  have  grafted  their  subsequent  doctrines. 


24 


IDOLS  OF  THE  BUDHA. 


into  hell : secondly — As  being  born  out  of  the  circumference  of  the  world,  they  would  lose  the  privilege 
of  the  Nirwana,  or  final  rest : thirdly — Being  born  of  a slave  they  would  forfeit  the  knowledge  of  the 
doctrine  that  confers  happiness:  fourthly — Females  are  not  considered  in  Budhist  doctrine  endowed 
with  the  same  privileges  for  future  happiness  as  males,  a tenet  engrafted  into  Islamism : fifthly — The 
forms  of  tigers,  bears,  &c.,  are  the  brute  vehicles  wherein  human  beings  are  born,  as  punishments  for 
atrocious  crimes.  It  is  not  therefore  surprising  that  such  privileges,  so  earnestly  desired  by  his  followers, 
should  produce  and  encourage  the  disposition  to  dedicate  the  hosts  of  idols  which  crowd  all  the  great 
temples  of  the  Budha. 


CHAPTER  III. 


THE  TRANSMIGRATION  OF  SOULS,  AND  THE  JUTAKAS  OF  THE  RUDHA. 


“ Materia  appetit  formam.”— “ The  same  spirit  which  animated  one  body,  may,  on  its  dissolution,  animate  another ; which  I take  to  be 
the  meaning  of  Pythagoras  by  his  transmigration  of  souls  or  spirits.” 


The  doctrine  of  the  metempsychosis  seems  alike  important  to  both  portions  of  the  Budhist  system;  it 
is  united  to  the  refined  and  mystic  tenet  of  the  spirit,  or  influx  of  divine  life,  individuated  through  all 
forms,  which  pronounces  all  matter  to  be  illusion,  and  which  wearies  the  power  of  thought  by  the  subtlety 
of  its  ratiocinations  ; while  the  penances  and  the  severity  of  the  sufferings  of  the  Budha  Gaudma, 
and  the  searching  rigour  of  his  morals,  as  laid  down  in  the  first  principles  of  his  religion,  mark  the 
importance  attached  by  this  reformer  to  his  doctrine  of  a God  incarnating  in  man,  to  teach  and  lead 
mankind  by  those  steps  to  the  supreme  bliss,  through  the  purifying  process  of  transmigrations:*  “ and 
the  Pythagoreans,  grounding  their  principles  upon  this  primitive  doctrine,  ask — ‘ Can  that  spirit,  which 
gives  life  and  motion,  and  partakes  of  the  nature  of  light,  be  reduced  to  nonentity?  Can  that  sensitive 
spirit  in  brutes  which  exercises  memory,  one  of  the  rational  faculties,  die,  and  become  nothing  ?’  If  you 
say,  they  breathe  their  spirits  into  the  air,  and  there  vanish,  that  is  all  1 contend  for.  The  air  indeed 
is  the  proper  place  to  receive  them,  being,  according  to  Laertius,  full  of  souls ; and,  according  to 
Epicurus,  full  of  atoms,  the  principles  of  all  things;  for  even  this  place,  wherein  we  walk  and  birds  fly, 
has  so  much  of  a spiritual  nature,  that  it  is  invisible,  and,  therefore,  may  well  be  the  receiver  of  forms, 
since  the  forms  of  all  bodies  are  so ; we  can  only  see  and  hear  its  effects ; the  air  itself  is  too  fine, 
and  above  the  capacity  of  the  eye.  What  then  is  the  ether  that  is  in  the  region  above  ? and  what  are 
the  influences  or  forms  that  descend  from  thence  ? The  souls  of  creatures,  the  Pythagoreans  hold,  are  a 
portion  of  ether  ; and  all  philosophers  agree  that  ether  is  incorruptible  ; and  what  is  so,  is  so  far  from 
being  annihilated  when  it  gets  rid  of  the  body,  that  it  lays  a good  claim  to  immortality .”  Such  are  the 
observations  of  the  entertaining  and  amiable  writer,  Whitelock  Bulstrode,  in  his  Essay  in  defence  of 


* “ Whoever  is  unacquainted  with  my  law,  says  Fo,  and  dies  in  that  state,  must  return  to  the  earth  till  he  becomes  a perfect 
Samanean.  In  order  to  this  he  must  destroy  within  himself  the  Trinity  of  Maya ; he  must  make  himself  like  a man  whose  four 
limbs  have  been  cut  off;  he  must  think  without  seeming  to  think;  he  must  forsake  every  thing,  extinguish  his  passions,  unite  and 
identify  himself  with  the  law,  and  comprehend  the  religion  of  annihilation.”  Again — “ Fo  meant  to  say  nothing  more  than  that  the 
primitive  substance  is  eternal  and  unchangeable ; according  to  him  its  first  and  its  highest  revelation  is  the  pure,  luminous,  transparent 
ether,  the  boundless,  infinite  space,  not  a void  resulting  from  the  absence  of  forms,  but  on  the  contrary  the  foundation  of  all  forms,  and 
anterior  to  them.  All  creations,  the  work  of  Maya,  are  as  nothing  before  the  uncreated  being,  and  all  motion  must  cease  in  his  profound 
and  sacred  repose.  The  universe  exists  of  necessity ; it  has  existed  from  all  eternity,  but  only  in  its  principle,  which  is  the  eternal  pow  er 
of  Nature,  producing  and  reproducing  incessantly  from  its  own  substance."—  Crcuzer,  vol.  i. 


E 


26 


THE  TRANSMIGRATION  OF  SOULS. 


Pythagoras,  observations  which  deserve  our  attention,  as  marking  the  close  affinity  with  Budhist  tenets 
in  the  system  of  the  Samian  philosopher. 

It  would  occupy  too  great  a portion  of  time  and  space  to  draw  up  an  historical  sketch  of  the  doctrine 
of  the  metempsychosis,  although  such  a sketch  would  form  the  most  valuable  illustration  of  the  Budhist 
faith.  We  must  be  content  for  the  present  to  mark  the  evident  traces  of  the  primitive  doctrine,  as  well 
as  the  modem,  in  this  one  principle — that  souls  must  atone  by  penances,  in  inferior  forms,  and  through 
the  lustration  of  transmigration,  for  their  sins  in  any  present  stage  of  their  existence,  so  that  affer  having 
been  condemned  to  occupy  the  bodies  of  men  or  animals  more  or  less  degraded,  they  may  finally  be  fitted 
for  Nirwana,  or  a state  of  bliss  with  the  Eternal  Spirit.  # 

How  skilfully  this  system  of  Budhist  morals  is  adapted  to  establish  the  influence  of  the  priests, 
and  to  sustain  the  character  of  its  doctrine,  cannot  be  more  clearly  demonstrated  than  by  the  appeal  to  its 
powerful  influence,  after  a period  of  twenty-three  centuries,  over  so  large  a portion  of  the  Eastern 
world. 

The  history  of  Budliism  exhibits  several  periods,  in  which  the  decaying  strength  and  rigour  of  its 
laws  have  been  renewed  and  brought  into  active  influence  by  the  collection  and  the  preaching  of  the 
bana,  or  doctrines  ascribed  to  Gaudma,  the  author  of  the  present  scheme ; this  is  shown  in  the  primitive 
historic  details  of  its  successive  teachers,  as  well  as  in  various  parts  of  the  Asiatic  Researches.  The 
skilful  combination  of  original  patriarchal  history  with  the  individual  acts  of  subsequent  Budhas 
appears  to  have  shed  a permanent  interest  on  the  lawrs  and  moral  enactments  of  the  Budhist  code,  as 
being  thus  gathered  out  of  the  oldest,  and  therefore  purest,  sources  of  knowledge.  The  more  the 
system  is  considered  in  its  scheme  and  applicability  to  society,  the  more  clearly  however  it  will  appear 
that  the  doctrine  whereby  the  modern  reformer  and  teacher,  Gaudma,  chiefly  established  his  influence,  and 
upon  which  hinges  his  appearance  in  the  system  of  the  present  period,  is  the  doctrine  of  the  metempsy- 
chosis, as  a purifying  scheme  of  rewards  and  punishments,  a doctrine  called  for  imperatively  by  the 
vacuum  in  the  system  of  a directive  energy,  which  void  it  is  designed  to  supply.* 

It  is  chiefly  from  the  character  of  Pythagoras,  and  various  parts  of  Herodotus,  that  we  can  derive 
illustrations  of  this  difficult  and  interesting  subject,  and  the  doctrines  of  the  Pythagorean  school  are 
clearly  the  transcripts  of  the  lessons  which  that  celebrated  philosopher  had  acquired  in  Egypt,  where  he 
is  supposed  to  have  been  initiated  into  the  esoteric  dogmas,  while  the  wisdom  of  Mizraim  was  highly 
flourishing  and  distinguished,  anterior  to  the  sweeping  devastation  caused  by  the  Persian  spoiler.  The 
view  given  by  Herodotus  of  the  portion  of  Egyptian  doctrine  which  he  denominates  a knowledge  of 
the  immortality  of  the  soul,  is  howrever  widely  different  from  the  active  scheme  of  the  metempsychosis 
of  Budhism  ; it  certainly  imports  transmigration,  but  in  a way  that  leaves  out  of  it  the  genuine  character 
of  the  tenet,  namely,  its  being  a purifying  process  ; and  from  its  inapplicability  as  a source  of  corrective 
and  repressive  operation  upon  the  mind,  it  seems  probable  that  Herodotus  alluded  chiefly  to  some 
opinions  which  had  been  held  by  Pythagoras,  which  were  very  imperfectly  understood,  for  they  amount 


• Dr.  Russell  says — “ There  is  the  best  reason  to  believe  that  the  Egyptian  hierophants,  as  well  as  the  Brahmins  of  the  East, 
maintained,  originally,  the  doctrine  of  a direct  refusion  of  the  human  soul  into  the  essence  of  the  great  parent  spirit."  This  is  the 
doctrine  of  the  Nirwana,  which,  with  the  first  records  of  the  Budhist  history,  is  drawn  from  patriarchism.  The  metempsychosis  is  only 
to  be  regarded  as  a supplementary  tenet,  devised  by  the  theologue  and  the  lawgiver,  to  strengthen  the  bonds  of  the  social  union  in 
their  communities. 


THE  TRANSMIGRATION  OF  SOULS. 

solely  to  this  “ That  the  Egyptians  had  the  conception  of  a hades  and  t *1 
after  the  death  of  the  body,  passed  into  some  other  animal,  which  was  bor  , S°U'  °f 

that  it  transmigrated  through  all  the  creatures  which  inhabit  the  sea  the  lanTTn ^ ‘°  ** 

havmg  performed  this  circuit  in  three  thousand  years,  it  again  entered'a  human  ’Zy  " ? ^ ^ 
Ihe  Budhist  doctrine  exhibits  the  Budha  Gandmn  oc  1 • y' 

circle  of  the  creation,  through  all  the  existences  of  the  ^ ^ 

station  oftmman  life,  that  the  details  of.  these  passages  oH.is  cTil  **  fa  "«* 

doctrine;  and  his  five  hundred  and  fifty  incarnations  are  emb  V ,1  • ^ m“de  exemPlars  of 
perfectibility  of  his  moral  character, . and  to  communicate  to  each"  *°  h°'d  l'P  the 

knowledge  that  it  had  been  visited  by  a divine  teacher  and  a Uudha  HhTfoll  ^ ^ ‘CSS°n 
being  required  to  perform  a round  of  three  thousand  years,  wherein  ■ ° ^ !°  fr°m 

forth  to  them,  that  they  are  exhorted  and  instructed  to  practise  the  comm  'Tf  ? suffermS  is  hcl<1 

may  ^ 0^  ^e  transmigration,  and  appear  in  the  Za  Lok  * ^ ^ 

Nirwana,  or  final  bliss.  ' L k ’ tllus  Proceeding  to 

The  Pythagoreans  held  doctrines  far  more  accordant  with  that  of  the  n »,■  . 
^ZLTCltteThWfVariI0rdW8  °f  being8SUPeri0r  t0  BleI!’  wbose  souls  had  emanated 

- nazzrs  x:rtion;  - 

theh“  °f  **  — - - ^ 

Herodotus  has  given  us  a most  interesting  and  curious  narrative  relative  to  Scythia,  which  contains 

IZ  °f  hlfSt0neal  detaih  Very  US6ful  fOT  traci"g  ‘Ho  wide  range  of  this  tenet;  for  his  history  of 
Zalmoxis  goes  for  to  prove  the  adoption  of  Budhist  principles  among  the  Celtic  tribes  of  the  Ister,  both  as 

'T3™  reC?  " the  S6Venth  b0°k  °f  Strab°’  and  in  ‘He  observations  of  Larcher.  His  retreat  to  a 
cave  and  wilderness,  and  the  precept  to  abstain  from  the  blood  of  animals,  are  of  this  description  • 

the  tenet  of  the  eternal  existence  of  the  soul,  held  by  the  Celtic  tribes,  appears  also  to  have  been  derived 
from  Zalmoxis,  whom  they  deemed  a god,  or  Budha,  he  being  manifestly  a teacher  and  a hermit,  or 
ascetic,  of  the  peculiar  character  with  which  such  a lawgiver  and  teacher  is  invested.  Zalmoxis  is  called 
also  the  Genius,  which  means  the  same  as  “ deified  Budha,”  and  his  name  in  the  Thracian  language 
means  “ skin  of  the  bear;”  the  import  of  which  signifies  “the  initiated;"  and  intimates  that  he  had 
renounced  the  world,  and  assumed  the  garb  of  ascetic  life,  which  was  the  act  of  the  Budha  Gaudma 
as  King  Wessantara.  It  is  recorded  that  Pythagoras  too  was  called  Zalmoxis,  because  he  had  been’ 
wrapped  at  his  birth  in  a bear’s  skin.  The  name  of  Gebeleizis,  which  is  mixed  up  with  this  legend,  is 

also  peculiarly  suitable  to  the  inferences  already  drawn,  as  M.  Larcher  says,  that  it  means  “ Him  who 
gives  repose.” 

La  Loubere’s  interesting  account  of  Siam,  attests  the  painful  feeling  with  which  the  people  of 
that  country  regard  existence,  as  being  subject  to  the  penalties  of  this  doctrine,  a feeling  fully  shared  by 
the  Birmans;  for  the  present  stage  of  human  life  they  deem  to  be  a penalty  and  degradation,  and  the 

• Sec  the  account  of  the  cavern  of  Zalmoxis  as  fixed  by  M.  DAnville  to  be  Mount  Kasron,  on  the  small  river  of  the  same  name 

on  the  confines  of  Transylvania  and  of  Moldavia,  in  Strabo,  vol.  iii. 


‘28 


THE  TRANSMIGRATION  OF  SOULS. 


award  of  the  future  is  anticipated  with  anxious  dread;  which  is  the  same  doctrine  as  we  have  already 

shown  to  have  been  taught  in  the  Ionic  school.  ... 

The  Maha-vansi  contains  a passage  referring  to  the  birth  of  the  Budha,  particularly  illustrative  ot 

this  doctrine,  and  of  the  view  which  it  takes  of  the  nature  of  the  omniscience  ascribed  to  him.  It 
represents  Gaudma  as  having  performed  the  entire  round  of  the  metempsychosis,  and  having 
successively  animated  all  the  destined  vehicles  of  animal  forms,  and  passed  into  a final  state  rf  existence 
in  the  heaven  Toisite,  preparatory  to  his  birth  as  Budha,  apd  thus  proceeds “ Our  grades  Budha, 
being  in  the  heavens,  resolved,  at  the  prayer  of  gods  and  of  men,  to  become  man  •,  and,  considering  what 
tribe” was  proper  for  his  birth,  he  perceived  that  the  sun-descended  tribe,  Maha-samata,  was  superior,  and 
that  this  tribe  would  be  suitable  for  his  birth  ; moreover,  because  he  himself  was  of  that  tribe  m his 
former  existence,  and  reigned  as  king ; to  wit,  once  by  the  name  of  Maha-samata,  once  by  the  name  of 
Maha-mandatoo  Chackrawarty,  once  as  Maha-soodesarna,  once  as  Mak'ha-dewa,  once  as  Tuny,  once  as 
Cusa,  once  as  Rawma,  once  as  king  Udayab’haddaya,  once  as  king  Mahinsaka,  once  as  king  Cantahary , and 
at  last  as  king  Wessantara ; in  which  state  of  life,  having  been  charitable  and  pious  to  a high  degree,  he 
transmigrated  into  the  divine  world  Toisite,  &c.”  The  important  list  of  names  herein  recapitulated  no 
doubt  relates  to  individual  personages,  and  we  hence  see  that  Gaudma  is  considered  as  possessing  the 
perfect  consciousness  of  these  various  periods  of  existence,  and  of  the  continuous  thread  of  events 
throughout  their  figurative  stages.  It  is  this  knowledge  which  is  designated  in  the  doctrine 
omniscience,  or,  as  it  is  termed  in  the  doctrinal  books,  “ the  knowledge' of  the  past,  the  present,  and  the 
future,”  known  to  the  Budha. 

It  is  curious  to  observe  how  closely  Pythagoras  copied  this  doctrine,  and  pretended  that  his  own  soul 
had  similarly  transmigrated,  and  successively  animated  different  bodies. 


“ Ev'n  I,  who  these  mysterious  truths  declare, 

Was  once  Euphorbas  at  the  Trojan  war ; 

My  name  and  lineage  I remember  well. 

And  how  in  f gilt  by  Sparta's  king  I fell. 

In  Argive  Juno’s  fane  I late  beheld. 

My  buckler  hung  on  high,  and  own’d  my  shield,”  &c. 


Pythagoras  here  claims  and  exercises  the  very  same  faculty  of  omniscience,  as  is  ascribed  exclusively 
to  the  Budha  by  the  Palee  name  Astawedsawe,  which  means  the  foreknowledge  of  the  creation  and 
destruction  of  a world,  as  well  as  the  knowledge  of  the  hearts  of  others,  and  of  the  forms  occupied  in 
the  past  transmigrations.  To  exhibit  a further  conformity  with  the  Budhist  doctrine,  Pythagoras  retires 
to  a cave,  where,  after  the  example  of  Zalmoxis,  he  secludes  himself  for  a long  period,  and,  upon  Ins 
reappearance,  speaks  of  a return  from  hades.  In  these  points  we  see,  from  the  example  of  the  illustrious 
Samian,  how  minutely  the  actions  of  the  Budha  were  copied,  as  well  as  his  precepts ; and  it  seems 
therefore  evident,  that  the  general  character  of  his  doctrine,  as  it  is  at  present  condensed  in  the  writings, 
was,  in  fact,  the  great  guide  of  the  Celtic,  Scythian,  Egyptian,  and  Grecian  disciples  of  this  school. 


JUTAKAS  OF  THE  BUDHA. 


2i) 


JUTAKAS  OF  THE  BUDHA— PLATES  I.  TO  V. 

The  following  narratives  will  furnish  a most  interesting  illustration  of  the  doctrine  on  which  we 
have  already  dwelt  so  long,  and  they  are  also  the  oldest  specimens  remaining  of  the  striking  mode  of 
speaking  To  the  eye  by  pictorial  delineations ; there  is  scarcely  a more  interesting  subject  td  be  found  in 
the  study  of  man  than «the  examination  of  the  paintings  of  antiquity,  which  Robertson,  the  historian,  so 
aptly  terms  “ picture-writing.”  We  should  lose  ourselves  in  a wide  field  of  conjecture,  if  we  ascribed  to 
a common  origin  all  those  habits  of  life,  and  all  those  usages,  civil  and  religious,  in  which  we  can  trace 
a mutual  resemblance ; we  must  endeavour  to  separate  the  parts  which  are  evidently  of  arbitrary 
adoption,  from  those  feelings  which  may  be  produced  alike  in  every  clime  by  some  common  impulse 
or  sentiment  in  our  nature.  It  is  certainly  of  high  importance  to  point  out  and  illustrate,  wherever 
they  occur,  the  analogies  of  language,  of  fictions  in  cosmogonies,  and  of  rites  and  customs,  even  where 
we  cannot  trace  the  links,  or  follow  up  the  fact  to  any  historical  epoch  ; for  what  is  human  knowledge, 
if  we  define  its  abstract  character,  but  “ reminiscence,  or  the  recovery  of  ideas  ?”  The  long  struggle 
between  the  Budhists  and  the  Brahmins  dispersed  the  former  over  all  the  regions  of  central  Asia, 
and  through  the  islands  of  the  Eastern  Archipelago ; in  the  various  migrations  which  followed,  we 
may  account  for  striking  coincidences  existing  between  India  and  Egypt  and  the  Phenician  colonies ; 
but  how  can  we  account  for  a conformity  of  astronomical  and  astrological  data,  and  of  religious  rites  and 
ceremonies,  and  connect  together  those  of  the  Budhists  and  the  inhabitants  of  the  new  continent  of 
America?  Many  interesting  approximations  between  the  traditions  of  the  new  continent,  and  those 
of  followers  of  the  religion  of  Budha,  have  been  illustrated  with  peculiar  force  by  M.  Humboldt; 
but  in  nothing  are  they  more  strongly  evidenced  than  in  the  practice  of  picture-writing,  “exhibiting 
the  representation  of  an  event  with  pictures,  in  which  the  objects  represented  are  in  a state  of  action 
with  each  other.”  We  find  many  valuable  particulars  in  the  recital  of  the  first  conquerors  of  the 
new  world,  such  as  those  concerning  the  paintings  which  were  sketched  by  the  Mexican  artists  to  convey 
to  the  unfortunate  Montezuma  a representation  of  the  wonderful  strangers  who  had  arrived  within  his 
dominions  ;*  and  of  the  same  class  with  the  Mexican  paintings,  according  to  the  remarks  of  M.  Humboldt, 
may  be  ranked  the  sketches  contained  in  the  Siamese  manuscripts!  in  the  library  at  Paris.  In  these 


• " Pilpatoe  and  Teutile  endeavoured  to  dissuade  Cortes  from  visiting  the  capital ; and  during  this  interview  some  painters,  in  the 
train  of  the  Mexican  chiefs,  had  been  diligently  employed  in  delineating,  upon  white  cotton  cloths,  figures  of  the  ships,  the  horses,  the 
artillery,  the  soldiers,  and  whatever  else  attracted  their  eyes  as  singular.  When  Cortes  observed  this,  and  was  informed  that  these 
pictures  were  to  be  sent  to  Montezuma,  in  order  to  convey  to  him  a more  lively  idea  of  the  strange  and  wonderful  objects  now  presented 
to  their  view  than  any  words  could  communicate,  he  resolved  to  render  the  representation  still  more  animated  and  interesting,  by 
exhibiting  such  a spectacle  as  might  give  both  them  and  their  monarch  an  awful  impression  of  the  extraordinary  prowess  of  his  followers, 
and  the  irresistible  force  of  their  arms.  The  trumpets,  by  his  order,  sounded  an  alarm  ; the  troops,  in  a moment,  formed  in  order  of 
battle;  the  infantry  performed  such  martial  exercises  as  were  best  suited  to  display  the  effect  of  their  different  weapons;  the  horse,  in 
various  evolutions,  gave  a specimen  of  their  agility  and  strength ; the  artillery,  pointed  toward  the  thick  woods  which  surrounded  the 
camp,  were  fired,  and  made  dreadful  havoc  among  the  trees.  The  Mexicans  looked  on  with  that  silent  amazement  which  is  natural 
when  the  mind  is  struck  with  objects  which  are  both  awful  and  above  its  comprehension.” — Robertson' s America. 

+ The  coincidences  with  Mexican  subjects  go  much  deeper  than  the  use  of  picture-writings  only.  The  Budha  Gaudma,  in  his 
reprobation  of  human  sacrifices  and  enforcement  of  bloodless  rites,  by  substituting  flowers  and  incense  for  his  service,  exhibits  a striking 
resemblance  to  the  Mexican  deity,  the  mild  Quatzalcoatl,  who  is  described  as  exercising  the  same  pleasing  influence  over  the  Mexican 


JUTAKAS  OF  THE  BUDHA. 


30 

subjects,  as  well  as  in  the  observations  of  ancient  writers,  and  in  many  portions  of  the  Chinese  annals 
we  may  trace  the  purpose  of  instruction  by  the  eye ; and  the  development  of  the  legends  winch  we  shal 
see  recorded  in  these  plates,  will  have  a higher  interest  from  their  belonging  to  the  class  of  representatior 
which  apparently  gave  rise  to  pictorial  history. 

The  accounts  of  Bambadat-rajah,  of  Useeratenam-rajah,  and  the  very  important  history  o essan  ara- 
rajah,  are  translations  from  the  celebrated  Palee  book,  the  Jutakas,  or  the  550  incarnat.ons  of £ Budha 
which  is  a Work  regarded  by  all  the  followers  of  the  Bndha  with  particular  reverence,  and  held  as  the 
,rreat  compendium  of  doctrine.  It  is,  in  fact,  the  most  precious  exemplar  of  the  metempsychosis,  winch 
may  be  designated  the  keystone  of  Budhist  faith,  wherein  is  embodied  the  instruction  requisite  or 
moral  guidanee  in  the  different  stages  of  existence.  The  Budha,  who  has  appeared  in  every  form  of 
animal  life,  and  sustained  every  character  of  mortal  existence,  in  which  might  be  exhibited  an 
example  of  morals,  is  thence  declared  to  have  animated  the  form  of  every  sentient  being,  whether  insect, 
bird,  beast,  or  man  ; in  the  latter  state  he  is  supposed  to  have  completed  every  state  of  existence  by  e 
550  incarnations:  these  are  the  transcripts  of  his  respective  lives  in  these  various  characters  all  recording 
the  events  and  trials  wherein  the  Budha  is  the  chief  actor,  and  in  which  he  manifests  a life  of  purity, 
and  dies*  in  the  acquisition  of  all  virtue  compatible  with  the  state  of  being  which  he  had  taken  upon 
him.  Were  the  Jutakas  * completely  known  (as  it  may  be  hoped  from  the  present  prospect  of 
encouragement  to  this  branch  of  oriental  literature  they  soon  will  be),  we  should  learn  how  materially 
many  interesting  works  of  fiction  accord  with  the  doctrine  of  a divine  personage  animating  the 
brute  as  well  as  the  human  frame;  and  thus  considering  the  divine  teacher  under  the  form  of  a lion, 
we  could,  without  violence,  give  to  the  same  animal  the  organs  of  speech  and  reason.  In  the  Budhist 
states,  these  series  of  events  or  narratives  of  the  acts  of  Budha,  are  the  subjects  of  picture-writings, 
purely  such,  and  exhibiting  every  variety  of  feeling  and  event  of  his  life;  the  good  actions  winch  are 
exhibited  by  the  virtues  of  Budha  becoming  the  catastrophe  or  moral  of  the  delineation.  The  temples, 
therefore,  exhibit  always  some  portions  of  the  Jutakas,  or  incarnations,  as  recorded  by  those  paintings; 
and  at  any  time  that  the  Budhist  priests  ju^ge  it  expedient  to  reprove  a growing  tendency  to  a 
particular  sin,  and  to  check  its  progress,  they  simultaneously  hang  the  walls  of  the  pansilas  and  dagobas 
of  Budha  with  the  particular  Jutaka,  which  describes  the  Budha  as  overcoming  that  sin,  and  by  his 
example  condemning  its  practice.  The  three  subjects  which  follow  will  clearly  exemplify  this  point. 
In  Bambadat-rajah  we  see,  in  a most  animated  and  lively  manner,  the  punishment  of  tyranny  and 
cruelty;  while  in  Useeratanam-rajah  a less  terrible  catastrophe  is  made  the  correction  of  less  flagitious 


tribes,  but  her  harmless  rites  were  despised  and  set  at  nought  by  the  fierce  Aztech  race.  Tl.ere  is  indeed  much  of  magic  and  violence 
strangely  commixed  with  the  milder  tenets  of  Budhism,  and  we  shall  find,  lurking  in  its  historical  dogmas,  many  traces  of 
violence  and  bloodshed.  These  are,  in  fact,  indications  of  two  different  sources  of  doctrine;  the  primary  one,  the  mild  and  benign ; 
the  fiercer  and  more  palpable,  the  seed  of  a much  later  era.  Thus  the  Budha  Gaudrna,  in  a portion  of  h,s  doctrine,  promises  by 
his  own  lips,  to  those  who  dedicate  images  to  him,  an  exemption  from  the  metempsychosis,  and  that  they  shall  neither  be  hears  nor  wild 
I, easts,  hut  that  they  shaU  he  born  as  a golden  image  with  tigers'  teeth ; an  idea  marked  by  every  trait  hut  that  of  mildness  or  of 

beneficence.  . . „ . , . . 

* The  term  for  death  is,  “ visits  the  Dewa  Loka."  The  Budhist  doctrine  treats  death  m conformity  with  the  transmigration ; 

this  follows  death  in  the  heavens,  or  Dewa  Loka.  The  Birman  and  Chinese  phrase  of  - visiting  the  celestial  mansions,"  their  courtly 
formula  of  announcing  the  emperor’s  death,  is  merely  declaring,  that  he  has  led  a life  of  such  virtue  as  to  insure  Ins  transmigrating  into 
the  heavens  without  experiencing  any  penal  process  in  the  change  of  his  existence : it  is  an  exemplification  of  a dogma  in  the  Budhist 
doctrine  of  the  metempsychosis,  which  is  necessary  for  the  right  understanding  of  the  phrase. 


JUTAKAS  OF  THE  BUDHA. 


31 


impiety,  and  a less  degree  of  crime.  The  narrative  of  King  Wessantara  is  a portion  of  history  of  very 
particular  interest,  exhibiting  the  Budha,  who  has  now  passed  through  every  part  of  his  separate 
incarnations,  in  his  last  stage  of  existence,  preparatory  to  his  being  born  into  the  heaven  Toisite,  and 
becoming  the  Budha.  “ At  last,”  the  Maha-vansi  narrates,  “ he  was  King  Wessantara,  in  which  state 
of  life,  having  been  charitable  and  pious  in  a high  degree,  he  transmigrated  into  the  divine  world 
called  Toisite.”  This  Jutaka  we  consider  most  valuable  for  the  view  of  the  doctrine,  as  it  is  likely 
to  show  the  steps  by  which  the  Budha  arrived  at  the  highest  state  of  perfectibility  which  the  pro- 
gressive scale  of  growing  excellence  can  exhibit ; and  on  an  attentive  perusal  of  this  singular  tale,  that 
state  will  be  found  to  consist  “ in  the  extirpation  of  the  passions  of  the  soul,  and  even  the  feelings  of 
nature,  and  in  acquiring  such  an  abstract  isolation  of  mind,  as  conveyed  to  the  rapt  visionary  of  this  most 
ancient  of  doctrines  a conception  of  having  already,  in  this  active  stage  of  trial,  re-entered  (as  far  as  the  will 
is  concerned)  into  the  divine  essence.”  It  is  curious  to  trace  in  this  fundamental  dogma  of  Budhism, 
the  essence  and  principle  of  the  school  of  Zeno,  and  to  perceive  how  much  the  far-famed  stoics  are  out- 
done in  their  doctrine  of  superiority  of  mind  over  external  impressions  of  pain  by  the  Budha  and  his 
disciples  * The  motives  which  appear  interwoven  with  this  singular  stretch  of  ratiocination  by  the 
votaries  of  the  Budha  form  the  pivot  of  Budhism.  Self-abstraction,  to  an  extent  equal  to  the  anni- 
hilation of  the  passions,  seems  to  be  the  chief  medium  of  purification  and  of  acquiring  the  supreme 
bliss;  and  this  faculty  appears  to  be  gained  by  the  Budhist  worshipper  through  the  purgatorial  and 
refining  process  of  transmigrations  during  his  existence  on  earth.  Thus  is  identified  a spark  of  divine 
life,  which  (to  use  the  words  of  their  own  doctrine)  never  dies,  but  as  a leech  fastens  to  its  recipient  by 
one  end,  ere  it  relinquishes  its  hold  at  the  other ; a body,  therefore,  is  ready  to  be  the  recipient  of  the 
ethereal  spark. 

The  Jutakas  of  Gaudma  being  one  of  the  most  esteemed  of  the  Budhist  writings,  and  preserved 
in  every  temple,  at  least  in  part,  if  not  the  whole  manuscript,  it  is  matter  of  great  gratification  that  the 
period  wherein  they  were  translated  from  the  Palee  into  the  Singalese  character,  can  be  determined 
on  no  less  authority  than  that  of  the  Maha-vansi,  which,  containing  the  historical  details  of  a con- 
siderable portion  of  the  Budha- verouse,  with  dates  most  carefully  affixed  to  every  transaction  of  the 
missions  or  promulgation  of  the  Budha’s  doctrine,  furnishes  us  on  this  very  subject  with  the  particulars 
that  are  so  desirable.  It  states,  that  “ Ceylon  had  long  been  subject  to  the  Indian  princes,  when, 
about  the  year  1290  of  the  Christian  era,  the  King  Wijya-bahu  recovered  his  independence,  and 
shook  off  the  Indian  yoke.”  The  conquerors  having  formerly  conveyed  to  the  banks  of  the  Ganges  the 
holy  relics  of  the  Budha,  and  especially  his  sacred  tooth,  his  successor,  the  King  Parakkerm-bahu, 
determined  to  regain  the  holy  tooth  of  Gaudma,  which  had  been  conveyed  to  India  as  the  spolia 
opima  of  conquest ; and  repairing  to  Damba-dewa,  which  was  now  threatened  by  an  invasion  from  the 


• There  is  a passage  in  Strabo,  lib.  xv.,  stating,  that  King  Porus  was  induced,  by  the  reputation  of  the  Roman  name,  to  send  an 
embassy  to  Augustus  Caesar.  He  says,  that  the  ambassadors  stopped  at  Athens  on  their  route  homewards ; and  here  a well  trained 
disciple  of  those  patriarchs  who  succeeded  the  Budha,  and  who  usually  terminated  their  career  by  fire,  prepared  to  give  to  the  Athenians 
a striking  proof  of  Eastern  doctrine.  Having  erected  a lofty  pile  of  wood,  he  approached  it,  wearing  only  a pair  of  drawers,  and  anointing 
himself  with  oil,  he  sprung  with  a laugh  upon  the  pile,  and  perished  amid  the  flames:  the  Athenians  built  for  him  a tomb,  on  which 
they  inscribed,  according  to  Strabo — “ Here  lies  Zarmanus  Chagan,  an  Indian,  of  the  city  of  Bargoza,  who  made  himself  immortal, 
according  to  the  custom  of  his  country.”  Dion  Cassius  calls  him  Zarmarus;  most  probably  Zarmanus  and  Zarmarus  are  the 
corruption  of  “ Samanars,"  the  Indian  appellation  of  the  Budhists. 


3*2 


JUTAKAS  OF  THE  BUDHA. 


Tartars,  he  negotiated  with  such  skill  as  to  obtain  its  restoration,*  and  returned  in  great  triumph  to 
Ceylon.  The  king  of  Ceylon  instantly  built  a splendid  temple  for  its  reception,  wherein  he  also 
replaced  the  minny  phalange , or  supreme  seat  of  the  Budha,  also  the  patrya  datoo  carandu , or  the 
sacred  drinking-cup  of  the  temple.  From  the  manner  in  which  these  articles  are  mentioned  in  the 
pages  of  the  Maha-vansi,  it  would  seem  probable  that  the  minny  phalange , and  the  bona  patrya  are 
insignia  expressly  sacred  to  the  Budha.  The  narration  then  proceeds : — “ This  king,  having  had  a pious 
priest,  who  was  versed  in  different  languages,  as  his  tutoc,  he  became  acquainted  with  all  the  550 
Jutakas  related  by  the  Budha,  which  the  king  afterwards  caused  to  be  carefully  translated  from  the 
Palee  language  into  the  Singalese,  and  they  were  afterwards  revised  by  several  skilful  priests,  and 
published  throughout  the  island  of  Ceylon.  The  book  containing  the  Singalese  translation  of  the  550 
Jutakas,  which  was  in  the  possession  of  the  king,  he  afterwards  gave  to  the  chief  priest,  called  Madan 
Carre,”  and  the  date  thereof,  in  the  Budha-verouse,  answering  to  about  the  year  1290,  is  carefully 
appended. 

It  seems  most  reasonable  therefore  to  conclude,  that  the  manuscript  now  in  the  possession  of  the 
Royal  Asiatic  Society,  being  in  the  Singalese  character,  is  a copy  of  the  translation  made  by  order  of 
the  Singalese  monarch  in  1290;  it  is  thus  described  by  Mr.  Clough,  who  was  for  many  years  a 
missionary  in  Ceylon ; and  who  has  inspected  its  condition,  and  gone  through  its  leaves.  The  Singalese 
book  is  called  Pansiya  panas  Jutaka,  from  Pan,  five — siya,  hundred — panas , fifty — Jutaha,  incarnation 
— that  is,  the  550  incarnations  of  Budha,  which  he  underwent  during  his  probation  for  that  highest  and 
most  sacred  character. 

During  these  transmigrations,  he  entered  into  every  possible  state  of  existence,  from  the  gods  down 
to  the  meanest  reptile,  and  had  to  associate  with  beings  of  every  kind.  Sometimes  lie  was  among 
the  gods — sometimes  among  the  demons — more  frequently  among  men,  and  often  with  beasts,  birds, 


* This  celebrated  tooth,  the  regaining  of  which  established  the  throne  of  king  Parakkerm-bahu,  seems  to  have  maintained  its  interest 
even  to  the  present  era,  and  we  may  as  well  conclude  its  history  in  this  note. 

J.  Ribeyro,  in  his  Histoirc  de  Ceylan,  published  1701,  informs  us  “that  in  1560,  Constantin  de  Bragnnza  forcibly  carried  off  the 
tooth,  and  refusing  the  enormous  sum  which  was  offered  for  its  return,  publicly  reduced  it  to  ashes,  as  a demonstration  of  his  zeal.  The 
priests  of  the  Budha,  however,  were  more  than  a match  for  the  exemplary  Braganza,  as  they  pretended  to  have  found  the  identical  tooth 
lying  on  a rose,  rescued  no  doubt  by  the  Budha  himself,  who  left  a worthless  counterfeit  to  suffer  the  intended  indignity.  It 
would  however  seem  that  subsequent  revolutions  have  transported  this  relic  to  the  bunks  of  the  Ganges,  to  judge  from  the  missions  sent 
by  Minderagee  Praw,  the  late  emperor  of  Birmah,  to  Calcutta,  to  bargain  for  its  possession.” 

“ To  unravel  the  motives  which  led  the  king  of  Damba-dewa  to  relinquish  thus  tranquilly  so  rich  a dependence  as  the  island  of 
Ceylon,  and  also  to  restore  the  tooth,  a very  important  light  is  supplied  to  us  by  the  narrative  of  Marco  Polo,  who  makes  mention 
of  a formidable  inroad  of  Tartars,  troops  of  Kublai  Khan,  about  this  period,  into  the  Eastern  parts  of  Bengal  and  the  adjacent 
provinces.  At  this  time,  1272,  Ava,  or  the  empire  of  Birmah,  appears,  under  the  title  of  Mien,  to  have  been  united  to  the  sovereignty  of 
Bangala.  The  king  of  Bangala  and  Mien  lost  a pitched  battle  of  most  sanguinary  character.  '1  he  Tartars  seem  to  have  followed  the 
course  of  the  Brahmaputra  river,  and  from  these  mountainous  districts  to  have  penetrated  into  the  plains  of  Bengal  and  of  Ava : a very 
bloody  and  protracted  struggle  followed,  which  finally  terminated  in  the  Tartars  taking  possession  of  Pah-gahn,  the  capital  of  Ava,  the 
celebrated  ruins  of  which  still  attest  its  former  grandeur." — See  Marsdens  Marco  Polo,  445 — 449. 

Colonel  Symes,  in  his  nariative,  observes  of  this  city — “Pah-gahn  is  said  to  have  been  the  residence  of  forty-five  successive 
monarchs,  and  to  have  been  abandoned  about  500  years  ago,  in  consequence  of  a divine  admonition.  Whatever  may  be  its  true  history,’ 
remarks  Colonel  Symes,  “ it  certainly  was  once  a place  of  no  ordinary  splendour."  There  can  be  no  question  that  the  divine 
admonition  which  led  to  the  abandonment  and  decay  of  Pah-gahn,  and  to  the  surrender  of  Ceylon  and  of  the  Budha's  tooth,  are,  in 
truth  attributable  to  the  inroad  and  hostilities  of  the  Tartars,  who,  in  the  end,  made  an  entire  conquest,  according  to  Marco  Polo,  of  the 
kingdom  of  Bangala;  it  was  at  this  period  that  the  Tartars  became  acquainted  with  the  elephant  for  uses  of  war,  and  they  ever  after- 
wards introduced  them  into  their  armies ; for  which  purpose,  one  portion  of  the  tribute  exacted  from  these  provinces  consisted  of 
elephants  for  their  armies. 


JUTAKA  OF  BAMBADAT-RAJA. 


33 


and  fishes.  These  Jutakas  contain  the  complete  history  of  his  visits  or  births  among  these  different 
classes  of  beings,  and  give,  at  the  same  time,  the  substance  of  his  intercourse  with  them,  for  the 
purpose  of  exemplifying  three  of  the  chief  traits  in  his  character-purity,  compassion,  and  wisdom. 
Every  Jutaka  closes  by  such  strong  exhibitions  of  these  excellencies,  that  the  beings  about  him  discover 
that  they  have  been  visited  by  Blmdisataya  (the  name  he  had  while  a candidate  for  the  Budhaship), 
who  vanishes;  and  they  are  left  to  moralise  and  improve  the  example  he  has  set  them,  by  some 
parable,  narrative,  or  discourse,  concerning  his  infinite  wisdom,  purity,  and  compassion.  And 
that  all  may  attain  what  he  has  attained,  namely,  Nirwana,  they  are  to  act  agreeably  to  the  principles 
and  maxims  laid  down  in  the  Jutakas,  on  which  account  this  is  looked  upon  as  the  chief  book  among 
the  Budhists.  The  book  was  originally  written  in  Palee,  and  translated  into  Singalese.  The  copy  in 
question  contains  1172  leaves,  or  2344  pages.  A native  writer  would  write  about  four  pages  per  day 
upon  an  average,  and  thus  the  whole  would  employ  him  586  days. 

The  following  are  faithful  translations  of  three  of  these  remarkable  narrations,  the  last  of  which, 
relating  to  King  Wessantara,  possesses  the  greatest  share  of  the  reverence  of  the  followers  of  the 
Budha,  from  its  recording  the  precise  stage  which  concludes  the  whole  series,  and  exhibits  the  soul 
purified  by  its  process  to  a perfectibility  which  exonerates  it  from  all  thraldom  of  the  body  by 
desires,  appetites,  or  affections,  and  terminates  in  the  Budhaship.  The  wtfrd  Wessantara  means  “ a 
change  of  existence  or  transmigration  but  its  precise  signification  must  be  regulated  by  the  state  of  the 
person  desiring  it ; though  it  is  seldom  used  unless  in  reference  to  those  desiring  the  highest  state,  or 
Nirwana.  The  expressions  and  style  of  the  original  are  closely  preserved,  as  exhibiting  the  precise 
ideas  conveyed  by  the  doctrine  of  the  Jutakas. 


THE  JUTAKA  OF  BAMBADAT-RAJA— PLATE  I. 

“ Budha  was  once  born  a merchant  in  the  country  called  Barrenas  (Benares),  and  as  he  was  one  day 
passing  with  his  wife  in  a carriage  through  the  capital  of  the  king  called  Bambadat,  in  the  kingdom  called 
Rajagaha-nouwara,  the  king,  perceiving  from  his  palace  the  young  merchant  and  his  wife,  and  becoming 
captivated  with  her  beauty,  immediately  formed  a plot  to  obtain  the  wife.  He  accordingly  called  one 
of  his  officers,  and  giving  him  one  of  his  precious  stones,  directed  him  to  go  and  drop  it  unperceived 
into  the  merchant’s  carriage.  He  moreover  ordered  another  officer  to  go  and  seize  the  merchant,  accusing 
him  of  stealing  the  king’s  precious  stone,  and  to  bring  them  both,  the  man  and  his  wife,  to  his  presence, 
by  way  of  complaining  of  them.  The  officers  did  as  they  were  ordered.  When  therefore  the  merchant 
and  his  wife  were  brought  to  the  king,  he  pretended  to  inquire  into  the  case,  and  ordered  the  merchant 
to  be  put  to  death,  and  his  wife  to  be  detained  in  the  palace. 

“ The  king,  not  satisfied  with  this  order,  rode  out  on  his  elephant  himself  to  the  place,  to  see  that 
his  sentence  was  properly  executed ; but  when  the  executioner  lifted  up  his  sword  to  give  the  mortal  blow 
to  the  victim,  and  before  the  stroke  fell,  the  god  Sekkraia,  who  was  enraged  at  the  brutal  and  cruel 
conduct  of  the  king,  in  the  twinkling  of  an  eye  put  the  king  in  the  place  of  the  merchant,  and 
conveyed  the  merchant  to  the  seat  of  the  king  on  the  elephant : the  executioner  gave  the  fatal  blow, 
when,  perceiving  his  mistake,  he  dropped  the  sword  on  the  ground,  and  stood  still,  not  knowing  what 

F 


:J4 


JUTAKA  OF  BAMBADAT-RAJA. 


to  do ; but  the  people  in  general,  who  were  long  tired  of  their  king,  and  hated  him  for  his  tyrannical 
and  cruel  conduct,  the  moment  they  saw  it  rejoiced  at  the  event,  and  soon  after,  placing  his  wife  by 
the  merchant  on  the  elephant,  they  carried  them  both  to  the  palace  with  loud  acclamations  of  joy, 
and  then,  placing  the  merchant  on  the  throne,  acknowledged  him  to  be  their  king  from  that  day. 


EXPLANATION  OF  PLATE  I.* 

1.  The  merchant  passing  in  a carriage  with  his  wife. 

2.  The  officer  drops  the  precious  stone  into  the  carriage. 

3.  The  officer  seizes  the  merchant,  and  charges  him  with  the  theft. 

4.  The  merchant  is  brought  before  the  king  as  a criminal. 

5.  The  king  passes  sentence  of  death  upon  him. 

6.  The  merchant’s  wife  is  detained  in  the  palace. 

7.  The  king  rides  out  to  the  place  of  execution. 

8.  The  god  Sekkraia  places  the  merchant  on  the  elephant. 

9.  The  king  is  conveyed  to  the  place  of  the  merchant. 

10.  The  executioner’s  surprise. 

11.  The  merchant’s  wife  placed  beside  her  husband  on  the  elephant  by  the  people. 

12.  The  merchant  and  his  wife  repairing  to  the  palace. 

13.  The  new  king  and  queen  on  the  throne. 


* As  the  outline  and  style  of  the  plates,  illustrative  of  these  narratives,  unquestionably  evince  somewhat  of  a European  character, 
it  is  of  importance  to  subjoin  the  remarks  of  one,  who  was  an  eye-witness  of  these  representations  in  the  temples,  and  who  notices  this 
seeming  coincidence.  Whence  derived,  and  however  these  subjects  have  become  naturalized  in  Ceylon,  it  is  not  now,  perhaps,  in  our 
power  to  trace ; they  are,  however,  genuine  transcripts  of  original  drawings  presented  by  the  priests  to  Sir  Alexander  Johnston,  during 
his  residence  as  Chief  Justice  in  that  island. 

Captain  Mackenzie,  who,  in  the  year  1796,  visited  the  West  and  South  coasts  of  Ceylon,  gives  an  interesting  detail  of  his 
observations.  Among  other  particulars,  he  describes  a temple  of  Budha,  at  Villigaam  ; after  noticing  the  idol,  which  was  in  a 
reclining  posture,  and  of  gigantic  size,  he  thus  proceeds: — “ The  gallery  which  ran  round  the  inner  apartment,  was  entirely  covered 
with  paintings,  in  compartments  rudely  finished,  each  apparently  containing  the  history  of  some  event  of  the  life  of  Budha : these 
the  priests  told  me,  were  also  narrated  in  a great  book,  always  kept  by  the  modeliar  of  the  place.  One  of  these  paintings  seemed 
to  represent  the  birth  of  the  divine  child;  others  represent  his  juvenile  adventures,  some  of  which  seemed  akin  to  the  sportive  Kighen  s 
amusements  on  the  plains  of  Muttra.  In  one,  a youth  held  eager  converse  with  a nymph,  amid  deep  shades  and  woods,  while  a 
monkey,  hid  by  the  branches  of  a tree,  seemed  to  listen  with  mischievous  intent.  In  another,  the  god  appeared  as  a youth,  slily 
stealing,  and  distributing  handfuls  of  coin  from  a chest,  towards  which  an  aged  man  approached  with  cautious  steps,  holding  a huge 
key  in  his  hand.  On  others,  processions  appeared  ; feasts  seemed  prepared ; food  was  distributed  to  the  poor  of  various  nations  (as 
appeared  by  their  various  habits);  and  the  different  habits  and  manners  of  men  in  active  life  were  portrayed.  A large  white  elephant 
made  a conspicuous  figure  in  most  of  these  assemblies.  The  style,  or  costume  of  these  paintings,  was  entirely  different  from  that  of  the 
Hindus  in  the  peninsula,  and  plainly  belonged  to  a different  people,  though  they  undoubtedly  showed  those  of  the  Singalese  and  the 
followers  of  Budha.  On  observing  in  these  representations  chairs,  tables,  metal  lamps,  and  raised  seats,  such  as  are  used  by  the  present 
race,  inhabiting  the  coast  of  the  European  part  of  Ceylon,  which  I had  at  first  supposed  they  had  borrowed  from  their  present  masters, 
I reflected  that  these  indicated  a connexion  with  the  nations  to  the  Eastward,  which  still  use  them,  and  that  custom,  so  widely  different 
from  that  of  the  Hindus,  who  always  seat  themselves  on  carpets,  or  on  cloths  spread  on  the  ground,  might  have  been  imported  from 
China,  Siam,  or  Pegu,  with  their  other  customs  and  religion.'* — Asiatic  Researches , vi.  437- 

The  paintings  are  <igain  noticed  in  pages  443  and  446,  of  the  same  volume ; but  the  last  observation  just  quoted,  assigning  the 
style  of  furniture  exhibited,  to  China,  Siam,  or  Pegu,  appears  erroneous  ; as  it  should  be  observed,  that  the  Indo-China  states  admit 
having  received  their  arts  and  religion  from  Ceylon.  The  great  book,  stated  to  be  in  the  possession  of  the  modeliar , and  from  the  contents 
of  which  the  subjects  of  the  paintings  were  furnished,  was,  without  doubt,  the  temple  copy  of  the  J utakas. 


T III  IK  ST<(DRT  4D.1F  IBAMBABAHT  IRA  JJAB 


-'•■e 

fffil; 

n 

H 

JMH  Bjjfrjft 

■ ""“ 

TJiSSJBIBMATANAM  MAJAJH,  Parti 


JUTAKA  OF  USEERATANAM-RAJA. 


35 


THE  JUTAKA  OF  USEERATANAM-RAJA.— PLATES  II.  AND  III. 

“There  was  once  an  emperor,  in  Damba-dewa,  called  Useeratanam-raja,  who  was  an  enemy  to 
the  Budhist  religion,  and  led  a sinful  life,  by  drinking,  killing  animals,  and  committing  acts  of 
violence  on  people,  and,  through  his  bad  principles,  all  his  subjects  became  as  wicked  as  himself.  The 
Budha,  who  was  then  born  god  Sekkraia,  seeing  the  misery  of  the  empire,  and  taking  compassion  on 
its  wretched  state,  assumed  the  form  of  a limiter,  while  the  god  Matalee  took  that  of  a most  frightful 
dog  of  enormous  size.  They  both  descended  from  heaven,  and  the  hunter  led  the  dog  by  an  iron 

t 

chain  into  the  capital  of  the  emperor.  As  soon  as  they  got  within  the  walls  of  the  palace  the  dog  began 
to  bark ; the  sound  was  louder  than  thunder  itself.  The  affrighted  guard  ran  and  related  this  circum- 
stance to  the  emperor,  who,  on  hearing  the  sound,  was  not  less  terrified  than  the  guard  himself. 
While  the  guard  was  still  with  the  emperor,  the  hunter  and  his  dog  appeared  before  him,  and  the 
dog  began  to  bark  still  louder.  The  emperor,  who  was  so  alarmed  that  he  could  scarcely  support  himself 
from  falling  to  the  earth,  summoning  up  all  his  courage,  asked  the  hunter  what  he  wanted  there  ? and 
why  his  dog  barked  with  such  a horrible  voice?  To  which  the  hunter  answered,  that  it  was  through 
hunger  that  the  dog  thus  barked,  and  that  this  was  his  reason  for  coming  to  hirft.  The  affrighted  emperor, 
who  would  gladly  have  done  any  thing  to  stop  his  barking,  readily  promised  to  satisfy  his  hunger,  and  sent 
for  the  food  which  was  dressed  for  his  table,  which,  on  placing  it  before  the  dog,  he  ate  all  at  once,  and 
began  to  bark  again.  The  emperor  sent  for  more,  and  more,  until  all  that  was  in  his  kitchen  was  consumed. 
The  emperor,  then  finding  that  the  dog  was  not  yet  satisfied,  sent  for  the  victuals  that  were  prepared 
for  his  subjects,  until  the  whole  that  was  in  his  city  and  the  neighbourhood  was  consumed.  Still  finding 
that  he  could  not  satiate  his  hunger,  the  emperor  asked  the  hunter  what  more  he  could  expect,  seeing 
that  all  the  food,  both  in  the  city  and  the  neighbourhood,  had  been  produced  and  consumed?  To  which 
the  hunter  replied,  that 4 this  sort  of  food  would  never  satisfy  his  dog’s  hunger,  for  that  he  delighted  in 
the  flesh  of  his  enemies.’  The  emperor  then  asking  him  whom  he  meant  by  saying  his  enemies  ? he 
began  to  say,  ‘ My  enemies  are  those  who  profess  no  religion ; those  who  are  addicted  to  drunkenness ; 
those  who  kill  animals;*  those  who  commit  acts  of  violence  on  people  ; and,  in  short,  all  those  who  lead 
any  sort  of  wicked  life,  unless  they  promise  to  abstain  from  their  sins,  and  to  lead  a good  life.’  The 
emperor,  seeing  that  he  himself  should  not  be  exempted  on  these  points,  and  fearing  the  consequences, 
readily  promised  to  adhere  to  his  doctrine,  which  example  was  immediately  followed  by  all  his  subjects. 
The  hunter  thereupon  assumed  his  real  form,  as  the  god  Sekkraia,  as  did  the  dog,  and  after  having 
preached  to  the  king  and  his  subjects  the  religion  of  Budha,  they  ascended  into  the  heaven  from  which 
they  came.” 

EXPLANATION  OF  PLATES  II.  AND  III. 

1.  The  emperor  sits  in  his  palace  drinking,  and  commands  an  attendant  to  beat  a beggar  whom 
he  sees  coming. 

• The  Budhist  doctrine  dooms  “ those  who  kill  animals , and  who  are  by  profession  hunters,  warlike  kings,  ministers,  and 
governors,  who  oppress  the  people,  to  the  great  hell,  Sengata,  there  to  be  ground  between  four  burning  mountains  for  ..IKK)  years. 
Asiatic  Researches,  vi.  220. 


36 


JUTAKA  OF  KING  WESSANTARA. 


2.  The  attendant  desires  a watchman  to  do  so. 

3.  The  watchman  beats  the  beggar. 

4.  The  emperor  amuses  himself  in  hunting. 

5.  A stag  is  killed  and  taken  away. 

6.  The  king  returns  from  hunting  to  his  palace. 

7.  The  hunter  and  his  dog  arrive  at  the  tower  gate. 

8.  The  palace.  # 

9.  The  gate. 

10.  The  hunter  and  his  dog  come  into  the  presence  of  the  eyiperor. 

11.  The  emperor. 

1 2.  The  queen  frightened. 

13.  The  queen  faints  away. 

14.  The  dog  eats  all  the  food  that  is  set  before  him. 

15.  Baskets  of  victuals. 

16.  Officers  report  to  the  emperor  that  no  more  food  can  be  procured. 

17.  Queens  in  the  palace. 

18.  Queens  attending  the  bana , or  sermon. 

19.  Emperor  and  his  attendants  hear  the  ba)m. 

20.  The  god  Sekkraia  in  his  natural  form. 

21.  Matalee  in  his  natural  form. 

THE  JUTAKA  OF  THE  KING  WESSANTARA. — PLATES  IV.  AND  V. 

“ The  Budha  was  once  born  King  Wessantara,  in  the  kingdom  called  Jayatoo-roopura ; he  was 
universally  beloved  by  all  his  subjects  for  his  eminent  virtues;  he  had  also  an  ail-aita,  or  a white 
elephant,  which  was  sent  to  him  from  heaven,  and  which  itself  possessed  many  virtues.  At  this  time 
there  was  a great  famine  in  the  country  called  Calinga,  occasioned  by  want  of  rain,  and  the  king  of  that 
kingdom,  called  the  Calinga-raja,  hearing  of  the  different  virtues  of  the  white  elephant,  and  the  mild 
and  beneficent  disposition  of  the  owner  of  it,  sent  eight  of  his  trusty  Brahmins,  to  go  to  the  King 
Wessantara,  and  borrow  the  elephant  in  his  name,  as  it  was  the  only  means  to  restore  Calinga  to  its 
fertility  and  former  state,  for  the  virtues  of  the  elephant  are  such,  that  rain  will  not  fail  to  fall  wherever 
the  elephant  is,  if  it  is  but  wished  for.  The  Brahmins  immediately  departed,  and,  after  a long  journey, 
arrived  at  the  place  of  their  destination,  and  went  and  met  the  king  as  he  Avas  riding  out  on  this  very 
elephant  to  the  hall  of  public  alms.  The  eight  Brahmins,  then  placing  themselves  on  a lofty  spot,  and 
saluting  the  king  by  lifting  up  their  arms,  informed  him  of  the  puqjort  of  their  journeys  the 
king  becoming  deeply  affected  by  Avliat  he  heard  from  them,  immediately  alighted  from  this  royal 
animal,  and  delivered  it  to  them,  notwithstanding  the  murmurs  and  entreaties  of  his  attendants,  and  other 
persons  in  general,  to  the  contrary. 

“ The  people  of  King  Wessantara’s  kingdom,  who  were  very  much  displeased  at  this  act  of  their 
master’s,  finding  that  all  their  remonstrances  had  no  effect  on  the  mind  of  the  king,  all  proceeded  in  a 
body  to  their  king’s  father,  the  old  king,  named  Sanda-maha-raja,  and  informed  him  of  it ; avIio,  growing 


W 


UJ S SEERA.TANAM  RAJAH. 
Poxt  H. 


JUTAKA  OF  KING  WESSANTARA. 


37 


more  and  more  enraged  at  this  news,  sent  immediately  an  order  to  Wessantara,  his  son,  to  quit  the 
kingdom  within  the  space  of  one  day. 

I he  king,  after  distributing  all  his  riches  among  the  poor,  set  out  the  next  morning  with  his 
queen,  Mantra-dewa,  and  two  young  children,  in  a carriage  drawn  by  two  horses,  to  go  to  the 
wilderness,  where  an  immense  rock,  with  a cave,  called  Wanga-geriyah,  is  situated,  and  there  to  assume 
the  habits  of  hermits.  While  on  his  way  he  was  accosted  by  two  Brahmins,  who  came  too  late  to 
receive  any  thing  from  the  king,  and  who# desired  him  to  give  them  the  carriage  and  the  horses;  the 
king,  immediately  descending  with  the  queen  from  the  carriage,  presented  it  to  them  with  a cheerful 
countenance.  After  doing  this  act,  the  Icing  and  the  queen,  each  taking  a child  in  their  arms,  proceeded 
on  their  journey  on  foot;  in  their  progress  to  the  wilderness  they  were  obliged  to  pass  through  the 
kingdom  of  his  father-in-law,  named  Chatiya-raja,  and  not  wishing  to  let  his  father-in-law  know  any 
thing  of  his  intention,  he  took  his  lodging  for  the  night  in  a public  place,  or  ambalam.  The  next 
morning  one  of  the  slaves  of  the  palace  happening  to  pass,  saw  and  immediately  knew  them,  not- 
withstanding the  disguise  of  their  dress : she  saluted  and  talked  with  them,  and  learning  their 
resolution  to  go  to  the  wilderness,  immediately  informed  her  mistress,  Chatiya-dewa,  the  mother-in-law 
of  the  King  Wessantara;  who,  on  hearing  this  account,  immediately  repaired  to  the  spot,  with  the 
raja  her  husband,  to  see  their  relations.  When  they  understood  from  them  their  reasons  for  leaving 
their  own  kingdom,  and  coming  to  theirs,  they  used  their  best  endeavours  to  prevent  them  from 
prosecuting  their  intended  journey  into  the  wilderness ; but  finding,  after  every  entreaty,  that  they  were 
resolute  to  go,  the  King  Chatiya  at  last  obtained  their  consent  to  stay  with  them  for  seven  days,  that 
he  might  cause  the  road  to  Wanga-geriyah  to  be  cleared  within  that  time ; and  he  immediately  despatched 
a sufficient  number  of  persons,  with  proper  officers,  to  execute  this  commission.  At  the  expiration  of  that 
time,  when  the  officers  who  were  sent  into  the  wilderness  came  and  reported  to  their  king  that  they  had 
executed  his  orders,  he  communicated  the  same  to  his  son-in-law,  and  the  King  Wessantara  then  advised 
his  queen  to  remain  with  her  father,  as  it  would  be  a hard  thing  for  a woman  to  go  and  live  in  the 
wilderness,  where  there  are  many  dangers ; but,  finding  that  she  was  resolved  upon  accompanying  her 
husband,  and  that  all  his  persuasions  to  remain  with  her  parents  had  no  effect  on  her  mind,  the 
King  Chatiya  took  leave  of  his  daughter,  and  son-in-law  Wessantara,  who,  with  his  queen  and  two 
children,  proceeded  on  his  journey  in  the  wilderness  to  the  place  called  Wanga-geriyah,  and  there  they 
took  the  habits  of  hermits. 

“ The  King  Chatiya  soon  after  taking  leave  of  his  son-in-law,  called  to  him  a trusty  hunter,  or  wedilali , 
who  was  distinguished  for  his  skill  and  courage,  and  placed  him  as  a guard  in  the  way  that  led  to  the 
rock  Wanga-geriyah,  to  prevent  any  person  whatever  from  going  thither,  lest  some  mischief  should  happen 
to  them  or  their  children. 

“ It  happened  about  this  time  that  an  old  Brahmin,  called  Jutaka,  of  another  kingdom,  who  had  a 
thousand  pieces  of  gold  in  his  possession,  having  occasion  to  go  a journey,  deposited  it  for  security 
with  another  Brahmin,  who,  during  the  absence  of  his  friend,  little  expecting  to  see  him  again,  spent  the 
whole  stock  of  gold  with  which  he  was  entrusted ; but  some  time  after,  Jutaka  returning  from  his 
journey,  went  to  his  friend  and  demanded  his  gold;  on  finding  that  he  could  not  produce  it,  Jutaka, 
taking  up  a stick,  threatened  to  beat  him  and  to  carry  him  to  prison.  The  terrified  Brahmin,  seeing  that 
all  his  tears  and  entreaties  would  make  no  impression  on  the  mind  of  the  old  Brahmin,  at  last  proposed 


38 


JUTAKA  OF  ICING  WESSANTARA. 


to  give  his  daughter  (who  was  a beautiful  maid)  to  him  in  marriage,  in  compensation  for  his  gold.  The 
old  Brahmin,  rejoiced  at  this  offer,  caused  the  marriage  ceremony  to  be  published  immediately,  and  went 
home,  taking  his  bride  with  him. 

« While  Jutaka  was  living  happily  with  his  wife,  some  of  his  neighbours,  being  jealous  of  his  happiness, 
took  an  opportunity  to  make  a false  impression  on  her  mind  against  her  husband  ; for,  on  a certain  day, 
when  Jutaka’s  wife  was  drawing  water  at  a well  near  his  house,  some  of  the  neighbours  assembling 
there  first  began  to  speak  of  the  cruel  manner  in  which  she  ^yas  daily  treated  by  her  husband,  and  then 
advised  her  to  desire  her  husband  to  get  some  slaves  for  her.  Jutaka’s  wife,  on  hearing  this,  broke  the 
pot  at  the  well,  and  returning  home  in  a rage  to  her  husband*  seized  and  threw  him  on  the  ground, 
and  began  to  treat  him  in  a most  scandalous  manner,  pulling  his  beard  and  beating  him,  and  telling 
him  that  she  was  not  his  slave,  to  do  every  kind  of  mean  labour  in  his  house,  and  if  he  wished  her  to 
remain  in  his  house,  he  must  procure  her  two  slaves ; she  also  told  him  that  the  easiest  way  to  get  them, 
was  to  go  into  the  wilderness,  and  apply  to  Wessantara,  the  most  charitable  of  hermits.  Jutaka,  who 
loved  his  wife  beyond  any  thing  on  earth,  and  feared  the  consequences  that  would  ensue  if  she  was  not 
gratified,  promised  to  undertake  the  journey,  and  bidding  adieu  to  his  wife,  departed,  taking  with  him 
his  astronomical  book  and  the  travelling  bag.  After  passing  through  the  village,  having  directed  his  way 
towards  the  wilderness,  he  drew  near  the  place  where  Wessantara  was;  and,  as  he  was  passing  by  the 
post  of  the  hunter,  who  was  placed  there  by  the  King  Chatiya,  the  hunter  perceiving  him,  took  his  bow 
and  arrows,  and  began  to  pursue  him  with  his  dog.  The  terrified  J utaka,  seeing  the  danger  that  he 
was  in,  climbed  the  nearest  tree,  crying  out  to  the  hunter — ‘ Stop,  do  not  betray  the  trust  which  the 
king,  your  master,  has  committed  to  you,  for  I was  the  tutor  of  the  King  Wessantara,  who  is  now 
in  the  wilderness,  and  am  going  thither  by  order,  of  King  Chatiya,  your  master,  to  persuade  him,  if 
possible,  to  return  to  his  kingdom,  for  what  other  business  could  I have  to  undertake  this  tedious 
journey?’  The  hunter,  believing  the  artful  story  of  Jutaka,  assisted  him  to  descend  from  the  tree,  and, 
after  conducting  him  some  way,  took  leave  of  him,  directing  him  into  the  right  road  ; and  Jutaka,  pro- 
ceeding on  his  journey,  at  length  came  to  the  place  called  Wanga-geriyah,  where  the  King  Wessantara 
was,  and  applied  to  him  for  his  children.  The  king,  as  he  had  made  a vow,  the  moment  that  he  became 
a hermit,  never  to  refuse  to  any  person  any  thing  whatever,  whilst  he  possessed  it,  could  not  do  otherwise 
than  comply  with  his  request;  accordingly,  he  called  his  two  children,  and  delivered  them  to  Jutaka 
by  pouring  water  on  their  hands. 

“ As  soon  as  Jutaka  had  thus  obtained  what  he  wanted,  he  took  leave  of  the  king,  and  joyfully  departed, 
taking  the  two  young  royal  slaves  with  him  ; but  as  soon  as  he  got  out  of  sight  of  the  king,  he  tied 
the  arms  of  the  children  to  make  them  more  secure,  and  led  them.  Fortunately  for  the  children,  Jutaka, 
missing  the  right  road,  after  wandering  for  some  time  in  the  wilderness,  at  last  came  to  the  kingdom  of  their 
grandfather,  Chatiya-raja,  who,  on  hearing  that  his  grandchildren  were  in  his  dominions,  in  the  possession 
of  an  old  Brahmin,  immediately  sent  trusty  officers  to  bring  them  all  before  him.  When  they  were 
all  come,  and  he  had  learned  from  Jutaka  the  fate  of  the  children,  he  proposed  to  him  to  give  him  the 
weight  of  the  children  in  gold  ; to  which  Jutaka  agreeing,  the  king  ordered  the  children  to  be  weighed,  and 
their  weight  in  gold  to  be  given  to  him  : he  also  directed  that  he  should  be  entertained  with  the  choicest 
food;  which  being  accordingly  done,  the  king  took  the  two  young  grandchildren,  but  Jutaka,  who  had 
never  tasted  so  many  delicacies  in  his  life,  devoured  so  much  more  than  he  could  reasonably  hold,  that  it 


I 


JUTAKA  OF  KING  WESSANTARA. 


39 


proved  fatal  to  him.  So  he  died  some  hours  afterwards  by  the  bursting  open  of  his  bowels,  and  thus  his 
gold  went  back  to  the  king’s  store.” 


EXPLANATION  OF  PLATES  IV.  AND  V. 

1.  The  King  Wessantara  on  the  throne. 

2.  The  king  riding  out  on  an  ail-^ita,  or  elephant,  attended  by  the  guards ; and  a party  of 
Bramins  apply  to  him  for  the  loan  of  his  elephant. 

3.  The  king  delivers  up  his  elephajit  to  them. 

4.  Giving  alms  to  the  poor  mendicants. 

5.  Cooking  the  alms. 

6.  The  ministers  entreating  the  king  to  desist  from  his  resolution. 

7.  The  ministers  taking  leave  of  their  master. 

8.  The  king  and  queen  taking  leave  of  their  father. 

9.  The  king  and  his  family  proceed  to  go  to  the  wilderness. 

10.  A Brahmin  craves  the  king’s  carriage  and  horses  of  him. 

11.  The  king,  after  giving  the  carriage  and  horses,  begins  to  walk  with  the  queen,  carrying  the 
children  in  their  arms. 

12.  Sitting  in  the  ambalam  with  their  children. 

13.  The  slave  sees  and  recognises  them. 

14.  The  King  Chatiya  comes  and  salutes  his  son-in-law. 

15.  The  King  Wessantara  exhorts  his  queen  to  remain  with  her  parents. 

16.  The  King  Chatiya  directs  his  subjects  to  go  and  clear  the  road  into  the  wilderness. 

17.  The  King  Chatiya  takes  leave  of  his  son-in-law. 

18.  The  queen  takes  leave  of  the  king,  her  father. 

19.  The  King  Wessantara  sits  in  his  cell  in  the  dress  of  a hermit. 

20.  The  queen  sits  in  her  cell  with  the  children  in  the  hermit’s  dress. 

21.  Jutaka,  the  Brahmin,  receives  his  intended  wife  from  her  father. 

22.  Jutaka  goes  with  his  wife  to  his  home. 

23.  The  wife  of  Jutaka  draws  water  at  a well,  where  her  neighbours  instruct  her  how  to  get  some 

slaves. 

24.  Jutaka’s  wife  abuses  her  husband,  and  insists  on  his  procuring  her  some  slaves 

25.  Jutaka  takes  leave  of  his  wife  to  go  in  search  of  slaves. 

26.  Jutaka  proceeds  on  his  journey. 

27.  Jutaka  attacked  by  the  hunter  on  his  road. 

28.  Jutaka  applies  to  the  king  for  the  children. 

29.  The  King  Wessantara  gives  his  children  to  Jutaka. 

30.  Jutaka  leads  the  children. 

31.  Jutaka  and  the  children  are  brought  before  King  Chatiya. 

32.  The  children  are  weighed  against  gold. 

33.  The  death  of  Jutaka. 


40 


JUTAKA  OF  KING  WESSANTARA. 


In  tracing  the  adventures  of  King  Wessantara,  here  delineated,  the  first  and  most  prominent  object 
is  the  ail-aita,  or  white  elephant,  the  copy  of  the  great  elephant  belonging  to  the  paradise,  or  garden  of  the 
Tavateinza  heaven.  This  important  animal  was  regarded  as  oracular  and  capable  of  giving  responses,  and 
it  has  been  considered  as  a token  of  political  power,  as  well  as  of  the  divine  favour.  By  the  chief  Indo- 
Chinese  states,  the  possession  of  such  a quadruped  is  ascribed  to  the  especial  favour  of  the  Budha,  and  it 
is  regarded  as  a gift  from  the  gods  of  the  heavens,  who  order  the  process  of  events  in  this  sublunary  stage; 
and  the  Dewa  Loka  heavens  are  thus  frequently  declared  to  shower  down  gold,  jewels,  robes  of  honour, 
chettras  of  dignity  (umbrellas),  whenever  the  gods  are  propitious.  For  a monarch  to  proclaim  himself  the 
king  of  the  white  elephant,  is  the  same  as  to  designate  himself  thy  favourite  of  the  gods,  and  also  to  ascribe 
all  virtue  and  excellence  to  his  actions ; and,  therefore,  any  similar  assumption  or  transfer  of  it  to  any  other 
state  or  person,  would  be  resented  as  the  renunciation  of  a divine  right.  Thus  Wessantara,  meditating  the 
assumption  of  the  Budhaship,  and  prepared  for  the  most  signal  sacrifices,  bestows  his  ail-aita  upon  the 
Brahmins  who  beg  it ; and  herein,  also,  are  shown  the  property  of  the  animal  to  work  miracles,  and  the 
inherent  divinity  which  he  possesses,  that  they  ground  the  request  on  the  expectation  that  his  presence  will 
deliver  them  from  a great  drought;  the  ministers,  however,  deeming  it  to  be  an  act  of  impiety,  refuse 

to  participate  in  it,  and,  exposing  themselves  to  the  consequences,  expostulate,  and  finally  leave  him. 

« 

Having  divested  himself  of  his  royal  and  sacred  supremacy,  he  next  exhibits  himself  as  the  feeder  and 
benefactor  of  the  mendicant  class.  The  rank  and  importance  which  these  naked  and  disfigured  fanatics 
assume  in  the  presence  of  the  proudest  princes  can  only  be  attributed  to  the  deep  impression  which  this 
act  of  the  Budha  Gaudma’s  humility  was  calculated  to  make ; but  it  does  not  appertain  to  the  life  of 
Gaudma  alone,  for  the  Prince  Kumara,  as  well  as  every  character  of  the  sacred  histories,  made  a practice  of 
feeding  this  class,  as  a portion  of  duty.  Wessantara  now  proceeds  to  distribute  his  riches,  and  resigning 
his  kingly  power,  to  retire  to  the  wilderness,  as  the  Ban  Perust,  who,  after  fifty  years  of  age,  devotes 
himself  to  the  service  of  God  in  the  desert,  which  appears  to  have  been  the  usual  road  of  every  aspirant 
after  heavenly  exaltation  or  earthly  honours.  Zoroaster  dwelt  amid  the  caves  and  scorching  plains  of 
Mazanderan  ; Pythagoras  retired  to  the  cave  of  Zalmoxis ; Mahomet  brooded  over  his  mission  in  the 
solitudes  of  A1  Hafia.  He  finally  marks  the  consummating  act  of  self-surrender,  by  giving  up  his 
children  at  the  request  of  J utaka,  whose  sordid  and  avaricious  qualities  seem  purposely  introduced  to 
heighten  the  colouring,*  and  to  aggravate  the  sacrifice  of  thus  yielding  even  his  children  to  a being 
in  all  respects  unworthy  of  the  least  exercise  of  benevolence.  With  this  last  act,  as  the  climax  of 
self-denial,  the  tale  concludes  with  a stroke  of  retributive  morality,  in  making  Jutaka  to  perish  from 
the  consequences  of  his  own  ill-regulated  appetite ; thus  exhibiting  the  exaltation  of  Wessantara 
to  the  heaven  Toisite,  and  Jutaka’s  exemplary  punishment  and  death,  a tenet  precisely  expressing  the 
Budhist  idea. 


The  act  of  “weighing  the  children  against  gold,"  is  an  act  of  piety  frequently  resorted  to  by  Indian  princes  in  great  trouble  or 
extremity  of  sickness,  to  propitiate  the  favour  of  heaven  ; the  gold  being  distributed  among  religious  mendicants. 


BEINGS  LIVING  IN  THE  UNIVERSE. 


41 


BEINGS  LIVING  IN  THE  UNIVERSE. 

Before  we  enter  upon  the  description  of  the  heavens,  it  may  be  useful  to  draw  into  one  view  the 
different  agents  of  Budhism,  as  exhibited  in  the  legends  and  doctrine  of  this  faith,  for  this  list, 
together  with  the  recapitulation  of  their  abodes,  will  greatly  aid  the  reader  to  understand  what  follows. 

All  living  beings  belong  to  one  of  the  three  following  classes  : — 1.  The  Cliama,  or  reproduction. — 
2.  The  Rupa,  or  material,  that  is  to  say,  visible  gods. — 3.  The  Arupa,  or  immaterial.  These  beings 
ascend  in  progressive  transmigrations  from  the  lower  to  the  higher  classes,  according  to  their  good  or  bad 
conduct  in  that  which  they  have  just  left ; and  their  last  state  of  final  beatitude,  which  is  indissoluble 
and  unchangeable,  is  Nirwana.  As  beings  are  continually  proceeding  from  one  state  of  existence  to 
another,  so  are  the  worlds  which  they  inhabit ; and  neither  the  beginning,  nor  the  termination,  of  this 
unbroken  chain  of  mundane  systems,  was  known  to  Gauclma  himself.  These  beings  inhabit  “ the 
Loka  or  Logha,”  a word  expressing  the  universe,  and  signifying  successive  destruction  and  reproduction, 
and  are  thus  classed : 

Mankind,  and  the  Nat  gods  their  inspectors  and  judges,  with  attendants  ranging  in  rank  as  tutelary 
genii  and  evil  demons.*  To  this  first  class  are  appropriated  the  earth,  the  atmospheric  regions  above  it, 
forming  the  region  of  Mienmo,  and  the  six  Dewa  heavens,  which  successively  arise  above  each  other  in 
superior  splendour. 

To  the  second  class,  the  Rupa,  or  visible  gods,  belong  the  sixteen  heavens  of  Brahma  Loka,  7 to  22. 

The  third,  all  spirit,  or  immaterial,  which  comprises  the  Passe  Budhas,  the  Arihats,  and  all 
faithful  followers  of  the  Budha,  who  have  gained  the  state  of  Nirwana,  occupy  from  23  to  26. 

The  Budhas  in  their  hall  of  glory  (Mokse)  occupy  the  sky,  or  empyrean,  above  all. 

1.  The  Chama  class  comprises  the  inhabitants  of  this  planet;  combined  with  which  may  be  classed 
the  superior  beings  of  the  unknown  southern  part,  which  (although  imaginary  beings)  are  frequently 
mentioned  in  the  Budha  books,  namely  : — 

2.  The  gods  of  the  Himaleh  Parkwette. 

the  Satagirinam  Parkwette. 

the  Wissametee  Parkwette. 

the  Wipoele  Parkwette. 

3.  In  a doctrinal  conformity  of  character  with  those  beings  are  the  five  hill-gods  of  Ceylon,  to  whom 
the  Budha,  through  the  chief  god  of  the  Dewa  Loka,  deputed  the  superintendence  of  the  earth.  These 
are  the  Pattinnee,  or  gods  of  healing.f  Wisme-karma,  the  chief,  or  protector  of  the  Budha  faith,  as  the 
god  of  the  mountain  Waykoote,  governs  the  destinies  of  Ceylon  ; he  is,  also,  the  artificer  of  the  immortal 
arms  of  Sekkraia,  herein  resembling  Vulcan,  the  Lemnian  deity,  and  forms,  with  the  aid  of  his  genii,  the 
stupendous  excavations  of  the  rock  temples. 

' It  is  worthy  of  notice,  that  both  these  classes,  the  genii  and  demons,  are  called  devils , and  although  mischievous  are  not 
determinately  and  purely  evil  agents. 

t It  is  impossible  not  to  advert  to  Chiron,  the  Centaur,  skilled  in  pharmacy  and  surgery,  invested  with  immortality,  and  a species 
of  demi-god,  inhabiting  Mount  GEta,  which  was  also  the  scene  of  the  exploits  of  the  Nemean  Hercules. 


G 


42  BEINGS  LIVING  IN  THE  UNIVERSE. 

Saman-dewa,  who  reigns  on  Adam’s  Peak,  and  governs  the  whole  class  of  genii,  &c.,  entitled  the 
Koombandeo,  or  inferior  gods.* 

Kandi-kumara,  who  is  worshipped  at  Katregam. 

Wiebesana,  the  god  of  power  for  the  temple  of  Calany. 

These  servants  of  the  gods  of  the  heavens  of  the  Dewa  Loka  possess  the  power  of  transformation, 
and  of  commanding  the  elements  of  the  atmosphere. 

4.  The  Asura-raja,  king  of  the  Asura  Loka,  which  lies  beneath  the  Maha-meru  stone,  in  the  region 

Treekooto,  3000  juzana  high,  which  is  sustained  on  three  rocks  of  carbuncle ; supporting  the  central 
mount  Mienmo.  # 

5.  Suthagiria,  the  chief  of  the  demons,  obedient  to  the  region  of  Jugandere. 

6.  The  four  elementary  gods  of  the  first  Dewa  Loka,  who  exercise  an  influence,  as  it  will  be  seen, 
on  its  inhabitants,  and  can  command  the  regions  of  the  atmosphere ; these  are 

Dirtheraach  Shetheire,  the  god  of  the  East, 


Wiroedhe West, 

Wiroe  Pakshe North, 

Tiroe  Wenne South. 


These  possess  as  a bon  or  'abode,  the  first  heaven,  or  the  Dewa  Loka  Tjaturum-maharakeye,  and  their 
office  is  to  watch  around  the  Parkwette,  or  Maha-meru  stone,  and  to  warn  the  god  Sekkraia  of  the 
approach  of  his  enemy,  the  Asura-raja. 

7.  The  thirty-two  councillors,  or  recorders  (visitors  of  the  earth),  who  report  to  the  chief  god, 
Sekkraia,  on  the  moral  state  of  man,  and  who  inhabit  the  second  Dewa  Loka,  or  the  Tavateinza  heaven 

8.  The  god  Sekkraia,  in  many  respects  resembling  the  god  of  the  sun  of  the  Greek  myths,  chief  of 
the  second,  or  Tavateinza  heaven. 

Other  deities,  not  particularized  in  the  codes,  range  in. the  heavens,  Nos.  3 to  5. 

9.  The  sixth  Dewa  Loka  is  the  abode  of  the  Wassawarty-raja,  a chief,  and  most  powerful  Nat  god, 
who  is  so  decidedly  the  enemy  of  the  Budha,  as  to  be  called  in  some  manuscripts,  the  Anti-Budhist. 
This  deity  we  shall  trace  in  his  legend,  as  exercising  an  open  as  well  as  covert  hostility  against  the  laws 


* In  illustration  of  the  rank  and  importance  which  these  agents,  or  inferior  gods,  hold  in  the  opinion  of  the  votaries  of  the  Budha, 
we  subjoin  the  following  ceremonial  at  the  interment  of  the  late  King  of  Siam,  wherein  these  deities  were  the  chief  characters  exhibited. 
“ The  funeral  of  the  late  King  of  Siam  took  place  on  the  23d  of  April,  1825,  and  among  the  crowded  procession  were  introduced  the 
following  representations  of  the  divine  inhabitants  of  the  Budhist  aerial  and  celestial  regions: 

“ The  figure  of  a rhinoceros,  of  the  size  of  an  elephant,  upon  a sledge,  or  carriage  upon  low  wheels,  drawn  by  men  and  horses,  with 
a small  temple  on  its  back,  in  which  was  a quantity  of  yellow  dresses,  to  be  given  to  the  priests  as  offerings. 

“ Two  figures  of  elephants  (very  large)  drawn  as  above. 

“ Two  figures  of  horses,  similarly  drawn. 

“ Four  figures  of  large  monkeys,  two  and  two. 

“ Four  figures  of  eagles,  two  and  two. 

“ Four  figures  of  cocks,  two  and  two. 

“ Four  figures  of  wild  men,  or  giants,  two  and  two. 

“ Four  figures  of  lions  of  immense  size,  two  and  two. 

“ These  were  followed  by  the  figures  of  a variety  of  other  indescribable  beasts  and  birds,  two  and  two,  and  each  figure  bore  its 
supply  of  dresses  for  the  priests. 

Eight  hundred  men  dressed  in  white,  with  white  caps  or  helmets — these  represented  celestial  messengers,  and  their  purport  was, 
as  if  to  show  the  soul  of  the  deceased  king  the  way  to  heaven.  Along  with  these  were  many  bunds  of  music.” — Cranford's  Embassy  to 
Slam,  318. 


These  are  all  of  the  Koombandeo,  or  gods  of  the  Jugandere. 


BEINGS  LIVING  IN  THE  UNIVERSE. 


43 

and  person  of  Gaudma,  and  yet  we  find  him  and  his  followers  placed  in  the  highest  Dewa  Loka  of 
splendour  and  happiness. 

10.  The  Brahma  Loka  heavens,  where  the  god,  Sahan-pati  Maha-brahma,  is  supreme ; he  inhabits  the 
Brahma-keyepenam,  or  supreme  ninth  heaven  of  the  Brahma  Loka,  and  is  the  chief  of  all, except  the  Budhas. 

11.  To  the  Budha,  the  supreme  of  the  Budhist  faith,  is  assigned  the  sky,  the  blue  empyrean,  the 
cerulean  ether,  the  peculiar  region  of  the  great  Olympian  Jove,  in  his  highest  elevation.  In  the 
Budhist  doctrine  the  elements  are  deified,  and  the  empyrean  is  a hon  or  habitation,  called  Nirwasanyana 
Sansa-yattia,  and  deified  as  the  giver  of  Nirwana.  This  region  is  the  hope  of  every  Budhist,  and  the 
reward  of  every  faithful  follower  ant^  disciple  of  the  Budha,  wherein  he  rests,  sheltered  for  ever 
from  every  change,  and  iii  the  possession  of  all  possible  good.  Here,  in  a hall  of  glory,  repose  the  Budhas, 
and  among  others,  Gaudma,  whose  transmigTation  into  this  abode, 'or  becoming  Nirwana,  as  it  is  termed, 
marks  the  commencement  of  the  present  era. 

Thus  the  three  classes  of  beings  are  subdivided  into  thirty-one  species ; each  having  its  proper 
bon  or  habitation  in  the  Chama.  There  is  also  the  Asura  Loka,  or  universe  below  the  great  abyss,  the 
rocks,  central  stone,  and  gardens,  but  not  the  original  tree  of  inebriating  fruit;  this  abode  or  bon , 
forms  No.  1. 

The  four  hells,  states  of  suffering,  called  Ape,  No.  2. 

The  subterranean  world,  or  the  portion  of  the  earth,  which  is  the  abode  of  the  Naga  gods,  or 
serpents,  No.  3. 

The  world,  Manoepeloka,  the  abode  of  man,  No.  4. 

The  Mienmo  central  stone,  and  its  regions,  Jugandere,  &c.,  tenanted  by  the  Koombandeo,  or 
tutelary  gods,  or  devils ; also  by  inferior  deities  who  transmigrate ; gods  of  rocks,  woods,  and  trees, 
snakes,  birds,  and  giants,  No.  5. 

The  six  Dewa  Loka  gods  of  the  elements,  conducting  the  metempsychosis,  or  purifying  changes  of 
man’s  existence,  Nos.  6,  7,  8,  9,  10, 11. 

Thus  are  formed  the  eleven  bon , or  states  of  existence,  of  which  four,  the  hells,  are  states  of  misery, 
and  seven  declared  to  be  states  of  happiness.  The  Asuras  therefore  we  find,  are  not  reckoned  as  in 
suffering,  nor  purely  evil  agents. 

In  the  Rupas,  or  sixteen  bons  of  the  heavens  of  Maha-brahma,  and  Brahma  gods,  Nos.  7 to  22,  the 
twenty-second  heaven  forms  a Zian,  or  refuge,  indissoluble  at  the  occurrence  of  a determinate  period  of 
mundane  destruction,  wherein  the  existence  of  those  beings  who  have  acquired  a title  to  Nirwana,  but  as 
yet  not  advanced  to  the  triumphing  heavens,  is  preserved  for  Nirwana,  with  certain  other  beings  destined 
to  be  the  germs  of  a renewed  world ; and  termed  therefore,  a triumphing  heaven  in  the  arupa  state, 
comprehending  Nos.  22  to  26. 

The  27th  bon,  is  the  sky,  the  empyrean,  or  hall  of  glory. 

Respecting  the  happiness  of  all  these  different  classes  of  beings  it  is  stated  generally  in  the  writings, 
that  the  happiness  of  each  state  is  double  that  of  the  inferior  one,  and  the  lives  of  the  inhabitants  of  each 
bon , or  habitation,  endure  four  times  as  long  as  those  of  the  next  inferior  species.  According  to  this 
ratio,  the  highest  gods  of  the  sixth  Dewa  Loka  would  live  576  millions  of  years. 

The  duration  of  the  lives  of  the  Brahma  deities  increase  similarly,  and  their  almost  interminable 
periods  may  be  found  in  the  Asiatic  Researches , vi.  215. 


TIIE  EARTH  AND  ATMOSPHERIC  REGION. 


4(> 

to  the  lake  of  Anaudat,  is  the  lake  Zaddan,  encircled  by  blooming  gardens  and  mountains  of  gold,  silver, 
carbuncles,  and  crystal,  one  of  which  emits  a splendour  equal  to  that  of  the  sun.  To  the  west  of  the 
lake  Zaddan  is  a beautiful  cave  filled  with  gold  and  jewels,  and  to  the  north  is  another  lake  fifty  juxana  in 
length,  and  as  much  in  breadth ; its  waters  nourish  various  flowering  trees,  and  its  sands  are  minute 
fragments  of  crystals  and  of  diamonds.  Between  the  lakes  grows  the  Gnaung-bayn,  or  the  Budha  tree, 
which  is  sacred,  as  being  the  tree  under  which  Gaiidma  received  his  divine  nature;  and  here  resides  the 
king  of  the  elephants,  named,  from  the  place  of  his  abode,  Zadda ; he  is  king  of  the  white,  red, 
and  black  elephants,  all  which  weave  and  wear  crowns  of  flowers  of  the  sacred  tree,  and  in  winter 
live  in  golden  caves,  near  which  reside  genii,  birds,  and  other  g beings.  The  most  celebrated  is  the  lion 
Chalarasi,  and  a lion  which  has  a human  head  and  a lion’s  body;  this  kind  is  never  seen  but  when  a 
Budha  appears  on  earth.  Such  are  a few  of  the  details  characterising  the  Mienmo  mount,  the  prototype 
of  the  Olympian,  Samothracian,  and  other  sacred  hills. 

Connected  herewith,  is  the  region  of  the  air,  or  Jugandere,  the  region  covering  the  earth,  which  is 
on  the  summit  of  Mienmo,  and  the  seat  of  the  stars  and  planets,  and  all  the  bodies  which  we  call 
celestial.*  This  abode,  which,  with  its  inhabitants,  is  subject  to  the  chief  of  the  first  Dewa  Loka  heaven, 
is  divided  into  four  portions,  each  of  which  districts  is  guarded  by  its  appropriate  inhabitants,  and  these 
maintain  the  region  about  the  sacred  mount  and  the  earth  against  the  rebel  Asuras.  The  first  portion 
is  called  Ivoombandeo  Ludaia,  and  is  the  residence  of  genii,  or  inferior  gods  of  the  woods,  rivers,  and 
rocks,  the  prototypes  of  the  Pan,  Hamadryads,  and  Naiads,  of  Greece.  The  second  station,  called 
Yakhsa  Ludaia,  is  tenanted  by  the  giants.  The  third,  termed  Garuda  Ludaia,  is  the  region  of  the 
Nat  gods,f  under  the  shape  of  monstrous  birds  ; these,  by  the  power  Galoun,  can  cause  rain.  The 
fourth,  called  Naga  Ludaia,  is  the  abode  of  the  nagas , serpents,  and  dragons,  who  are  also  Nat  gods. 
Thus  the  monstrosities  of  fiction  derive  their  weight  and  impress  from  forming  an  intermediate  state 


alabaster,  is  most  commonly  yellow,  or  gilt.  The  form  and  countenance  of  the  Singalcse  Budha  Mr.  Finlayson  deems  to  be  decidedly 
Egyptian  or  Ethiopian.  The  priests  of  the  Budha  are  gilt  and  embalmed  after  death,  as  the  Egyptian  mummies  frequently  are, 
and  the  Budhist  priests  of  Siam  use  a staff,  with  a bird’s  head  carved  on  it ; thus  in  the  same  manner  all  the  images  of  Osiris  invariably 
carry  this  staff,  so  that  it  is  called  the  sceptre  of  Osiris.  As  the  bull  Apis  and  Mnevis  were  an  actual  incarnation  of  deity,  and  furnished 
oracles,  so  the  white  elephant  is  considered  a Budha,  and,  according  to  M.  Klaproth,  was  reputed  to  furnish  oracles  so  late  as  the 
eighth  century.  We  may  also  trace  a striking  resemblance  between  the  natural  scenery  of  the  two  countries,  for  as  Egypt,  a longitudinal 
valley,  composed  of  black  slime,  or  mud,  from  the  yearly  inundation  of  the  Nile,  was  called  Chemia  or  Black,  by  Plutarch,  so  is  Siam, 
a similar  valley,  corresponding  in  its  soil,  arising  from  the  deposits  of  the  Mei-nam  river,  called  Chiamay,  Syamay  or  Black  ; and  in  the 
city  of  Arracan,  the  country  whence  the  Birmans  derived  their  faith,  have  recently  been  discovered  figures  of  the  Egyptian  sphynx, 
and  also  parts  of  an  ancient  zodiac,  in  a series  of  very  ancient  signs,  in  perfect  conformity  with  those  transmitted  down  to  us. — Asiatic 
Journal  for  1826,  513. 

The  Siamese  exhibit  the  most  striking  resemblance  to  the  ancient  Egyptians  in  the  custom  of  shaving  their  heads,  in  their  frequent 
ablutions,  in  the  practice  of  wearing  linen  invariably  followed  by  the  priests,  and  also  in  the  character  of  their  physiognomy  and  complexion. 
It  is  a fact  worthy  of  particular  remark,  that  wherever  the  rites  of  Egypt  penetrated,  there  the  use  of  linen  by  the  sacerdotal  order  may  be 
traced.  We  may  add  another  point  of  resemblance,  inasmuch  as  the  Siamese  manifest  a stronger  dislike  than  any  other  branch  of  the 
Indo-Chinese  race  to  the  pursuits  of  commerce  and  navigation. 

• It  seems  evident,  from  many  particulars,  that  this  region  is  one  of  the  most  important  of  the  system,  as  being  characterised  by 
sundry  incidents  in  the  existence  of  the  Budha,  and  also  being  the  abode  of  the  chief  agents  in  his  deification  and  power  ; thus  the  river 
which  flows  from  this  spot  is  said  to  be  the  stream  on  which  the  miracle  of  the  golden  dish  floating  against  the  current  is  exhibited, 
which  enables  the  Budha  to  claim  the  Budhaship.  It  is  also  the  abode  of  the  dragon  king,  who  awakes  and  hails  the  new  god,  as  well 
as  the  compound  lion,  always  placed  near  the  Vihari  of  Gaudma.  Here  too  is  the  sacred  tree,  with  its  fruits  and  flowers.  All  these 
things  figure  in  the  progress  and  life  of  the  Budha : in  this  region,  Jugandere,  we  shall  trace  also  the  abodes  of  the  four  Pattinnee  gods. 

t Around  Jugandere  is  Issedari  Pagwatte,  where  lives  a bird  called  Gourouuss,  one  hundred  and  fifty  juzana  in  height. — Asiatic 
Researches,  i.  406. 


the  earth  and  atmospheric  region. 


47 


through  which  the  soul  transmigrates  from  the  earth  into  the  heavens,  of  which  this  region  is  the  border 
or  frontier,  and  they  act  probably  as  ministers  of  punishment,  when  the  sins  committed  consign  the 
delinquent  to  the  hells,  or  to  a degradation  of  form.  In  this  systematic  arrangement  we  may  trace  a 
clue  to  the  magic  power  of  enchanters,  who  are  often  described  as  assuming  and  exercising  the 
privilege  of  transforming  human  beings  into  bestial  forms,  either  at  their  caprice  or  as  a punishment ; 
since,  in  the  local  situation  of  these  genii  and  dragons,  we  immediately  discover  the  mode  whereby  such 
intermediate  agents  become  the  organs  of  good  or  evil  to  man— conceptions  which  have  struck  deep  root 
into  the  literature,  feelings,  and  machinery  of  the  East,  and  thence  extended  to  the  great  bulk  of 
mankind. 

ft 

The  scene  of  their  agency  is  the  region  of  the  sacred  mount  Mienmo,  the  type  of  the  Maha-meru,  the 
centre  of  the  universe,  in  its  roots  penetrating  downwards  to  the  central  abyss,  even  to  the  hells,  the  abode 
of  condemned  souls,  and  of  the  Asuras  or  rebel  spirits ; while,  in  its  upward  progress,  it  is  the  link  and 
foundation  of  every  stage,  of  the  heavens ; it  therefore  connects  together  these  regions  with  the  state  of 
man's  existence.  Thus,  as  a covering  to  the  earth,  or  its  azure  vault,  it  becomes  its  primary  region  or 
atmosphere,  wherein  are  stationed  beings  superior  to  man,  called  inferior  gods,  in  whose  direction  is 
the  great  regulating  principle  of  rewards  and  of  punishments  attendant  on  the  transmigrations  after 
death.  « 

l he  all-powerful  interest  attached  to  these  beings,  therefore,  naturally  results  from  their  proximity 
to  the  earth,  their  personal  association  with  man,  and  their  power  of  transformation,  itself  a feature  in 
the  existence  of  man  ; the  difference  being,  that  these  genii  (alike  transcripts  of  the  Simorgh,  the  Garuda, 
and  other  fictions  of  Eastern  imagery)  exercise  the  power  of  assuming  shapes  at  will,  whereas  in  man, 
his  mortal  existence  is  made  a medium  of  discipline  and  degrading  confinement,  whence  the  figurative 
expressions  of  a prison,  a tenement  of  clay,  &c.,  as  applied  to  the  body,  are  probably  derived. 

In  the  sketch  of  the  protecting  genii,  and  their  abode,  given  in  the  Asiatic  Researches  (vi.  265), 
is  a legend  purely  oriental,  connected  with  the  most  striking  type  of  orientalism,  the  king  of  the 
dragons.*  This  legend  exhibits  two  incidents,  prominently  detailed  in  every  Budhist  work  on  the 
life  of  Gaudma,  and  which  have  neither  interest  nor  meaning,  without  the  elucidation  of  the  doctrine, 
which  is  as  follows : — A woman,  bearing  a plate  or  dish  of  rice,  beholds  Gaudma  leaning  against  his 
tree  (the  bogaya),  and  she  conceives  the  desire  of  performing  a meritorious  action,  by  presenting  to  him 
her  rice-dish  for  his  repast ; Gaudma,  by  his  prescience  knowing  and  deciding  to  accept  the  offer, 
intimates  to  her,  that  her  inward  thought  and  wish  will  in  future  come  to  pass.  Gaudma,  after  eating 


Dr.  W arton  observes,  “ that  there  is  no  character  more  strictly  Oriental  than  the  dragons  of  romance  and  fiction ; they  are 
intermixed  with  every  tradition  of  early  date,  and  of  themselves  confer  a species  of  illustrative  evidence  of  origin.  In  no  writings  me 
these  characters  more  marked,  than  in  the  details  of  Budhism ; these  record  particulars  of  the  Nagas,  or  kingly  snakes,  inhabiting  the 
cavities  under  the  earth,  corresponding  with  the  abodes  of  Tiresias  and  the  Greek  seers,  a region  of  mystery  and  darkness,  wherein 
revolves  much  of  the  system  of  divination  and  oracular  response,  connected  with  inflation,  or  a sort  of  possession,  designating  the  spirit  of 
Python  himself,  the  dragon  serpent  slain  by  Apollo.  The  great  divining  deity  of  Delphi  was  invoked  at  a spot  placed  over  the  supposed 
central  abyss,  in  the  vicinity  whereof  the  temple  stood;  near  it,  two  mighty  fissured  rocks  towered  above  its  roof,  from  whence  an 
aperture  opened  to  the  bowels  of  the  earth.”  Such  are  the  descriptions  given  by  ancient  writers,  but  from  the  higher  parts  of  Parnassus 
being  of  limestone,  containing  entrochi  and  other  organic  remains,  Dr.  Daubeny  considers  that  certain  gaseous  exhalations  from  the 
ground  co-operated  with  the  enthusiasm  of  the  moment  in  bringing  on  the  ecstasies  of  the  priestesses.  Near  this  opening  stood  a pillar 
of  two  convoluted  Nagas,  or  serpents,  still  existing  in  the  hippodrome  of  Constantinople,  and  the  tripod,  on  which  the  reluctant  priestess 
was  held  or  bound  down  to  receive  the  afflatus  from  the  abyss,  by  virtue  of  which  the  response  was  accounted  a divination. 


48 


THE  EARTH  AND  ATMOSPHERIC  REGION. 


of  the  rice,  knowing  now  that  the  rite  was  fulfilled,  that  he  was  become  a Hi  id  ha,  to  show  his  supreme 
will,  according  to  the  ancient  doctrine,  throws  the  dish,  which  proves  to  be  of  gold,  into  the  stream, 
to  demonstrate  to  the  world  his  miraculous  power,  by  its  ascending  against  the  current ; which  result 
of  course  takes  place,  so  that  the  dish  actually  ascends  against  the  current  of  the  river  lvassi,  and  Gaudma 
is  acknowledged  to  be  the  Budha. 

There  is  a reference  to  this  part  of  the  Budhist  doctrine  in  the  following  passage,  which  at  once 
connects  the  dragons,  or  the  ancient  Ophite  worship,  with  the  Budha  Gaudma : — “ Below  the  first 
heaven  are  found  many  Nat,  who  inhabit  waters,  woods,  and  mountains,  in  the  shape  of  large  birds, 
dragons,  and  the  like;  and  it  is  said  that  the  king  of  the  dragons  saw  the  first  god  (the  first  Budha),  and 
that  he  will  see  the  last.  This  king  of  the  dragons  always  sleeps  at  the  foot  of  the  Hemavunta 
mountains,  whence  springs  the  river  Kassi  (the  Ganges,  near  Benares),  during  the  existence  of  a world, 
and  he  only  awakes  at  the  appearance  of  a new  god  (a  Budha).  When  any  human  being  has  arrived 
at  such  a transcendent  degree  of  merit  as  to  deserve  to  be  declared  a Budha,  he  eats  rice , which  has 
been  boiled  in  a golden  “goblet,  and  he  then  manifests  a proof  of  his  newly  acquired  divinity,  by 
throwing  the  goblet  into  the  river  Kassi.  The  goblet  floats  against  the  stream  till  it  arrives  at  the 
place  where  the  king  of  the  dragons  sleeps;  there  it  strikes  against  the  rock  and  makes  a noise,  when 
the  king  awakes.” 

In  all  works  on  Budhist  doctrines,  the  era,  or  Budha-verouse,  is  termed  the  period  “ when  the 
milken  rice  came  into  the  world  which  evidently  alludes  to  this  incident  of  Gaudma’s  eating  the 
rice,  a symbol  of  the  acquiescence  of  the  dragon  king  in  his  exaltation  to  the  Budhaship.  The  floating 
of  the  golden  dish,  although  in  the  narrative  described  without  any  comment  which  marks  its  true 
import,  formed  in  reality  the  sign  and  miracle  by  which  the  elevation  of  the  Budha  was  ratified; 
and  the  act  of  the  woman  became  a most  important  office  of  duty  and  respect  to  the  great  Eastern 
lawgiver,  as  furnishing  the  test  of  his  divinity,  by  presenting  to  him  rice,  the  produce  of  the  earth, 
probably  in  token  of  its  submission  to  his  divine  will,  f 

Connected  with  the  Maha-meru,  the  Hemavunta,  or  Mount  Imaus,  and  those  sacred  mounts,  whence 
flow  the  sacred  Kassi  and  other  streams,  which  confer  such  sanctity  on  the  sources  of  rivers,  and 
the  Jugandere,  the  region  of  the  air,  are  also  the  hill-gods,  for  their  abodes  are  on  the  peaks  of  hills 
which  ascend  into  the  same  atmospheric  region  superior  to  man.  These  four  deities  form  the  subjects  of 
plates  6,  7,  8,  and  9,  and  exhibit  these  four  gods  attended  by  one  of  each  of  the  four  classes  of  the  genii 
of  Jugandere,  the  spot  designated  in  the  doctrine  as  the  residence  of  the  four  Nathe  Dewa  gods.  The 
legends  of  the  Budha  narrate  that  their  president  or  chief,  Wisme-karma,  has  thus  allotted  their 
positions : — 

Wisme-karma-raja,  inhabits  Waykotte,  Himaleh-vanni,  a peak  of  the  Himaleh  mountains. 

Saman-dewa-raja  dwells  on  Adam’s  Peak,  the  most  celebrated  of  the  mountains  of  Ceylon. 

* The  practice  of  the  court  of  Inimerapura,  in  selecting  for  presentation  to  the  golden  feet  a tmzzur  of  rice,  is  grounded  on  this 
incident  in  the  life  of  the  Budha,  and  not  on  the  ideas  suggested  by  Synies  ; it  is  significant  of  the  spiritual  superiority,  as  well  as  temporal 
supremacy,  claimed  by  the  Birmah  emperor  ; and  it  also  forms  part  of  the  established  etiquette  of  the  court,  precisely  to  copy  the  example 
and  actions  of  the  Nat  gods,  into  whose  heavens  they  expect  to  transmigrate. 

t It  is  probably  from  this  tradition,  that,  in  the  marriage  rite  among  the  Birmans,  and  also  in  all  transactions  of  business,  the 
contract  is  made  valid  by  each  presenting  the  other  contracting  party  with  a little  laspac,  a sort  of  ten-leaf  steeped  in  oil,  to  eat,  which 
act  of  eating  is  the  ratification. 


the  earth  and  atmospheric  region. 


49 

"r'h"’P“1  “ *•  P*S”‘*  - -*•  « .1..  ..p  or  Maha-meru 

Wiebesana-dewa-raja,  holds  his  residence  at  Calany. 

These  gods  are  respected  in  the  Dewales,  which  are  large  buildings,  and  are  always  four  in  numher  • 
ey  watch  to  cure  the  srck,  and  to  preserve  men  from  incurring  losses  in  their  goods,  and  are  represented 
res.  mg  on  the  peaks  of  then  high  mountains,  whence  they  inspect,  govern,  and  exercise  a tutelary 
superintendence  over  then  favourite  districts.  Their  mountains  are  so  lofty  that  they  are  elevated  int'o 
the  lunar  mansions,  the  regions  of  Jugandere,  the  portion  of  the  universe  stretching  from  the  Manoepe- 
loka,  or  human  world,  to  the  Tjaturun.maha-rit,  or  first  heaven  of  the  Dewa  Loka,  comprising  the  tract 

wherein  the  orbits  of  the  sun,  moon,  and  planets  are  marked  out. 

This  region,  as  before  stated,  forms  the  habitation  of  the  inferior  created  agents,  who  can  command 
the  elements ; who  exercise  the  gift  of  the  metempsychosis  at  will,  by  assuming  different  shapes ; and 
who,  through  the  central  navel  of  the  earth,  or  Mem  stone,  can  pass  through  the  earth,  and  transport 
themselves  to  either  the  invisible  world  of  Hades  below  the  central  abyss,  or  ascend  (as  the  Asuras 
are  often  represented  to  attempt)  to  the  Dewa  Loka  of  the  palol  tree. 

In  the  legends  of  the  scenery  and  inhabitants  of  this  region,  we  tr*ee  a striking  picture  of  the 
imaginary  beings  with  which  the  traditions  of  aU  mountainous  regions  abound;  for  the  hills  of  the 

gods  of  Greece,  even  Parnassus  itself,  are  not  more  vocal,  or  more  deeply  interested  in  the  actions 
oi  man  than  those  of  the  Budha  system.* 

The  character  of  the  Pattinee  gods  requires  development,  because  they  exhibit  the  chief  traces 
remaining  of  the  ancient  paganism  of  Ceylon,  and  probably  of  other  Eastern  regions.  When  the  Budha 
Gamlma  introduced  his  faith,  and  sought  to  attach  the  inhabitants  to  his  doctrine,  the  belief  in  demons 
was  too  strongly  rooted;  he  therefore  wisely  forbore  to  aim  at  a fruitless  extirpation,  but  forbade  any 

acts  of  worship  or  priests  in  honour  of  these  gods.  The  following  curious  particulars  are  collected  from 
authentic  sources : 

• 

“ The  Dewales  and  Kowiles,  are  places  consecrated  to  the  Kappooism,  or  demon-worship,  of  Ceylon 
w nch  is  the  character  of  these  celebrated  chief  gods  of  the  hills.  Drums  and  tom-toms  are  beaten  in 
their  honour  in  the  morning  and  evening,  and  trumpets  and  horns  sounded.  In  the  month  of  July  the 
great  offering  takes  place,  and  in  the  montli  of  November  only  the  Dewales  are  illuminated.  The  daily 
offerings  consist  merely  of  boiled  victuals,  upon  which  the  common  servants  and  superintendents,  called 
B.tmorales,  Kappoerales.f  and  Basnaikerales,  subsist.  The  office  of  priest  does  not  exist  in  the  Dewales, 

• Birtheniach  Shetheire  the  god  of  the  muses,  and  of  music,  resides  also  in  the  mountains  of  Jugandere,  or  first  Dewa  Loka  heaven 

1 1 f’e  K,a?P“er“leS  °f  the  DcwaIes  derive  a c°nsiderable  emolument  from  the  sale  of  charms.  A native,  with  one  of  these 
pin  e rom  ns  o y,  esteems  himself  secure,  and  will  boldly  face  the  danger  from  which  he  would  timidly  fly  if  destitute  of  the 
ancit  protection.  ese  charms  consist  often  of  a piece  of  olla-leaf,  covered  with  astrological  signs  and  unintelligible  jargon  These 
may  be  seen  hangmg  from  the  arms,  legs,  or  necks  of  the  natives;  as  they  imagine  that  the  evils  which  float  about  in  the  air  ,re 
prevented  from  al.ght.ng  on  the  hmbs  of  those  who  are  thus  protected.  If  an  accident  happens  to  a superstitious  Singalese,  at  a time 
when  he  has  not  one  about  his  person,  he  has  immediate  recourse  to  a Kappoerale,  persuaded  that  his  charm  is  as  efficacious  to  cure  as  it  is 
powerful  to  preserve."— Harvard’s  Narrative  of  the  Mission  to  Ceylon,  211. 

“ The  Na8“'  or  snake  S°ds’  supposed  to  give  the  power  to  some  men  to  blight  all  the  fruit  they  look  at;  and  this  they  call 
aes-was,  or  eye-poison.  I knew  a native  (Singalese),  of  whom  his  countrymen  said,  that  if  he  looked  on  a tree,  it  would  wither  • 
they  told  me  the  Naga-raja,  or  king  serpent  was  on  him  .'-Remarks  by  Mr.  Fox.  It  is  (among  other  ideal  evils)  against  this  eye-poison 
that  charms  are  sought  for.  ^ ^ 


H 


50 


THE  HILL  GODS,  OR  PATTINEE  DEITIES. 


and  much  less  in  the  Kowiles,  which  are  merely  chapels  situate  in  villages  and  hamlets,  wherein  no 
service  is  performed ; only  every  person  may  there  offer  boiled  victuals.”  The  chief  attendants  are  the 
Kappoerales,  who  also  appear  to  act  as  the  celebrated  conjurors,  or  wizards  of  the  North,  and  they  are 
appointed  in  the  following  manner : — 

“ When  a Kappoerale  of  a temple  dreams  that  he  must  appoint  a man  as  Kappoerale,  then  he 
goes  and  mentions  to  the  man  his  dream,  and  then  the  man  of  whom  the  Kappoerale  dreamed,  upon  this 
inquiry,  goes  to  wash  himself,  and  to  keep  clean  (pure),  and  he  goes  to  the  temple  to  do  the  duties  of  a 
Kappoerale,  by  offering  some  flowers  and  other  things  to  the  deity.  From  that  day  he  must  not  eat 
any  fresh  fish,  or  any  other  thing,  except  rice  and  dried  fish,  nor  drink  any  liquor  but  water ; they 
appoint  him  a day.  and  on  that  day  the  head  Kappoerale  of  the  temple  comes  and  says  to  him,  that  he 
was  appointed  as  Kappoerale  of  that  temple ; with  that  the  appointed  Kappoerale,  with  all  the  others, 
calls  all  the  beggars  of  the  place  within  the  temple,  and  gives  them  alms.”* 

The  duty  of  a Kappoerale  is,  that  ‘‘one  of  them  always  remains  at  the  temple,  to  open  it,  to  keep  it 
always  clean,  to  light  the  lamps,  and  when  people  come  there  to  make  their  prayers,  to  let  them  in,  and  to 
accept  the  presents  they  bring  to  the  temple,  and  when  any  sick  persons  are  brought  there,  to  read  some 
prayers,  and  to  strike  their,  bodies  with  some  medical  oil  that  is  in  the  temple.  In  the  temple  of 
Nawegammooa  there  are  four  Kappoerales.” 


THE  FOUR  HILL  GODS,  OR  PATTINEE  DEITIES.— PLATES  XXII.  XXIII.  XXIV.  AND  XXV. 

Pattinee  Dewa  (plate  22).  The  history  of  the  Dewa  Pattinee' is  one  of  the  most  extravagant  of  the 
Budhist  legends.  She  marries  a merchant,  who  after  a time  resolves  to  travel,  and  is  warned  by  her,  if 
he  sees  a flight  of  birds  to  turn  back  again,  to  avoid  promiscuous  women,  and  on  no  account  to  talk  to 
goldsmiths.  In  his  adventures  he  neglects  all  these  injunctions  ; he  sells  the  Pattinee’s  golden  ear-ring, 
and  its  beauty  attracts  the  notice  of  the  emperdr ; the  goldsmith  charges  the  merchant  with  a robbery, 
and  he  is  unjustly  ordered  to  be  beheaded.  His  life  being  charmed  by  his  wife,  the  Pattinee,  the 
executioner,  to  his  great  terror,  finds  that  he  cannot  strike  the  fatal  blow,  but  he  is  instructed  by  the 
merchant  himself  wherein  Die  spell  consists,  and  he  is  decapitated.  No  sooner  is  this  done  than  darkness 
ensues,  fires  issue  from  the  earth,  and  it  rains  blood,  which  prodigies  are  performed  by  the  power  of  the 
enraged  Pattinee,  who  has  learned  the  fate  of  her  husband  from  a bird  on  the  wing,  which  witnessed  his 
execution.  The  sovereign  is  advised  to  appease  her  by  sacred  offerings,  and  she  ranks  as  the  goddess  of 
healing. 

Another  legend  associates  the  Pattinee  with  the  demons  of  the  island,  and  Vige-raja,  or  the  lion 
king.  She  is,  in  fact,  the  mischievous  fairy  of  Ceylon,  presiding  over  the  planets,  and  appearing  in 
its  legends  and  tales  of  witchcraft. 

Wiebesana-dewa-raja  (plate  23)  is  the  deity  who  protects  the  temple  of  Calany,f  and  is  mighty 

* The  giving  of  alms  seems  to  form  so  integral  a part  of  every  act,  either  in  the  worship  or  government  of  Eastern  states,  that  it 
appears  in  fact  to  exhibit  a recognition  or  practice  of  that  religion  which  custom  has  rendered  general. 

t A temple  of  Budha  exists  at  Calany,  about  six  miles  north-east  from  Columbo.  The  images  are  of  stone,  nearly  the  same  as  that 
at  Budha  Gyah.  Both  agree  in  long  pendent  ear-rings  and  crisped  hair ; but  the  heads  of  all  the  images  of  the  Budha  at  Calany  are 
crowned  with  a sort  of  tiara,  somewhat  resembling  a hand.  The  lotos  appears  to  be  the  favourite  flower  of  the  god,  and  also  the  keyera 


■PatUn 


m 

r gk 

v >41 

s 

Si 

ll 

iVvy 

v^*  \ 

T > 

[('  /& 

i>/A 

\\  A 

v - / 

> 

It  ,/% 

A 

1 

V:  1 

( / > 

\ 

S.  1 •'  J\ 

J//  ^ 

c 


t 


THE  HILL  GODS,  OR  PATTINEE  DEITIES. 


51 


ovef  a number  of  deities,  and  equal  in  power  to  Saman-dewa-raja.  In  the  second  visit,  which  was 
made  by  the  Budha  to  Ceylon,  after  reconciling  two  warring  princes  of  the  Nagas,  Gaudma  gave  the 
minny  phalange  and  the  sacred  tree  to  Wiebesana,  that  by  worshipping  the  same  they  might  become  liis 
faithful  followers,  and  obtain  Nirwana.  He  is  accompanied  by  two  singular  birds,  which  remind  11s  of 
the  compound  figures  in  Persepolitan  sculptures  of  winged  monsters,  which  are  probably  drawn  from 
the  same  originals  as  the  Budha  birds  and  sphynxes ; these  birds  are  named  in  the  Asiatic  Researches 
(vol.  i.  p.  406).  The  particular  utility  of  these  plates  arises  from  their  supplying  the  connecting  link 
between  the  agents  of  this  region  and  the  doctrine  of  the  Budha ; showing  how  it  has  mixed  its  tenets 
with  the  ancient  Kappooism  of  Ceylon* 

Saman-dewa-raja  (plate  24)  is  the  king  of  the  inferior  deities  of  Koombandeo ; he  is  described  as 
having  attended  the  preaching  of  Budha  at  his  first  arrival  at  Mayhangamy,  and  in  consequence 
renounced  his  wickedness.  He  is  now  declared  to  be  living  with  his  deities  on  the  top  of  Samana 
Galle  (Adam’s  Peak,)  with  power  over  Ceylon.  In  this  mount  (which  is  also  a Mienmo)  grows  the 
tree  called  Kirri-palol,  also  Kinni-naga,  and  Raja-tenai.  The  Budha  seat  of  power,  the  minny  phalange, 
was  buried  below  this  tree,  under  the  charge  of  Saman-dewa-raja,  for  the  purpose  of  offering 
supplication  thereon  ; that  the  nagas , snakes,  might  obtain  blessedness,  that  is,  that  they  might  by  virtue 
of  the  doctrine  be  converted  to  the  faith  of  the  Budha ; and  the  same  is  the  stony  seat  below  the  said 
tree  in  the  island  Minne-naga  Dewa-inne,  whereupon  the  Budha  sat  down,  leaned  against  the  said 
tree,  preached,  and  communicated  the  feelings  (virtues)  of  his  body.  The  divine  Nagas  are  of  mighty 
power,  kc.  as  Dewas ; and  the  divine  snakes,  who  invited  Budha  the  third  time  to  Ceylon,  and  who 
are  called  Mani-okkeke,  who  live  in  the  river  Calany,  have  the  same  power  and  happiness.*  Saman-dewa 
is  delineated  as  standing  on  the  minny  phalange , or  seat  of  power,  on  which  the  Budha  always  sits, 
which  seat  is  invested  with  the  powers  of  the  flying  chariots,  &c.,  of  Oriental  fictions ; he  is  accompanied 
by  the  white  elephant,  an  incarnation  of  the  Budlias,  as  the  bull  Apis  was  of  the  Egyptian  god. 

Wisme-karma  is  represented  (plate  25)  as  a great  favourite  of  the  god  Sekkraia,  and  the  artificer  of 
the  rock-temples  and  palaces  of  the  Budha ; he  is  accompanied  by  a garuda,  or  magic  bird,  and  by  a Naga 
snake,  both  being  local  genii  of  Jugandere.  He  is  a powerful  deity,  having  great  influence,  and  living 
in  a mountain  called  Waykoote,  which  is  in  the  wilderness  of  Damba-dewa,  called  Himaleh-vanni, 


and  gool-acheen,  two  of  the  most  fragrant  flowers  of  India.  Images  of  the  Budha  represent  him  in  different  positions,  sitting  or 
sleeping,  and  his  devotees  are  bearing  each  a nagisur  flower,  with  sixteen  representations  of  dagobas,  which  are  said  to  represent  the 
sixteen  temples  of  this  description  in  the  island  of  Ceylon.  This  idol-temple,  which  is  very  old,  is  called  a vihari,  or  college. — Asiatic 
Researches,  vi.  449. 

* The  above  may  be  fairly  concluded  to  refer  to  the  contests  between  the  native  princes,  termed  Nagas,  from  their  Kappooism,  or 
national  faith,  antecedent  to  the  introduction  of  Budhism ; the  struggle  for  the  minny  phalange,  or  throne,  was  neither  more  nor  less  than 
striving  for  the  lead  and  mastery  in  the  doctrine.  The  ascending  of  the  mystic  seat,  announced  the  Budha.  or  Muni,  and  elevated  its 
possessor  in  rank  above  regal  authority.  The  minny  phalange,  it  was  conceived,  would  support  none  but  the  rightful  Budha,  or  his 
lawful  representatives,  and  possessed  the  virtue  of  enlarging  or  contracting  its  dimensions,  as  their  number  required.  The  legend  of  Budha 
says — “ After  the  Budha  had  edified  the  gods  by  his  bana,  he  gave  Ceylon  to  Saman-dewa,  and  gave  him,  at  the  same  time,  a handful  of 
his  hair,  which  Saman-dewa  locked  up  in  achest,(a  minny  phalange)  with  precious  stones  ; this  is  recorded  of  the  second  visit  made  by 
Gaudma  to  Ceylon,  when  lie  came  from  the  pagoda  of  Settawanna.  His  third  visit  was  on  the  third  of  May,  in  his  eighth  year,  at  the  request 
again  of  a serpent  of  godly  power,  Mnni-okkeke-garum,  by  whom  he  was  again  worshipped  on  his  seat  of  power,  and  he  converted  by  his 
sermons  a number  of  men.  He  tarried  for  some  time,  with  five  hundred  Rahatoous,  his  disciples,  in  the  pagoda  of  Calany,  and,  at  the 
request  of  Saman-raja,  he,  as  the  moon  that  rises  from  the  East,  repaired  to  the  rock  of  Samana  Galle,  to  witness  the  rain  of  flowers  and 
precious  stones,  caused  by  the  joy  of  the  Dewa  Loka  gods. 

11  2 


52 


THE  HILL  GODS,  OR  PATTINEE  DEITIES. 


to  whose  charge  Ceylon  was  committed*  by  the  god  Sekkraia.  The  important  part  which  he  fills 
in  the  Budhist  system,  is  farther  detailed  in  his  character  as  a minister  of  this  god  in  the  Tavateinza 
heaven. 

Kandi-kumara,  whose  residence  is  on  the  rock  called  Maha-meru  Parkwette,  situate  between  the 

bottom  of  the  sea  and  the  Asura  Loka  below  the  abyss,  is  also  worshipped  at  Katregam,  at  which  temple 

o-reat  numbers  assemble  on  his  festival.  He  has  six  heads  and  twelve  hands,  ten  of  which  are  for  ten 
o 

warlike  weapons: — 1.  Trisoele  or  harpoon — 2.  The  pallos — 3.  The  spring  or  ring  (the  valhalla  invented 
by  Wisme-karma),  sharp  outside ; by  turning  it  round  on  the  finger  it  is  thrown  on  the  enemy — 4.  A pike 

5.  A line 6.  A shin-breaker — 7-  A standard,  with  a cock  (the  dienza)  on  it — 8.  A throwing  chain — 9- 

A bow  and  arrow — 10.  A sword.  He  is  represented  riding  on  a peacock,  and  he  became  invested  with  his 
power  from  worshipping  the  Budha  when  seated  on  the  viinny  phalange,  under  his  palol  or  bagaya  tree, 
whereby  he  obtained  from  him  the  power  to  cure  the  sick  in  general,  especially  such  as  are  of  royal 
blood,  to  perform  wonders,  to  do  good  to  animals,  to  assist  men  in  distress,  and  to  work  miracles,  with  a 
direction,  however,  that  men  should  respect,  hut  not  worship  him  as  one  of  the  Dewa  Loka  gods. 

His  festival,  the  first  day  of  the  new  moon  in  July,  brings  together  immense  numbers  of  Gentoos, 
Bramins,  Pattinees,  and  Mains,  from  Madura  and  the  coast  of  Coromandel ; the  ceremonies  are  as 
follows: — Sixteen  women  make  preparations  for  the  procession — three  tusked  elephants  are  richly 
adorned ; the  largest  bears  a tilted  awning,  covered  with  silk,  and  having  curtains  of  the  same,  within 
which  is  an  ivory  seat,  wrought  with  gold,  silver,  and  precious  stones,  upon  which  is  laid  a gold  sword.f 
A small  elephant  on  each  side  of  the  larger  one  bears  a Ivappoerale  (an  attendant  of  the  temple  of 
Kumara),  holding  and  waving  a hairy  tail  of  the  Tjameri each  of  the  women  has  twro  brass  bowls 
filled  with  sapan  water;  eight  of  them  walk  on  the  right,  and  eight  on  the  left  of  the  smaller 
elephants,  saying,  “ May  those  who  are  assembled  here  fare  well.”  Thus  the  crowd  proceeds  through 
the  streets  with  colours,  tom-toms,  drums,  and  lighted  torches,  the  houses  too  being  illuminated : this  is 
continued  for  fifteen  days,  until  the  day  after  the  full  moon,  when  the  procession  is  continued 
throughout  the  night  until  the  morning ; when,  the  tilted  awning  being  lifted  off,  and  the  elephants 
driven  away,  a palanquin,  richly  adorned  and  hung  with  cloth  of  gold,  in  which  is  laid  the  said  gold 
sword,  but  what  it  contains  more  cannot  be  known,  is  borne  by  two  Kappoerales  to  a shallow  river, 
situate  about  a mile  from  the  temple,  and  then  it  is  placed  in  the  water,  whilst  one,  by  the  name  of 
Dieje-kappoerale  (one  who  can  cleave  or  cut  the  water),  draws  out  the  sword,  and  gives  a blow 
to  the  water,  showing  thereby  that  the  water  in  the  most  rapid  stream  stands  still,  in  a miraculous 
manner,  for  a moment;  the  ceremony  ends  at  seven  in  the  morning,  when  the  sword  is  carried 
into  the  temple.  The  moment  the  palanquin,  or  tilted  awning,  is  placed  in  the  river,  numbers  rush 


* It  is  recorded  that  the  space  of  time,  reckoning  from  the  day  of  delivery  in  charge,  up  to  the  29th  of  November,  1828,  would 
make  2370  years,  eight  months,  and  seven  days ; the  precision  here  manifested  in  the  calculation  of  the  present  era  of  the  Budha 
becomes  evidence  of  much  importance,  in  ascertaining  the  series  of  historical  annals  of  this  sect,  as  the  Maha-vansi,  which  is  divided  into 
eighty- nine  chapters,  carries  the  history  of  the  Budha  faith  until  within  350  years  of  the  present  period. 

+ Kumara  is,  moreover,  the  god  of  war,  as  is  indicated  also  by  the  formidable  array  of  hostile  weapons  ; the  symbol  of  the  gold  sword 
recals  the  narrative  of  Herodotus  (referring  to  Scythia),  who  says  the  Scythian  god,  Xaca,  one  of  the  appellatives  of  Budha,  was  adored 
under  the  symbol  of  a golden  sword ; the  similarity  of  the  name  and  symbol  shows,  therefore,  the  existence  of  this  faith  in  these 
regions. 

X The  chowry,  formed  of  the  tuft  of  the  yak — See  an  account  of  this  animal  in  the  Asiatic  Researches,  iv.  351. 


THE  HILL  GODS,  OR  PATTINEE  DEITIES. 


53 


into'it  with  their  clothes  on  to  bathe.  Offerings  of  gold  and  silver  are  presented ; those  that  are  sick 
come  in  person,  or  send  images  of  gold  and  silver  with  their  names,  for  the  purpose  of  being  offered 
to  recover  health,  or  to  prevent  sickness  and  death.  Thus  the  votive  offerings  presented  to  Apollo  at 
Delphi  bore  the  names  of  the  donors,  and  various  marble  slabs  are  deposited  in  the  British  Museum, 
which  bear  the  impress  of  the  diseased  part,  with  an  invocatory  address,  or  one  of  grateful 
acknowledgment  of  benefit.  A very  remarkable  slab  has  a pair  of  eyes,  on  one  of  which  an  incision,  as 
of  couching,  is  clearly  to  be  distinguished* 

The  offering  house,  erected  in  honour  of  Ivandi-kumara,  at  Katregam,  is  considered  as  more 
sacred  than  the  temple  built  in  Kandy  for  the  use  of  the  king,  so  that  the  presents  of  the  king  are  sent  to 
Ivatregam  for  the  purpose  of  being  offered,  and  the  natives  of  Kandy  in  crowds  attend  his  festivals. 
The  Mains,  who  come  in  great  numbers  from  the  coasts  of  Madura  and  Coromandel,  call  Kandi-kumara 
a Nabbie  or  prophet  of  theirs. 


See  Articles  in  Room  xv.,  245  to  251,  Catalogue  of  the  British  Museum. 


CHAPTER  V. 


THE  DEWA  LOKA,  OR  SIX  HEAVENS. 


“ Now  being  let  loose  from  that  prison  (the  body),  where  the  spirits,  or  forms,  were  detained,  a little  time  restores  them  to  their 
universality  'in  the  heavens;’  and  flowing  in  an  ocean,  ‘the  sky,’  where  celestial  influences  are  continually  descending,  and 
vapours  ascending,  they  receive  new  impresses  of  virtue,  ‘ new  forms,'  to  fit  them  for  further  service.’’ — Bulstrodc  on  Pythagoras. 


The  next  point  of  the  Budhist  system,  and  a very  interesting  portion  of  the  subject  is  unquestionably 
the  Dewa  Loka  heavens,  and  their  gods,  as  these  are  invested  with  qualities  combining  an  agency  and 
interest  in  the  actions  of  man,  which  become  thereby  associated  with  their  superior  powers  and  dignity. 
These  gods  are  termed  the  Nat;*  their  character  and  operative  influence  on  man  are  described  in 
various  parts  of  the  Budhist  writings  with  the  richest  imagery,  elucidating  most  of  the  grandeur, 
etiquette,  and  observances  of  the  great  princes  and  monarchs  of  this  faith,  who  appear  to  have  been  intent 
upon  transfusing  the  details  of  the  Tavateinza  heaven  and  of  the  Dewa  Loka  into  their  titles  and  usages, 
and  to  have  framed  their  courts  after  the  royal  and  splendid  scenes  of  the  Nat  paradise.  In  these  abodes 
are  the  mines  of  gold  and  silver,  of  diamonds,  rubies,  and  all  precious  stones  ;f  gardens,  or  a paradise 
of  sandal,  and  all  odoriferous  woods  ; trees,  the  produce  of  which  are  robes  (splendid  personal  ornaments), 
and  all  sorts  of  riches:  these  are  at  the  disposal  of  the  gods  for  great  and  virtuous  kings  and  men, 
votaries  of  the  Budha. 


* If  the  inferior  gods  of  Jugandere  are  described  so  as  to  remind  us  of  the  interesting  tales  of  the  Arabian  Nights,  the  Nat  deities 
are  more  essentially  the  presiding  genii  of  the  Arabian  fictions  and  the  beneficent  fairies  of  the  W est ; they  bestow  riches  at  will ; they 
can  assume  all  forms  ; they  wield  the  elements.  The  diamond  fruits  of  Aladdin’s  garden  are  an  exact  copy  of  their  gardens,  and  of 
the  produce  of  the  padze-zebayn  tree. 

t One  portion  of  Budha  doctrine  will  explain  the  original  cause  of  laying  such  stress  on  the  possession  of  diamonds,  rubies, 
sapphires,  and  other  precious  stones,  and  enumerating  them  so  elaborately.  These  splendid  ornaments  and  vestments  grow  on  the 
sacred  trees  of  the  Nat  paradise,  the  padze-zebayn  in  Zabudistan ; they  are  also  formed  in  the  bowels  of  the  earth,  and  are  at  the 
disposal  of  the  gods  of  the  Dewa  Loka,  and  their  servants,  the  genii  of  the  Jugandere,  the  region  of  the  hills  ; the  doctrine  describing 
these  celebrated  hills  as  the  haunts  of  these  spirits,  and  endowing  them  with  all  the  treasures  of  the  depths  of  the  earth.  We  see  at  a 
glance  how  powerfully  this  scheme  has  been  sustained  in  the  Eastern  world  by  the  circumstance  of  their  mines,  both  of  rubies  and  gold, 
being  seated  amid  these  very  mountains.  In  conformity  with  this  faith  has  arisen  the  class  of  Arabian  fictions,  which  invariably  exhibit 
a giant  or  genius,  who,  in  conformity  with  the  sleep  of  the  dragon  king,  is  usually  awakened  from  a trance,  and  who  sometimes  capriciously 
opens  his  stores  of  gold  to  the  intruder.  As  it  is  deemed  impossible  to  acquire  the  knowledge  of  these  mines  without  the  permission  of 
the  genii,  their  possession  is  the  proudest  boast  of  the  monarch,  and  the  origin  of  their  being  so  pompously  enumerated  in  his 
royal  titles;  accordingly  Minderagce  Praw,  the  Emperor  of  Ava,  proclaimed  himself  emperor  of  the  ruby,  agate,  lasuli,  sapphire,  and 
opal  mines,  of  gold  and  silver,  amber,  &c. — Sytncs,  iii.  331. — See  also  Crosier's  article  on  the  Emperor  Vong  Telling  of  China. 


T1IE  DEWA  LOKA,  or  six  heavens. 


'I  HE  FIRST  AND  SECOND  HEAVEN PLATE  VI. 

Tjaturum-maharakeye,  the  first  of  the  Dewa  T nl™ 

% i l 4.  i i JJe  L,okd  havens,  commences  at  the  summit  of  Ju 

ft™'  r.;'  r 1,1  * pl“  - *•  — ■ -* **. «.  rf 

lo  ™»n  elo„s  ,l„  „,d  „ „ic|,  „ J t|ie  t 'd 

d i d'  T B “ •'»  "«»  «-  «¥«,  to  distinguish  years, 

7 , “ f 1 “4  ™>  » TW  cpitd  ei,y  inlengt,  J 

o„,  .bo«.„d  juzana.  A,  ,h,  ™d,„c,  of  the  god  S.U™.  is  d«,iW  „ being  in  ,U  lllin« 
hod,  the  Tj.tnrd,u  „d  W,im  he.v.ns,  ,h.  Mowing  deseriplion  of  i„  g„„deu,  and  eiehe,  will 

L“;:  IT  **  hm.S“bj"  “ ‘"™  ,h'  N“’  » — - 

...  Tl‘°  01'  Pa,laCe  °f  the  S°d’  18  fifty  JUzana  in  diall‘etc'-.  this  palace  is  within  of  gold,  and 
without  of  crystal ; the  moon  palace  is  formed  externally  of  silver,  and  within  of  carbuncle.  In  this  heaven 

also  grows  a great  sacred  tree,*  which  will  last  as  long  as  the  world.  Here  reside  the  four  gods  assistant 
to,  yet  independent  of  the  god  Sekkraia,  for  Sekkraia  is  higher  in  dignity,  without  exercising  any  control 
or  authority.  These  four  gods,  being  of  the  same  rank,  and  having  the  same  power,  constantly  watch 
over  the  safety  of  Sekkraia,  which  is  menaced  by  his  enemy  the  Asuragod;  they  also  superintend  that 
is,  watch,  the  events  of  the  four  parts  of  the  world;  for  the  Budhist  religion  in  no  shape  intimates  any 
authoritative  divine  interference,  only  by  the  aid  of  doctrine  and  the  fear  of  the  transmigration. 

The  first,  Dirtheraach  Shetheire  (see  plate  6,  lower  division),  presides  over  the  East.  His  attendants 
their  clothes,  his  chariot  and  horses,  are  all  of  them  of  a white  colour,  and  his  arms  are  of  crystal.  He 
is  the  chief  over  the  muses  and  of  music.f  His  residence  is  described  to  be  in  a city  shining  with 
splendour,  on  the  summit  of  Jugandere,  to  the  east  of  Mount  Mienmo.  Its  pillars,  walls,  and^eams 
are  of  silver,  suiting  the  bowers  of  light.  In  the  whole  of  this  heaven  grows  the  padze-zebayn  tree, 
on  which,  in  place  of  fruit,  hang  precious  garments,  the  most  exquisite  viands,  and  whatever  can  afford 
delight  tor  personal  ornament  or  feasting.  Every  where  are  to  be  seen  running  streams,  lakes,  and  the 
most  delicious  gardens.  On  the  whole,  this  habitation,  or  bon , is  filled  with  delights'. 

The  second  god,  here  called  Wiroedhe,  governs  the  West,  and,  together  with  his  servants  and 
chariots,  is  of  an  azure,  or  blue  colour.  He  presides  over  innumerable  Koombandeo,  or  angels; 
but  chiefly  the  thirty-two  counsellors  and  four  assistant  gods.  His  heaven  is  also  the  grand  residence 
ot  the  chief  god  Sekkraia,  who  is  supreme  in  dignity  throughout  the  six  Dewa  Loka.  He  appears  to 
rank  as  the  god  of  light,  having  direction  of  the  elements,  and  the  sun  itself  being  his  splendid  palace. 
This  god  is  described  as  having  a bright  shining  body  of  prodigious  bulk,  and  similar  to  the  light  of  a 
lamp,  wearing  a diamond  crown  three  yodoons  in  height.  His  form,  ever  bathed  with  precious  perfumes, 
is  clothed  with  divine  garments,  and  decorated  with  ornaments  emitting  the  brightest  rays.  Every 
Sackwalle,  or  world,  has  a Sekkraia  god,  who  ranks  as  regent  of  the  sun,  while  he  is  also  attached 

* Each  bon,  or  island,  has  a sacred  tree,  which  lasts  its  term  of  existence,  and  marks  its  prosperity  or  decline  by  its  flowers.  This 

particular  doctrine,  which  will  be  found  more  largely  treated  of  hereafter,  seems  entitled  to  be  the  prototype  of  the  consecration  of  trees 
to  mark  the  same  results  to  individuals  in  the  Arabian  tales. — See  one  of  the  most  pleasing  of  its  fictions,  the  Rose-tree,  in  the  beautiful 
tule  of  Simoustapha. — Weber's  Tales  of  the  East,  ii.  49. 

+ These  gods  of  the  Eastern  bon  have  subject  to  them  certain  genii  of  an  inferior  rank,  also  called  Nat,  or  Nathe : these  are  giants, 
great  birds,  evil  genii,  dragons,  and  the  like,  which  inhabit  in  the  desert  of  Mount  Jugandere. — Asiatic  Researches,  vi.  183. 


56 


THE  DEVVA  LOKA,  OR  SIX  HEAVENS. 


to  every  material  incident  in  the  life  of  the  Budha ; he  is  always  present  at  the  inebriating  festival  of  the 
Budha,  described  in  a subsequent  page.  Sekkraia  also  performs  the  office  of  holding  the  golden  seine 
or  net,  for  the  reception  of  the  Budha  at  his  birth,  and  it  was  he  who  preserved,  as  a precious  relic,  the 
hair  which  Gaudma  cut  off  with  a golden  sword,  and  flung  into  the  Dewa  Loka  heavens,  when  he 
renounced  royalty,  by  cutting  off  his  locks,  and  professing  himself  thereby  an  ascetic,  as  will  appear  more 
fully  in  the  legend  expressly  relating  to  the  Budha. 

The  descriptive  sketch  of  this  heaven  cannot  be  better  supplied  than  from  Dr.  Buchanan’s 
selections  in  the  6th  volume  of  the  Asiatic  Researches. 

“ The  god  Sekkraia  resides  in  the  great  city  Maha-soudassana,  which  has  a square  form ; its  gilded 
wall  surrounding  it  being  a perfect  square.  The  gates  are  of  gold  and  of  silver,  adorned  with  precious 
stones.  Seven  moats  surround  the  city,  and  beyond  the  last  range  a row  of  marble  pillars  studded  with 
jewels;  beyond  which  are  seven  rows  of  palm  trees,  bearing  rubies,  pearls,  gold,  &c. ; lakes,  odoriferous 
flowers,  and  fragrant  trees,  with  the  padze-zebayn  trees,*  are  dispersed  around.  To  the  south  of  the  city  is 
the  garden  Parasa,  and  to  the  west  that  of  Massata.  To  the  north-east  is  a very  large  hall,  extending 
every  way  500  juzana;  its  circumference  900,  its  height  450  juzana.  From  its  roof  hang  golden  bells  ;f 
and  its  walls,  pillars,  and  stairs  shine  with  gold  and  precious  stones.  The  pavement  is  of  crystal,  and  each 
row  of  pillars  contains  100  columns.  The  road  to  this  hall  is  twenty  juzana  long,  and  eighteen  broad, 
bordered  with  trees  bearing  fruits  and  flowers.  Whenever  Sekkraia  repairs  to  this  hall  the  winds  shake 
off  all  the  flowers  (fresh  ones  instantly  blooming  on  the  trees),  with  which  the  presiding  gods  of  the 
winds  adorn  the  road  in  honour  of  his  approach,  and  the  flowers  are  so  abundant  that  they  reach  up  to 
the  knees.  In  the  centre  stands  the  great  imperial  throne,}:  surmounted  by  the  white  chettra,  or 
umbrella : it  shines  with  gold,  and  pearls,  and  jewels.  It  is  surrounded  by  the  thirty -two  shrines  of  the 


• In  the  Tavateinza  heaven  grows  the  padze-zebayn  tree,  on  which,  instead  of  fruits,  hang  precious  garments,  delicious  viands,  and 
whatever  can  give  enjoyment  to  the  Nat  deities  ; beyond  which  are  seven  rows  of  palm  trees,  on  which  grow  gems  of  gold  and  silver. 
In  the  centre  of  the  garden  grows  the  celebrated  flower,  which  is  as  large  as  a chariot  wheel.  The  garden  is  called  nanda,  or  crowd, 
because  the  Nat  gods  frequent  it  in  multitudes  to  pull  the  flower,  and  wear  it  in  their  hair.  Here  is  the  renowned  twining-plant,  lota, 
which  every  thousand  years  produces  a most  exquisite  fruit.  In  order  to  get  at  this  fruit,  the  Nat  gods  assemble  in  crowds  for  one 
hundred  years  before  it  ripens;  and  for  one  whole  year  sing  and  dance,  accompanied  by  drums,  and  other  musical  instruments. 
Having  eaten  of  that  fruit,  the  Nat  become  inebriated  for  four  entire  months. 

Sekkraia,  and  his  thirty-two  counsellors  and  gods,  periodically  visit  the  celebrated  tree,  or  lota,  wjiich  is  the  sacred  image 
of  the  heavens.  This  tree  is  surrounded  with  several  padze-zebayns,  and  when  it  flowers  its  ruddy  splendour  extends  all 
around.  Arrived  there,  Sekkraia  takes  his  seat  on  his  magic  stone,  and  the  whole  assembly,  seated,  begin  to  celebrate  the  festival, 
which  lasts  for  four  months.  They  need  not  ascend  the  tree  to  gather  the  flowers,  for  the  Nat  of  the  winds  shake  it,  and  make  the 
flowers  fall ; and  lest  the  beauty  of  the  flowers  should  be  spoiled,  the  winds  support  them,  and  permit  them  not  to  touch  the  ground.  The 
whole  bodies  of  the  Nat  are  then  covered  with  the  odorous  dust  coming  from  the  stamens  of  the  flowers.  Reading  these  poetic  episodes 
of  sweets  and  flowers,  we  need  not  wonder  at  the  offerings  of  flowers  constituting  the  chief  service  of  the  temples,  and  the  flowers  strewed 
for  the  Budha  are  always  typical  of  this  festival. 

The  following  exhibits  the  conformity  in  the  doctrine  of  Islamism — “ The  tree  of  happiness,  or  tuba,  they  fable,  stands  in  the  palace 
of  Mahammed,  though  a branch  of  it  will  reach  to  the  house  of  every  true  believer  ; and  it  will  be  laden  with  fruits  of  tastes  unknown 
to  mortals.  So  if  a man  desire  to  eat  of  any  particular  kind  of  fruit,  it  will  immediately  be  presented  to  him  ; or  if  he  choose  flesh,  birds 
ready  dressed  will  be  set  before  him,  according  to  his  wish.  The  boughs  will  spontaneously  bend  down  to  the  person  who  would 
gather  of  its  fruits,  and  will  supply  the  blessed  not  only  with  garments,"  &c.  &c. — Sale’s  Koran,  127-  From  the  roots  of  the  tree 
flow  rivers  of  water  and  milk,  and  honey  and  wine ; also  the  river  of  life. 

t And  the  sounds  of  the  bells  hanging  on  the  trees  will  be  put  in  motion  by  the  wind  proceeding  from  the  throne  of  God  when  they 
wish  for  music  ; nay,  the  very  clashing  of  the  golden-bodied  trees,  whose  fruits  are  pearls  and  emeralds,  will  surpass  description. 

+ The  throne  of  the  Emperor  Minderagee  Praw,  called  Yazapulay,  was  an  imitation  of  the  sacred  seat  of  the  Budha ; while  the 
royal  robes,  covered  with  gold,  with  the  golden  wing  on  each  shoulder,  mark  the  emperor’s  studied  adoption  of  the  dress  and  splendour 
of  the  god  Sekkraia.  The  Bramins,  in  white,  chanting  a hymn,  show  the  perfect  copy  which  is  transfused  into  the  ritual  and 
observances  of  this  court.  The  lavish  gilding  of  the  temples  and  kiaungs  are  all  grounded  on  the  Tavateinza  heaven,  and  an  emulation 


THE  DEWA  LOKA,  OR  SIX  HEAVENS.  57 

counsellors;  and  behind  these  the  other  Nat,  each  in  his  proper  place:  the  four  assistant  gods  also 
attend,  while  the  inferior  gods  touch  their  musical  instruments,  and  sing  melodiously.  The  four 
assistant  deities  then  command  their  inferior  gods  to  go  through  this  southern  island,  or  the  world,  and 
inquire  diligently  into  the  actions  of  mankind;  if  they  observe  holy  days,  and  laws  (the  Budha’s 
precepts),  and  exercise  charity.  At  this  command,  quicker  than  the  winds,  the  messengers  pass  through 
this  world,  and  having  carefully  noted  in  a golden  book  all  the  good  and  evil  actions  of  men,  they 
immediately  return  to  the  hall,  and  deliver  the  record*  to  the  four  presiding  gods,  who  pass  it  to  the 
lesser  deities,  and  they  onward  until  it  reaches  Sekkraia.  He,  opening  the  book,  reads  aloud ; and  if  his 
voice  be  raised,  it  sounds  over  the  whole  heaven  of  Tavateinza.  If  the  Nat  hear  that  men  practise  good 
works,  and  observe  the  Budhist  laws,  they  exclaim — ‘ Oh  ! now  the  infernal  regions  will  be  empty,  and 
our  abode  full  of  inhabitants !’  If,  on  the  contrary,  there  are  few  good  men — ‘ Oh  ! wretches,’  say  they, 
t ‘ men  and  fools,  who,  feasting  for  a short  life,  for  a body  four  cubits  in  length,  and  a belly  not 
larger  than  a span,  have  heaped  on  themselves  sin,  which  will  render  them  miserable  in  futurity  !’  Then 
the  god  Sekkraia,  that  be  may  induce  men  to  live  virtuously,  charitably,  and  justly,  speaks  thus 
‘Truly,  if  men  fulfilled  the  law  (the  Budha’s  precepts),!  they  would  be  such  as  I am.’  After  this  be 
will,  with  all  his  train,  to  the  number  of  36,000,000  of  Nat,  return  to  the  city  with  music. 

* 4 

In  the  centre  of  the  glorious  city  of  Maha-soodassana  rises  the  palace^  of  Sekkraia,  surrounded  with 
golden  and  silver  standards : who  can  describe  the  lustre  of  its  beauty,  or  the  gorgeous  splendour  and 
glory  wherewith  it  shines ! 


of  copying  on  earth  that  region  into  which  they  aspire  to  transmigrate  after  death,  as  they  can  only  appear  therein  in  virtue  of  these 
and  similar  acts  and  meritorious  deeds.  In  the  chettrus,  or  umbrellas  of  rank,  the  grade  of  dignity  is  accurately  observed.  The  emperor 
bears  a white,  as  Sekkraia  ; the  princes  a gilded,  as  the  god's  assistant ; the  wingyers  red,  as  the  counsellors ; the  governors  blue,  or 
azure ; and  the  commonalty  black. 

Zechariah  i. — “ Then,  said  I,  O my  Lord,  what  are  these  ? And  the  angel  that  talked  with  me,  said  unto  me,  I will  show  thee 
what  these  be.  And  the  man  that  stood  among  the  myrtle  trees  answered  and  said.  These  are  they  whom  the  Lord  hath  sent  to  walk 
to  and  fro  upon  the  earth.  So  they  walked  to  and  fro  upon  the  earth,  and  they  said.  We  have  walked  to  and  fro  through  all 
the  earth,  and  behold  all  the  earth  sitteth  still,  and  is  at  rest.” 

+ 1 he  expression  here  used  of  the  surrounding  deities  saying  smilingly — a term,  which  is  meant  in  sorrow  and  reproach — is 
somewhat  remarkable,  and  the  more  so,  as  the  sculptured  images  of  the  Budha,  as  well  as  most  of  the  oldest  Egyptian  gods,  embody 
the  exact  idea ; moreover,  it  is  precisely  the  tone  and  character  of  all  the  Eginetan  statues,  the  most  ancieut  forms  of  Greek  art, 
which  are  unfortunately  lost  to  this  country,  a deprivation  which  cannot  he  repaired,  when  it  is  considered  how  perfect  would  have 
been  the  Greek  school  of  sculpture,  if  in  one  unbroken  series  the  Eginetan,  Phigalian,  and  Elgin  marbles  had  been  united.  The 
remarks  ot  the  N at  tend  to  encourage  morals  by  showing  the  progression  of  the  Budha's  followers  to  the  highest  stage  of  divine  happiness 
J “ Guudma  taught — Whoever  honours  his  parents  and  old  age  ; whoever  respects  the  thre  eexcellent  things,  namely,  the  Budha, 
his  law,  and  the  Rahans  ; whoever  abhors  wrangling  and  disputes;  whoever  is  charitable,  particularly  to  the  Ralians ; — all  such  persons 
shall  after  death  transmigrate  into  Tavateinza.” — Asiatic  Researches,  vi.  215. 

§ A picture  of  much  striking  beauty,  alluding  to  this  palace,  and  the  connexion  of  its  chief  god  with  the  earth,  is  drawn  with 
such  felicity  in  Amorassan,  that  it  may  be  appropriately  introduced : 

“ The  words  of  power  were  spoken,  and  a thick  gray  cloud  came  rolling  from  the  north.  In  its  passage  over  the  mountain 
Caucasus,  its  shadow  fell  on  the  pavilion  of  mortal  excellence.  The  roof  of  this  brilliant  pavilion  is  formed  of  moonshine ; the  golden 
columns  on  which  it  rests  are  beams  of  the  sun,  and  in  number  a thousand  and  thirty ; its  walls  are  composed  of  woven  aether,  meteor 
fires,  and  the  condensed  evaporations  of  aromatic  shrubs  and  flowers.  A profusion  of  falling  stars  is  showered  over  the  whole  paviliou, 
and  it  floats  upon  the  clouds  of  autumnal  evenings,  which  form  for  it  a floor  of  the  most  brilliant  crimson.  This  is  the  abode  of  the 
spotless  and  generous  spirits  of  those,  who,  while  on  earth,  dignified  and  enlightened  human  nature  by  their  virtues,  and  who  have 
purchased  for  themselves  after  death  a seat  in  the  society  of  the  pure  genii  by  their  glorious  actions.  On  the  ethereal  walls  of  this 
pavilion  ure  continually  represented  every  noble  and  virtuous  action,  from  the  first  instant  of  its  suggesting  itself,  to  the  moment  of  its 
completion.  Nothing  can  be  more  brilliant,  nothing  more  soft,  than  the  colours  of  which  these  pictures  are  composed:  unlike  those  of 
earth,  instead  of  fading,  they  become  more  bright  and  fresh  with  each  succeeding  day.  But  when  a mortal,  even  to  the  moment  of 
dissolution,  remains  faithful  to  the  heavenly  inspiration  which  incites  him  to  glorious  deeds,  when  the  lamp  of  his  life,  in  expiring,  still 


1 


58 


THE  DEWA  LOKA,  OR  SIX  HEAVENS. 


“ To  the  north-west  of  the  great  city,  is  a most  celebrated  tree,  the  sacred  image  of  the  heaven,  which 
lives  for  the  duration  of  one  world.  Under  this  tree  is  a prodigious  stone,*  sixty  juzana  long,  fifty  broad, 
and  fifteen  high.  It  is  smooth  and  soft  like  cotton,  and  elastic  under  the  feet  of  Sekkraia,  being 
depressed  when  he  stands  upon  it,  and  rising  again  when  he  descends  from  it,  as  if  it  were  sensible  of  the 
honoured  weight  by  which  it  is  pressed.  When  the  affairs  of  our  southern  island  are  prosperous  (when  men 
live  virtuously),  the  half  of  the  god  Sekkraia’s  body  sinks  into  the  stone  (see  plate  6,  figure  2);  but  when 
evil  prevails,  the  stone  remains  tense  and  rigid,  like  a drum.  When  the  tree  flowers,  its  ruddy  splendour 
extends  around  for  fifty  juzana,  and  its  agreeable  odour  for  twice  that  distance.  When  it  has  flowered,  the 
keeper  of  the  tree  (the  guardian  god)  notifies  it  to  Sekkraia,  who  is  immediately  seized  with  a desire  to  see 
it,  and  demands  an  elephant;  no  sooner  has  he  spoken  than  the  elephant  Erravumf  appears  ; for  here,  as 
in  all  the  heavens,  there  are  no  animals  as  on  earth ; whenever  the  Nat  wish  for  them  they  appear.);  This 
elephant  has  thirty-three  heads,  on  which  ride  the  god  and  his  thirty-two  counsellors,  under  ruby  thrones. 
Having  arrived  at  the  sacred  tree  to  collect  the  flowers,  and  Sekkraia  being  seated  on  the  stone,  they  begin 
to  celebrate  the  festival  of  four  months : this,  therefore,  is  the  tree  of  the  intoxicating  quality  which 
inebriates  the  Nat,  and  which  produced  the  fall  and  wars  of  the  Asura  gods.  To  gather  the  flowers 
they  need  not  ascend  the  tree,  for  the  Nat  of  the  winds  shake  it,  and  make  them  fall,  and  lest  the  beauty 
of  the  flowers  should  spoil,  the  winds  support  them,  nor  permit  them  to  touch  the  ground:  the 
whole  bodies  of  the  gods  are  then  covered  with  the  odorous  dust,  coming  from  the  stamens  of  the  flowers. 

“ This  tree,  in  another  part  of  the  doctrine,  is  called  “ a renowned  creeping  plant,  which  every  thousand 


throws  forth  a flame,  which  warms  and  enlightens  posterity  witli  the  remembrance  of  his  virtues,  then  does  the  whole  pavilion  blaze 
with  celestial  radiance.  The  reflection  of  this  sacred  shining  light  pierces  through  the  thick  vapours  which  compose  our  atmosphere* 
and  illumines  the  horizon  with  a soft  trembling  glow.  The  pilgrim  stops,  and  gazes  in  rapture  on  the  lovely  vision ; the  ignorant  man 
of  wisdom  affixes  to  it  some  unmeaning  name,  and  leaves  the  matter  just  where  he  found  it ; and  the  natural  philosopher  accounts  for  the 
phenomenon  falsely,  and  astonishes  his  auditor  at  the  profundity  of  his  science.  The  setting  sun  poured  its  lustre  through  the  transparent 
pavilion,  gilded  its  roof  and  pavement,  and  illumined  the  pictures  on  the  walls  of  a;ther.  The  spirits  of  the  pure  enjoyed  in  silent 
rapture  the  sight  of  the  glorious  actions  of  the  good  on  earth.”*— Lewis’s  Romantic  Tales. 

* This  stone  is  doctrinally  one  of  the  class  of  the  Betulia,  or  oracle  stones,  such  as  the  Budha’s  seat  is  composed  of,  and  similar  to 
the  magical  rocks  and  rings.  The  stone  is  endowed,  instinctively,  with  the  power  or  sympathy  of  indexing  the  state  of  moral  good  and 
evil  in  the  world ; as  the  minny  phalange , or  throne,  of  which  every  Budha’s  seat  is  a type,  instinctively  recognises  its  possessor  to  be  a 
divine  teacher,  without  which  virtual  right,  it  will  not  yield  to  him  a seat.  Of  this  same  class  are  the  cube  seats  of  Osiris,  and  the 
judge  of  the  dead  in  the  Amenthes  of  Egyptian  doctrine,  and  the  custom  of  the  Mogul  emperor  weighing  himself,  and  estimating  the 
prosperity  of  his  rule  by  the  depression  of  the  balance,  is  in  perfect  conformity  with  the  actions  of  Sekkraia. 

t The  following  derivation  of  this  name  is  borrowed  from  the  celebrated  scholar,  to  whom  Europe  is  so  largely  indebted  for  whatever 
is  most  genuine  and  valuable  in  Sanscrit  literature,  Mr.  Colebrooke.  Airavata  is  the  name  of  an  elephant,  in  Hindu  mythology,  which 
bears  the  god  Indra.  The  female  elephant,  which  is  his  companion,  is  named  Airavate ; both  derived  from  Iravat , the  ocean  (or  any 
thing  watery),  which  again  comes  from  Ira,  water,  with  the  termination  vat,  for  an  adjective  derivative.  Airavate,  or  Airawate  (there  is 
no  difference  between  v and  w in  Sanscrit),  is  the  proper  name  of  the  Ravi  river,  in  the  Punjab ; and  of  the  river  which  passes  through 
Ava.  Wadie,  or  wady  is  a mere  corruption,  substituting  d for  / ; and  has  no  distinct  independent  sense. 

The  common  terms  in  Sanscrit  for  an  elephant,  in  general,  are  Ilasti  (whence  the  Hindu  term  Hut’he),  Gaja,  and  other  synonyma  ; 
and  among  them  Pilu,  whence  the  Persian  Fil  and  Pil,  the  names  of  the  celebrated  isle  at  the  head  of  the  river  Nile,  termed  the  Isle  of 
Elephanta.  Airavate,  for  so  I conclude  the  name  for  Pegu  should  be  written,  must  be  derived  from  hira  a diamond,  or  airavate, 
adamantine. 

M.  Langl£s,  in  his  very  erudite  work,  Monumens  des  Index,  speaking  of  Indra  Natta,  the  Hindu  god  of  the  elements,  says,  his 
u vahan,  Iravatti,  signifies  aqueous,  a very  significant  metaphor  for  the  god  of  clouds  and  storms.”  But  the  vahan,  or  vehicle,  is  always 
an  elephant,  thus  showing  the  connexion  between  the  name  of  the  Irrawady  river  and  the  animal. 

\ Precisely  grounded  on  this  passage,  and  similar  to  the  Tavateinza  in  its  colours,  is  the  Paradise  of  Maugraby,  beyond  comparison 
the  richest  and  most  imaginative  Arabian  tale  of  the  series.  His  resort,  in  conformity  with  the  region  of  enchantments,  is  placed  amid 
Mount  Atlas,  and  the  animals,  viands,  and  jewels,  are  supplied  also  spontaneously  at  the  wish,  and  the  narrative  assumes  a new  interest, 
step  by  step,  as  it  develops  such  conformity  with  the  primary  roots  of  Eastern  doctrine,  whence  its  imagery  is  drawn. 


the  dewa  loka,  or  six  heavens.  w 

in  th'  — - -• 
this  fruit  the  gods  assemble  here  in  crowds  f for  ' 7” ‘ m°8t  debC10US  ^ In  °rder  to  Set 

r,  r r - ? — 

fru..  . ,,y  become  ,„,b,„M  fa  four  Wire  moot vi  20? 

h...  h„,«o  not  tb,  light  either  of  the  „ fa  , „f  ^ 

Nat  gods  being  sufficient,  for  they  shine  like  so  many  suns  or  stars. 

The  Nat  Asura  expelled  from  their  heavens,  are  of  the  nature  of  the  gods  of  Tavateinza,  although 

1 ";r°; w icl; formerly  thcy  occupied;  the — *»  ^ ^ 

relate  ! Gaudma,  before  he  became  a god,  when  he  was  in  the  state  of  a man,  with  thirty-two  other 
men,  by  the  good  work  of  repairing  the  highways,  and  by  other  virtuous  actions,  deserved,  after  death,  to 
become  Nat  Tavateinza.  On  appearing  in  the  heavens,  the  ancient  inhabitants  of  that  happy  abode,  in 
sign  of  hen-  joy,  and  with  flowers  in  their  hands,  descended  half  way  down  Mienmo,  in  order  to  welcome 
their  future  companions,  and  Gaudma,  who  then  was  called  Maga,  began  to  contrive  how  he  might  drive 
these  Nat  gods  from  their  ancient  possessions.  He  and  his  companions  accordingly  pretended  to  have 
runk  wine;  but  what  they  drank  was  not  true  wine;  but  the  former  Nat  Tavateinza,  imitating  the 
examp  e of  these  men,  drank  real  wine,  and  became  intoxicated.  Then  Maga  and  his  companions 
< ragged  the  Nat,  while  insensible,  by  the  heels,  and  cast  them  out  of  the  Tavateinza  heavens  ■ but  as 
the  lot,  acquired  by  the  merit  of  the  good  actions  of  these  Nat,  was  not  expired,  a habitation  formed 
itself  for  them  between  the  feet  of  Mienmo;  and  this  habitation  is  called  Asura  bon,  which,  in  every 
thing,  except  its  sacred  tree,  resembles  the  heaven  Tavateinza. 

In  Asura  bon  there  is  also  a tree,  under  which  there  are  four  immense  stones,  each  of  them  three 
hundred  juzana  square.  On  these  rocks  sit  the  four  Asura  princes,  when  they  determine  suits,  and 


• Thus  Mohammed,  says  Abulfeda,  in  the  account  of  his  nocturnal  ascent,  having  ascended  to  the  seventh  heaven,  “ was  thence 
carried  up  to  sedrat  the  lotus  tree  (corresponding  with  the  tree  of  life.  Genesis,  chap.  si.  ver.  9.),  where  were  the  sources  of  the  four 
rivers  of  Paradise,  the  two  inner,  and  the  two  outer,  called  the  Nile  and  the  Euphrates.”— Hales  Chronology,  iii.  130. 

t It  is  worth  while  classing  under  this  head  the  various  references  to  trees.  Every  bon  or  abode  of  gods  has  its  specific  sacred  tree  . 
so  have  the  four  islands,  and  the  earth  is  also  distinguished  by  different  trees  appropriated  to  each  Budha.  The  river  Ganga  is 
placed  to  the  south  of  the  banian  tree,  and  the  water  thereof  is  « seerad.”  The  sulgass  trees  flourish  only  in  Paradise  and  in  Damba-dewa. 
The  sull  is  the  tree  of  the  Budha  Gaudma,  and  this  tree  being  sacred  to  Budha,  and  named  in  his  doctrine  with  reverence  the 
Bram.ns,  in  the  bitterness  of  their  enmity  to  the  Budhists,  in  their  long  contests  for  the  supremacy,  actually  applied  its  wood  to  impale 
them  as  heretics ; and  thus  has  been  introduced  that  most  cruel  and  barbarous  practice  as  the  punishment  of  apostacy.  The 
palol  tree  is  also  called  kirri-naga,  as  well  as  rajaca-tenah  ; with  this  tree  is  associated  the  stone  seat  of  the  Budha,  produced  from  the 
earth.  It  appears  by  the  religion,  that  the  minny  phalange  had  been  buried  below  the  tree  kirri-naga-rupa,  which  is  in  the  isle 
Miiini-naga  Dewa-inne,  in  charge  of  the  deity  Saman-dewa-raja,  for  the  purpose  of  the  kingly  snakes  making  their  supplication 
that  they  may  obtain  the  blessedness  (Nirwana).  On  this  seat  the  Budha  had  sat  down,  leaning  himself  to  the  said  tree,  and  preached, 
and  the  feelings  of  his  form  were  transfused  into  that  seat. 

Dr.  Buchanan,  in  his  Essay,  connects  this  account  with  that  of  the  Ficus  Indicus,  or  Boga.  “ Near  the  sacred  lakes  of 
Tavateinza  grows  the  great  gnaung-bayn  tree,  sacred,  because  under  its  shade  Gaudma  received  his  divine  nature.  This  tree  is  the  Ficus 
Indica,  or  h icus  religiosa,  called  also  bogaya-bayn.  From  the  characters  with  which  it  is  written,  it  is  evidently  a Palee  word  from  Bodi 
or  Bodisat,  which  means,  'will never  perish.*" 

In  the  rich  assemblage  of  curious  articles,  suited  to  the  ritual  of  the  Budha,  brought  from  the  Burmese  dominions,  the  produce  of  the 
war  of  1826,  is  a minny  phalange,  or  throne  of  the  Budha,  in  the  heaven  of  Brahma  Loka.  It  is  curiously  and  strikingly  incrusted 
with  coloured  glass,  displaying  in  a most  ingenious  manner  the  combat  of  Sekkraia  and  the  Asuras,  while  the  two  kingly  snakes  are 
represented  in  the  undulating  border.  The  substance  of  the  minny  phalange  is  of  the  palol  or  bogaya  wood,  and  it  not  only  serves  the 
Budha  for  his  throne,  but  it  is  also  made  use  of  as  a chest  for  the  bana  or  sermons,  which  the  legend  represents  him  to  have  preached  • as 
when  seated  on  it  he  leant  against  the  same  tree,  and  passed  from  the  state  of  man  into  the  divine  nature.  It  is  predicted  in  the 
doctrine,  that  the  future  Budha  Maitri  will  separate  for  his  offering  tree  the  iron-wood  tree,  called  nagaha. 


60 


THE  DEYVA  LOKA,  OR  SIX  HEAVENS. 


administer  justice  to  their  subjects.  Among  these  Asuras,  one,  in  the  length  of  time,  lias  obtained  supreme 
dominion,  and  has  become  emperor  of  all  the  Nat  dwelling  in  this  abode. 

The  Asuras  have  another  ground  of  complaint  against  Sekkraia,  for  an  insult  to  the  daughter  of  their 
sovereign.  Mindful  of  these  injuries,  the  Asuras  vowed  perpetual  war  against  the  Nat  gods  of  Tavateinza, 
and  when  they  saw  their  sacred  tree  producing  flowers  different  from  the  glorious  one  of  their  former  abode, 
breathing  vengeance,  they  were  wont  to  ascend  the  mount  Mienmo,  and  to  take  prisoners  the  giants 
great  birds,  dragons,  and  other  genii,  retained  there  by  Sekkraig  as  a guard  for  his  frontiers.  On  this, 
Sekkraia,  mounting  his  elephant,  and  calling  to  his  assistance  the  divinities  of  the  sun,  moon,  and  stars, 
and  those  of  the  winds  and  clouds,  created  new  forms  of  Nat  gods,  and  of  these  raised  an  army, 
without  the  walls  of  the  great  city ; but  the  Asuras  prevailing,  forced  him  to  retire  within  the  walls. 
The  rage  of  the  Asura  was  then  wont  to  abate,  and  Sekkraia,  having  collected  his  forces,  used  to  drive 
them  from  his  walls,  and  to  pursue  them  in  their  flight.  The  Asura  having  failed,  touched  a drum,  made 
of  the  claws  of  Cancer,  and  then  retired  to  their  own  abode.  In  these  battles  no  one  was  killed,  the 
combatant  Nat  gods  only  tore  one  another.  Now,  however,  the  Asura  remain  quiet  at  home,  nor  do 
they  any  more  engage  in  warlike  enterprises. 

The  wars  of  the  god  Sekkraia,  and  the  Budhist  descriptions  of  its  scenery,  refer  entirely  to  this 
Dewa  Loka.  The  god  Sekkraia,  presiding  over  these  heavens,  and  awarding  the  changes  of  transmigration 
to  mortals,  is  described  with  great  splendour ; among  his  four  assistants,  he  reckons  as  one  of  his  chief 
ministers  Wisme-karma-dewa,  so  celebrated  and  skilled  in  architecture,  that  he  is  called  “ the  wonderful 
artist,”*  for  Wisme-karma  invented  the  chakkra-valalla  for  the  use  of  Sekkraia:  this  formidable  weapon, 
with  which  the  god  Sekkraia  became  thereby  invested,  is  described  as  striking  such  terror  by  its  mere 
appearance  into  the  rebel  Asuras,  when  they  had  advanced  beyond  the  region  of  .Tugandere,  after 
overcoming  the  guards  of  genii,  &c.  stationed  there,  that  the  Asuras  immediately  took  to  flight. 
It  appears  in  the  writings,  that  the  god  Sekkraiaf  proposed  to  attend  a birth-day  festival  of  the  Asuras, 
accompanied  by  his  gods.  The  Asuras,  aware  of  his  visit,  prepared  for  him  a japani  (intoxicated  toast),  which 
being  known  to  Sekkraia,  he  prohibited  his  followers  from  partaking  of  it ; and  the  Asuras,  tasting  of  it 
in  error; became  so  intoxicated,  that  Sekkraia,  assisted  by  his  deities,  drove  the  Asuras  from  the  heavens, 
and  flung  them  by  the  heels  into  the  ocean,  thus  becoming  the  supreme  god  of  the  Dewa  Loka,  and 
of  the  palol  tree,  which  thrives  throughout  the  Treekooto,  and  beneath  the  base  of  Mienmo.  The 
Asuras,  lamenting  the  inferiority  of  the  parasatoo  tree  in  their  place  of  exile,  under  the  central  abyss, 
wage  incessant  war,  and  seek  through  these  regions  to  regain  their  beautiful  tree. 

Wisme,  having  thus  assisted  Sekkraia,  now  resides  in  the  mountain  called  Waykotte,  which  is  in  the 
wilderness  of  Ilimaleh-vanni,  and  to  his  charge  Sekkraia  has  committed  the  protection  of  Ceylon  and  of 
the  Budha  doctrine.  The  capacity  of  Wisme  to  form  extensive  rock  temples  appears  also  in  the 
legend  of  the  life  of  Gaudma,  when,  as  Prince  Kumara,  having  resolved  on  the  ascetic  state,  he 
betook  himself  to  the  forests.  “ Deep  in  their  shades  he  discovered  a rock,  with  a building  upon  it 

• One  of  the  most  splendid  of  the  caves  of  Ellora  is  denominated  the  workshop  of  Wisme-karmu. 

+ In  this  narrative,  we  have  related  of  Sekkraia  the  same  event,  namely,  the  expulsion  of  the  Asuras  from  their  heaven,  as  on  the 
foregoing  page  had  been  ascribed  to  Gaudma,  when  on  earth.  The  legend,  however,  is  in  both  instances  identified  with  Gaudma,  as  a 
■Singalese  MS.,  in  the  author’s  possession,  declares  that  it  was  the  act  of  the  Budha,  as  the  god  Sekkraia ; and  is  only  another  stage  of 
the  metempsychosis,  or  Pythagorean  tenet  of  separate  bodies  and  existences,  prepared  for  the  same  spark  or  emanation  of  the  divine 
energy. 


THE  DEW  A LOKA,  OR  SIX  HEAVENS. 


HI 


like'a  palace  called  Parne,  which,  with  all  that  was  found  within  it,  was,  by  order  of  the  god  Sekkraia, 
produced  by  his  favourite  Wisme-karma  in  the  twinkling  of  an  eye;  the  garment  also  which  was  found 
withm  lt  was  Pllt  on  by  him,  and  he  appeared  like  a pilgrim,  and  walking  in  the  air*  (became  Rabat). 
Seeing  that  the  roads  were  levelling  and  decorating  towards  the  capital  city,  he  asked  for  what  purpose 
it  was  done,  on  which  the  inhabitants  told  him  that  it  was  to  be  in  readiness  to  receive  the  Rudha 
Deepankara,  who  was  coming  with  400,000  j-  Rahatoons;  on  hearing  this  he  stepped  with  such  a 
trembling  noise  upon  earth,  as  if  an  ear-ring|  of  the  god  Sekkraia  fell  down.”  The  ear-ring  manifestly 
means  the  chakkra-valalla,  or  thunderbolt,  invented  for  the  god  by  Wisme-karma ; and  it  was  such 
an  incident  which  Southey  has  described  in  the  following  spirited  passage  of  Kchama,  who  had  expelled 
the  Sekkraia  god  of  the  swerga  bowers  : 


Kehama,  like  a thunderbolt,  alights. 

In  wrath  he  caine ; a bickering  flame 
Flashed  from  his  eyes,  which  made  the  moonlight  dim, 
And  passion,  forcing  way  from  ev'ry  limb, 

Like  furnace-smoke,  with  terror  wrapt  him  round. 
Furious  he  smote  the  ground  ; 

Earth  trembled  underneath  the  dreadful  stroke. 
Again  in  sunder  riven ; 

He  hurl’d  in  rage  his  whirling  weapon  down. 

But  lo ! the  fiery  Sheckra  to  his  feet 
Return’d,  as  if  by  equal  force  re-driven  ; 

And  from  th’  abyss  the  voice  of  Baly  came. 


The  legend  of  the  Budha  throws  an  important  light  on  the  enmity  of  the  Asura  god,  and  displays 
him  as  bent  upon  opposing  the  perfectibility  and  progress  of  Gaudma.  It  is  as  follows : — “ Gaudma, 
having  received  the  sanction  (nomination)  of  Budha  Brahma-dewa,  and  of  the  second  Budha  Gautama 
without  any  assigned  period,  is  by  the  third  Budha  Deepankara  declared  his  immediate  successor.  He 
abjures  royalty,  worships  the  Budha  by  levelling  his  paths  before  him  (the  meaning  of  the  phrase 
repairing  the  highways),  and  notifies  his  accession  by  the  golden  argha  floating  to  the  mount  of  the 
dragon  king ; he  eats  the  rice  offering,  accepts  the  Ivoosatana  grain,  and  betakes  himself  to  the  depths  of 
a forest  for  the  period  of  the  day  which  ushers  in  his  exaltation  ; then,  in  the  evening,  going  to  the  place 
where  his  tree  now  stands,  and  the  way  to  which  (similarly  to  the  approach  of  the  tree  of  the  Tavateinza 
heaven),  had  been  prepared  by  the  gods  themselves,  he  strews  the  Ivoosatana  seed ; this  consummates  the 
energy  of  his  will,  whereby,  in  the  doctrine,  he  is  declared  to  assume  the  Budhaship ; the  earth  opens, 


* The  gift  of  Meipo,  or  of  miracles,  is  a great  object  of  ambition  to  every  Budhist;  its  chief  privilege  is  the  faculty  of  walking  in  the 
air ; thus  Pia  Metnk,  the  Chinese  who,  upon  the  expulsion  of  the  Birman  invaders,  mounted  the  throne  of  Siam,  in  one  of  his  religious 
frenzies,  took  it  into  his  head,  that  by  still  more  intense  devotion  than  he  had  hitherto  practised,  he  might  attain  the  supernatural  gift, 
and  by  this  means  be  enabled  to  ascend  direct  to  heaven,  in  the  easy  and  rapid  manner  in  which  a bird  soars  to  the  sky.  He  sent  fo.  tlie 
priest  of  Guatama,  who  declared  the  project  to  be  quite  feasible.— Crau/urd’s  Mission  to  Siam,  182.  Mr.  Finlayson  also  states  the 
application  of  a Siamese  noble  to  acquire  this  faculty. 

t It  is  remarked  by  an  accurate  observer  of  the  Slngalese  race,  that  by  this  number,  as  also  by  the  thirty-six  million  of  Nat  gods, 
mentioned  at  page  57,  no  more  is  meant  than  a large  indefinite  number,  such  as  is  signified  by  an  assart  hat/ a of  years. 

J The  cundala  baranaia,  translated  the  ear-ring  of  Sekkraia,  and  having  a constant  wavering  and  shining  lustre,  and  which  fell  to 
earth,  seems  clearly  to  be  the  same  as  the  ring,  chakkra,  invented  by  Wisme-karma,  to  arm  the  god  against  the  rebel  Asuras ; of 
which  the  rings  ornamenting  these  and  also  the  Indian  deities  are  the  types. 


(>*2 


THE  DEWA  LOIvA,  OR  SIX  HEAVENS. 


and  produces  to  him  his  seat  of  power,  namely  the  minny  phalange , or  throne,  fourteen  cubits  high,  on  which 
he  seats  himself,  and  the  tree  against  which  he  leans  seems  to  be  a pillar  of  silver  (the  resemblance 
of  the  Tavateinza  tree).  All  the  gods  repair  before  and  praise  him,  at  which  moment  a great  light  shines 
on  the  place,  and  there  comes,  sitting  on  a stupendous  elephant  bigger  than  the  greatest  mountain,  the 
Asura  <md  Wissewarte-mara,  with  an  innumerable  company  of  armed  Asuras.  lie  himself  has  a sword 
with  which  he  could  separate  the  heavens  in  two,  by  which  he  intends  to  intimidate  the  Budha, 
and  to  obtain  his  seat  by  force ; but  the  mere  recollection  of  his  good  deeds,  disperses  and  defeats  the 
Asuras,  and  he  becomes  Budha  with  the  name  of  Gaudma. 

These  two  legends  are  somewhat  contradictory,  and  yet  they  merit  a closer  investigation,  as  from 
them,  connected  with  an  incident  in  the  life  of  the  Budha,  may  be  gathered  the  fault  of  the  Asuras, 
which  produced  their  punishment  of  expulsion : from  this  portion  of  the  Budhist  doctrine  having  been 
very  confusedly  stated,  as  well  as  the  mystical  descriptions  of  the  ear-ring  of  Sekkraia,  <kc.  these  passages 
of  the  life  of  the  Budha  appear  not  only  to  have  been  misunderstood,  but  to  have  fastened  upon 
Gaudma  the  charge  of  fraud  and  abominable  cunning.* 

The  preceding  narratives  describe  the  heaven  Tavateinza,  and  its  beautiful  tree,  producing  once  in  a 
thousand  years  an  inebriating  fruit,  which,  when  partaken  of,  intoxicates  the  gods,  and  on  the  flowering 
of  which  they  hold  a festival  of  four  months. 

We  further  gather,  that  Gaudma,  filling  up  the  circle  of  his  prescribed  forms  and  existence,  previously 
to  becoming  the  Budha,  abjured  his  royalty,  became  a Rabat,  and  assisted  in  levelling  the  roads 
for  the  then  Budha  Deepankara;  by  this  act  of  duty  and  piety  to  him,  he  became  recognised 
by  him  as  his  successor.  This  stage  of  his  duty  performed,  he  dies, , and  appears  in  the  Tavateinza 
heaven,  as  the  god  Sekkraia,  with  thirty-two  companions,  or  the  Nat  dewas,  his  counsellors.  As 
his  next  stage  was  to  become  king  Wessantara  (the  only  mediate  link  to  his  exaltation  to  the 
Budhaship),  the  invitation  of  himself  to  the  festival  (which  is  clearly  the  same  as  that  held  at  the  great 
tree  which  intoxicates),  seems  to  intimate  that  it  wras  the  duty  of  Gaudma  to  refrain  from  partaking 
of  the  personal  indulgences  or  enjoyments  of  its  perfumes,  flowers,  and  nectareous  liquor,  as  a part  of 
his  abstaining  merits.  The  Asura  god,  then  the  chief  deity  of  Tavateinza,  plots  to  circumvent  this 
resolve,  by  giving  to  Gaudma  a japani  (probably  rice)  steeped  in  the  juice  of  the  fruit  of  the  tree,  and 
called  the  intoxicating  toast,  thereby  to  defeat  his  future  exaltation ; but  Gaudma,  by  his  prescience, 
aware  of  this  deceit,  refrains  with  his  counsellors  from  partaking  of  it,  and  the  Asuras,  falling  into 
their  own  snare,  are  overcome  and  thrown  into  the  sea. 

Their  rejection  of,  and  resistance  to,  Gaudma  becoming  the  Budha,  and  the  snare  of  tempting 
Gaudma  to  sin  through  the  enticing  pleasures  of  the  tree  and  its  festival,  both  levelled  against  his  becoming 
Budha,  seem  then  to  have  been  the  crime  of  the  Asuras ; and  this  idea  is  sustained  by  the  prohibitions 
so  strongly  marked  in  the  Budha  ritual  against  the  Rahans,  his  foDowers,  ever  partaking  of  any 
inebriating  liquor  (the  term  of  the  law  is  the  same  as  that  which  describes  the  liquor  of  the  Tavateinza 
tree),  or  using  scented  flowers,  perfumes,  fragrant  fruits,  &c.  These  clauses  are  manifestly  referable 
to  the  scene  of  the  festival  and  the  snare  of  the  Asuras;  while  also  the  prohibitions  against  partaking 
of  any  night  repast,  and  the  heinous  offence  which  the  Budha  doctrine  attaches  to  a seemingly  indifferent 


* See  note  of  Dr.  Buchanan,  Asiatic  Researches , vi.  212. 


HIE  DEW  A LOKA,  OR  SIX  HEAVENS. 


action  of  the  appetite,  show  that  there  lurks  some  hidden  meaning  under  this  clause,  such  as  the  rebellion 

of  the  Asuras,  and  the  attack  on  his  person  on  the  night  of  his  becoming  the  Budha,  may  serve  to 
explain. 

The  doctrinal  account  of  the  Nagas  or  snakes  with  human  faces  and  the  folds  of  the  serpent ; of 
the  Asuras  thrown  into  the  ocean,  and  subsequently  settling  themselves  in  the  regions  of  the  air, 
intermediate  between  the  earth  and  the  heavens;  of  their  bon  or  habitation  being,  in  the  doctrine, 
declaratory  for  a limited  time ; all  these  are  points  of  much  interest;  they  are  manifestly  transcripts  of 
earlier  records  than  the  era  of  Gaudma. 

The  notion  of  the  celebrated  feast  of  the  inebriating  fruit,  and  of  the  rejoicings  which  followed  the 
warnings  of  the  Nat  god,  and  preceded  the  fact  of  a Budha  being  about  to  appear  on  earth,  has  clearly 
been  a doctrine  in  the  East  in  the  earliest  ages,  and  throws  back  original  Budhism  to  a period  of  time 
long  anterior  to  the  commencement  of  the  law  of  Gaudma.  The  historical  details  of  the  popular 
celebration  of  this  identical  festival*  held  in  honour  of  the  Budha  will  demonstrate  how  deeply  rooted 
its  practice  had  become  at  a very  early  period  of  history,  and  what  strong  ground  tliere  is  to  infer 


that  we  have  preserved  a memento  of  it  in  many  of  our  common  games  and  old  customs,  practised  in 
remote  parts  of  our  own  island  even  to  the  present  day. 

The  third  god,  called  Wiroe  Pakshe,  rules  the  North,  and  is,  with  his  servants,  as  ruddy  as  the 
blood-red  coral.  He  is  supreme  over  the  Naga-batteyo,  or  the  Cobra-copiles,  inhabiting  the  heavens. 
The  upper  part  of  the  body  of  these  snakes  has  the  shape  of  a human  being,  and  the  lower  part,  from 


• Cf  The  Persians  and  Babylonians  held  a festival,  which  they  denominated  Sacea,  from  their  god  Saca,  or  Budha  Sacya.  During  his 
festival,  men  and  women  gave  themselves  up  to  the  most  unrestrained  drunkenness  and  lasciviousness.” — Selclen  de  Diis  Syr'uc. 

“ It  has  been  inquired,  why  this  festival  was  called  Sacea  ; and  some  have  imagined  that  it  was  instituted  by  Cyrus,  in  commemoration 
of  a victory,  which  he  obtained  over  the  Scythians,  Sacee ; but  there  is  nothing  in  it  which  resembles  the  commemoration  of  a victory. 
Berosus  mentions  the  festival  by  its  name  Sacea,  as  a Babylonian  institution,  and  Ctesias,  in  those  books  which  treat  of  times  preceding 
Cyrus.  Hesychius  calls  it  a Scythian  festival ; he  likewise  tells  us  that  the  Babylonian  Seches  was  the  appellation  of  the  planet  Mercury 
or  Budha.  From  the  old  Persico-gothic  festival,  our  Christianized  forefathers  of  the  middle  ages,  whose  ancestors  emigrated  out  of  the 
north  of  Iran  and  Hindostan,  borrowed  their  ecclesiastical  mummery  of  the  Abbot  of  Misrule,  and  other  singular  practices." — 
Faber,  ii.  497- 

**  Among  the  Celtic  nation,  the  new  moon  nearest  to  the  winter  solstices  was  peculiarly  celebrated.  The  chief  Druid  went  into  the 
woods  on  that  night,  and  cut  with  a golden  sickle  a branch  of  the  mistletoe  of  the  oak,  called  Ghiah,  in  the  Celtic.  The  people  also  cut 
branches  for  themselves,  and  carried  them  home,  after  they  had  been  blessed  by  the  chief  Druid,  whence  the  usage  of  adoruing  our  churches 
with  evergreens. 

“ In  France,  at  the  Christmas  gambols,  as  late  as  the  reign  of  Louis  XIV.,  when  they  were  suppressed  on  account  of  their  irregularities, 
traces  of  the  Druidical  usages  were  found.  A man,  personating  a prince  ( roi  Joliet,  “ a mummer”),  set  out  from  the  village  into  the 
woods,  bawling  out,  Au  gui  menez,  le  roi  le  veult ; the  monks  followed  in  the  rear,  with  their  begging  boxes,  which  they  rattled,  crying 
tire-lire,  and  the  people  put  money  in  them,  under  the  fiction  that  it  was  for  a lady  in  labour.  Persons  in  disguise  ( guiscards)  forced 
into  dwelling-houses,  playing  antic  tricks,  and  bullying  the  inmates  for  money  and  choice  victuids,  crying,  tire-lire,  tire-lire,  maint  du  blanc 
ct  point  du  bis  (pis ).  Hence,  says  the  late  Professor  Robison,  of  Edinburgh  (from  whose  work  on  Natural  Philosophy,  p.  200,  this  note 
is  taken),  evidently  was  derived  the  guiscarts  of  Edinburgh,  and  their  cry  * Hog  menay,  troll  lollay,  Gie 's  your  white  bread,  and  none  «> 
your  gruy.’  The  old  French  au  gui  menez,  and  the  Scottish  hog  menay,  are  plainly  corruptions  of  the  Greek  ctyiau.r}vrlt  * holy  moon. 
which  was  anciently  supposed  to  be  in  labour  at  the  time  of  the  conjunction  or  new  moon.  Perhaps  tire-lire  may  be  a corruption  of  lirez 
— draw  forth,  and  ‘ put  money  for  the  king namely,  roi  Joliet,  the  mummer.” — Hale’s  Chronology,  i.  153. 

The  season  of  the  epagomene,  or  days  of  carousal,  were  celebrated  at  Babylon,  similarly  to  the  Saturnalia  at  Rome ; and  it  was 
during  their  excess,  and  the  consequent  inebriety  of  the  guards,  that  her  gates  of  brass  were  opened,  according  to  the  word  of  prophecy,  the 
river  drawn  off,  and  her  empire  for  ever  destroyed.  Quintus  Curtius  represents  the  Babylonians  as  excessively  addicted  to  wine  and  the 
consequences  of  ebriety. 

The  season,  character,  and  connexion,  of  the  holy  moon  in  the  Christmas  gambols  in  France  mark  it  as  an  Eastern  fragment,  the  moou 
being  figured  as  labouring  under  the  same  eclipse  as  the  planet  Rahoo. 


(.  j tjie  dewa  loka,  or  six  heavens. 

the  middle,  that  of  a snake.  Himself  and  attendants  can  assume  at  will  the  shape  of  men  and  of  birds, 
or  of  any  animals ; they  can  become  the  same  as  rocks  or  trees,  or  take  any  inanimate  form. 

These  Naga  snakes  are  deemed  Nat  deities,  and  have  the  power  of  transforming  themselves  into  all 
shapes  excepting  in  the  four  following  cases  :-l.  In  rest  by  sleep.-2.  Falling  to  death—S.  Eating  of 
terrestrial  food.-*.  Intercourse  with  mankind.  In  these  hints  we  evidently  trace  out  the  serpent 
fairies,  forming  the  structure  of  the  imagery  and  enchantments  of  Eastern  fictions.* 

The  connexion  of  the  Nagas  or  Cobra-copile  Serpents  with  mountains  is  equally  strong  m 
Hinduism  In  the  Dherma  Sastra  both  Nagas  and  Garudas  are  named  as  races  of  men  descended  from 
Atri ; but  in  the  language  of  mythology,  the  Nagas  or  Urugas  are  large  serpents,  and  the  Garudas 

immense  birds,  like  the  simorg  of  the  mountain  Caf. 

The  king  of  the  serpents  formerly  reigned  in  Chackra  Giri ; and  his  subjects  were  obliged,  by  the 

power  of  Garuda,  to  supply  that  enormous  bird  with  a snake  each  day  : their  king  at  length  refused  to 
<,ive  the  daily  provision.  This  enraged  Garuda,  who  threatened  to  devour  the  snakes  and  their  king ; nor 
would  his  menaces  have  been  vain,  if  they  had  not  all  retired  to  Sand, a Dwipa,  where  they  settled 
between  the  Cali  and  the  sea,  near  the  station  of  Swami  Carticeya,  god  of  arms,  where  they  are  supposed 
to  live  still  unmolested,  because  Garuda  dares  not  approach  that  more  formidable  divinity.  “ Then,”  says 
the  Indian  writer,  “ they  who  perform  yearly  and  daily  rites  in  honour  of  Sancha  Naga  will  acquire 
immense  riches.”  The  mountains  of  snakes  are  mentioned  by  the  Nubian  geographer,  and  are  to  this 
day  called  Hubab  or  Snake,  and  the  same  region  was  named  Ophiusa  by  the  Greeks,  who  sometimes 
extended  the  name  to  the  whole  African  continent.  The  breath  of  the  Naga  king  is  believed  to  be  a 
fiery  poisonous  wind,  and  by  this  hypothesis  they  account  for  the  simoom,  which  blows  from  the 
mountains  of  Hubab  through  the  whole  extent  of  the  desert.  “ Astica,  a rislii  or  saint,  so  overcame  the 
royal  Naga,  and  reduced  his  size,  as  to  carry  him  about  in  an  earthern  vessel ; and  crowds  of  people 
are  now  said  to  worship  him  at  the  place  of  his  residence,  near  the  river  Cali/’t  This  legend  resembles 
that  of  the  snake,  Haridi,  of  Upper  Egypt;  and  so  intimately  is  the  scenery  of  mountains 
associated  with  these  beings,  that  the  same  term  applies  to  both.  Thus  « Naga  or  motionless,  is  a Sanscrit, 


• « The  Nagas,  or  dragons,  thus  invested  with  great  power,  and  the  capacity  ^assuming  divers  forms,  “ ‘ | “uvltenS 

benefits,  or  signal  injuries,  throughout  the  whole  detail  of  their  cavern,,  their  ^ ^y  who  preserved  Zoheide 

which  accompany  these  rare  gifts,  form  the  basis  of  the  wonder-working  fictions  of  Arabia.  Tim.  the  y P 
from  her  envious  sisters,  had  been  bound  in  her  natural  form  os  a Naga,  and  for  a time  became  liable  to  death  . under  the  su  pe 
privileges,  she  was  preserved  by  Zoheide,  and  she  amply  rewarded  her  preserver  for  the  aid  wh.ch  she  TUto, 

Pari  Banou,  in  the  romantic  and  delightful  tale  of  Prince  Ahmed,  is  one  of  the  very  same  c ass,  on  in  a , , , f 

Naga  cavern,  and  drawn,  from  these  Budhis,  representations;  and  such  also  are  the  acquired  pre.entsof.he  ™ “ 

sighted  telescope,  the  apple  that  gives  life,  and  the  self-conveying  carpet : these  have  all  their  prototypes  » ^ 

but  especially  the  beautiful  story  in  the  Arabian  tales  of  the  Prince  Simoustapha  and  Setelpedour,  queen  of  Ginn, Stan  « .entwely  <* 
upon  these  Nat  regions  throughout  its  incidents.  The  supernatural  mist  which  shrouds  Simoustapha,  and  whwh  nearly  c«t  lurn  ns  lift, 
a Naga  power,  as  also  the  punishment  of  chaining  the  rebellious  Genius  to  a pillar,  and  then  hrea  h,„g 

to  increase  its  sterility."  Every  portion  of  the  narrative  might  be  wrought  out  to  meet  its  exact  coun  crpar  , ^ rf  charnls 

feelings  and  sentiments  of  the  followers  of  the  Budha,  which  were  never  more  prone  to  place  reliance  „ 1 _f  pe_.  wa8 

Pad  talismans,  thau  at  the  present  period,  as  our  late  warfare  evidenced.  Thus  Dr.  Buchanan  relates-..  1 he  late » ^ ""J 
constantly  occupied  in  digging  and  searcl.ing  for  a temple  which  he  had  dreamt  of  as  containing  treasure,  a i l which  had  the  power  ot 
rendering  itself  visible  or  invisible,"  and  says,  " all  good  people  were  in  consternation  on  account  of  certain  T0  ; 

magic,  are  supposed  able  to  change  themselves  into  tigers,  or  other  wild  beasts,  and  thus,  without  duuger  of  detection,  can  commit 

nodturnal  spoils.” — Asiatic  Researches,  vi.  173. 

+ Asiatic  Researches,  iii.  345. 


heavens. 


tiie  dewa  loka,  or  six 


65 


term *for  a mountain;  and  Nasa  its  rpm.W  . .• 

elephant.”  ° ° Ua  Slgnifies  botb  a fountain  snake  and  a wild 

The  following  account  of  the  Cobra-copile  kings  refers  verv  nrnR  v i . 

the  introduction  of  Budhism,  and  the  opposition  made  bv  tl  l with 

prevalent  in  these  hill  regions.  At  the  present  dav  tl  . ^ ? ° the  °rlgmal  °l),lite  idolatry, 

by  certain  tribes  called  Nagas,  who  are  the  relics  of  ^ 

has  been  accomplished  among  the  savage  .inhabitants  of  tl  . ° ™ th®  tlgrf;  but  much 

by  the  mild  doctrine  of  the  Budha.  ^ 

copile  snakes,  or  Naga  kings,  called  Choolo-dewa  and  Maha-dewr"8  * “’e  kl"Sly 

“These  two  kingly  snakes  had  found  a precious  stone  in  their  haunts,  and  a consequent  alterea 
tton  ensued  be  ween  them  each  saying  against  the  other,  -it  is  mine,  it  is  mine  ■ but  big 
unable  to  force  * one  from  the  other,  they  began  to  make  war  with  their  great  hosts  of  snakes,  and  these 

“ ““I"!.  a 3 Unna  GaUe’  SltUate  at  Wannia’  Which  is  t0  the  south  of  Naga  Dwipa,  the 

Thus  it  seems  intimated  by  the  history  on  which  this  legend  rests,  that  the  throne  or  seat  of  power 
is  the  jewel  which  had  been  buried  below  the  tree  Kiri-naga-rooka,  which.is  on  the  isle  Minni-na-a 
Dewa-mne  leavmg  the  same  to  the  charge  of  the  deity  called  Saman-dewa-raja,  for  the  purpose  of 
offering  and  making  supplication  there  by  the  divine  snakes,  that  they  might  thereby  obtain  the 
bhss  of  the  Budha  faith.  In  these  expressions  is  clearly  intimated  the  part  which  Saman-dewa  was 
supposed  to  have  had,  in  drawing  off  the  minds  of  those  ancient  idolaters  of  Ceylon  from  their  older 
superstition,  the  worship  of  the  serpent,  to  the  faith  of  the  Budha.  These  fragments  of  history  are 
useful  as  being  the  only  traces  of  a state  of  things  buried  in  oblivion,  and  as  describing  the  chief  Naga 
deities  by  characters  which  we  recognise  in  all  our  ancient  romances.  Thus  the  Nagas  are  held  to  be 
equal  in  power  and  other  felicities  to  superior  deities.  They  are  capable  of  being  transformed  into 
divers  si, apes  at  their  pleasure  at  all  times,  excepting  in  four  cases,  namely,  in  rest  by  sleep,  falling 
to  death,  eating  food,  or  enjoying  the  carnal  pleasure.  They  have  mighty  power  even  so  far  as  to 
destroy  the  country,  by  breathing  forth  venomous  fumes,  rain,  fire,  and  winds.  They  are  gifted  with 
long  life,  all  happiness,  and  celestial  blisS;  and  the  divine  snakes,  called  Mani-okkeke,  who  live 

in  the  river  Calany,  and  who  invited  the  Budha  for  the  third  time,  have  also  the  same  power  and 
happiness. 


The  fourth  god,  called  Wiroe-wenne,  directs  the  South,  and  is,  together  with  his  attendants,  of 
a golden  hue ; he  is  chief  of  the  Asuras  or  demons.  These  beings  are  not  the  rebel  Asuras,  but 
the  beneficent  demons,  acting  in  conformity  with  the  other  servants  of  Sekkraia,  and  the  inferior 
classes  of  Jugandere. 

“ The  duties  of  these  four  divinities  are,  the  protection  of  their  chief  Sekkraia  from  the  attack  of  his 
enemy,  the  god  Wepetyiette-asura-enderea,  who  is  as  powerful  as  Sekkraia,  and  resides  below  the  abyss 
of  the  sea,  and  in  the  world  of  Asura  Loka.” 

The  doctrine  of  the  Budha  says,  that  the  demons,  when  nature  produced  the  sun,  moon,  and  stars,  were 
human  beings,  but,  on  account  of  their  horrible  sins,  they  fell  from  the  state  of  felicity.  If  they  commit 
greater  sins,  they  suffer  greater  punishments,  and  condemned  men  are  reckoned  by  them  among  the 
demons  ; while,  on  the  contrary,  the  demons  wrho  die,  and  are  born  as  men,  and  commit  no  more  sin,  can 


K 


66 


THE  DEWA  LOKA,  OR  SIX  HEAVENS. 


arrive  at  the  state  of  heaven  and  felicity.* * * §  These  demons  obey  their  chief,  Wiroe-wenne ; they  go  to 
make  war  against  the  enemy  of  Sekkraia,  and  they  eat  the  flesh  of  the  dead.f  Although,  according  to 
the  command  of  the  Budha,  they  are  entitled  to  no  honours,  as  being  enemies  to  the  human  race,  yet 
the  Singalese  show  them  honours,  and  make  offerings,  because  they  fear  that  demons  can  visit  human 
beings  with  sickness ; and  therefore  they,  in  cases  of  sickness,  invoke  them,  and  make  offerings  of 
money,  also  of  boiled  and  unboiled  meats,  and  cause  the  throat,  arms,  legs,  and  body  of  the  sick  to  be 
tied  by  the  Bali  conjurors,  with  necklaces  or  threads  (as  amulets)  dyed  yellow  with  saffron  water. 

All  persons  who  observe  the  five  commandments  of  the  Budha,  transmigrate  after  death  to  this 
region  where  a body  is  ready,  either  of  more  exalted  or  degraded  condition,  according  to  their  past  deeds, 
into  which  they  are  instanter  born  again.  And  from  hence  the  four  assistant  gods  send  forth  their 
writers,  on  or  about  the  new  moon,  to  inspect  into  the  conduct  and  actions  of  men,  and  to  record  the 
good  or  evil  which  they  may  do.  Eight  days  after  the  new  moon,  being  the  first  quarter,  they  send  out 
their  sons  to  make  a similar  report.  Eight  days  afterwards,  or  about  the  full  moon,  the  four  gods  walk 
the  earth  in  person,  and  complete  their  report,  which  they  give  to  the  god  Sekkraia  in  his  audience  or 
supreme  council,  consisting  of  himself,  as  president,  and  thirty -two  inferior  gods,  yet  higher  in  rank  than 
the  four  assistant  gods  and* other  inferior  deities.  Thus  these  gods  are  informed  of  the  actions  of  men, 
and  the  supreme  council  rejoice  when  the  number  of  virtuous  men  in  the  world  exceed  the  dishonest ; 
but,  when  the  wicked  prevail,  they  sorrow  in  the  highest  degree,  and  these  things  arc  fully  described  in 
the  Palee  book  Dewadootesastre.t 

In  this  statement  we  see  the  character  of  the  tribunal,  through  the  agency  of  which  the  judgment 
and  award  of  the  retributive  scheme  of  the  metempsychosis  is  conducted.  Its  declarations  teach  us  that 
man,  ere  he  can  arrive  at  Nirwana,  must  die  several  times,  and  appear  many  times  in  the  sixth  Dewa 
Loka,  to  be  born  again  into  the  world  ; until  he,  having  enjoyed  in  the  eleven  heavens  below 
Brahma  Loka,  a foretaste  of  felicity,  at  last  arrives  at  the  Zian  of  the  five  triumphing  heavens, 
the  true  triumph  of  repose  to  the  wandering  soul,  which,  tossed  from  change  to  change, § and 
dreading  the  frightful  threatenings  of  the  Asura  torments,  after  once  arriving  in  these  heavens,  there 
enjoys  in  full  lustre  all  possible  joy  for  ever,  as  transmigration  takes  place  no  more. 

On  the  contrary,  when  men  die  in  the  commission  of  sin,  they  are  born  in  the  hell  as  irrational 
animals  ; but  if  they  did  any  good  in  their  former  life,  they  are  released,  after  an  immense  period,  from 
their  condemned  state ; they  are  again  born  into  the  human  world,  and  may  arrive  at  the  felicity  of  the 
heavens  by  ceasing  to  commit  sin. 

• In  this  singular  passage,  we  have  the  demonstration  of  all  beings,  divine  as  well  as  human,  being  subject  to  the  laws  of  transmi- 
gration, which  are  operative  on  all,  according  to  a scale  of  moral  deeds.  This  faith,  then,  is  a complete  test  of  a code  of  moral  enactments 
and  motives,  applied  to  the  regulation  and  government  of  man  ; an  experiment  which  renders  the  study  of  Budliisiu  an  important  and 
curious  subject  for  the  philosopher. 

t In  this  portion  of  Budhist  doctrine  we  see  the  admission  of  demons  also  into  the  scheme  of  Gaudma,  and  the  chief  perplexities  and 
entanglements  of  its  agencies  and  traditions  may,  perhaps,  hereafter  be  explained  by  a judicious  examination  of  those  deities  and  customs 
borrowed  from  Kappooism,  such  as  the  hill-gods,  serpent,  or  Naga  worship,  and  demons,  contrasted  with  the  primitive  Budhist  faith  ; our 
limited  range  of  knowledge  thus  far  allows  little  more  than  the  production  of  fragments,  and  detached  portions  of  this  ancient  doctrine. 

+ This  transcript  is  a parallelism  to  the  account  of  the  festival  at  the  palol  tree.  A judgment  follows  immediately  after  death, 
which  is  pronounced  by  an  inferior  god  of  the  sixth  Dewa  Loka,  called  Yame-raja,  who  apportions  to  the  deud  the  stage  of  existence 
on  which  they  shall  enter.  The  wicked  sink  to  hell  unheard,  which  hell  is  concealed  under  the  abyss  of  the  earth,  and  under  the 
infernal  water,  where  winds  commonly  blow  stronger  than  the  fiercest  hurricane  on  earth. 

§ See  the  myth  of  Cupid  and  Psyche  in  Apuleius. 


IDJEWA.  L OKA. 


the  dew  a loka,  or  six  heavens. 


67 


description  of  the  plates  of 


THE  SIX  DEWA  LOKA/ 


Winch,  with  the  Jugandere,  make  the  Seven  Regions. 


THE  FIRST  HEAVEN,  CALLED  “ TJATURUM-MAHARAKE YE.”— PLATE  VI. 

As  the  character  of  these  heavens  has  been  fully  discussed  in  the  preceding  pages,  the  plates  will 
be  better  understood  by  referring  to  them,  and  to  the  legends  attached  to  their  character.  Each  figure  is 
represented  s.ttmgona  minny  phalange,  or  throne,  with  his  attendants ; the  Eastern  Dewa,  is  described  at 
page  55,  of  a wlnte  or  silver  hue,  his  attendants  are  playing  on  the  drum.  The  god  of  the  South,  the 
azure,  or  blue,  on  the  same  page;  the  god  of  the  ruddy  or  coral  colour,  connected  with  the  Naga,  or 
Cobra-copile  snakes,  on  page  63  ; the  yellow,  or  golden,  who  is  attended  by  the  Yakshe,  or  genii  of  the 
region  Jugandere  Parkwette,  is  described  at  page  65. 


THE  SECOND  HEAVBN,  CALLED  “ THE  TAVATEINZA.” — PLATE  VI. 

The  first  figure,  beginning  from  the  left  of  the  plate,  represents  Sekkraia,  with  an  attendant  holding 
a chowry,  or  tail  of  the  yak , which,  in  Palee,  is  called  tzameri,  and  its  hairy  tail,  semera.  The  centre 
compartment,  and  those  on  each  side  of  it,  show  Sekkraia,  with  his  four  assistant  gods,  in  the  scene  of 
the  transmigration,  prepared  to  hear  the  report  of  his  messengers,  sent  to  go  through  the  earth  and  report 
on  the  actions  of  mankind  (page  57) ; lie  holds  a vessel,  to  partake  of  the  chink  of  the  sacred  tree ; he  is 
seated  on  the  minny  phalange,  or  seat  of  the  Budha.  In  the  next  part  he  is  represented  under  the  sacred 
tree  (page  58),  and  on  the  stone,  or  talismanic  seat,  which  sympathetically  denotes  the  well-being  or 
vices  of  mankind.  From  half  of  his  person  being  buried  in  the  seat,f  a favourable  report  of  the  virtuous 
actions  of  mankind  is  indicated.  The  supernatural  properties  of  this  charmed  seat  remind  the  reader 
of  the  various  rings  of  charmed  stones  presented  by  magicians  (page  58),  acting  as  preservatives,  and 


• Analysis  of  Arabian  account  of  the  Seven  Heavens. — “ Of  the  seven  heavens  they  say  its  stones  are  pearls  and  jacinths;  the 
walls  of  its  buildings  enriched  with  gold  and  silver ; and  that  the  trunks  of  all  its  trees  are  of  gold  ; among  which  the  most  remarkable 
is  the  tree  called  Tuba,  or  the  tree  of  happiness ; also  of  the  river  of  life  ( Sale’s  Koran , 127),  and  of  springs  and  fountains,  whose  pebbles 
are  rubies  and  emeralds,  their  earth  of  camphor,  their  beds  of  musk,  and  their  sides  of  saffron,”  &c.  &c.,  in  all  which  descriptive 
sketches,  the  Arabian  prophet  has  accurately  copied  from  the  details  of  Oriental  doctrine. 

t The  splendid  temple,  built  by  the  Khalif  Omar,  at  Jerusalem,  is  termed  in  the  Mussulman  law  El  Harem,  or  the  temple,  which 
word  signifies  “ the  place  consecrated  by  the  peculiar  presence  of  the  divinity.”  The  Moslem  faith  acknowledges  but  two  temples , that  of 
Mecca,  and  that  of  Jerusalem  ; both  are  called  A1  Harem.  In  Showing,  therefore,  that  the  tenets  of  Islamism  have  taken  the  legend  of 
Sekkraia,  and  of  the  foot-print  of  the  Budha,  and  literally  applied  them  to  Mohammed,  and  the  A1  Harem  of  Jerusalem,  the  strongest 
testimony  is  furnished  of  the  manner  in  which  the  Arabian  doctrine  has  made  use  of  the  Oriental  doctrines  of  Budhism.  In  the  relation 
of  the  celebrated  night  journey  of  the  prophet,  we  are  informed  that  “the  prophet,  after  leaving  El  Borak  (the  celestial  beast)  at  the 
gate  of  the  temple  of  Jerusalem,  came  to  offer  up  his  prayer  upon  El  Sahhara  (Jacob’s  stone,  as  the  Moslems  term  it,  which  the  Khalif 
Mervan  built  an  additional  aisle  to  inclose),  with  the  other  prophets  and  angels,  who,  having  saluted  him  (Mohammed)  respectfully, 
yielded  to  him  the  place  of  honour.  At  the  moment  when  the  prophet  stood  upon  El  Sahhara , the  rock,  sensible  of  the  happiness  of 
bearing  the  holy  burden,  depressed  itself,  and  becoming  like  soft  wax,  received  the  print  of  his  sacred  foot  upon  the  upper  part.  The 
believers,  after  having  touched  the  print,  sanctify  themselves  by  passing  the  hand  over  the  face  and  beard.” — Ali  Beys  Account  if  the 
l cm  pic  of  Jerusalem. 


68 


THE  DEWA  LOKA,  OR  SIX  HEAVENS. 


indicative  of  fidelity,  or  of  the  continuance  in  existence  of  some  being  whose  life  is  attached  to  the 
charm  : these  and  all  the  fables  of  stone  talismans  are  portions  of  legends  traceable  to  the  agate  seats,  or 
talisman ic  thrones  of  Eastern  gods;  and  it  is  not  improbable,  from  the  extraordinary  value  set  on  the 
Yu  stone,  that  the  seat  was  of  that  kind  of  agatized  stone. 


THE  THIRD  HEAVEN,  CALLED  “ YAME,”  PRESIDED  OVER  BY  SOO-YAMI-RAJA. — PLATE  VII. 

He  adjudges  the  wicked,  and  sentences  them  to  the  various  hells,  according  to  the  nature  of  their 
crimes.  Two  attendants  are  playing  on  the  drum,  ten  thousand  of  whom  are  said  to  have  been  present 
at  the  birth  of  Gaudma,  in  honour  of  his  assumption  of  the  Budhaship.  The  very  curious  banner 
suspended  from  the  pole,  with  eight  metallic  points,  and  ending  in  a ball,  is  described  in  the  great 
procession  of  the  god  Sekkraia,  as  emitting  an  agreeable  murmur,  and  the  dagobahs  of  the  Budha  always 
have  a bell  suspended  near,  that  the  worshipper  may  strike  upon  it,  to  acquaint  this  Nat  god  with  his  act 
of  piety  in  making  an  offering,  whereby  he  hopes  to  propitiate  his  favour.  Yame-raja  is  a deity  greatly 
dreaded,  and  performs  the  same  functions  in  the  Budha  doctrine  as  the  deity  of  Patala,  and  the  Minos 
and  Rhadamanthus  of  the  Greek  mythology.  We  may  recognise,  in  the  suspended  banner,  the  description 
of  the  suspended  strings  of  metallic  knobs  which  were  hung  near  the  oracle  of  Jupiter  Ammon,  and 
which  formed  one  mode  of  augury,  for  it  was  deemed  propitious  when  these  metallic  knobs  were  agitated 
by  a stream  of  wind,  so  as  to  emit  an  agreeable  tinkling.  As  most  oracles  were  also  figured  to  be  situate 
over  an  Omphalie,  or  central  cavity  of  the  earth,  and  to  receive  the  augury  from  a supernatural  afflatus, 
the  coincidence  becomes  very  clear,  as  to  the  position  of  these  heavens  over  the  rock  Maha-meru 
Parkwette,  or  world  stone. 


THE  FOURTH  HEAVEN,  CALLED  “ TOISITE,”  RULED  BY  THE  GOD  SUNTO-SITE,  PLATE  VII, 

< 

is  the  residence  of  every  candidate  for  Budha ; and  here  now  abides  the  future  Budha  Maitri,  until 
the  expiration  of  the  Biulha-verouse,  or  Gaudma’s  prophecied  supremacy  of  5000  years,  when  he  is 
to  be  born  intb  the  world.  Of  the  Budha-verouse,  2369  years  had  expired  in  1827,  so  that  2631  years 
remain  for  its  continuance  ; after  which,  the  Budha  Maitri  will  enter  on  his  government.  After  the  era 
of  Maitri,  this  Calpe  will  end,  and  the  universe  will  be  destroyed  by  fire. 

The  first  part  appears  to  exhibit  the  god  Maitri,  awaiting  the  expiration  of  the  period  assigned  for 
his  abode  in  the  heavens  ; a portion  of  the  presents  given  on  the  birth  of  the  Budha,  and  ten  thousand 
raja  kings  of  this  heaven  making  offers  of  displaying  fire-works,  called  chumana , each  of  which  was 
three  yodoons  in  height. 

The  second  part  refers  to  the  following  portion  of  the  history  of  Gaudma : — When  prince  Rahoola 
was  born  to  him,  according  to  the  Eastern  mode  of  expression,  the  news  made  him  cheerful  as  the 
god  Sekkraia  when  returned  from  subduing  his  enemies,  the  rebel  Asuras;  Gaudma,  as  he  was  returning 
to  his  palace,  met  a female,  who  in  a song  represented  to  him  all  the  good  and  ill  to  which  a man  is  subject 
in  life.  This  mystic  song  seems  to  have  decided  him  on  renouncing  royalty,  and  becoming  an  ascetic; 
he  rewards  her  with  a golden  chain,  and  returning  pensively  to  his  palace,  which  was  shining  as  that  of 
Sekkraia,  some  dancing-women  came  to  divert  him ; this  appears  to  be  represented  in  the  plate. 


IBKWA  LOKA 


I 


70 


THE  DEW  A LOKA,  OR  SIX  HEAVENS. 


or  connexion  with  the  world,  and  the  existing  essence  ascends  by  regular  and  stated  progressiohs  to 
Nirwana.  The  attendants  on  the  Maha-raja  are  represented  with  conch  shells*  These  are  thus  noticed  in 
the  birth  of  the  Budha: — “ Ten  thousand  Sekkraias  offered  to  blow  ten  thousand  conch  shells 
(ehanks),  all  wreathed  to  the  right,  and  each  was  one  hundred  and  twenty  cubits  in  length,  and,  when 
blown,  the  sound  is  succeeded  by  an  unremitted  and  unslackened  echo  for  the  space  of  four  months  and 
two  full-moon  days.” 

The  time  here  specified  seems  again  to  infer  the  coincidence  of  the  birth  of  Budha  with  the  celebrated 
festival  of  the  great  tree  of  the  Nat  paradise ; and  the  legend  of  conch  shells  may  also  be  traced  in  Indian 
fable,  if  we  turn  to  Sancha-dwipa,  or  the  island  of  shells,  which  is  said  to  refer  particularly  to  the  large 
buccinum , or  the  conch  shell  of  Sekkraia.  The  Red  Sea,  which  abounds  in  shells  of  extraordinary  size  and 
beauty,  was  considered  as  part  of  the  Sanchabdhi,  and  the  natives,  according  to  Strabo,  wore  large  collars 
of  shells  for  ornament  and  for  amulets. 

Thus  also  in  the  Puranas  it  is  declared  that  the  Dwipa  had  the  appellation  of  Sancha,  because  its 
inhabitants  lived  in  shells,  or  in  cavernsf  hollowed  like  them,  and  with  entrances  like  their  mouths.  The 
idea  of  an  actual  habitation  in*  a shell  was  not  new  to  the  Greeks,  who  represent  Cupids  and  also 
young  Nereids  as  living  ip  shells;  and  their  marine  deities  are  the  most  imaginative  beings  of  their 
captivating  fables4 

Thus  we  find  agencies  of  evil  propensity  placed  in  the  very  firmament,  on  the  borders  of  the  sixth 
Dewa  Loka ; hostile  Asuras,  who  attack  the  region  of  Sekkraia,  and  his  four  guardian  gods,  from  under- 
neath the  Mienmo  stone ; and  also  existing  on  the  borders  of  the  Brahma  Loka,  or  highest  heavens  of 
the  gods,  in  Wassawarty  and  his  gods.  Whether  these  two  hostile  classes  perform  any  part  in  the 
trials  of  the  metempsychosis  may  be  learned  when  we  obtain  a more  perfect  knowledge  of  the  doctrinal 
codes  ; but  the  coincidence  of  their  position  on  the  confines  of  each  state  of  separate  existence,  the  Dewa 
Loka,  and  the  Brahma  Loka,  as  well  as  the  character  of  hostility  to  the  Budha,  deserve  our  particular 
notice.  Thus  again  it  is  stated — “ When  the  Jtfudha  is  born  into  the  world,  having  overcome  the  many 
oppositions  of  Wassawarty-raja,  or  Anti-Budha,  who  is  the  chief  of  the  six  Kamelokes,  and  thousands  of 
Bra  hmas,  he  obtains  his  Budhaship.” 

This  extract  manifestly  alludes  to  Asuras,  the  Wassawarty  chief  or  rebel  Asura,  and  shows  the  view 
already  taken  of  the  wars  of  Sekkraia,  and  the  crime  of  the  Asura,  in  resisting  the  elevation  of  the  Budha, 
to  be  a correct  one.  May  not  this  fragment  of  history  allude  to  the  resistance  of  some  partisans  of  the  former 


* The  value  attached  to  the  chank  shells  appears  in  the  following  extract : — “ The  minister  said  to  me  that  he  had  a message  to 
deliver  from  the  king,  and  pointed  to  three  chank  shells  which  lay  before  him.  The  Budhists  employ  them  for  religious  purposes. 
Ordinary  ones  are  of  little  or  no  value ; but  when  nature  produces  a lusus,  by  inverting  the  usual  order  of  the  spiral  convolutions  of  the 
shell,  they  are  in  great  request,  being  valued,  according  to  their  size  or  beauty,  at  from  one  to  two  hundred  pounds  a-piece.  One  of  the 
shells,  exhibited  by  the  minister,  was  of  this  description,  and  had  been  presented  to  the  king  by  the  Rajah  of  Zigor.  Over  and  above  its 
own  supposed  value,  it  was  richly  set  with  pearls  and  rubies.  In  Siam,  no  subject  is  allowed  to  be  possessed  of  one  of  these  shells.  They 
are  not  employed  in  the  common  ceremonies  of  the  Budhist  worship,  but  upon  solemn  occasions  only,  wheu  they  are  filled  with  water  ; 
over  which  certain  incantations  being  repeated,  the  element  is  considered  holy,  and  thought  to  confer  a blessing  upon  whomsoever  it  is 
sprinkled  over.  The  object  of  exhibiting  the  shells  upon  the  present  occasion,  was  to  point  out  the  difference  of  them,  and  to  request  one 
of  the  precious  ones  from  the  governor-general  for  the  king. — Craufurd’s  Mission  to  Siam,  101. 

t “ Sancha-sura  dwelt  in  a palace,  which  was  in  a shell  in  the  ocean,  and  his  subjects  are  represented  as  cannibals,  and  even  as 
demons.” — See  Island  of  Suafcim,  &c.  Asiatic  Researches,  iii.  347. 

\ May  not  the  Budhist  legends  have  furnished  the  prototype  of  the  Tritons,  the  heralds  of  the  ocean-god  of  the  Greeks? 


71 


tiie  dewa  loka,  or  six  heavens. 


Budhism,  which  was  sought  to  be  reformed  by  Gaudma  on  his  appearance  in  Ceylon  ? Certainly,  in  the 
present  system,  it  is  erroneous  still  to  make  this  portion  of  the  heaven  the  abode  of  these  Asuras  as 
it  narrates  circumstantially  their  expulsion  from  it,  for  their  double  attempt  on  the  person  and  exaltation 
of  the  Budha.  It  is  curious  to  notice  the  manner  in  which  these  evil  and  rebellious  deities  are  disposed 
of:  rejected  from  their  heavens,  they  still  have  a sacred  tree,  and  a bon.  or  habitation,  answering  to  the 
Dewa  Loka  which  they  have  lost ; a tree,  the  roots  of  which  descend  from  the  heaven  through  the  surface 
of  the  great  central  mount  Mienmo  to  .the  abyss  beneath.  It  was  from  this  abyss  (in  the  history  of 
Gaudma,  we  find)  that,  as  the  Budha  leaned  against  the  tree,  a » ninny  phalange  rose  for  his  throne;  and 
through  the  same  chasm,  or  central  cavity,  after  a strong  light,  arose  the  Wassawarty  Asura  on  his 
elephant,  with  his  followers,  to  depose  the  Budha. 

The  irruption  of  the  rebel  Asuras  from  the  central  abyss,  and  the  imagery  of  this  portion  of  the 
Budha  doctrine,  may  receive  illustration  from  a consideration  of  the  ideas  entertained  on  the  subject  by 
the  ancient  world.  By  the  phraseology  of  this  passage  the  Wassawarty-raja  of  the  sixth  Dewa  Loka 
and  the  Asuras  of  the  abyss  are  blended  together.  Does  it  mean  that  the  Asuras  assist  the  gods  of  the 
sixth  heaven  in  their  opposition?  This  question  none  of  the  manuscripts  or  doctrinal  books  fully 
clear  up. 

It  is  very  interesting  to  see  how  closely  the  imagery  of  the  book  of  Job  coincides,  in  many  particulars, 
with  the  philosophy  of  the  Budha  doctrine.  Wassawarty-raja,  the  chief  angel  or  deity  of  the  sixth  Dewa 
Loka,  is  the  enemy  and  opposer  of  the  Budha,  the  chief  divine  personage ; and  although  Wassawarty  is 
characterised  as  the  Adversary , the  Anti-Budhist , yet  he  appears  before  Sekkraia  and  the  Budha,  and  has 
much  in  common  with  the  evil  agent  of  the  book  of  Job,  and  this  is  most  strikingly  illustrated  by  the  sixth 


to  the  twelfth  verse  of  the  first  chapter,  as  follows : — “ Now  there  was  a day  when  the  sons  of  God  came 
to  present  themselves  before  the  Lord,  and  Satan  came  also  among  them.  And  the  Lord  said  unto 
Satan,  Whence  comest  thou  ? Then  Satan  answered  the  Lord,  and  said,  From  going  to  and  fro  in  the 
earth,  and  from  walking  up  and  down  in  it.  And  the  Lord  said  unto  Satan,  Hast  thou  considered  my 
servant  Job,”  &c.  Here  the  evil  spirit  is  introduced  into  the  Divine  presence,  as  bearing  the  character  of 
“ the  accuser  or  adversary,”  rather  than  of  that  rebellious  spirit  whose  malignant  nature  had  erected  his 
kingdom  in  opposition  to  the  Most  High.  Satan  here  accompanies  the  sons  of  God ; he  listens  to 
questions,  and  shows  himself  ready  to  obey  commands.  It  may  therefore  be  inferred,  that  the  early 
opinions  of  the  Jews,  in  regard  to  supernatural  agency,  did  not  exclude  from  the  service  of  the  Almighty 
the  ministrations  even  of  those  less  perfect  spirits,  whose  office  it  was  to  convey  to  the  bar  of  Heaven  a 
record  of  human  guilt,  and  to  return  thence  with  power  and  authority  to  punish  it.  Some  traces  of  this 
simple  theology  may  be  found  in  the  Old  Testament  much  later  than  the  age  of  Job.  in  the  prophet 
Zechariah,  where  the  accuser  again  appears ; and  in  the  vision  of  the  four  chariots,  the  angel  answered 
and  said,  These  are  the  four  spirits  of  the  heavens,  which  go  forth  from  standing  before  the  Lord  of  all 
the  earth.  And  he  said,  Get  you  hence,  walk  to  and  fro  through  the  earth;  so  they  walked  to  and  fro 
through  the  earth.  And  they  said,  We  have  walked  to  and  fro  through  the  earth,  and  behold  all  the 
earth  sitteth  still,  and  is  at  rest.” — Zech.  i.  8,  9,  10,  11;  vi.  5,  7,  8. 

There  is  unquestionably  no  similitude  between  “the  accuser”  of  Job  and  of  Zechariah,  and  the 
master  demon  described  by  the  Jews  from  the  time  of  Ezra  as  the  prince  of  hell ; and  considering  the 


THE  DEWA  LOKA,  Oil  SIX  HEAVENS. 


7*2 

book  of  Job  as  pointing  to  no  species  of  idolatry  but  that  of  Sabcism  (by  the  moon  walking  ill  her 
brightness,  and  the  sun  in  its  shining),  and  the  glory  and  worship  of  these  two  bright  luminaries  as  the 
great  corrupting  cause  therein  exhibited,  it  is  worthy  of  inquiry  how  far  the  doctrine  of  the  two  principles, 
the  good  and  evil,  may  not  be  the  most  ancient  and  prevalent  of  doctrines,  and,  in  fact,  the  primary 
universal  doctrine  of  the  East,  of  Shinar. 


* The  reader  is  referred  for  fuller  information  on  the  subject  of  these  scriptnral  quotations,  as  well  as  of  the  opinions  held  by  the 
Jews  on  this  point  prior  and  subsequent  to  the  time  of  Ezra,  to  the  publication  of  Dr.  Russell,  on  the  Connexion  of  Sacred  and  Profane 
History — a work,  which  forms  a very  valuable  completion  to  the  labours  of  the  learned  Prideaux,  and  of  Slmckford.  The  coincidence  of 
so  much  of  Budhist  tradition  with  the  primitive  patriarchal  faith,  is  the  most  interesting  and  important  portion  of  this  attempt  to 
illustrate  its  true  scope  and  meaning. 


CHAPTER  VI. 

THE  BRAHMA  LOKA,  OR  SIXTEEN  HEAVENS,  AND  NIRWANA. 


" The  empyrean,  and  grosser  aether,  with  the  zones  of  heaven,  intelligent  angels,  and  souls  of  men,  together  with  the  subordinate  demons, 
and  agents  of  Ormuzd,  have  their  transcripts  in  the  doctrine  of  the  Magians,  or  Budhists  of  Magadha ; the  region  wherein  we 
trace  the  Magi  and  Samaneans  of  antiquity.  The  Nirwana,  or  state  of  ultimate  reward,  in  the  system  of  the  Budha,  is  laid  in 
' the  empyrean,  or  sty in  which  light  also  the  empyrean  itself  is  worshipped  by  the  Chinese  as  the  element  of  supreme  bliss.” 
— Essay  on  Pythagoras. 

“ Wadd  was  supposed  to  be  the  heaven,  and  was  worshipped  under  the  form  of  a man,  by  the  tribe  of  Calb,  in  Daumat  al  Jaudal.”— 
Sale's  Koran , 25. 


It  has  already  been  stated  that  in  Budhism  there  are  twenty-six  heavens,  or  Loka ; and  it  is  very 
material  for  the  right  understanding  of  the  scheme  of  this  religion,  that  the  distribution  and  the  operative 
energies  and  result  of  the  various  stages  comprised  within  their  circle  should  be  fully  investigated.  To 
comprehend  the  whole  system,  it  is  desirable  to  take  a general  view  of  it,  as  hinging  upon  three 
points : Firstly,  the  world-stone  of  the  central  mount  Mienmo,  by  which  bon , or  habitation,  which  is  the 
atmosphere  above  the  earth,  the  human  world,  or  Kama  Loka,  becomes  the  ford  or  passage  to  Nirwana. 
This  at  once  opens  the  key  to  its  trials,  changes,  and  transmigrations ; for  the  lowest  stage  of  rational 
existence  is  by  this  one  gift  in  prospect,  namely,  Nirwana,  declared  to  be  not  only  bearable,  but  a privilege 
beyond  the  bliss  of  any  other  worlds,  however  great  their  excellencies  and  enjoyments.  The  system, 
therefore,  sets  out  from  the  darkness  and  uncertainties  of  life,  of  which  the  doctrine  is  full ; for  a remedy, 
it  points  to  an  unchangeable  state. 

Secondly.  The  next  stage  is  that  of  Jugandere  Parkwette,  the  region  occupying  the  first  circle  of 
atmosphere  that  encompasses  the  earth,  comprising  the  tops  of  the  highest  mountains.  That  the 
mountains  of  the  earth  are  of  this  class  is  proved,  because  the  Budhist  temple  of  Moellegirri-galle,  on 
Adam’s  Peak,  is  declared  to  be  within  this  region  ; their  inhabitants  are  genii,  giants,  great  birds,  dragons, 
and  snakes.  All  these  beings  are  gifted  with  the  power  of  transformation,  and  can  exercise  the  privileges 
of  the  metempsychosis  at  will ; and  as  the  deities  of  the  Dewa  Loka,  their  superiors,  can  create  at  a wish 
whatsoever  they  desire  to  have  or  enjoy,  so  these  genii  appear  to  hold  the  same  rank,  and  to  supply  the 
incidents  for  Eastern  fictions  and  the  wonders  of  enchantment,  as  well  as  for  the  ascription  of  high 
mountains  to  divinities : such  were  the  Ida-crowned  goddess  Cybele,  and  Olympian  Jove ; for  they, 
although  ranked  among  the  highest  of  gods,  have  tempers  as  capricious,  revengeful,  and  malignant,  as 
these  inferior  deities,  or  the  fairies  and  genii  of  Africa.  Their  agency  is  very  extensive,  and  in  a \erj 

L 


74 


TIIE  BRAHMA  LOKA  HEAVENS,  AND  NIRWANA. 


mysterious  manner  intermingled,  with  the  whole  of  the  six  Dcwa  Loka,  as  well  as  affecting  the  Asura 
Loka,  or  the  abode  of  evil  spirits  beneath  the  waters  of  the  central  abyss.  Thus  the  Meru  stone,  or  centre 
of  the  world,  is  supposed  to  be  on  a cavity  or  navel  of  the  earth,  through  which  the  evil  Asuras  ascend 
and  descend  at  will  to  a bon  or  habitation  in  the  air,  which  they  possess  for  a limited  period,  and  whence 
they  carry  on  a constant  war  against  Sekkraia,  the  chief  god  of  the  sixth  Dcwa  Loka. 

Thirdly.  The  six  Dewa  Loka,  or  heavens,  are  entirely  mansions  applied  to  the  progress  of  man 
to  the  state  of  the  gods,  to  the  progress  of  the  metempsychosis,  and  to  that  of  gods  to  be  future  Budhas' 
The  genii,  and  other  inhabitants  of  the  Jugandere  Parkwettc,  are  the  servants  of  these  Nat  gods,  and 
form  a circle,  connecting  the  abode  of  the  Asuras  in  the  lowest  abyss  with  the  Dewa  Loka,  where  they 
once  reiffned,  and  whence,  as  we  have  traced  in  the  wars  of  the  god  Sekkraia,  they  were  expelled. 

Fourthly.  The  heavens  Brahma  Loka,  the  next  link  in  the  system  of  the  universe,  are  from  seven 
to  nine.  The  god  resides  in  the  ninth  heaven,  or  Brahma  Ivuki,  and  is  declared  in  the  doctrine  to  be  the 
great  god  Salian-pati  Maha-brahma.  He  is  the  supreme  of  the  whole  system  when  a Budha  is  not  in 
the  calpe ; and  although  a Budha  is  sometimes  wanting,  yet  the  doctrine  declares  that  a Maha-brahma, 
or  superior  to  all  gods,  is  always  found. 

Speaking  generally,  the  doctrine  divides  these  heavens  into  eight  regions,  called  llupa  Loka,  or 
heavens  of  superior  gods,  and  informs  us  that  “ Winyanaspandaya,  the  principle  that  lives,”  passes 
through  these  abodes,  until,  having  enjoyed  in  the  three  Brahma  Loka  heavens,  numbered  7 to  9, 
a foretaste  of  felicity  with  the  Maha-brahma,  it  enters  the  eight  heavens  Arupa,  10  to  17,  whence  it 
arrives  at  the  five  triumphing  heavens,  18  to  22,  so  named  from  their  auspicious  proximity  to  the  region 
of  final  bliss;  herein  terminating  their  “degrees  of  regeneration,”  and,  as  the  lofty  title  imports, 
enjoying  in  full  lustre  all  possible  joy,  it  at  length  enters  Nirwana , the  gift  and  property  of  the  llupa 
Loka  heavens,  23  to  26. 

The  tenets  of  Budhism  further  teach,  that  on  the  approach  of  a final  termination  of  the  calpe  by 
fire  or  flood,  the  last  Zian,  or  triumphing  heaven,*  becomes  a refuge  to  certain  portions  of  Nat  gods, 
and  other  beings,  who  are  there  saved  from  the  grand  catastrophe,  and  thus  form  the  germs  of  a 
future  world,  or,  as  it  is  termed,  “of  the  universe  again  arising  into  existence.”  This  most  essential 
portion  of  a system,  which  sets  out  with  excluding  a Creator  and  governor,  must  be  found  in  the  heavens 
A ham  n a-ch  ahha-ta  n a i,  Winnya-nankya-tanai , Akenjya-tanai , and  Newesanjya-tanai.  These  four  tanai 
form  the  Zian,  or  four  refuge  heavens  for  souls  of  Nirwana. 

In  this  remedial  tenet  of  Budhism,  which  provides  by  this  Zian  for  the  lack  of  a creative  god 
in  the  system,  may  likewise  be  noticed  the  correctness  of  denominating  the  system  a circle,  because  a 
participation  in  this  high  privilege  of  Zian,  or  preservation,  when  the  Sackwalle,  or  worlds,  are  destroyed, 
is  extended  only  to  the  Zian  of  the  four  Arupa  Loka,  called  also  the  Shoepu  Loka,  or  golden  heavens, 
and  a Zian  of  the  Asura  Loka  below  the  central  abyss.  Every  world  and  system  exhibited  in  the 

* A curious  passage  in  an  authentic  Budhist  manuscript  adverts  to  this  Zian,  in  the  Brahma  Loka,  as  follows: — “One  of  so  created 
worlds,  called  Magul  Sackwalle  is  this  world,  which  had  been  like  unto  a dark  dungeon  containing  nothing,  until  it  came  to  pass  that 
Brahmas  from  the  world  above,  called  Awkassana  Brahma  Loka,  which  had  nut  been  destroyed,  having  from  time  to  time  descended  and 
continued  to  inhabit  the  air,  through  the  power  of  flying,  lighted  on  the  earth,"  &c.  &c.  Awkassana  is  therefore  pointed  out  as  one  of 
the  Zians  surviving  the  great  catastrophe. 


THE  BRAHMA  LOKA  HEAVENS,  AND  NIRWANA.  ?- 

Sackwalle ; all  the  abodes  of  men,  genii,  Dewa,  and  Brahma  r nl-o  • i , 

Arupa  and  Asura  endure  throughout  the  catastrophe,  and  repeople  Arising  worlds^  ^ ^ 

The  Palee  doctrinal  books  speak  of  Nirwana  as  an  exemption  from  old  L f \ 
death  ; and  as  being  also  the  acquirement  of  all  bliss.  It  is  defined  to  be  “ s ’ '°m  ^ 

health,  wherein,  if  the  being,  so  benefited,  be  questioned  what  it  means,  one  can  ZwZ  v ",  ^ 

of  suffermg,  and  the  acqmrement  of  enjoyment  gathered  even  from  the  contrast,  ' Thus  Gaudma  ta uZ 
concerning  Nrrwana.  Agam,  to  quote  the  expressions  used  by  the  Budhists,  - Gaudma  is  the  only  Z 
and  pure  god,  who  knows  five  laws,  called  Zizza,  and  who  can  bestow  Nirwana,  The  bana,  or  sermons 
of  the  Budha,  declare  that  whoever  abstains  from  sila,  the  ten  sins,  in  all  successive  transmigrations  shall 
improve  m vrrtue,  until,  at  length,  he  becomes  worthy  of  beholding  a god,  and  of  hearing  his  m-eat  voice  and 
thus  he  will  obtam  Nirwana;  adding,  that  his  votaries,  so  acquiring  Nirwana,  shall  see  other  gods  or 
teachers,  ansmg  after  him  ; alluding  to  the  Maitri  Budha,  who,  after  the  expiration  of  the  five  thousand 
years,  allotted  to  Gaudma's  doctrine,  will  assume  the  direction  of  the  system.  Now,  all  these  expressions 
are  clearly  demonstrative  of  a continued  vitality  in  the  state  of  Nirwana.  Even  when  the  Budha  bestows 
Nirwana,  h.s  votary  hears  his  great  voice,  beholds  the  god,  and  accepts  a state,  which  enables  him  to  see 
the  succession  of  other  Budlias.  Such  is  the  clear  import  of  the  phrases  used,  which  cannot  leave  us  to 
doubt  of  the  system  possessing  an  ulterior  state  of  reward,  combined  with  positive  vitality.  It  should 
likewise  be  kept  steadily  in  view,  that  Budhist  doctrine  always  treats  life,  in  the  stage  of  human  existence, 
as  a state  of  suffering  and  misfortune ; regarding  it  as  a situation  of  painful  probation,  growing  out  of  its 
changes,  which  can  be  escaped  from  in  no  other  way  than  by  the  acquirement  of  the  unchangeable  state 
of  Nirwana.  Every  expression  of  illusion,  disappointment,  and  pain,  is  applied  to  life,  and  the  opposite 
epithets  of  unruffled  peace,  repose,  and  profound  tranquillity,  ascribed  to  the  envied  rewards  of  Nirwana ; 
expressions  carried  even  to  the  length  of  non-existence. 

The  Budlias  are  of  two  classes  ; the  Passi  Budlias,  who  are  those  followers  whose  devotedness  has 
spread  the  faith  and  doctrine  of  Gaudma  through  the  East,  and  become  renowned  in  the  sacred  books ; 
such  was  Sumada  Tapasaio,  for  whose  express  residence  a monastery  was  built  by  the  god  Sekkraia,  and 
who  was  born  in  the  heavens  of  glory,  that  is,  was  exalted  as  a Passi  Budha  to  one  of  four  heavens,  or 
Zian ; which,  according  to  their  respective  merits  and  dignities,  are  also  possessed  by  those,  who  have 
attained  to  these  highest  privileges  of  the  Budhist  heavens  from  the  priesthood  and  royal  ranks  There 
are  also  twenty-two  Laotouras  Budlias,  whose  histories  are  lost,  all  of  whom  are  in  Nirwana.  These  repose 
in  the  Mokse,  or  hall  of  glory,  which  Gaudma  declares  in  his  bana  to  be  situate  upon  the  top  of  the 
highest  of  the  twenty-six  heavens.  The  empyrean,  or  vivifying  ether,  is  described  as  the  giver  of  life 
to  souls,  the  bestower,  as  well  as  the  bon,  or  region,  of  Nirwana ; hence,  in  ancient  doctrine,  we  find  the 
heavens  apostrophised  as  an  active  agent.  In  conformity  with  this  view  of  the  Budhist  scheme,  the 
Chinese  worship  the  heavens,  not  generally  as  an  element,  but  the  bon,  or  Zian,  which  is  Nirwana,  and 
the  giver  of  it,  according  to  the  subtleties  of  Budhist  metaphysics.  The  motto  to  this  chapter  also  shows 
that  the  Arabians  had  a similar  idea  of  the  heavens.  No  portion  of  Budhism  is  more  misunderstood  than 
the  state  of  Nirwana,  for,  in  the  amplitude  of  imagery  used  in  the  doctrinal  books  to  exhibit  its  peace  and 
exemption  from  change,  and  to  depict  it  as  a contrast  to  the  rigours  and  penances  of  the  metempsychosis, 
the  actual  existence  or  vitality  of  the  state  seems  to  be  lost  sight  of  and  denied ; but  as  it  is  implied 
throughout  the  philosophy  of  the  metempsychosis,  our  view  would  be  very  imperfect  without  an  attempt 


7(> 


THE  BRAHMA  LOKA  HEAVENS,  AND  NIRWANA. 


to  clear  up  this  point.  The  philosophy  of  the  doctrine  seems,  amid  all  its  subtle  ratiocination,  to  abhor 
a vacuum,  as  in  all  the  gifts  flowing  from  the  Budha,  both  vitality  and  choice  are  implied,  so  it  may  hold 
well  enough  here  that  the  Budhas  themselves  are  doctrinally  considered  to  exist,  and  to  continue  to  act 
according  to  the  foregoing  expressions.  The  doctrine  of  the  heavens  infers  that  the  spiritual  influences 
are  constantly  flowing  down  from  the  heavenly  bodies;  that  the  air  (derived  from  the  empyrean)  is 
held  to  be  the  body,  or  medium,  that  conveys  them  down  to  the  earth  ; and  while  these  forms  flow 
continually  forth  from  the  ether,  or  empyrean,  the  abode  of  the  Budha,  he  alone  has  the  gift  of  Nirwana, 
which  is  the  ultimate  bliss  proposed  in  his  doctrine,  and  the  great  prize  sought  for,  through  life  and  in 
death,  by  his  followers. 

Although  it  would  appear  that  the  portion  of  the  Brahma  heavens,  also  of  the  Nirwana,  is  closely 
associated  with  the  prosperity  and  bliss  of  the  disciples  of  the  Budha,  yet,  as  the  doctrine  of  the 
metempsychosis  confines  itself  within  the  range  of  the  earth,  of  the  atmospheric  region  of  .Tugandere 
which  covers  it,  and  of  the  six  Dewa  Loka  heavens,  so  these  subjects  are  the  prototypes,  which  are 
carefully  copied  in  the  sacred  buildings,  and  in  the  palaces,  dress,  and  courtly  etiquette,  of  the  sovereigns 
who  follow  the  Budhist  faith.  The  sketches  of  the  gods  of  the  hills  and  of  the  Dewa  Loka,  however 
rude  in  design,  supply  many  subjects  of  coincidence  with  the  descriptive  sketches  of  their  doctrine,  while 
the  sixteen  regions  of  the  Brahma  gods  are  treated  with  an  oblivious  and  chilling  neglect. 


U 


sackwale. 


1 


CHAPTER  VII. 


the  sackwalle.— PLATE  XXI. 


“ fhe  heavenly  bod,eS  are  contmually  at  work  for  us,  by  their  perpetual  motion  emitting  a vital  heat,  which,  clothing  itself  with  an  aerial 
vest,  enters  into  the  chambers  of  the  deep,  and  there  forms  all  that  variety  which,  coming  forth,  we  call  the  works  of  nature." 


1 he  Budhist  doctrine  of  the  earth  and  the  celestial  system  is  marked  by  a total  ignorance  of  the  real 
structure  and  situation  of  these  bodies,  but,  as  its  votaries  strictly  adhere  to  the  conformation  which  is 
given  in  the  sacred  books,  it  becomes  necessary  to  explain  it  agreeably  to  the  diagram  which  represents 
their  ideas. 

Its  surface  is  that  of  an  inclined  plane,  in  the  centre  of  which  stands  the  centre  pillar  Maha-meru,  or 
Mienmo.  The  immense  bulk  of  Mount  Mienmo  is  sustained  on  three  rocks,  as  on  three  feet,  which  are 
carbuncles,  each  three  thousand  yodoons  in  height,  which  are  consolidated  to  the  sila-pathavy.* 

Mount  Mienmo,  therefore,  is  the  centre  elevation  of  the  inclined  plane  of  this  earth.  “This  king  of 
mountains  is  encircled  by  seven  chains  of  hills,  as  by  so  many  belts,  between  which  are  seven  rivers,  called 
Sida.  The  height  of  the  hill,  or  rock  belts,  and  the  depth  of  the  rivers,  decrease  as  they  recede  from 
Mount  Mienmo.  Thus  the  first,  or  highest  Jugandere,  is  in  height  eighty-four  thousand  yodoons ; the 
sea  of  the  same  depth : the  second,  or  Issedari,  forty-two  thousand ; the  sea  the  same ; and  so  on  in 
proportion. 

“ The  four  different  faces  of  the  Mount  Mienmo  communicate  their  respective  colours,  not  only  to 
the  seas  lying  opposite  to  them,  but  also  to  the  islands  and  their  inhabitants. 

“The  eastern  face  of  Mienmo  being  silver,  the  eastern  island  and  its  inhabitants,  its  trees  and  rivers, 
with  all  the  eastern  sea,  as  far  as  the  Tchiakrevatte,  or  outer  boundary  of  the  seven  rock  circles,  are  white 
like  milk.  The  west  of  Mienmo  and  all  the  islands  and  seas  on  that  side  are  green ; the  northern  are 
yellow  or  golden ; the  southern  a pale  carbuncle.” 

In  the  diagram  (plate  21),  the  centre  circle  is  the  space  occupied  by  Mienmo,  and  the  seven 
concentric  rings  are  the  supposed  chains  of  hills,  between  which  are  the  seas ; the  outer  circle  is  the 
Tchiakrevatte,  and  the  atmosphere,  the  region  of  the  Jugandere,  covers,  as  a vaulted  cope,  the  whole  of 
these  divisions.  This  leads  us  to  the  first  heaven,  the  path  of  the  sun,  the  moon,  and  the  planets,  in  the 
circle  of  the  zodiacal  signs.  The  subjoined  accountf  will  furnish  the  Budhist  idea  of  the  four  great 


* See  Asiatic  Researches,  i.  176- 
+ The  human  world  is  formed  into 


four  great  continents,  each  of  which  is  surrounded  by  five  hundred  islands;  one  standing  in 


78 


THE  SACICWALLE. 


continents,  as  marked  on  the  diagram  by  the  four  larger  lines  meeting  in  the  centre ; also  of  the  faces  of 
the  imagined  inhabitants. 

The  eastern  island,  Poorwavidaiha,  is  shaped  like  the  moon  in  her  quarters. 

The  western  island,  Upiru-godhana,  which  is  like  the  full  moon,  is  not  liable,  like  ours,  to  increase 
and  diminution,  but  always  lasts  for  five  hundred  years.  The  inhabitants  differ  from  us  in  height  and 
stature,  being  giants,  but  resemble  us  in  commerce,  agriculture,  and  arts. 

The  northern  island,  Oturookurodiwana,  is  square,  and.  has  peculiar  privileges.  The  inhabitants 
practise  neither  husbandry  nor  commerce,  the  tree  padza-zebayn  producing  vestments,  fruits,  rice, 
and  various  viands*  of  most  exquisite  flavour  on  its  leaves  and  branches.  When  the  repast  is  finished, 
the  remains  disappear  of  themselves ; and  such  is  its  nature,  that  it  extinguishes  all  sensation  of  hunger 
for  seven  days.  They  live  a thousand  years  without  suffering  or  sickness,  or  altering  from  the 
freshness  of  youth.f 

The  southern  island  is  the  abode  of  man,  and  the  conditions  and  states  of  man  are  bestowed  by 
Gaudma,  according  to  the  merit  or  demerit  of  men  in  a former  life;  but,  though  human  existence  as  a 
state  is  deemed  (for  reasons  hereafter  mentioned  when  the  metempsychosis  is  considered)  a state  of 
suffering,  yet  the  southern  island  is  regarded  as  by  far  the  most  desirable  bon , or  habitation,  even  beyond 
the  longevity  of  the  inhabitants  of  the  northern,  who  enjoy  a thousand  years  of  constant  happiness,  solely 
because  to  this  world  only  belongs  a Budha,  and  to  the  beings  of  this  world  the  power,  by  following  his 
precepts,  to  acquire  unchangeable  bliss  and  a perpetual  existence.  This  might  be  implied  by  the 
preference  given  to  it  over  the  northern  island;  for  if  annihilation,  or  non-existence,  followed  Nirwana  in 
the  southern  world,  the  ceasing  to  exist,  which  then  would  follow  the  term  of  life  of  a thousand  years  of 
bliss,  must  be  preferable  to  the  same  gift,  obtained  in  this  world,  after  an  afflictive  series  of  existences. 
It  is  therefore  evident  that  the  Nirwana  awarded  to  the  southern  world  is  a superior  gift  to  the  state  of 
non-existence,  the  portion  of  the  northern,  after  the  termination  of  their  one  thousand  years  of  happiness. 

Thus,  in  allusion  to  this  doctrine,  the  earth  is  called  the  ford  of  Nirwana,  and  that  one  gift  of 
Nirwana  exceeds  and  outweighs  all  other  privileges. 

the  eastern  direction,  called  Poorwavidaiha  ; one  in  the  western  direction,  called  Upiru-godhana  ; one  in  the  northern  direction,  called 
Oturookurodiwana  ; and  the  other  in  the  southern  direction,  called  Tumboodweepor,  where  we  live  ; in  which  the  whole  four  divisions  of 
the  world,  known  by  Europeans,  are  included.  The  three  former  are  between  eight  and  nine  thousand  yodoons  in  circumference,  and  the 
latter  alone  was  ten  thousand  yodoons  of  land;  till  three  thousand  thereof  being  destroyed  by  a flood,  it  is  now  reduced  to  seven 
thousand  yodoons  of  land. 

The  natives  of  these  four  great  divisions  can  have  no  correspondence  with  each  other,  on  account  of  the  great  distance  at  which 
they  are  placed,  and  their  features  are  said  to  differ  from  one  another ; the  faces  of  the  people  of  the  northern  world  are  round,  in  the 
southern  oval,  in  the  eastern  square,  and  in  the  western  triangular ; the  inhabitants  of  the  northern  are  the  happiest,  for  they  live  to  the 
age  of  a thousand  years.  They  worship  Budha,  and  are  never  in  want,  for  whatever  they  desire  is  presented  to  them  of  itself;  and  the 
others  also  have  their  respective  qualities ; yet  this  quarter,  wherein  we  live,  is  esteemed  to  be  the  holy,  for  the  Budha  is  always  born 
here  ; consequently,  this  is  the  only  place  to  procure  merit  by  good  deeds  for  future  happiness. 

* In  Aladdin,  we  see  the  supplies  of  the  padza-zebayn  wrought  into  Arabian  fiction. 

+ This  period  of  a thousand  years  alludes  to  the  great  festival  of  Sekkraia,  occurring  each  thousand  years,  described  in  the  Dewa 
Loka,  itself  a saturnalia  of  the  gods,  and  the  mysteries  of  the  Cabiri,  and  the  Dionysiac,  and  Bacchic  rites,  of  which  Alexander’s  feasting 
and  riotous  voyage  on  the  Indus  was  a cepy.  The  longevity  and  freshness  of  these  beings  remind  us  of  the  gifts  of  youth  in  Arabian  tales. 


THE  SACKWALLE. 


7B 


A BRIEF  ACCOUNT  OF  THE  RELIGION  OF  BUDHA,  AND  THE 
OF  THE  WORLDS  BY  PERIODICAL  SEASONS,  WITHOUT  A 


CREATION  AND  DISSOLUTION 
FINAL  BEGINNING  OR  END. 


The  universe  is  considered  to  be  unlimitedly  extensive,  and  to  contain  so  many  Saekwalles  * that 
if  one  of  them  were  filled  to  the  brim  with  mustard  seeds,  and  the  same  distributed  at  the  rate  of 
one  seed  to  a Sackwalle,  the  mustard  seeds  would  be  consumed  before  all  the  Saekwalles  should  be 
supplied  witli  the  same. 

Of  those  Saekwalles  our  world  is  reputed  to  be  the  happiest,  and  is  highly  esteemed  for  its 
producing  Budhas,  which  no  other  does,  and  consequently  it  has  a name  peculiar  to  itself,  Magul,  or 
happy  Sackwalle. 

It  is,  as  other  SackwaUes,  encircled  by  a rocky  wall,  3,610,350  yodoons  in  circumference,  arranging 
itself  with  distinct  worlds,  one  over  the  other,  at  a fixed  distance  of  42.000  yodoons,  beginning  from  the 
bottom  till  the  top,  viz. 

First  the  air,f  next  the  water,  and  then  the  earth  supported  thereon,  within  which  are  situated  the 
thirty-six  great,  and  one  hundred  and  twenty-eight  subordinate  hells,  and  the  world  of  Nagas,  or  the 
divine  snakes ; and  on  the  surface  of  the  earth  is  situated  the  human  world,  over  which  stand  the  six 
e v n of  the  Dewa  Xjoka  ^ods,  one  over  the  other.  Above  these  are  the  sixteen  heavens  of  Brahmas, 
after  the  same  manner.  Their  happiness,  age,  and  power,  are  greater  by  degrees  as  they  are  high  one 
over  the  other.  The  uppermost  heavens  of  Brahmas  are  indissoluble,  but  all  the  rest  are  dissolved  and 
created  by  themselves  at  every  periodical  season,  called  culpa ; a culpa  is  divided  into  fourteen  munoos, 
and  each  munoo  is  divided  into  two  hundred  and  eighty-four  yoogas,  of  which  the  present  yooga,  called 
cali-yooga,  is  the  one  hundred  and  twelfth  yooga  of  the  munoo  wywaswatte,  in  the  culpa  swaita 
waraha ; which  yooga  is  computed  at  432, 000^  years,  and  again  there  is  a quarterly  dissolution  to  which 
the  human  world  alone  is  subjected. 

Budha  is  so  rare  that  numerous  culpas  often  pass  without  blessing  the  world  with  a Budha,  but  this 
present  culpa,  luckily  producing  five  Budhas  (of  whom  four  are  past  and  one  is  expected),  is  styled 
Maha  Budha-culpa. 


• A set  of  all  kinds  of  worlds  situated  one  over  the  other,  within  a circular  rocky  wall,  called  Chakrawarty. 

t The  universe,  called  Loga  Loka,  after  it  has  been  destroyed  by  fire,  water,  or  wind,  is  again  of  itself  restored  to  its  ancient  form  ; 
which  is  not  supposed  to  be  spherical,  but  a circular  plane,  elevated  somewhat  in  the  centre.  This  earth  is  entirely  surrounded  by  a 
chain  of  rock,  called  Tchiakrevatte,  from  the  surface  of  the  sea ; this  rock  extends  each  way  up  and  down  82,000  juzana.  The  earth's 
diameter  is  1,203,400  juzana,  its  circumference  is  three  times  its  diameter;  and  its  thickness  240,000  juzana ; the  half  of  this  depth  is 
dust,  the  lower  half  a solid  compact  rock,  called  sila-pathavy.  This  immense  body  of  dust  and  rock  is  sustained  by  a double  thickness 
of  water,  and  that  again  by  twice  its  thickness  of  air,  below  which  is  supposed  a vacuum.  Besides  this  earth  of  ours  there  are,  of  the 
same  form,  10,100,000  others,  whicli  mutually  touch  in  three  points,  forming  between  them  a similar  number  of  equilateral  spaces,  which, 
on  account  of  the  sun's  rays  not  reaching  them,  are  filled  with  water  intensely  cold. — Asiatic  Researches,  vi.  175. 

+ The  following  numbers  instance  their  application  in  the  Budhist  scheme  to  their  doctrine  as  well  as  philosophy  ; the  assankayu  is 
described  by  04  ciphers,  for  if  this  number  04  be  used  to  divide  a maha-kalpe,  00,211,200,000,  the  quotient  is  940,800,000,  which  can 
be  equally  divided  by  04,  by  4,  by  80,  and  by  32,  all  remarkable  numbers  in  the  mysterious  calculations  of  the  Budhists.  If  the  numbers 
of  antakalpas,  80,  be  multiplied  by  the  number  of  Budhas,  5,  it  will  give  400 ; and  if  04,  the  number  of  ciphers  in  an  assankaya,  be 
multiplied  by  5,  it  will  give  320 ; these  two  numbers  added  together,  make  the  quotient  of  432,000,  divided  by  000,  a period  famous  as 
the  great  Saros  among  the  Chaldeans  as  well  as  the  Indians;  432,000  representing  the  cali  of  the  Bramius.  It  is  certainly  not  enough 
that  this  number  should  be  produced  by  means  of  certain  divisions  and  multiplications,  but  it  might  be  proved  that  these  numbers  are 


80 


THE  SACKWALLE. 


When  the  days  of  a culpa  are  completed,  and  the  rain  ceased,  six  more  suns  will  be  added  to  the 
present,  making  seven  suns  altogether ; they  will  alternately  rise  and  set  without  making  distinction  of 
night,  and  shine  with  such  mighty  heat,  till  they  have  consumed  to  ashes  the  whole  universe,  including 
even  the  great  rock  Maha-meru ; when  that  is  done  the  whole  of  the  universe  will  be  inundated,  and 
in  time  become  icy,  and  so  remain. 

When  the  Brahmas  of  the  saved  heavens  see  this  ice,  many  of  them  have  a desire  to  walk  upon  and 
taste  it;  and  so  continuing  for  some  length  of  time,  walking  on  and  tasting  it,  they  are  transformed  to 
males  and  females,  and  then  the  carnal  desire  is  created  in  them,  and  from  that  moment  they  cease  to  be 
Brahmas,  and  remain  upon  the  same  in  pairs,  without  being  able  to  go  back  to  their  heavens*  They 
are,  nevertheless,  well  contented  with  their  situation,  and  the  ice  proves  to  them  delicate  food,  having  a 
heavenly  taste.  They  need  not  the  light  of  a sun,  for  the  illumination  of  their  own  bodies  gives 
them  ample  light. 

This  is  the  origin  of  the  human  world,  but  in  time  the  illumination  of  their  own  bodies  subsiding, 
the  necessity  of  a sun  was  felt,  which  was  accordingly  formed,  as  well  as  a moon ; thus  the  divine  nature 
retained  by  them  being  diminished,  and  the  ice  consumed,  the  earth  proved  to  be  excellent  food,  having 
a delicate  savour ; next  to  which  they  lived  upon  a certain  creeping  plantf  produced  by  the  earth,  and 
then  mushrooms ; so  by  degrees  they  lost  all  their  miraculous  and  delicate  food,  the  brightness  of  their 
bodies,  and  the  great  age  they  were  possessed  of,  and  other  such  things.  They  were  then  necessitated 
to  build  houses  for  their  shelter,  and  to  labour  for  their  subsistence  ; their  work,  however,  was  light  and 
easy  at  first,  as  the  planting  of  one  single  grain  of  suyanjata-ell  (a  kind  of  heavenly  grain  without  husk) 
produced  a harvest  of  such  abundance,  that  many  families  might  be  supported  by  it  for  a year. 


particularly  marked  in  tlieir  religion.  The  number  5 stands  for  the  five  Budhas,  of  whom  one  is  to  come  ; the  number  4 stands  for  the 
four  Budhas  who  already  have  appeared,  and  also  the  four  assankayas  of  the  transmigrations  of  Gaudma,  the  fourth  Budha ; 80  is  the 
number  of  years  of  the  last  life  of  the  same  Budha ; for,  according  to  the  most  authentic  works,  he  was 


Koomara,  Prince,  . 

Years. 

. 16 

King  .... 

. 13 

Ascetic  .... 

. 6 

Budha  .... 

. 45 

80 

32  represents  his  great  qualities  as  well  as  his  middling  ones,  which,  added  together,  amount  to  04,  the  number  of  ciphers  of  the 
assankaya.  In  short,  the  4 assankayas , 100,000  maha-kalpas,  and  32  great  qualities  of  the  Budha,  compose  mystically,  if  not 
arithmetically,  the  cali  of  the  Bramins,  of  432,000  years.  Having  lost  their  astronomical  books,  they  have  attempted,  by  a series  of 
forced  unintelligible  calculations,  to  produce  the  numbers  resulting  from  the  astronomical  experiments  of  their  system,  as  they  themselves 
have  preserved  nothing  of  the  science  excepting  the  numbers. 

In  the  Sonnets  of  Petrarch,  by  the  late  Lord  Charlemont,  note  20  to  sonnet  120,  his  lordship  gives  the  following  account  of  the 
sentiments  of  this  celebrated  poet,  which  exhibits  a fac-simile  agreement  with  these  Budhist  extracts ; it  will  likewise  be  seen,  in  the 
progress  of  this  work,  that  Dante  has  similarly  used  the  descriptive  imagery  of  the  places  of  torment  in  his  Inferno . “ The  Platonic 

philosophy  was  fashionable  in  the  days  of  Petrarch,  and  breathes  its  spirit  of  obscure  refinement  through  all  his  writings.  This  philosophy 
taught  that  human  souls  were  originally  created  equal  in  number  with  the  stars,  and  were  distributed  through  the  expanse  of  heaven, 
each  one  adapted  and  appropriated  to  its  peculiar  star,  where  they  existed  in  the  enjoyment  of  happiness,  and  the  blissful  contemplation 
of  the  divine  essence.  It  sometimes,  however,  happened,  as  a disease  incident  to  these  spirits,  that  some  of  them  were  fired  with  a 
longing  desire  for  earthly  habitations ; upon  which  they  were  immediately  degraded  from  their  high  station,  and  sent  down  to  animate 
mortal  bodies,  through  a succession  of  which  they  transmigrated,  until  this  criminal  desire  became  purged  away.”  “ Petrarch  here,”  says 
the  commentator,  “ alludes  to  this  opinion,  and  asks  in  what  particular  part  of  the  heavens  did  the  pre-existent  spirit  of  Laura  reside  ?” 

+ Probably  the  kusatana,  or  creeping  grass,  the  grains  of  which  were  eaten  by  Gaudma,  the  instant  before  his  assumption  of  the 
Budhaship. 


THE  SACKWALLE. 


81 


13y  the  diminution  of  the  happiness  of  the  human  world,  and  the  gradual  increase  of  wickedness, 
mankind  found  the  necessity  of  a ruler  being  elected,  and  accordingly  an  immense  concourse  of 
people  assembling  together,  one  among  them  was  appointed  to  be  their  king ; he  became  immediately 
a mighty  monarch,  and,  as  he  was  elected  by  the  universal  consent  of  the  people,  he  was  called  Malta - 
sammata,  and  is  the  first  king  of  the  human  world  in  this  culpa,  who  reigned  many  thousands  of  years. 
His  posterity,  as  well  as  the  posterity  of  the  whole  human  race,  losing  their  might,  age,  happiness,  &c. 
have  been  by  degrees  brought  to  their  present  state ; and  by  their  future  increase  of  sins,  this 
deterioration  will  go  on  until  the  world  shall  be  reduced  to  an  extremely  mean  state,  when  men  shall 
live  no  longer  than  ten  years,  and  their  stature  be  reduced  to  a very  diminutive  size  ; when  a quarterly 
dissolution  will  take  place,  by  which  almost  all  the  animals  will  perish,  excepting  those  that  will  take 
shelter  under  the  rocks  and  in  caves,  without  being  wetted  even  by  a single  drop  of  that  dreadfully 
destructive  element,  which  will  continually  fall  in  torrents  for  seven  days,  each  drop  of  the  size  of 
neper  a and  palmeira  trees,  according  to  a previous  notice  given  by  a JDeweta .*  Such  as  are  wetted  even 
by  a single  drop  of  this  rain  shall  appear  to  each  other  as  tigers  and  bears,  and  whatever  they  handle  shall 
become  destructive  weapons  : so  they  will  assault  each  other  till  they  all  perish. 

They  that  are  saved  under  the  rocks  and  in  caves,  on  coming  forth  after  the  devastation,  shall  see 
this  awful  destruction  of  the  world,  and  shall  be  greatly  amended  themselves,  and  renounce  one  sin, 
forbidden  by  one  of  the  five  commandments  of  the  Budha  ; their  children  shall  renounce  two  sins ; their 
grandchildren  three  sins,  and  so  on.  Their  longevity,  size,  and  the  productions  of  the  soil,  shall  increase 
by  degrees,  and  the  world  shall  be  totally  free  from  sin  and  wickedness  till  its  inhabitants  increase  so 
much  in  age  and  happiness  as  to  think  themselves  immortal,  and  then  they  will  relapse  by  degrees 
into  depravity. 

Except  the  worlds,  &c.,  which  are  dissolved  and  created  by  themselves  by  periodical  seasons, 
without  any  final  beginning  or  end,  all  living  things  depend  on  two  principles,  koosula-lcarma  and 
alcoosula-learmay  or  the  merits  of  good  deeds  and  bad  deefds.  A man  by  the  merits  of  his  good  deeds 
may  be  born  a god,  and  for  bad  deeds  an  ant ; and  this  is  the  case  with  all  living  things,  including 
gods,  &c.  The  heaven  is  not  to  yield  its  happiness  for  ever  to  any  being,  nor  the  hell  its  misery,  but 
only  so  long  as  their  good  or  evil  deeds  deserve.  Thus  the  souls  of  all  living  things,  in  every  Sackwalle, 


'*  There  are  three  remote  causes  for  the  destruction  of  the  world,  luxury,  anger,  and  ignorance ; from  these,  by  the  power  of  fate, 
arise  the  physical  or  proximate  causes,  namely,  fire,  water,  and  wind.  The  first  two  causes  have  been  described,  the  third,  by  wind, 
seems  to  be  the  most  universal  and  overwhelming ; the  writings  relate  that  a thousand  years  before  such  event,  a certain  Nat  descends 
to  this  island  ; his  hair  is  dishevelled,  his  countenance  mournful,  and  his  garments  black  ; he  passes  every  where  through  the  public  ways 
and  streets,  with  doleful  voice  announcing  the  approaching  disaster.  In  the  same  manner  as  the  fowls  of  heaven,  and  the  fish  of  the  sea, 
by  a certain  natural  instinct,  have  a foreboding  of  storms,  so  the  Nat  perceive  the  approach  of  a world's  destruction. 

When  the  world  is  destroyed  by  wind,  the  Nat  having  finished  his  warnings,  a fine  rain  falls,  but  it  is  the  last  rain  during  that  world. 
The  wind  begins  to  blow,  and  gradually  increases ; at  first  it  only  raises  sand  and  small  stones,  but  at  length  it  whirls  about  immense 
rocks,  and  the  summits  of  mountains ; then  shaking  the  whole  earth,  it  dissipates  this  and  the  others,  with  all  the  habitations  of  the  Nat, 
Rupa,  and  Arupa,  and  scatters  them  through  the  immense  extent  of  the  skies. — Asiatic  Researches,  vi.  242,  244. 

Each  world  has  sixty-four  periods  before  the  grand  or  final  cataclysm  ; out  of  sixty-four  times,  it  is  fifty-six  times  destroyed  by  fire, 
seven  times  by  water,  and  once  only  by  wind.  The  world  which  immediately  preceded  this  was  destroyed  by  fire. 

Thus  it  appears  that,  in  the  great  final  catastrophe  of  wind,  the  whole  universe  is  dashed  in  pieces,  and  scattered  throughout  the 
extent  of  space.  This,  therefore,  being  the  most  dreaded  of  all  misfortunes,  is  the  very  catastrophe  alluded  to  by  the  Celtic  inhabitants  of 
the  countries  bordering  the  Danube.  When  Alexander  inquired  of  them  what  they  most  feared?  their  reply  was,  that  the  heavens 
would  fall  on  their  heads.” — See  Arrian's  Account,  also  Strabo. 

M 


82 


THE  SACKWALLE. 


are  liable  to  removal  from  one  body  to  another,  according  to  their  respective  merits.  Men  after  death 
may  be  born  again  as  any  kind  of  animals,  gods,  men,  devils,  &c.,  and  even  so  the  beasts  or  other  beings 
may  exist  again  as  men  or  gods  according  to  their  deserts. 

Budha  enacted  three  degrees  of  doctrine  in  84,000  sections,  one  concerning  gods,  the  second  the 
clergy,  and  the  third  the  laity.  Besides  numerous  precepts  which  he  enacted  for  the  observation  of  the 
priests  of  the  highest  and  higher  orders,  there  are  ten  commandments,  five  of  which  are  to  be  observed 
by  the  common  disciples,  eight  by  the  opasekas,  or  holy  priests,  and  the  whole  (ten)  by  the  Sameneras,* 
or  the  priests  of  the  lowest  quality,  viz. 


TABLE  I. 

1.  Thou  shalt  not  kill. 

2.  Thou  shalt  not  steal. 

3.  Thou  shalt  not  commit  fornication. 

4.  Thou  shalt  not  say  any  manner  of  falsehood. 

5.  Thou  shalt  not  drink  any  intoxicating  liquor. 

TABLE  II. 

In  this,  four  of  the  five  commandments  are  the  same  as  in  the  first  table,  the  third  commandment 
only  being  altered  ; for  after  thou  shalt  not  commit  fornication,  this  adds  nor  even  admit  a lustful  desire, 
nor  suffer  the  touch  of  a woman,  and  then  come  the  three  following. 

6.  Thou  shalt  not  eat  at  an  unpermitted  hour. 

7.  Thou  shalt  abstain  from  dancing,  singing,  and  playing  music,  nor  shalt  thou  see  them. 

8.  Thou  shalt  not  use  high  and  great  seats. 

% 

TABLE  III. 

The  eight  foregoing. 

9.  Thou  shalt  abstain  from  the  use  of  flowers  and  perfumes  of  all  sorts. 

10.  Thou  shalt  not  receive,  use,  or  touch  gold,  silver,  and  coins  of  metal,  or  any  other  kind. 

The  five  first  commandments  are  called  Prawnaghata,  Adattie-duna , Kamamettya-chara , Moosa- 
tvada,  and  Soora-mcryue ; in.  case  any  of  these  offences  have  been  committed  accidentally,  or  any  way 
else,  without  having  accomplished  their  respective  qualities,  they  cannot  have  amounted  to  full  crimes, 
consequently  not  arisen  from  a purpose  of  sinning. 

I.  Prawnaghata  has  five  qualities. 

1.  A being  or  an  animal. 

2.  The  knowledge  that  it  is  so. 

3.  The  desire  of  killing  it. 

4.  Projecting  means  how  to  kill  it. 

5.  The  act  of  killing  it. 


• Samanean  Bramina. 


THE  SACKWALLE. 


83 


* II.  Adattie-duna  has  four  qualities. 

1.  The  knowledge  that  the  property  belongs  to  others. 

2.  The  desire  of  stealing. 

3.  Projecting  means  to  steal. 

4.  Committing  the  theft. 

III.  Kamamettya-chara  has  four  qualities. 

1.  Any  woman  who  is  not  a man’s  own  wife,  or  any  man  who  is  not  a^woman’s  own  husband. 

2.  The  lustful  desire  in  man  or  woman. 

3.  The  project  used  to  commit  jt. 

4.  The  act  of  committing  it. 

IV.  Moosawada  has  three  qualities. 

1.  The  knowledge  of  its  being  a falsehood. 

2.  The  saying  it. 

3.  Making  the  hearer  believe  it. 

V.  Soora-meryue  has  three  qualities. 

1.  The  knowledge  that  it  is  a spirituous  liquor. 

2.  The  drinking  it. 

3.  Experiencing  its  intoxicating  effect. 

There  are  ten  sins,  three  of  which  are  committed  by  deeds,  four  by  words,  and  three  by  mind,  viz 
Three  by  deeds  are,  killing,  stealing,  and  debauching. 

Four  by  words  are,  lying,  backbiting,  talking  to  hurt  another’s  feelings,  and  idle  talk. 

Three  by  mind  are,  covetousness,  envy,  and  false  belief. 


Q 


CHAPTER  VIII. 


THE  CHAKKRAIA,  AND  THE  FOUR  ZODIACS.— PLATES  IX.,  X.,  XI.,  AND  XII. 


“ When  the  souls  of  the  hero  gods  quitted  their  mortal  tenements,  they  migrated  into  the  sun,  or  the  moon,  or  the  planets,  or  the 
constellations,  and  from  those  lofty  abodes  they  still,  as  Zopha  Samin,  or  celestial  speculators,  beheld  and  regulated  the  affairs  of  the 
lower  world. — Faber,  iii.  351. 


To  the  first  Dctva  Loka,  the  heaven  Tjaturum-maharakeye,  belong  the  sun,  moon,  and  stars,  which  are 
as  well  the  palaces  of  the  gods,  as  the  dividers  of  day  from  night,  and  of  the  seasons  ; also  the  movers  of 
good  or  evil  fortune  to  men.  This  region  extends  in  height  from  the  summit  of  Jugandere  to  the  top  of 
the  Mienmo  stone  or,  rather,  pillar.  It  also  covers  all  the  space  from  the  centre  Mienmo  stone  to  the 
Chakkre-vatti,  or  seventh  and  outermost  rock  circle;  thus  forming  the  covering  or  atmosphere  of  the 
seven  rock  circles,  and  their  seas,  and  the  four  great  islands  or  worlds,  of  which  our  planet,  the  earth,  is 
the  southernmost,  in  fact,  of  the  whole  system  of  the  Saekwalle. 

There  are  eight  planets,  which  will  hereafter  be  described  with  their  properties.  It  will  be  seen,  by 
a reference  to  the  plate  of  the  Saekwalle,  that  the  sun,  moon,  and  planetary  system,  revolve  round  the 
Mienmo  mount,  or  pillar,  and  that  the  earth  also  performs  this  movement.  The  stars  are  supposed  to  be 
constant  in  their  motion,  neither  declining  to  the  north  nor  to  the  south  ; but  the  sun,  moon,  and  planets, 
the  Budhists  conceive,  as  we  do,  to  have  a declination.  The  sun,  in  his  progress,  visits  the  twelve 
constellations,  or  twelve  zodiacal  signs,  and  in  the  space  of  a year  returns  to  the  same  place  in  the  heavens 
from  which  he  set  out.  This  same  revolution,  which  by  the  sun  is  performed  in  one  year,  is  performed  by 
the  moon  in  one  month.  There  are  three  seasons,  the  hot,  the  rainy,  and  the  cold  ; and  in  order  to 
distinguish  these  seasons,  there  are  three  roads  in  heaven,  an  inner,  a middle,  and  an  outer  road. 
The  inner  road  is  nearest  to  Mienmo,  and  when  the  sun  enters  it,  the  rainy  season  commences ; 
and  when  he  enters  the  outer  road,  the  cold  begins.  By  these  three  roads,  which  are  distant  from  each 
other  thirty-nine  thousand  and  ninety-three  juzana,  that  immense  space  between  Mienmo  and  the  Chakkre- 
vatti,  or  seventh  circle  of  rock,  is  divided  into  four  great  zones  ; the  inner  road  corresponds  with  our 
summer  solstice,  or  the  tropic  of  Cancer ; the  middle  with  our  equinox,  or  the  equator ; and  the  outer 
with  our  winter  solstice,  or  the  tropic  of  Capricorn.  Besides  these  three  roads,  there  are  three  paths,  one 
above  another,  which  supply  the  region  for  the  sun’s  progress,  when  nearer  to  or  further  from  the  earth. 
The  highest  of  these  paths,  and  the  most  remote  from  us,  is  that  of  the  elephant.  When  the  sun  visits 
this  path  we  experience  heavy  rain  and  great  cold ; this  path  is  therefore  named  after  the  elephant, 
which  frequents  cool  and  moist  places. 


THE  CHAKKRAIA,  AND  THE  FOUR  ZODIACS. 


85 


For  the  production  of  rain,  however,  seven  causes  are  assigned,  partly  physical,  and  partly  moral. 

1.  The  power  of  the  Nagas,  or  serpents. 

2.  The  power  of  Galoun,  or  large  birds. 

3.  The  power  Sissa,  signifying  the  moral  obedience  of  men. 

4.  Sila,  or  obedience  to  the  Budha. 

5.  1 lie  power  of  holy  men.  These  are  anchorets,  mentioned  as  residing  on  Hemavunta,  near  the 
abode  of  the  king  of  the  elephants. 

6.  The  condensation  of  the  clouds. 

7.  Certain  Nat  who  preside  over  showers,  and  who  occasion  rain  whenever  they  go  out  of  their 
houses  to  sport  in  the  air. 

When  the  sun  is  in  the  path  of  the  goat,  these  Nat  do  not  come  forth  on  account  of  the  great  heat, 
so  that  there  is  then  no  rain.  For  this  reason,  in  times  of  drought,  the  Birmans  assemble  with  a drum  and 
a long  cable.  Dividing  themselves  into  two  parties,  with  a vast  shouting  and  noise,  they  drag  the  cable 
contrariwise,  the  one  party  endeavouring  to  get  the  better  of  the  other ; and  they  think,  by  these  means, 
to  invite  the  Nat  to  come  out  of  their  houses,  and  to  sport  in  the  air.  The  thunder  and  lightning,  often 
preceding  rain,  are  the  clashing  and  shining  of  the  arms  of  these  Nat  in  thpir  mock-fights.  As  they 
acknowledge  Nats  presiding  over  rain,  so  there  are  others  governing  the  winds  and  the  clouds. — See 


Asiatic  Researches , vi.  194. 

The  middle  is  the  path  of  the  ox.  When  men  act  with  rectitude,  and  obey  the  Budha  laws,  the 
sun  moves  in  this  path,  which  is  highly  salutary  ; but  when  they  violate  the  laws,  the  sun  moves  either 
in  the  upper  or  the  lower  path,  with  much  injury  both  to  the  produce  of  the  earth  and  the  health  ot  the 
people.  The  lowest  is  the  path  of  the  goat,  because  that  animal  delights  in  dry  and  warm  places  ; when 
the  sun  therefore  is  in  the  goat’s  path,  it  produces  great  heat  and  drought  on  the  earth. 

The  sun’s  motion  is  quicker  than  that  of  the  moon,  for,  when  he  moves  in  the  Mienmo,  he  advances 
one  million  juzana  daily  ; in  the  middle  road  two,  and  in  £he  outer  three  million  juzana. 

From  these  particulars  may  be  inferred  how  imperfect  and  crude  are  the  Budhist  principles  of  the 
science  of  astronomy ; but  another  reason  may  be  alleged  for  the  very  erroneous  perceptions,  which  it 
exhibits  throughout  every  part  of  its  arrangement,  namely,  that  as  the  very  prosperity  and  wealth  of  the 
natural  world,  the  fertility  of  its  harvests,  the  duration  of  the  universe,  the  physical  state  of  man,  his 
duration  of  life,  and  even  his  stature,  are  influenced  and  acted  upon  by  the  moral  character  of  the  disciples 
of  the  Budha,  so  also  is  the  progress  of  the  planetary  bodies  through  the  heavens,  as  well  as  the  phenomena 
of  the  seasons,  made  to  sustain  the  same  doctrine,  and  to  move  and  act  conformably  to  the  obedience  paid 
by  the  Budha’s  followers  to  his  doctrine  and  example.  In  the  rules  laid  down  by  the  teachers  of  this 
faith,  every  possible  influence,  that  can  be  strained  to  bear  upon  the  influence  and  authority  of  the  Budha, 
is  most  rigidly  enforced. 

A proof  of  their  strict  adherence  to  this  system  is  supplied  by  the  testimony  of  one  ol  the  most 
enlightened  of  the  Budhist  priests  in  the  island  of  Ceylon,  the  orthodoxy  of  whose  opinions  on  any 
portion  of  the  doctrine  would  be  implicitly  acknowledged.  Upon  a remark  being  made  on  the 
imperfection  of  their  astronomic  data,  he  (the  high-priest,  Karetotte  (Enanse)  replied:— “It  is  not 
permitted  to  deviate  the  breadth  of  a hand  from  what  the  great  Budha,  in  his  bana,  has  revealed  : and, 
especially,  not  from  his  system,  that  the  whole  world  is  divided  into  four  parts,  and  that  the  one  part 
which  we  inhabit,  called  Damba-dewa,  contains  Europe,  Asia,  Africa,  and  America,  while  the  other  three 


THE  CHAKKRAIA,  AND  THE  FOUR  ZODIACS. 


8(5 

parts,  called  Pierwewedeeseye,  Oetoeroe,  Koeroedewa-inne,  and  Apperegodanaye,  are  unknown  ; that  the 
earth,  with*  all  the  surrounding  waters,  is  a flat  surface,  and  that  the  sun  has  its  horizontal  course  over  our 
heads.”  This  accords  precisely  with  the  delineation  given  in  the  Sackwalle  plates.  His  inode  of 
accounting  for  the  course  of  the  sun  is  given  in  his  own  words,  as  follows : — “ The  earth,  with  all  the 
surrounding  waters,  is  of  a flat  form  ; the  sun,  as  aforesaid,  has  its  horizontal  course  over  our  heads,  and 
appears  at  six  o’clock  in  the  morning,  from  that  part  of  the  world  which  we  call  Apperegodanaye ; and 
it  runs  so  over  Damba-dewa , as  far  as  the  end  of  this  part  of  the  world,  when  it  is  twelve  o’clock  at  noon  ; 
and  afterwards,  till  six  o’clock  in  the  evening,  it  advances  as  far  as  the  end  of  the  part,  situated  at  the 
left,  or  west  side,  called  Pierwewedeeseye.  So  that,  at  Pierwewedeeseye,  it  is  then  six  o’clock  in  the 
morning,  when,  at  Damba-dewa , it  is  twelve  o’clock  at  noon ; and  afterwards,  twelve  o’clock  at  noon, 
when  the  sun  sets  in  the  horizon  of  Damba-dewa ; and  the  sun  thus  follows  its  course  in  that  way 
until  the  next  morning  at  six  o’clock,  when  naturally  it  ought  to  be  twelve  o’clock  at  noon,  at 
A pperegodanaye." 

The  same  personage  promised  to  furnish  the  model  of  a Sackwalle,  in  relief,  in  clay,  upon  some 
planks,  but  afterwards  evaded  this  promise  in  a way  that  betrayed  a wish  to  escape  from  it.  His  plan 
was  as  follows : — “ To  make  a shape  of  wood,  resembling  a pointed  sugar-loaf,  for  the  large  rock 
Maha-meru.  Parkwette,  with  rocks  surrounding  it  like  hoops,  and  the  waters  or  seas  running  between  ; 
and  then  separate  into  four  the  great  machine,  or  the  said  rocks,  the  height,  breadth,  and  thickness,  whereof 
are  calculated  at  thousands  of  miles ; as  well  as  the  waters,  which  are  said  to  be  thousands  of  times  more 
extensive  than  our  greatest  ocean.  The  parts  of  the  circular  rocks,  standing  above  the  waters,  are  but 
half  of  the  whole  body,  the  other  half  of  the  same  shape,  form,  and  size,  lying  under  the  water  with  the  tops 
downwards .”  His  model  is  precisely  conformable  to  the  Sackwalle  plates,  which  are  inserted  in  the 
Calcutta  edition  of  the  Asiatic  Researches,  vii.  446. 


THE  SINGALESE  YEAR. 

The  commencement  of  the  Singalese  year  is  calculated  from  the  time  that  the  sun  enters  the  sign 
Aries,  and  the  day  that  the  sun  enters  each  sign  is  the  beginning  of  each  month.  These  are  called  solar 
months  ; there  are  no  more  than  twelve  of  them ; but  the  Singalese  have  another  sort,  called  lunar 
months,  which  they  calculate  from  one  new  moon  to  another.  Every  four  or  five  years  there  is  a year 
of  thirteen  solar  months,  the  last  of  which  they  call  the  superfluous  or  intercalary  month. 


The  names  of  the  solar  months  are  : — 

Meesa, 

Warsaba, 

Metoona, 

Cattaka, 

Sinha, 

Cunny, 

Toola, 

Warchika, 

Dahnoo, 

Makar  a, 

Cumba, 

Mena. 

These  are  marked  on  the  plates  of  the  zodiacs. 


And  those  of  the  lunar  months  are  : — 
Bak, 

Wasak, 

Poson, 

Esfala, 

Nikiny, 

Benara, 

Was, 

111, 

Undoowak, 

Doorooloo, 

Nawan, 

Madindina. 


THE  CHAKKRAI A,  AND  THE  FOUR  ZODIACS. 


87 


The  names  of  the  days  of  the  week  in  high  Singalese  are 
Rawe, 

Chandra, 

Cooja, 

Bmlha, 

Sooroo, 

Soockra, 

Sany. 


In  common  Singalese  they  are  : — 
Erida, 

Hamlooda, 

Angaharoowada, 

Budaha, 

Booraha  patinda, 

Sicooradah, 

Sanasooradali. 


The  Birman  writings  mention  eight  planets,  namely,  the  sun,  the  moon,  Mercury,  Venus,  Mars, 
Jupiter,  Saturn,  and  another,  named  Raliu,  which  is  invisible.  Deplorably  defective  as  are  the  schemes 
exhibited  in  the  Budhist  writings,  of  the  systems  of  the  universe,  and  absurd  as  are  the  dreams  whereon 
they  delight  to  dwell  in  all  their  practices  and  festivals,  there  is  reason  to  think  that,  formerly  (alluding 
to  the  influences  of  heavenly  agents),  they  were  much  better  acquainted  with  that  system.  They  have 
the  six  planets  known  to  the  ancients,  and  corresponding  with  the  same  number  admitted  by  us,  and  also 
a seventh,  and  even  an  eighth.  They  divide  the  zodiac  into  twelve  signs,  of  which  only  four  differ,  and 
that  but  slightly,  from  those  of  modern  astronomy.  Thus: — 

Gemini,  is  a husband  or  wife  ; Sagittarius,  a bow ; Capricorn,  a deer  ; Aquarius,  a waterpot. 

Dr.  Buchanan  remarks,  that  from  the  Budhists  having  enriched  their  sphere  with  an  eighth  planet, 
an  admirer  of  Oriental  literature  would  here  discover  the  Georgium  Sidus,  and  strip  the  industrious 
Herschell  of  his  recent  honours ; but  it  seems  more  resembling  an  astrological  sign,  growing  out  of  some 
fable  connected  with  a lunar  festival,  and  a desire  to  account  imperfectly  for  the  appearance  of  the  moon 
in  an  eclipse. 

The  Abb£  Dubois,  in  his  translation  of  the  Panchatantra,  or  fables  of  Vishnu-karma,  has  the 
following  tale  of  the  sun,  the  moon,  and  the  two  giants,  their  enemies. 

“ In  former  times,  when  the  gods  and  the  giants  joined  together  to  churn  the  ocean,  and  to  extract 
the  amrita  drink  which  confers  immortality,  two  giants,  enemies  of  the  gods,  mingled  with  the  assemblage 
by  a stratagem,  so  as  to  be  unperceived  by  any  one,  and  also  drank  of  the  amrita,  which  rendered  them 
immortal.  The  sun  and  the  moon  having  discerned  them,  gave  notice  of  it  to  the  preserver  god,  \ ishnu. 
Irritated  at  the  deceptive  intrusion  of  these  rebels,  and  at  their  fraud,  he  endeavoured  to  destroy  them  by 
means  of  his  terrible  chakkra ; but  the  attempt  proved  fruitless,  as  the  amrita,  which  they  had  drunk, 
made  them  immortal.  Vishnu,  therefore,  in  some  way  to  punish  them,  changed  them  into  two  planets, 
and  these  two  giants  were  thus  transformed,  the  one  into  the  planet  Raliu,  and  the  other  into  the  planet 
Ketu.  From  that  time  they  have  maintained  an  implacable  hatred  against  the  sun  and  the  moon,  the 
authors  of  their  disgrace  ; and,  although  far  inferior  to  these  planets,  they  never  cease  vexing  them,  and 
very  frequently  occasion  them  to  experience  the  effects  of  their  resentment,  by  darkening  their  splendour 
through  the  eclipses  which  they  cause.” 

The  astronomy  of  the  Budhists  is  chiefly  to  be  consulted  for  its  elucidation  of  the  history  and  the 
faith  of  the  sect.  In  these  ancient  memorials,  are  frequently  discoverable  affusions  to  migrations  ot 
communities,  and  affinities  existing  in  the  rites  and  practices  of  countries  the  most  remote  from  each 
other,  and  between  which  we  could  otherwise  trace  no  sort  of  connexion.  It  is  from  these  researches, 
aided  by  the  valuable  materials  furnished  by  the  industrious  and  learned  Humboldt,  that  we  may  trace 
the  striking  analogies  which  subsist  in  the  computation  of  time  and  zodiacal  signs,  between  the  1 aitar 


88 


THE  CHAKKRAIA,  AND  THE  FOUR  ZODIACS. 


Budhists  of  Northern  Asia,  and  the  Azteck  and  Toltcck  tribes  of  America;  a question  which  will  best 
follow  the  synoptic  table  of  the  four  plates  of  the  zodiac,  numbered  9,  10,  11,  12.  These  zodiacs 
differ  in  their  emblems,  as  will  be  seen  in  the  subjoined  arrangement,  and  they  furnish  thereby  materials 
of  value  for  comparison  with  other  monuments.  There  cannot  be  a higher  authority  for  the  preservation 
of  such  documents,  than  that  of  M.  Humboldt,  who  has  so  largely  contributed  to  realize  the  advantages 
of  the  investigation  which  he  recommends.  Conjecture  has  been  busily  at  work  to  establish  the  route  by 
which  the  tribes  of  Asia  and  America  have  reciprocally  contmunicated  with  each  other;  but  the  safest 
way  to  arrive  at  a conclusion  is  by  comparing  the  existing  materials  of  their  knowledge,  and  especially 
their  computations  of  time.  These  data  have  now  acquired  their  due  consideration,  and  are  become 
highly  useful  to  literature;  not  as  in  1705,  when  a zodiac,  sculptured  on  a block  of  marble,  and  still  in 
the  Vatican,  being  found  at  Rome,  and  reported  by  M.  Bianchini  to  the  French  Academy,  was  thus 
estimated  by  the  eloquent  Fontenelle : — “ The  monument,”  says  he,  “ in  which  Bianchini  sought 
explanations,  belongs  to  the  history  of  the  folly  of  mankind,  and  the  Academy  has  something  better  to 
do,  than  to  waste  its  time  in  researches  of  this  kind.”  Of  the  same  monument  it  is  observed  by  the 
Baron  Humboldt,  that  M.  de  Fontenelle  should  have  remembered  that  astrological  reveries  are  intimately 
connected  with  the  first  notions  of  astronomy,  and  that  they  were  of  service  in  throwing  light  on  the 
ancient  communications  of  nations  with  each  other.  It  will  be  seen  that  the  remarks  and  deductions  made 
by  Humboldt,  with  reference  to  Mexican  astronomical  data,  are  calculated  to  develop  facts  of  particular 
interest  and  moment,  as  to  a conformity  in  the  signs  used  by  the  Budhist  Tartars  and  the  Mexican 
tribes  ; facts  which  belong  to  the  existing  knowledge  and  practice  of  the  Budhist  communities  of  the  East. 

The  four  zodiacs,  which  are  represented  in  plates,  9,  10,  11,  12,  do  not  concur  in  giving  precisely 
the  same  signs.  Whether  the  alterations  are  indicative  of  a difference  in  antiquity,  or  to  what  other 
cause  they  should  be  attributed,  it  would  be  impossible  to  determine;  while  they  are  important,  as 
furnishing  a variety  of  examples,  to  establish  the  general  conformity  of  the  system  of  the  Budhists  with 
that  of  the  southern  hemisphere.  Their  accordance  and  disagreement  will  appear  at  one  view  in  the 
following  table — 


Zodiac. — Plate  9. 

].  The  Ram. 

2.  The  Bull. 

3.  Female,  with  instrument 
resembling  a guitar. 

4.  The  Crab. 

5.  The  Lion. 

6.  A Female,  with  fruit. 

7.  The  Balance. 

8.  A Water  Rat. 

9.  An  Archer. 

10.  Makaree,  a Sea  Monster. 

11.  The  Pot. 

12.  Two  Fish,  crossed  on  each 

other. 


Zodiac . — Plate  10. 

1.  The  Goat. 

2.  The  Bull. 

3.  Two  Figures,  with  musical 
instruments. 

4.  The  Crab. 

5.  The  Lion. 

6.  Female,  in  a boat  with  three 
flags,  holding  fruit. 

7-  The  Balance. 

8.  A Scorpion. 

9.  A Centaur. 

10.  Makara,  a large  Fish. 

11.  A Figure  crowned,  holding 
a pot,  or  vase. 

12.  Two  Fish,  reversed  in  pa- 
rallel lines. 


Zodiac. — Plate  11. 

1.  The  Goat,  resembling  the 
Tartarian  Goat. 

2.  The  Bull. 

3.  Two  Figures,  with  instru- 
ments, as  in  plate  10. 

4.  The  Crab. 

5.  The  Lion. 

6.  Female,  in  a boat,  as  in 
plate  10. 

7>  The  Balance. 

8.  A Scorpion. 

9.  Centaur,  as  in  plate  10. 

10.  The  Makaree,  a Sea  Mon- 
ster. 

11.  A Figure,  with  a pot,  as  in 
plate  10. 

12.  Two  Fish,  reversed  in  pa- 
rallel lines. 


Zodiac. — Plate  12. 

1.  The  Goat,  with  a bell  sus- 
pended at  its  neck. 

2.  The  Bull. 

3.  Two  Figures,  without  any 
musical  instruments. 

4.  The  Crab. 

5.  The  Lion. 

6.  A Female,  holding  a crim- 
son flower. 

7.  The  Scales  only. 

8.  A Scorpion. 

9.  A Bow  only. 

10.  Makara,  a large  Fish. 

11.  The  Pot. 

12.  Two  Fish,  reversed  in  pa- 
rallel lines.  , 


* 


Leo  Cancer 


Cafiruc/ryiud  %AtjUariuj 


the  chakkraia,  and  the  four  zodiacs. 


89 


/flie  centre  of  the  zodiac  (plate  9)  exhibits  ornaments  only. 

That  °f' the  Z°diaC  (l)kte  10)  has  sustaining  a plant,  inscribed  Rawsi-dolata. 

The  zodiac  (plate  11)  exhibits  the  sun  vvitli  its  radiated  beams. 

The  zodiac  (plate  12)  lias  a male  and  female,  named  Payay  and  Ritta;  the  female  is  depicted  as 
presenting  a flower. 

From  the  above  comparative  table  it  will  be  found,  that  though  most  of  the  signs  are  clearly  indicative 
of  the  same  meaning,  yet  the  zodiacs  concur  in  an  exact  conformity  in  only  three  of  them,  namely,  the 
second,  the  fourth,  the  fifth,  or  the  Bull,  the  Crab,  and  the  Lion  ; three  asterisms  which  are  found  in 
every  astronomical  system  of  the  East.  The  following  description  is  given  from  an  original  Budhist 
manuscript,  and  precisely  applies  to  the  zodiac  of  plate  10 

“ 1 he  following  are  the  twelve  signs  of  the  zodiac,  which  are  fully  explained  in  the  astronomical 
books,  called  Warahamihira  and  Daiwatnecahmedeenuwa. 

The  sign  Aries  is  in  the  shape  of  a goat,  and  of  red  colour  ; this  sign  is  the  house  of  Mars,  and  also 
a very  fit  place  for  Apollo,  and  unfit  for  Saturn. 

“ Taurus  is  in  the  shape  of  a bull,  and  of  white  colour  ; this  sign  is  the  house  of  Venus,  and  is  also  a 
very  fit  place  for  Luna. 

“ Gemini  is  in  the  shape  of  two  persons,  man  and  woman,  and  of  green  colour ; this  sign  is  a fit  place 
for  Mercury. 

“ Cancer  is  in  the  shape  of  a Crab,  and  of  a colour  between  white  and  red  ; this  sign  is  a fit  place  for 
Luna,  and  very  fit  for  Jupiter,  and  unfit  for  Mars. 

“ Leo  is  in  the  shape  of  a lion,  and  of  a smoke  colour ; this  sign  is  a fit  place  for  Apollo. 

“ Virgo  is  in  the  shape  of  a woman,  in  a ship,  holding  in  one  of  her  hands  a bundle  of  spikes  of  paddy, 
called  hal,  and  in  her  other  hand  a lamp  ; and  of  a colour  between  white  and  yellow.  This  sign  is  a fit 
place  for  Mercury,  and  unfit  for  Venus. 

“ Libra  is  in  the  shape  of  a pair  of  scales,  and  of  a variegated  colour ; this  sign  is  the  house  of 
Venus,  and  a very  fit  place  for  Saturn,  and  unfit  for  Apollo. 

“ Scorpio  is  in  the  shape  of  a scorpion,  and  of  black  colour ; this  sign  is  a fit  place  for  Mars,  and 
unfit  for  Luna. 

“ Sagittarius  is  in  the  shape  of  a bow,  and  of  the  colour  of  gold ; this  sign  is  the  house  of  Jupiter. 

“ Capricorn  is  in  the  shape  of  a shark,  and  of  a colour  between  blue  and  black  ; this  sign  is  the  house 
of  Saturn,  and  a very  fit  place  for  Mars,  and  unfit  for  Jupiter. 

“ Aquarius  is  in  the  shape  of  a pot,  and  of  a colour  between  blue  and  yellow  ; this  sign  is  the  single 
house  of  Saturn. 

“ Pisces  is  in  the  shape  of  two  fish,  and  of  a colour  between  red  and  black  ; this  sign  is  the  house  of 
Jupiter,  and  a very  fit  place  for  Venus,  and  unfit  for  Mercury.” 

These  zodiacal  representations  may  be  very  usefully  compared  with  the  account  which  is  given  by 
Dr.  Buchanan,  in  his  particulars  of  the  astronomy  of  the  Birmans.  The  omissions  which  he  laments  in 
the  accounts  which  he  obtained  from  Captain  Symes  are  most  fortunately  supplied  by  these  zodiacs,  and 
the  Nakshastra  diagram  now  first  given.  It  seems  very  probable  that  it  may  he  found  that  the  Budhists 
made  use  of  two  calculations,  the  one  grounded  upon  the  lunar  zodiac  of  twenty-seven  mansions,  and  a 
planetary  system  of  nine  figures,  representing,  as  Sir  William  Jones  observes,  the  sun,  moon,  and  planets, 

N 


90 


THE  CHAKKRAIA,  AND  THE  FOUR  ZODIACS. 


with  the  dragon’s  head,  or  ascending  node  and  tail,  or  descending  node,  described  by  the  signs  of  Hahu 
and  Ketu  * These  representations  are  clearly  attachable  to  the  Kappooism,  or  astrological  practices  of  the 
pagan  inhabitants,  who  practised  the  serpent  or  naga  worship,  and  also  invocations  to  demons,  and  will 
be  treated  of  in  reference  to  it.  This  belief  M.  de  Humboldt  considers  to  be  anterior  to  the  solar  zodiac, 
which  he  justly  regards  as  indicating  an  advanced  stage  of  knowledge,  and  to  have  been  derived  from  the 
far  more  ancient  and  original  lunar  zodiac  existing  in  higher  Asia,  and  thence  communicated  to  the 
regions  of  South  America. 

The  zodiacs  of  plates  9,  10,  11,  12,  clearly  indicate  that  the  Budhists  were  acquainted  with  a solar 
zodiac,  and  as  remarked  in  the  Asiatic  Researches , vi.,  20-1,  with  signs  represented  analogous  to  ours. 
That  these  signs  are  named  from  the  Arab  and  Greek  schemes  is  manifest  from  the  names  now  affixed, 
although  Sir  William  Jones  is  doubtless  correct  in  ascribing  the  original  derivation  to  the  Chaldeans. 

The  Budhist  writings  have  a solar  year  also  of  three  hundred  and  sixty -five  days,  commencing  on  the 
18th  of  April,  or  with  the  sign  of  Aries,  the  Ram.  Their  common  year,  however,  is  lunar,  and  by  this 
year  are  regulated  their  holy  days  and  festivals.  It  is  composed  of  twelve  months,  which  alternately 
consist  of  thirty  and  twenty-nine  days,  and,  to  make  it  agree  with  their  solar  year,  they  add  an  intercalary 
moon  every  third  year.  This  contrivance,  however,  could  not  make  the  lunar  and  solar  years  coincide, 
and  therefore  constant  alterations  are  necessary  to  make  the  festivals  occur  at  the  proper  seasons. 
Minderagee  Praw,  the  late  emperor  of  Birmah,  vainly  endeavoured,  throughout  his  reign,  to  correct  these 
errors  ; his  efforts  alienated  the  Rhahaans,  and  were  likely  to  have  caused  him  great  trouble  ; and  so  little 
progress  had  he  made,  that,  at  Rangoon,  they  celebrated  a grand  festival  a month  earlier  than  was  done 
at  Ammerapura. 

The  intercalation  of  times  affords  a most  striking  resemblance,  which  deserves  our  attention.  In  the 
Bali  or  stellar  astrology,  wherein  we  may  trace  the  faith  of  those  countries  now  exclusively  Budhist,  is 
one  Bali,  or  scheme  of  incantation,  exclusively  calculated  to  amend  what  they  deem  to  be  an  injury  of 
the  stars ; and  precisely  the  same  notion  is  exhibited  in  the  following  passages  in  M.  Humboldt’s  pages. 
— “ The  ancient  Egyptians  had  a lunar  and  solar  computation  of  time,  and  the  same  dislike  to  any 
innovation  as  the  modern  Budhists,  who  probably  proceed  upon  the  same  data  as  originally  guided  their 
calculations ; for  they  obliged  a monarch  to  swear,  on  his  accession  to  royalty,  never  to  permit  an 
intercalation  to  be  employed  during  his  reign.  As  both  the  Budhist  and  Mexican  writings  consider  such 
a period  as  exhibiting  a blank  or  void,f  within  which  space  every  unlucky  mortal,  who  has  the  misfortune 
to  be  born  into  the  world,  loses  the  celestial  agent  of  his  existence,  we  may  easily  conceive  the 
groundwork  laid  in  such  a belief  for  the  creation  of  popular  discontent  and  disquiet  on  the  question. 

The  civil  year  of  the  Azteck  Mexicans  was  a solar  year  of  three  hundred  and  sixty-five  days,  a 


* It  will  be  manifest  from  the  following  passage,  how  strongly  Sir  W.  Jones’s  opinion,  that  the  nine  Budhist  signs,  given  in  the  Asiatic 
Researches , vi.,  are  a planetary  system,  and  not  a zodiac,  is  sustained  by  Humboldt's  remarks  on  a similar  computation  in  the  Mexican 
scheme. — “ The  Mexicans  formed  a series  of  nine  signs,  called  the  lords  or  masters  of  the  night ; we  may  be  astonished  at  finding  a series 
of  nine  terms  in  a calendar,  that  makes  use  only  of  the  numbers  5,  13,  18,  20,  and  52.  We  may  even  be  tempted  to  look  for  some 
analogy  between  the  nine  lords  of  the  night  of  the  Mexicans,  and  the  nine  astrological  signs  of  several  nations  of  Asia,  who  join  to  the 
seven  visible  planets  two  invisible  Aragons,  to  which  they  attribute  eclipses : but,  without  doubt,  it  is  only  the  facility  with  which  the  nine 
lords  of  the  night  divide  themselves  forty  times  into  three  hundred  and  sixty  days,  that  has  given  the  preference  to  the  number  nine.’  — 
Researches  concerning  the  Institutions  and  Monuments  of  the  Ancient  Inhabitants  of  America,  by  M.  de  Humboldt,  i.  315. 
t See  these  blanks  among  the  asterisins  in  the  table  of  the  Nekates,  plate  17- 


jifiusa 


0 oV  'GXP  1/5  Virutj 


Irric. 


tv  Sun. 


75  0 


B r as  holy  cO  2P 


■uootf'  <jp  vrfsuoy  rnurmijr  Q 4\^*  ViTrFT,(f 


91 


the  chakkraia,  and^the  four  zodiacs. 

reckoning  of  the  sun,  named  TonalpohuaUi ; and  a lunar  year,  called  Metzlapoln.alli,  a reckoning  of  the 
jnoon ; derived  from  the  twenty  solemn  festivals  celebrated  during  the  course  of  a civil  year,  in  the 
teocallis,  or  houses  of  the  gods. 

Neither  the  Mexicans  nor  the  Peruvians  were  acquainted  with  the  small  period  of  seven  days,  nor 
are  the  Japanese  at  this  moment ; while  it  is  in  use  among  the  Chinese,  who  seem  also  to  be  aborigines 
of  the  elevated  plain  of  Tartary,  but  who  have  long  had  intimate  communications  with  Hindustan  and 
Tibet. 

The  Mexicans  had  five  periods  of  five  days  (half  decads) ; months  of  twenty  days;  civil  years  of 
eighteen  months,  01  three  hundred  and  sixty  days,  to  which  they  added  five  intercalary  days,  called 
nementemi,  or  voids ; indictions  of  thirteen  years ; xiuhmolpilli  (or  ligature  of  years),  half  centuries  of 
fifty-two  years ; and  (cehuehue  tilitzli,  or  old  age)  centuries  of  one  hundred  and  four  years.  The 
hieroglyphic  of  the  half  century  is  indicative  of  the  word,  a bundle  of  reeds  tied  by  a ribbon ; the 
century,  the  term  of  life,  lhe  children  born  during  the  intercalary  days  were  regarded  as  unfortunate, 
nemo-quichtli ; “ unhappy  men  or  women,  in  order,”  as  the  Mexican  writers  state,  “ that  these  very 
names  should  call  to  their  remembrance,  in  every  event  of  life,  how  little  they  ought  to  trust  to  their 
stars.”  It  is  a valuable  fact,  that  amid  all  their  errors  we  yet  may  find  the  traces  of  a perfect  system ; 
thus  the  ritual,  or  lunar  year,  had  twenty  half  lunations,  of  thirteen  days,  or  two  hundred  and  sixty 
days,  and  this  contains  fifty-two  half  decads,  or  small  portions  of  five  days.  In  the  divisions  of  the 
moon’s  periods  they  found  their  favourite  numbers  5,  13,  20,  and  52.  A cycle  of  52  years  contained 
1,460  small  periods  of  13  days;  and  if  to  these  we  add  13  intercalary  days,  we  shall  have  1,461  small 
periods ; a number  which  accidentally  coincides  with  the  number  of  years  constituting  the  Sothaic  period. 

The  analogy  between  the  denominations  of  the  Mexican  days  and  the  signs  of  the  Tibetian, 
Chinese,  Tartarian,  and  Mongol  zodiacs,  is  striking  in  the  eight  hieroglyphics  called  atl,  cipactli,  ocelotl, 
tochtli,  cohuatl,  quanhtli,  azomatli,  and  itzcuintli.  Atl,  water,  is  often  indicated  by  the  sign  of  water 
denoting  Aquarius ; cipactli  is  a sea-monster,  bearing  a strong  resemblance  to  Capricorn,  which  many 
nations  of  Asia  call  sea-monster;  thus  it  also  appears  in  the  annexed  zodiac  (plates  9,  10,  11,  and  12), 
as  makara,  the  fabulous  fish,  celebrated  for  his  exploits,  and  represented,  from  the  most  remote  antiquity, 
as  a sea-monster  with  the  head  of  an  antelope.  The  tiger,  the  hare,  the  female  ape,  the  dog,  the  serpent, 
and  the  bird,  are  asterisms  that  bear  the  same  names  in  the  Tartar  and  Tibetian  zodiacs.  The  Mexican 
ape,  ozomatli,  answers  to  the  heou  of  the  Chinese,  to  the  petchi  of  the  Mantchous,  and  to  the  prehou  of 
the  people  of  Tibet,  three  names  that  denote  the  same  animal.  Procyon  appears  to  be  the  ape  Hanuman, 
of  the  Hindu  mythology ; and  the  position  of  this  star  corresponds  very  well  with  the  place  of  the  ape 
in  the  Tartar  zodiac,  between  the  Crab.  Apes  are  found  also  in  the  sky  of  the  Arabians:  they  are  stars 
in  the  constellation  of  the  great  dog,  called  El  Ivurid,  in  the  catalogue  of  Kaswini.  I enter  into  these 
details  respecting  the  sign  ozomatli,  the  ape,  because  an  animal  of  the  torrid  zone,  placed  among  the 
constellations  of  the  Mongol,  Mandchou,  Azteck,  and  Tolteck  nations,  is  a very  important  point,  not 
only  in  the  history  of  astronomy,  but  also  in  that  of  the  migration  of  nations.* 

The  coincidences  with  Bianchini’s  zodiac,  supplied  from  the  pages  of  M.  Humboldt,  will  establish 
the  connexion  existing  in  these  data  of  early  science.  This  ancient  zodiac,  made  known  in  the 


N 2 


Humboldt's  Researches,  i.  342. 


92 


THE  CHAKKRAIA,  AND  THE  FOUR  ZODIACS. 


beginning  of  the  last  century,  proves  that  there  existed  in  the  East  solar  zodiacs,  in  which  are  found  the 
Tartarian  asterisms  of  the  Horse,  the  Dog,  the  Hare,  the  Dragon,  and  the  Bird,  arranged  so  that  the  Dog 
answers  to  the  Bull,  and  not  to  the  Ram,  of  the  Greek  zodiac,  while  the  Dog  and  the  Hare  are  separated 
not  by  four,  but  only  by  two  signs. 

This  monument  exhibits,  in  five  consecutive  zones,  the  figures  of  the  planets,  the  decani,  the 
asterisms  of  the  Greek  zodiac  repeated  twice,  and  the  signs  of  another  zodiac,  which  has  the  greatest 
analogy  with  that  of  the  Budhist  Tartars.  According  to  the  observation  of  M.  Visconti,  the  style  of  the 
figures  representing  the  planets  evidently  proves  that  it  was  sculptured  in  the  time  of  the  Caesars. 
In  this  mutilated  monument  we  recognise,  among  the  signs  of  the  interior  zone,  a Horse,  a Crab,  a 
Serpent,  a Dog,  a Hare,  two  Birds,  and  two  Quadrupeds,  one  with  a long  tail,  and  the  other  with  goat’s 
horns.  When  we  recollect  that  the  zodiac  which  contains  a Dog,  a Hare,  and  an  Ape,  belongs 
exclusively  to  Eastern  Asia,  and  that  it  has  probably  passed  thence  into  America,  we  are  surprised  to  see 
that  it  was  known  at  Rome  in  the  first  ages  of  our  era.  The  astrologers,  or  Chaldeans,  established  in 
Greece  and  in  Italy,  had,  no  doubt,  communication  with  those  of  Asia ; and  these  communications  must 
have  become  more  frequent  and  extensive,  in  proportion  as  astrology  was  more  in  vogue  among  the 
people,  and  at  the  court  of  the  Cssars.  Of  eight  signs  which  are  recognizable  in  the  planisphere  of 
Bianchini,  there  is  only  one,  the  Crab,  which  does  not  belong  to  the  Budhist  or  Tartar  zodiac. 

The  reader  is  referred  to  the  pages  of  the  Asiatic  Researches , volumes  2,  3,  9,  and  13,  for  the 
exposition  of  the  Indian  scheme  of  astronomy,  in  most  points  resembling  that  of  the  Budhist  writings. 
The  pertinacity  of  the  latter,  in  adhering  closely  to  the  curious  and  antiquated  descriptions  of  their 
sacred  books,  has  necessarily  led  to  the  encouragement  of  Indian  and  European  professors  of  astronomy 
at  the  different  courts,  for  the  purpose  of  rectifying  their  defective  and  embarrassing  systems  of 
computing  time.  Thus  most  of  the  Budhist  courts,  especially  the  Birman,  have  introduced,  as  a part  of 
their  retinue,  Indian  Bramins  and  astrologers,  who  frame  the  almanacs  upon  the  improved  systems  of 
calculation,  giving  the  true  time,  and  also  adroitly  intermeddling  with  the  state,  by  determining  lucky 
and  unlucky  days  and  other  contingencies.  In  China,  where  the  same  defect  exists,  the  remedy  has 
been  applied  by  means  of  individuals  sent  from  Europe,  highly  scientific  persons  of  the  Roman  Catholic 
faith,  who  have  availed  themselves  of  their  ostensible  calling  as  almanac-makers  and  astronomers,  to  carry 
on  the  views  of  the  Propaganda  Society  for  the  Diffusion  of  the  Christian  Faith.  The  volumes  6,  7,  and 
8,  of  the  Asiatic  Researches , may  be  very  profitably  examined  for  many  particulars  elucidatory  of  the 
Budhist  astronomical  scheme,  as  may  also  the  elaborate  work  of  M.  Creuzer,  on  the  Religions  oj 
Antiquity , which  has  been  translated  from  the  German  into  French  by  J.  D.  Guigniaut. 

It  has  been  shown  how  essentially  the  Budhist  system  builds  itself  upon  a close  and  intimate  union 
of  the  earth  and  its  inhabitants  with  the  Dewa  Loka  heavens,  to  both  of  which  the  atmospherical  region 
of  Jugandere  becomes  a boundary  and  a link.  It  is  the  scene  of  enchantment  and  magical  arts,  and  it 
is  also  the  region  wherein  are  placed  the  sun,  the  moon,  and  the  inferior  planets,  as  well  as  the  stars ; 
hence  the  intimate  tie  and  association  between  the  incantations  and  magic  arts  of  the  East  and  the 
celestial  orbs.  These  heavenly  bodies  are  all  appropriated  to  different  periods  of  the  lunations,  and 
calculated  upon  the  twenty-seven  Nekates,  or  lunar  mansions.  These  mansions  are  placed  upon  the  outer 
ridge  of  the  rock-circles,  already  described  in  the  Sackwalle.  The  Chackrawarty,  or  Chakkraia  ring, 
according  to  the  following  Singalese  doctrine,  is  named  the  Sarewasanharanam  Chakkraia,  and  is  in  the 


the  chakkraia,  and  the  four  zodiacs. 


93 

form.of  the  globe ; the  centre  is  fixed  on  the  Maha-meru,  84,000  juzana  in  height.  This  Maha-meru 
15  divided  into  eight  quarters — 

The  1st.  quarter  whence  the  sun  rises  is  the  East. 

^10  2c*-  South  East. 

The  3d. South. 

The  4th. South  West 

The  5th. West. 

The  6th North  West. 

The  7th. North. 

The  8th North  East. 

Beyond  the  Maha-meru,  are  lying  round  about  seven  Parkwettes,  or  circles  of  rocks  of  a lesser  size, 
called  Jugandere,  Ecsadari,  Karwike,  Sudessana,  Newendara,  WJnetaka,  and  Asswekara,  which  gradually 
decrease  in  height  to  the  Maha-meru  ; on  the  top  of  the  first  of  which,  Jugandere  Parkwette,  are  formed 
the  twelve  signs  which  the  sun  and  planets  preside  in,  as  the  twelve  divisions  in  the  Chakkraia  represent. 

1 he  whole  machinery  of  the  planetary  system,  as  far  as  refers  to  the  solar  zodiac,  requires  a separate 
illustration,  as  it  exhibits  a scheme  of  nine  planets  deduced  from  a lunar  zodiac  of  twenty-seven  signs. 
There  is  little  question  that  most  of  the  signs  of  the  lunar  mansions,  or  Nekates,  may  be  found  among  the 
sixty-eight  Birman  constellations,  given  by  Dr.  Buchanan.  It  would  not,  indeed,  be  matter  of  surprise, 
were  we  to  trace  an  identity  among  people  professing  the  same  faith,  and  drawing  their  doctrinal  and 
scientific  data  from  the  same  sources,  as  the  Birmans  and  Singalese  avowedly  do.  It  is  presumed  that 
the  plates  of  the  nine  planets  will  serve  to  show  that  Sir  William  Jones  is  right  in  referring  the  nine 
figures  to  a planetary,  and  not  to  a zodiacal  scheme;  the  comparative  analysis  of  the  American  and 
Tartar  signs  presents  a much  more  important  subject,  and  establishes  many  striking  coincidences  between 
the  distant  regions  to  which  they  belong. 

The  calculations  of  time  for  the  year,  also  the  enumeration  of  the  nine  planets,  and  of  the  months, 
differ  from  the  regular  computation,  and  are  expressly  the  parts  of  the  system  which  belong  to  the  more 
ancient  faith  of  the  inhabitants  of  Ceylon ; a system  upon  which  was  constructed  the  system  of  Bali 
worship,  or  planetary  influence,  which,  together  with  the  rites  of  devils,  or  rather  demons  and  serpent- 
worship,  still  operates  in  a very  extensive  and  powerful  manner  upon  the  inhabitants,  not  only  of  Ceylon, 
but  of  various  parts  of  Asia,  and  also  of  Africa. 

The  year  consists  of  365  days,  31  minutes,  and  15  seconds. 

1 hour  (JO  minutes. 

1 minute  60  seconds. 

15  days  one  division,  namely  pakse;  2 pakses  1 month  ; 2 months  1 irtoo ; 3 irtoos  1 ayene ; 2 ayenes  1 year ; 20  years  1 winsetia  ; 
3 winsetias  1 sestisanvvatsera. 

1.728.000  years  make  one  creta-yug. 

1.296.000  treta-yug. 

864,000  dwapere-yug. 

432,000* cali-yug,  or  one  eternal. 

• " On  looking  into  the  Singalese  books  we  find  several  striking  resemblances  between  the  astronomical  system  of  the  Budhists  and 
that  of  the  Bramins;  for  instance,  we  see  the  number  432  followed  by  any  number  of  ciphers,  which,  among  the  Indians,  is  the  result 
of  certain  combinations  in  the  movements  of  the  heavenly  bodies  ; combinations  which  agree  almost  exactly  with  the  calculations  founded 
on  Newton’s  system ; but  the  number  432,  among  the  Budhists,  is  no  longer  the  result  of  astronomical  combinations,  but  of  arithmetical 
ones,  arranged  expressly  to  obtain  it.” — M.  Joinville,  on  the  Astronomy  oj  the  Budhists,  Asiatic  Researches,  viii.  402. 


<)4 


THE  CIIAKKRAIA,  AND  THE  FOUR  ZODIACS. 


Brah me  20  years. 
Wisnoe  20  years. 
Jesware  20  years. 

60  years. 


The  nine  planets  are  the  Sun,  Moon,  Mercurius,  Venus,  Mars,  Jupiter,  Saturn,  Rawhoe,  and  Kehatoe. 


The  Names  of  the  Months. 


Mooherrem 

Satfer 

Rabeal  AnveJ 
Rabeal  Auher 
Joomadil  Anvel 
Joomadil  Auher 
Rajeb . 

Saban 
Ram  elan 
Sanwal 
Zilg-adoo 
Zilg-hadge 


December. 

January. 

February. 

March. 

April. 

May. 

June. 

July. 

August. 

September. 

October. 

November. 


The  Names  of  the  Days  of  the  Week. 


Aditye 

Sunday. 

Homa 

Monday. 

Angare  . 

Tuesday. 

Budha 

Wednesday. 

Brahaspety 

Thursday. 

Hookooroo 

Friday. 

Hoonekirroo 

Saturday. 

The  following  is  an  account  of  the  figures  of  the  nine  planets,  which  appear  in  the  books  called 


Nawaggraha-Suntiya,  or  Bali-sloke,  Warahamihira,  and  Daiwatneca.  These  astronomical  books  were 
brought  to  the  island  of  Ceylon  from  the  country  Damba-dewa,  and  are  expressly  calculated  for  the  Bali. 
The  figures  of  the  planets  are  represented  with  slight  deviations  in  the  plates  14  and  19- 

Jupiter  : this  planet  is  of  the  male  sex ; he  is  the  proprietor  of  the  two  signs,  Sagittarius  and  Pisces, 
and  chief  over  the  point  between  the  east  and  north,  called  in  Singalese  Issawna.  The  colour  of  his 
body  is  like  gold ; he  has  a crown  on  his  head,  and  a full  pot  in  his  hand ; he  moves  mounted  on  the 
back  of  a lion,  and  his  body  is  nine  hundred  yodoons  high. 

The  Sun  is  of  the  male  sex  ; he  is  proprietor  of  the  sign  Leo,  and  chief  over  the  east.  His  body  is 


of  copper  colour;  he  has  a crown  on  his  head,  and  a siriwesseya  in  his  hand;  he  moves  mounted  on  a 


horse,  is  six  lacs  of  yodoons  high,  and  is  a bad  planet. 

Venus  is  of  the  female  sex;  she  is  the  proprietor  of  the  signs  Taurus  and  Libra,  and  chief  over  the 
point  between  the  east  and  the  south.  Her  body  is  white ; she  has  a crown  on  her  head,  holds  in  her 
hand  a chamerra,  and  moves  mounted  on  the  back  of  a bull ; she  is  twelve  lacs  of  yodoons  high,  and  a 


good  planet. 

Mars  is  of  the  male  sex,  he  is  the  proprietor  of  the  signs  Aries  and  Scorpio,  and  chief  over  the 
south.  His  body  is  red  ; he  has  a crown  on  his  head,  and  an  unkussa  in  his  hand ; he  moves  mounted 
on  the  back  of  a peacock,  is  nine  hundred  yodoons  high,  and  a bad  planet. 

Rahu  is  of  the  male  sex ; he  has  no  sign,  and  is  chief  over  the  point  between  the  south  and  west. 
The  colour  of  his  body  is  like  fire  ; he  holds  in  his  hand  a weapon  of  the  shape  of  a fish,  moves  mounted 
on  the  back  of  an  ass,  is  thirty-six  lacs  of  yodoons  high,  and  a bad  planet. 

Saturn,  who  is  neither  male  nor  female,  is  the  proprietor  of  the  signs  Capricorn  and  Aquarius,  and 
chief  over  the  west.  His  body  is  black ; he  has  a crown  on  his  head,  and  holds  a mandewatte  in  his 
hand ; he  moves  mounted  on  the  back  of  a crow  or  raven,  is  three  thousand  yodoons  high,  and  a bad 
planet. 


THE  CHAKKRAIA,  AND  THE  FOUR  ZODIACS. 


95 


'Flie  Moon  is  of  the  female  sex  ; she  is  proprietor  of  the  sign  Cancer,  and  chief  over  the  point 
between  the  west  and  north.  Her  body  is  white,  she  has  a crown  on  her  head,  and  holds  a riband  in  her 
hand  ; she  moves  mounted  on  the  back  of  an  elephant,  is  fifteen  hundred  yodoons  high,  and  a good  planet. 

The  planet  Budha  or  Mercurius  is  neither  male  nor  female;  he  is  the  proprietor  of  the  signs 
Gemini  and  Virgo,  and  chief  over  the  north.  His  body  is  blue ; lie  has  a crown  on  his  head,  and  holds 
a chank  shell  in  his  hand  ; he  moves  mounted  on  the  back  of  a buffalo,  is  eight  hundred  yodoons  high, 
and  a good  planet. 

Kehettu  is  of  the  male  sex,  has  no  signs,  and  is  chief  over  the  centre  of  the  world.  His  body  is 
of  a smoke  colour ; his  face  is  like  that  of  a man  having  a crown  on  his  head.  The  shape  of  his  body 
resembles  that  of  a Cobra  de  Capello.  He  holds  in  his  right  hand  a chain  called  Japemawlawe,  and  a 
book  in  the  left ; he  moves  mounted  on  a cloud,  is  no  less  than  one  killa  of  yodoons  high,  and  a bad 
planet. 

According  to  the  horoscope  of  a man,  when  he  becomes  sick  by  means  of  the  ill  effects  of  planets, 
these  shapes  are  made  of  mud  as  a sacrifice,  and  held  before  the  patient,  while  certain  formula  are 
repeated  for  the  cure  of  such  complaints. 


THE  CHAKKRAIA.— PLATE  XX. 


As  the  Chakkraia  exhibits  the  twenty-seven  lunar  mansions  beginning  from  the  east,  wherein  is 
the  zodiacal  sign  of  Meesa  the  goat,  it  follows  that  the  great  centre  line,  forming  two  Ayanas,  or  two 
six  months,  which  divides  the  scheme,  is  from  north  to  south.  The  eastern  side  of  the  line,  called 

Oettray-anaya,  comprises  from  the  beginning  of  January  to  the  end  of  June.  The  western  side,  called 

% 

Dhaksinay-anaya,  comprises  July  to  the  end  of  December,  through  which  the  stars  travel. 

In  the  vicinity  of  the  Ayanas  are  three  divisions  of  time,  each  consisting  of  four  months,  called 
Gimhana,  or  16th  of  March  to  16th  July;  Washana,  or  16th  July  to  15th  November;  and  Haimanta,  or 
16th  November  to  15th  March  : beyond  which  are  six  Irtoos  or  Wasanta,  April  and  May  ; Griesma,  June 
and  July  ; Waroesa,  August  and  September;  Sarat,  October  and  November;  Haimanta,  December 
and  January  ; and  Sieiraya,  February  and  March  : and  as  mentioned  in  the  books,  Rajee-matandah,  and 
Jati-tatteedie,  or  the  speech  of  the  Isriens,  or  ancient  sages,  or  wise  men,  all  these  astrological  signs, 
comprising  the  twelve  signs,  exist  throughout  the  heaven,  which  is  thirty-six  lacs,  and  10,350  juzana 
in  extent. 

The  Budhist  Nekates,  or  lunar  mansions  around  the  Chakkraia,  in  plate  20,  are  twenty-seven  in 
number,  and  these  mansions  have  each  four  squares,  or  houses,  answering  to  the  phases  or  changes  of  the 
moon  ; consequently  the  original  number  of  twenty-seven  mansions,  multiplied  by  4,  gives  108,  which 
will  be  found  to  correspond  precisely  with  the  number  of  houses  or  squares  of  the  Chakkraia  circle  ; the 
tabular  notation  of  the  Chakkraia  demonstrates  the  calculation  of  each  lull  moon  to  be  nearly  two  Nekates 
and  a quarter  distant  from  that  preceding  it,  and  we  shall  thus  trace  around  its  rim  the  duration,  contiguity, 
and  progress  of  each  lunation,  in  connexion  with  the  tfionths  and  zodiacal  signs. 

Meese,  Maisa , the  goat,  includes  Aswida,  Berene,  and  one  of  the  blanks  ot  Ketty. 


9G 


THE  CHAKKRAIA,  AND  THE  FOUR  ZODIACS. 


Orsembe,  Wrasaba,  the  Bull,  includes  the  three  remaining  blanks  of  Ketty  and  Rchcne,  arfd  two 
blanks  from  Moewasirisa. 

Mittoene,  Mietuna,  the  Pair,  includes  the  two  remaining  blanks  of  Moewasirisa  and  Ade,  and 
three  blanks  from  Poonawasaya. 

Kateke,  Katakatja , the  Crab,  includes  the  one  remaining  blank  of  Poonawasaya,  Poese  and  Aslissa. 

Sinlia,  the  Lion,  includes  the  Mawneket,  Poewapala,  and  one  blank  from  Oettrapala. 

Kannie,  the  Virgin,  comprises  the  three  remaining  blanks  of  Oettrapala  and  Hataya,  and  two  blanks 
from  Sitaya. 

Toela,  Toola,  the  Scale,  comprises  the  two  remaining  blanks  of  Sitaya  and  Sa,  and  three  blanks 
from  Wisa. 

Ocrchika,  the  Scorpion,  comprises  the  one  remaining  blank  of  Wisa  and  Anoere,  and  Dete. 

Danoe,  Dhanoe , the  Bow,  comprises  Moele,  Poewasale,  and  one  blank  from  Oettrasale. 

Makere,  Makara,  the  Deer,  comprises  the  three  remaining  blanks  of  Oettrasale  and  Soene,  and 
two  blanks  from  Dewetaya. 

Coembe,  Koomba,  the  Pot,  comprises  the  two  remaining  blanks  of  Dewetaya  and  Siewase,  and 
three  blanks  from  Poewapoetoepaya. 

Miene,  Meina,  the  Fish,  comprises  the  one  remaining  blank  from  Poewapoetoepaya  and  Oettre- 
poetoepaya,  and  Raewatteya. 

These  are  the  twenty-seven  Nekates,  and  their  respective  twenty-seven  blank  spaces,  or  celestial 
rooms,  which,  in  the  circle,  comprehend  the  whole  of  the  twelve  signs,  and  refer  to  the  nine  planets. 

To  this  Chakkraia  appertain  also  three  months,  called,  Surya-masaya,  signifying  the  removing  of  the 
sun  from  one  sign  to  another,  month  by  month  ; Chandra-masaya,  signifying  the  expiring  of  the  summer 
or  dark  time,  and  beginning  the  new  moon ; and  Sawana-masava,  signifying  the  change  of  the  full  moon, 
and  the  commencing  of  the  dark  time.  Each  of  these  Surya,  Chandra,  and  Sawana  months  has  thirty 
days.  Moreover  the  Chandra-masaya,  or  month,  has  two  different,  Amawasa-poyas,  but  of  which,  the 
one  expiring  of  the  moon  is  the  natural,  and  the  continuing  of  the  moon  is  decrease  or  the  unnatural.* 
The  Sawana-masaya  has  two  Pasaloswaka  Pooyas,  or  full  moon  days,  of  which  the  full  moon  is  natural, 
and  that  which  is  not  the  entire  full  is  the  unnatural  Pasaloswaka. 

It  is  remarked  by  M.  Humboldt,  that  the  twelve  animals  are  used  to  denote  the  twelve  moons  of  the 
year,  the  twelve  hours  of  the  day  and  night,  and  the  twelve  celestial  signs ; but  all  these  divisions  into 
twelve  parts,  marked  by  different  names,  are  in  the  east  of  Asia  only  abstract  or  imaginary  divisions. 
They  serve  to  recal  to  mind  the  motion  of  the  sun  in  the  ecliptic;  but  the  real  starry  zodiac,  as  M. 
Bailly  justly  observes,  and  as  is  confirmed  by  the  more  recent  researches  of  Sir  William  Jones  and  Mr. 
Colebrooke,  consists  of  the  twenty-eight  lunar  mansions. 

It  is  true,  the  sun  is  said  to  enter  into  the  Twins  or  the  Scorpion  ; but  the  Chinese,  the  Hindfis,  and 
the  Tartars,  as  well  as  the  Budhists  of  Ceylon,  class  the  stars  only  according  to  the  system  of  the  Nekates 
and  Xakshastras.  The  division  of  the  zodiac  into  twenty-seven  or  twenty-eight  parts,  known  from  Yemen 

• This  expression  is  used  in  the  Budhist  writings,  and  seems  to  intimate  that  the  sun  and  moon,  although  they  appear  round  to  us, 
are  by  no  means  spheres. — Asiatic  Researches,  vi.  191.  Also  on  the  moon’s  giving  no  light  when  in  conjunction,  page  192  ; the  san^ 
thing  is  stated  on  the  subject  of  the  planets. 


THE  CIIAKKUAIA,  AND  THE  FOUU  ZODIACS.  !)7 

to  Hie  plains  of  Turfan  and  of  Cochin-china,  belongs  ,,.,.11  ., 

. • , „ _ ’ 0ngs’  as  wel1  as  the  small  portion  of  seven  days,  to  the 

most  ancient  monuments  of  astronomy  ; and  the  particulars  which  have  been  already  stated  of  Mexican 

tune  show  that,  among  the  nations  which  have  turned  their  attention  to  the  starry  vault,  the  lunar  zodiac 
dtvtded  into  twenty-seven  or  twenty-eight  mansions,  is  more  ancient  than  the  zodiac  in  twelve  parts 
which,  from  being  at  first  only  a zodiac  of  full  moons,  is  become  a solar  zodiac  ' 

Besides  the  real  division  of  the  ecliptic,  which  is  a zone  of  the  starry  heaven,  there  still  exist,  and 
especially  m eastern  As, a,  divisions  of  the  time  which  the  sun  employs  in  returning  nearly  to  the  same 
stars,  or  to  the  same  point  of  the  horizon.  The  signs  of  the  ideal  zodiac,  the  complete  revolution  of  which 

forms  a year,  arc  easily  transferred  to  the  constellations  themselves ; and  hence,  the  division  of  time 
becomes  a division  of  the  sphere. 

M.  Gama  admits,  that  the  Mexicans  intercalated  only  twenty-five  days  every  cycle  of  a hundred  and 
four  years,  or  twelve  days  and  a half  at  the  end  of  each  cycle  of  fifty-two  years.  The  intercalation  of 
twenty-five  days  ,n  a hundred  and  four  years,  says  M.  La  Place,  supposes  a more  exact  duration  of  the 
tropical  years  than  that  of  Hipparchus,  and  what  is  very  remarkable,  almost  equal  to  that  of  the 
astronomers  of  Almamon.  When  we  consider  the  difficulty  of  attaining  so  exact  a determination,  we  are 
led  to  believe,  that  it  is  not  the  work  of  the  Mexicans,  and  that  it  has  reached  them  from  the  old  continent ; 
but  from  what  people,  and  by  what  means  was  it  received  ? Why,  if  it  was  transmitted  to  them  from 
the  north  of  Asia,  are  their  divisions  of  time  so  different  from  those  which  have  been  used  in  that  part 
of  the  world?  In  our  present  state  of  knowledge  we  must  not  flatter  ourselves  that  we  can  solve  these 
questions;  but  even  not  admitting  the  intercalation  of  twelve  days  and  a half  in  a cycle,  and  not 
granting  to  the  Mexicans  the  knowledge  of  the  ancient  Persian  year  of  three  hundred  and  sixty-five  days, 
we  shall  find  in  the  hieroglyphics  of  the  days,  and  in  the  employment  of  the  periodical  series,  irrefragable 
testimony  of  an  ancient  communication  with  eastern  Asia.— Humboldts  Researches , i.  393. 

The  twenty-seven  Nekates,  or  signs  of  the  stars,  have,  as  a presiding  director,  Pattinee-dewa ; her 
legend  lias  been  given  in  the  chapter  which  treats  the  guardian  gods  who  belong  to  the  region 
Jugandere.  The  station  of  the  Dewa-Pattinee  is  evidenced  from  her  ruling  the  twenty-seven  lunar 
mansions  of  the  Chakkraia : she  is  represented  as  holding  in  the  left  hand  a rabbit*  and  in  the  right  a 
parrot. 


The  mischievous  and  supernatural  powers  of  this  Dewa  may  be  fitly  compared  to  the  Trows  or  Drows  of  Scandinavia,  and  the 
mischievous  tricks  and  transformations  of  our  witches,  among  which  we  ulso  most  commonly  observe  the  disguise  of  a cut  or  a rabbit. 


O 


98 


THE  CHAKKRAIA,  AND  THE  FOUR  ZODIACS. 


Figure 

1.  Assudu,  4 arms 

2.  B arena,  with  elephant’s  head  . 

3.  Cuity,  heifer's  head,  and  10  arms 

4.  Rehenna,  Cobra-copile  head 


Plate 

15 

15 

16 
1G 


■} 


16 

18 

18 

18 

18 

17 


5.  Muwasirusa,  a snake's  head  and 4 arms,  the  right  holding  \ 
a human  head,  and  the  left  the  chakkra  • j 

G.  Ada,  head  of  wild  beast  holding  a sword 

7.  Punuwasa,  cat's  head  holding  a golden  cord  . 

8.  Pusa,  an  antelope’s  head 

9.  Aslisa,  a cat’s  head 

10.  Manakat,  a leopard’s  head,  and  6 arms 

1 1 . Puwapal,  a hog’s  head  holding  up  a human  head,  and 

a bow  . 

12.  Uttrapal  as  Cuity,  heifer's  head  • -17 

13.  Hata,  heifer’s  head  • • *17 

14.  Sita,  head  of  the  tiger,  or  ocelot,  and  holding  a bell  . 17 

Thus  far  the  Xekates  proceed  from  left  to  right ; they 
now  reform  their  circle  by  retracing  their  course 
from  right  to  left,  thus : — 

15.  Seith,  a blue  bull’s  head,  arms  as  Nekate,  No.  5,  and  ) jy 

tusks,*  ranks  in  the  under  line  of  • ) 

1G.  Wisaha,  head  of  tiger,  6 arms  bearing  a bow,  hatchet,  ^ 
sword,  and  club  • • • • j 

17.  Anura,  a deer’s  or  antelope’s  head  • -17 

18.  Deta,  the  same,  holding  a large  ring  . • -17 

19.  Mula,  a demon  holding  a buccinum,  or  conch-whirled  jg 

shell 

20.  Puwasula,  a demon  with  bow 

21.  Uttrahula,  as  12 

22.  Suwana,  a demon  holding  a flower-pot 


17 


rled| 


18 

18 

18 


16 


16 


23.  Denata,  a female,  4 arms,  one  of  which  holds  a lotus 

24.  Siyah-wasa,  a horse's  head,  and  10  arms 

25.  Puwaputapali,  holding  the  magic  ring,  or  circle,  and  a 'j 

sword,  with  an  amethyst  ear-ring,  probably  a talis-  L j (j 
manic  one,  as  the  Pattinee’s  • • J 

26.  Uttrapulupah,  head  as  No.  12,  holding  a bow  and  an 

arrow,  represented  on  the  Nekate,  No.  5 . j 

27.  Rewaty,+  an  elephant’s  head,  bearing  two  instruments  i _ 

of  music  ■ • • • ) 

28.  These  two  blanks  are  also  referred  to  in  Bali,  pi.  17,  nnd  at  p- 91 . 


The  Hieroglyphic. 

• 

Zodiacal  Sign. 

. A cow. 

. Tiger,  or  ocelot. 
. Peacock. 

. . Tortoise. 

The  Goat. 
The  Bull. 

. . . Bull. 

A cow.  'i 

t A white  horse.  r 

Elephant.  S 

Cobra-copile.  j 

A large  fish. 

. . . A hog.  f 

J 

The  Twins. 
The  Crab. 

The  Lion. 

. . A peacock.  'I 

. Large  white  bird.  > 

White  elephant.  J 

The  Virgin. 

^ A human  figure,  with  tiger  s 'j 
"l  teeth.  y 

. . A white  elephant.  j 

The  Balance. 

A raven.  "v 

( A large  white  bird,  one  of  the  l_ 
1 Jugandere-dewa’s.  J 

The  Scorpion. 

A raven.  1 

The  Bow. 

A lion.  ) 

. A bull.  1 

. An  ocelot,  or  tiger. 

( Makaree,  or  the  sea-monster. 

-5  The  Copaetl  of  the  Mexican 
t zodiac. 

. A white  elephant. 

The  Deer. 
The  Pot. 

Makaree,  or  sea-monster. 

. A long  snake. 

The  Fish. 

. . . Two  fishes. 

The  following  table  of  coincidences  in  the  signs  of  the  twenty-seven  Nekates  with  the  zodiacs  shows 
the  great  probability,  that  the  solar  zodiac  took  its  origin  from  the  lunar  zodiac ; and  that  the  twelve 
signs  of  the  former  were  chosen  in  a great  measure  among  the  twenty-seven  lunar  mansions. 


• This  curious  figure  tallies  with  tlie  promise  made  by  the  Budha,  that  those  of  his  followers  who  consecrate  his  images  shall  be  born 
into  the  heavens,  and  be  made  like  a golden  image  with  tigers’  teeth.  May  not  each  Nekate  be  a separate  mansion  in  Budlm's  doctrine 
for  the  metempsychosis  ? 

t The  position  of  this  Nekate  is  evidently  the  Ilemavunta  chain  of  hills,  where  the  King  of  the  White  Elephant  is  placed,  which  b 
alike  designated  by  its  position  in  Aquarius.  Rewaty  also  is  the  same  as  Airawaty,  Irrawady,  signifying  aqueous  ; and  also  symbolically 
the  elephant. — See  the  description  of  the  elephant’s  path  in  the  account  of  the  planets. 


K - m\  *.  J 
L - * <\ 

\ ’ t'  y-^ 

J : % : \ 

fwA 

L y-'  / j J 

y ------  ■ 

\ 


r 


the  chakkraia,  and  the  four  zodiacs. 


99 


Among  the  Mindft  twenty-seven  Nakshas- 
tras,  lunar  houses,  are  the 

The  plates  of  the  Budlmt  Nekates,  or  lunar 
houses,  as  described  in  their  order,  ac- 
cording to  the  Singalese  year,  com- 
mencing with  Meesa,  the  Goat,  and  an- 
swering to  their  signs. 

The  zodiacal  signs  of  the  Greeks. 

Rat. 

Antelope. 

Arrow,  bow. 

Tail  of  the  lion. 

Beam  of  a pair  of  scales. 
Serpent. 

Horse. 

Goat. 

Ape. 

Eagle. 

Dog’s  tail. 

Fish. 

Nekate  24,  25,  the  Pot  Cumba. 
Nekate  22,  23,  Makere,  the  Deer. 
Nekate  19,  20,  21,  the  Bow. 
Nekate  10,  11,  12,  the  Lion. 
Nekate  15,  16,  the  Balance. 
Nekate  13,  14,  the  Virgin. 
Nekate,  17,  18,  Scorpio. 

Nekate  8,  9,  the  Crab. 

Nekate  6,  7,  the  Pair. 

Nekate  4,  5,  the  Bull. 

Nekate  1,  2,  3,  the  Goat. 

Nekate  26,  27,  the  Fish. 

Rat.  Aquarius.  Water. 

Ox.  Capricorn.  Sea-monster,  &c. 
Tiger.  Sagittarius. 

Lion. 

Dragon.  Balance. 

Serpent.  Virgin. 

Horse. 

Sheep.  Crab. 

Ape.  Twins. 

Bird.  Bull. 

Dog.  Ram. 

Hog.  Fish. 

On  an  examination  of  the  different  symbols  of  the  lunar  mansions,  or  Nekates,  of  the  plates  15,  16, 
17,  and  18,  it  will  be  found  that  they  are  reducible  from  twenty  to  fifteen  original  symbols,  as  several  of 
the  signs  are  repeated  twice  or  more,  thus — 


No.  1.  Assuda  resembles  No.  27- 

2.  The  Elephant. 

3.  The  Heifer  accompanies  the  Nekates  12,  13,  21,  and  26. 

4.  The  Cobra-copile. 

5.  A Snake  also. 

6.  A Wild  Beast. 

7-  A Cat,  also  9. 

8.  An  Antelope  resembles  17  and  18. 

10.  An  Ocelot  or  Leopard,  like  14  and  16. 

11.  A Hog. 

15.  A Bulk 

19,  20,  22.  Demons. 

23.  A Female. 

24.  A Horse. 

25.  Pattinee. 


Without  recurring  to  the  hieroglyphics,  water,  and  sea-monster,  according  with  Aquarius  and 
Capricorn,  the  six  signs  of  the  Tartar  zodiac,  found  in  the  Mexican  calendar,  are  sufficient  to  render  it 
extremely  probable  that  the  people  of  the  two  continents  drew  their  astrological  ideas  from  a common 
source.  Nations  which  have  never  had  any  intercourse  with  each  other  may  make  equal  divisions  of  the 
ecliptic  into  twenty-seven  or  twenty-eight  parts ; nations,  either  of  shepherds  or  hunters,  may  denote  the 
constellations  and  lunar  days  by  the  names  of  the  animals  which  are  the  constant  object  of  their  affections 
or  their  fears.  The  sky  of  the  Nomade  tribes  will  be  peopled  with  dogs,  stags,  bulls,  and  wolves,  without 
its  being  at  all  conclusive  that  these  tribes  have  formerly  made  part  of  the  same  people.  But  the  asses 
and  the  tigers,  which  figure  among  the  hieroglyphics  of  the  days,  and  in  the  Mexican  tradition  of  the 
four  ages  or  destruction  of  the  sun,  do  not  inhabit  the  northern  part  of  New  Spain  and  the  north-west 
coast  of  America.  Consequently  the  signs  Ozomatli  and  Ocelotl  render  it  singularly  probable  that  the 

o 2 


100 


THE  CHAKKRAIA,  AND  THE  TOUR  ZODIACS. 


zodiacs  of  the  Toltecks,  the  Aztecks,  the  Mongols,  the  Tibetians,  and  many  other  nations  now  separated 
by  a vast  extent  of  country,  originated  in  one  and  the  same  point  of  the  ancient  continent. 

These  are  facts  which  more  immediately  concern  the  history  and  the  migrations  of  nations,  and  which 
appear  not  to  have  been  hitherto  examined ; whence  it  seems  extremely  probable  that  further  researches 
will  establish  the  opinion  of  M.  Humboldt,  that  a great  part  of  the  names  by  which  the  Mexicans  denoted 
the  twenty  days  of  their  month  are  those  of  a zodiac  in  use  from  the  remotest  antiquity  among  the 
nations  of  eastern  Asia. 

The  table  which  he  has  given  exhibits,  1st,  the  Mexican  hieroglyphical  names ; 2dly,  the  Tartarian, 
Japanese,  and  Tibetian,  names  of  the  twelve  signs  of  the  zodiac;  and,  3dly,  the  names  of  the 
Nakshastras,  or  lunar  houses,  of  the  calendar  of  the  Hindus.  Such  are  his  observations,  which,  with  the 
following,  from  the  same  master-mind,  cannot  be  too  attentively  considered.  The  division  of  the  ecliptic 
into  twenty-seven  or  twenty-eight  lunar  houses  is  probably  more  ancient  than  the  division  into  twelve 
parts,  which  relate  to  the  annual  motion  of  the  sun.  Phenomena,  repeated  every  lunation  in  the  same 
order,  lix  the  attention  of  men  much  more  strongly  than  changes  of  position,  the  cycle  of  which  is  finished 
only  in  the  space  of  a year.  As  the  moon  is  placed,  in  each  lunation,  near  the  same  stars,  it  appears 
natural  that  particular  names  should  be  given  to  the  twenty -seven  or  twenty-eight  constellations,  through 
which  she  passes  in  a synodical  revolution.  The  names  of  these  constellations  have  by  degrees  been  given 
to  the  lunar  days  themselves,  and  this  apparent  connexion  between  the  sign  and  the  day  is  become  the 
principal  basis  of  the  chimerical  calculations  of  astrology. 

On  an  attentive  examination  of  the  names  which  the  Nakshastras,  or  lunar  houses,  bear  in  Hindustan, 
we  recognise  in  them  not  only  all  the  names  of  the  Tartar  and  Tibetian  zodiacs,  but  also  those  of  several 
constellations  which  are  identical  with  the  signs  of  the  Greek  zodiac.* 

The  following  remarks  will  explain  the  Hindu  representation  given  in  the  second  volume  of  the 
Asiatic  Researches , which  takes  no  notice  whatever  of  the  various  combinations  whereby  are  represented, 
as  in  the  plates  here  given,  the  Nekates  of  the  Lunar  zodiac,  as  well  as  the  solar  zodiacal  signs  which  are 
derived  from  them.  The  twelve  months  bear  patronymic  names,  derived  from  the  twenty-seven 
constellations,  or  lunar  mansions,  called  Nakshastras  ; which  is  the  real  meaning  of  the  Guranas,  when,  in 
symbolic  language,  they  speak  of  twelve  genii  of  the  months,  born  of  twelve  celestial  nymphs,  the 
progeny  of  the  god  Soma,  or  Tchandra,  by  twenty-seven  females. 

The  lunar  month  is  composed  of  thirty  days  of  twenty-four  hours,  personified  as  so  many  nymphs. 
It  is  also  divided  into  two  periods  of  fifteen  days  each,  which  are  often  reckoned  for  months  of  fifteen 
days.  The  first  is  the  new  moon  Amava ; the  Other  the  full  moon  Poumima,  or  rather  the  increase 
Pourva-paksha,  or  the  decrease  Apara-paksha.  Each  has,  properly  speaking,  fourteen  days,  as  the  day  of 
the  new  moon  and  that  of  the  full  moon  are  not  counted.  The  seven  days  of  the  week  bear  the  names 
of  the  seven  planets. 

When  we  thus  trace  that  the  gods  which  preside  over  the  sun,  the  moon,  & c.  are  calendary  and 
astronomical  beings ; that  they  preside  at  the  same  moment  over  time  and  space,  and  in  conjunction  with 
the  heavens  and  the  earth,  with  the  stars  and  the  elements,  with  animals,  men,  &c.  we  cannot  hesitate  to 
suppose  that,  in  the  highest  spheres,  the  seven  or  fourteen  Menous,  the  seven  Richis,  the  ten  Maharichis, 


* Researches  concerning  the  Institutions  and  Monuments  of  the  Ancient  Inhabitants  of  America,  i.  347- 


the  chakkraia,  and  the  four  zodiacs. 


101 


named  also  Pradjapatis,  should  be  viewed  as  analagous  beings,  and  chiefly  as  constellations  of  superior 
rank,  to  which  have  been  attached  the  calculations  of  a transcendental  chronology,  whether  of 
metaphysical  conceptions,  moral,  or  purely  poetic ; and  perhaps  also  of  events  and  facts,  and  historic 
personages : but  most  commonly  the  construction  or  form  alone  is  historical ; the  ground-work  being 
framed  on  the  most  ancient  symbols  of  Sabeism,  or  rather  of  primitive  Pantheism. 

In  treating  of  the  Bali,  or  system  of  stellar  influences,  these  Nekates  will  be  seen  to  be  most 
intimately  interwoven  with  the  belief  of  magical  arts,  and  the  scrupulous  fears  which  are  entertained  by 
the  disciples  of  Budha  upon  even  the  most  trivial  actions  and  occurrences  of  their  lives  as  connected  with 
a view  of  their  operative  power.  * 

While  every  effort  has  been  made  to  bring  together  into  one  view  the  discordant  fragments  of  the 
Budhist  writings  on  astronomy,  and  to  exhibit  their  analogies  with  the  astronomical  data  of  other 
countries,  the  author  deeply  laments  that  the  sketch  still  seems  to  be  so  imperfect ; nevertheless,  no 
labour  has  been  spared,  and  if  the  materials  exhibited  should  excite  attention,  and  induce  an  abler  pen  to 
take  up  the  subject,  he  shall  experience  the  highest  gratification. 


CHAPTER  IX. 


THE  HELLS. 


Before  me  Things  create  were  none,  save*  Things 
Eternal,  and  eternal  I endure. 

We  are  come 

Where  I have  told  thee  we  shall  see  the  souls 
To  misery  doom'd,  who  intellectual  good 
Have  lost. 

Carey’s  Dante,  Canto  iii. 

Wisdom  supreme ! how  wonderful  the  art 
W hich  thou  dost  manifest  in  heaven,  in  earth. 

And  in  the  evil  world,  how  just  a meed 
Allotting  by  thy  virtue  unto  all ! 

Carey’s  Dante,  Canto  xix. 


1 «r  subject  which  next  m succession  arises  to  the  pen  is  unpleasing  and  distasteful;  its  representations 
are  disagreeable  and  even  revolting,  but  it  is  a part  of  Budhism  too  material  to  be  expunged  or 
passed  by;  and,  moreover,  its  admission  into  the  belief  of  every  age  and  clime  confirms  the  fundamental 
truth  of  man  s consciousness  of  a fall  and  deflection  from  a state  of  innocence  to  wickedness 

the  Bui?6*  rre : ,beCOmeS  ^ Chi6f  S°UrCe  Wh6nCe  ^ g*her  the  views  and  character  of 
e Budl  ist  morals,  as  the  doctrine  of  the  hells  and  their  varied  and  horrible  torments  are  in  feet  the 

sfronghoid  of  the  metempsychosis,  and  form  by  their  threatenings  the  only  coercive  portion  of  the 

Budhist  scheme.  Composed,  as  I have  before  ventured  to  suggest,  of  two  portions  of  feUh,  it  exhil  it 

a universe  without  a moral  governor,  director,  or  creator;  the  Budha  and  all  the  gods  performing  no 

o .er  function  than  that  of  exhortation  and  preaching,  and  holding  up  the  metempsychosis  and  punish 

, I LI  The  1 “ mitated  ^ ^ (Dam^>  — » - moral  oLLnora.  eondTt  of 
mankind.  The  scheme,  as  ,s  testified  by  one  who  has  had  the  best  opportunity  of  examining  it  • is 

TLlt  , I T Tr  T°ralS  °f  the  m°St  eXemplary  kind’  SUCh  as  — a blush  of  shame  in  many 
a Christian,  who  feels  h.s  higher  privileges,  while  he  considers  the  inferiority  of  his  practice;  buIZ 


over  the  heart,  or  restraint  on  the  p^lilTThTu  oh t forbids” f natio”s-  visit  Burma],.  The  system  of  religion  here  has  no  power 

to  say,  there  is  not  a si„gle  Birman  in  the  connUy  who  if  he  hml  ” ma"y  ^ *»  h«U>  ^ ^ood,  yet  I presun, e 

either.  Though  the  religion  i„culcates  benevolence  tenderness  f ^ tvithout  danger  of  detection,  would  hesitate  to  do 

love  of  pleasure,  and  attachment  to  worldly  objects'  yet  it  is  destine T"  'nJUr,<?S’  “nd  ‘°Ve  °f  f,,omies-th»uS1' forbids  sensuality, 

votanes.  In  short,  ,he  Birman  system  of  religion  is  like  an  alabaster  i m ^ ! f°rmer'  " *°  SUbdue  thc  in 

Besides  bemg  destitute  of  life,  it  provides  no  atonement  for  sin.  Here  • ki,  Th  “f  beaUt'f“1 “U  its  I’arts>  but  destitute  of  life, 
the  world." — Jud son's  Narrative,  96.  “ "r  ^ dU°‘  the  g°Spi;1  ,riumPhs  0VM  thin  and  every  other  religion  in’ 


THE  HELLS. 


103 


system  is  absolutely  powerless  to  enforce  or  fasten  its  dictates  upon  the  conscience,  or  to  renovate  the 
heart,  and  the  result  is  described  in  strong  but  faithful  colours  by  Mr.  Judson. 

lhe  word  hell,  * here  used,  denominative  of  the  mansion  of  condemned  demons  and  mortals,  does 
not  impoit  a place  of  eternal  woe,  as  it  is  understood  by  us;  but  merely  an  abode  of  purgatorial 
penances,  more  or  less  severe,  and  of  longer  or  shorter  duration,  as  the  crimes  of  the  individuals  may 
seem  to  require.  Gaudma’s  precepts  and  doctrine  treat  these  terrible  scenes,  sad  as  they  are,  rather  as 
correctives f than  as  immutable,  since  it  is  declared  of  the  demons  that  none  are  so  lost  but  that  by  good 
deeds,  and  repenting  of  evil,  they  may  by  degrees  arrive  at  the  being  born  into  the  manepeoloke  or  earth, 
whence  by  transmigrations  they  may  arrive  in  the  Brahma  Loka,  and  attain  Nirwana ; and  also  no  god 
is  so  exalted  (while  short  of  Nirwana-pooraya),  that  he  may  not  commit  sins  so  as  to  fall  into  the  lowest 
hells.  The  system  comprises  all  in  a circle,  and,  as  the  adage  expresses  it,  meets  in  extremes. 

I he  hells  approximate  to  the  heavens,  and  the  centre  of  the  whole  system  of  the  universe  is  of 
adamantine  rock,  termed  the  Mienmo,  or  the  mountain  of  vision,  the  Maha-meru  or  great  world  stone, 
the  base  of  the  earth,  which,  as  its  supporter,  spans  over  primaeval  ether,  bearing  up  not  merely  earth,  but 
air,  and  skies.  Beneath  this  vast  arch  lie  the  hells,  or  Asura  mansions,  wherein  are  the  demonstrations  of 
the  incorruptible  ether,  the  same  as  in  the  empyrean  above  the  Brahma  Loka,  or  highest  heavens ; for  the 


• Hell,  as  a term,  is  a Saxon  word,  derived  from  hillan  or  helan,  to  hide,  or  from  hoi l,  a cavern,  and  though  now  scarcely  ever  used 
but  for  the  place  of  torment,  anciently  denoted  the  concealed  or  unseen  place  of  the  dead  in  general  ; as  is  manifest  from  the  version 
of  Psalms,  xlix.  1-1 — lvi.  16 — lxxxviii.  9 — lxxxix.  44,  in  King  Henry  VIII. 's  great  bible,  which  is  retained  in  our  liturgy;  and  so 
it  ought  to  be  understood  in  other  parts  of  that  translation.  It  nearly  corresponds  with  Hades,  the  invisible  place ; and  with  the  Hebrew 
Sheol,  the  invisible  state  of  the  dead,  “ the  place  and  state  of  those  who  are  out  of  the  way,  and  to  be  sought  for from  shaal  to  ask, 
require,  seek. 

t “ The  form  of  oath  administered  is  not  only  a curiosity  in  itself,  but  strikingly  illustrative  of  the  religious  opinions  and  character  of 
the  people,  and  therefore  I shall  transcribe  it  from  the  translation  of  Captain  Lowe.  It  is  as  follows: — “ I,  who  have  been  brought  here  as 
an  evidence  in  this  matter,  do  now,  in  presence  of  the  divine  Phrah-Phutt'hi-rop  (Budha),  declare  that  I am  wholly  unprejudiced  against 
either  party,  and  uninfluenced  in  any  way  by  the  opinions  or  advice  of  others,  and  that  no  prospects  of  pecuniary  advantage,  or  of  advance- 
ment to  office,  have  been  held  out  to  me  ; I also  declare  that  I have  not  received  any  bribe  on  this  occasion.  If  what  I have  now  spoken 
be  false,  or  if  in  my  further  averments  I should  colour  or  pervert  the  truth,  so  as  to  lead  the  judgment  of  others  astray,  may  the  three  holy 
existences,  viz.,  Budha,  lhe  Bali  (personified),  and  the  priests,  before  whom  I now  stand,  together  with  the  glorious  Dewatas  (demi-gods) 
of  the  twenty-two  ^firmaments,*  punish  me.  If  I have  not  seen,  yet  shall  say  that  I have  seen;  if  I shall  say  that  I know  that  which 
I do  not  know ; then  may  I be  thus  punished.  Should  innumerable  descents  of  the  deity  happen  for  the  regeneration  and  salvation  of 
mankind,  may  my  erring  and  migrating  soul  be  found  beyond  the  pale  of  their  mercy.  Wherever  I go,  may  I be  encompassed  with  dangers, 
and  not  escape  from  them,  whether  arising  from  murderers,  robbers,  spirits  of  the  earth,  of  the  woods,  of  water,  or  of  air,  or  from  all  the 
divinities  who  adore  Budha,  or  from  the  gods  of  the  four  elements,  and  all  other  spirits ! May  blood  flow  out  of  every  pore  of  my  body, 
that  my  crime  may  be  made  manifest  to  the  world ; may  all  or  any  of  these  evils  overtake  me  within  three  days,  or  may  I never  stir  from 
the  spot  on  which  I now  stand,  or  may  the  natsani,  or  lash  of  the  sky  (lightning)  cut  me  in  two,  so  that  I may  be  exposed  to  the  derision 
of  the  people ! Or  if  I should  be  walking  abroad,  may  I be  torn  in  pieces  by  either  of  the  four  supernaturally  endowed  lions,  or  destroyed 
by  venomous  herbs  or  poisonous  snakes ! If  in  the  waters  of  the  rivers  or  ocean,  may  supernatural  crocodiles  or  great  Ashes  devour 
me,  or  may  the  winds  and  waves  overwhelm  me;  or  may  the  dread  of  such  evils  keep  me,  during  life,  a prisoner  at  home,  estranged  from 
every  pleasure;  or  may  I be  afflicted  by  the  intolerable  oppressions  of  my  superiors,  or  may  a plague  cause  my  death ; after  which,  may  I 
be  precipitated  into  hell,  there  to  go  through  innumerable  stages  of  torture,  amongst  which,  may  I be  condemned  to  carry  water  over  the 
flaming  regions  iu  open  wicker-baskets  to  assuage  the  heat  felt  by  Than-Wetsuwan,  when  lie  enters  the  infernal  hall  of  justice ; and 
thereafter  may  I fall  into  the  lowest  pit  of  hell : or  if  these  miseries  should  not  ensue,  may  I after  death  migrate  into  the  body  of  a slave, 
and  suffer  all  the  hardships  and  pain  attending  the  worse  state  of  such  a being,  during  a period  of  years  measured  by  the  sand  of  four 
seas ; or  may  I animate  the  body  of  an  animal,  or  beust,  during  five  hundred  generations,  or  be  born  an  hermaphrodite  five  hundred 
times,  or  endure  in  the  body  of  a deaf,  dumb,  houseless  beggar,  every  species  of  disease  during  the  same  number  of  generations,  and  then 
may  I be  hurried  to  Narak,  or  hell,  and  there  be  crucified  by  Plma-Yain,  one  of  the  kings  of  hell  V'—Crawfurd's  Mission  to  Siam,  392. 


• Gods  of  the  Dewa  and  Brahma  Loka. 


104 


THE  HELLS. 


Budha's  doctrine  mentions  the  Zian  of  the  Asura  Loka,  which  survives  the  catastrophe  of  the  world  in 
the  same  manner  as  the  Zian  of  Nirwana;  and  further  establishes  it  by  passages  in  the  part  referring  to 
the  hell  Awichiya,  wherein  rebels  to  the  Budha,  if  unrepentant,  shall  be  punished  for  ever,  beyond  the 
duration  of  this  world,  and  throughout  the  next  succeeding  system  or  Budhas.  In  conformity  with  this 
passage,  the  doctrine  declares  that  those  who  acquire  the  gift  of  Zian  shall  see  other  teachers  (new  Budhas) 
arise.  The  metempsychosis  then  is  the  probation  for  gods  as  for  men,  and  fire  (the  element  which  purifies 
every  thing)  the  agent,  as  none  of  the  punishments  are  without  this  primary  element* 

The  hell  of  the  Budha  implies  the  same  thing  as  the  Tartarus  of  the  Grecian  poets,  but  is  not,  like 
it,  shut  and  barred  in  by  adamantine  gates,  which  neither  gods  nor  men  can  open.  It  is  in  fact  a 
probationary  state,  refining  by  fire,  whence  the  penitent  may  transmigrate  into  the  system  of  the  Dewa 
Loka,  through  the  Hades.  Thus  also  the  Greeks  and  the  Egyptians  held  a system  of  doctrine  in  perfect 
accordance  with  that  of  Budhism ; they  had  a Hades  or  Orcus  distinct  from  the  place  of  punishment ; 
the  former  in  the  central  parts  of  the  earth’s  hollow  sphere  (the  abode  of  Wapawaitei-raja,  the  refractory 
Asura  demon,  a character  apart  from  Wepetziethe-asura,  or  the  hellish  demon  as  he  is  termed),  a 
very  different  abode  from  the  Tartarus,  a place  below  the  abyss,  under  the  hellish  waters.  These  two 
divisions , m Budhist,  Egyptian,  and  Grecian  doctrine,  formed  in  fact  one  region  under  the  earth,  divided 
from  it,  and  rendered  invisible  to  our  eyes  by  the  shell  or  crust  of  the  terraqueous  globe. 

The  place  of  the  dead  then,  in  Budha  doctrine,  is  either  in  the*  bliss  of  Nirwana,  in  the  empyrean  or 
Zian,  or  in  the  starry  sphere,  the  abode  of  gods,  the  Brahma  Loka,  progressing  to  the  Zian  ; or  in  Hades, 

the  Dewa  Loka,  as  often  as  the  favourable  transmigration  occurs;  or  in  the  hells,  as  a purifying  and 
retributive  process. 

We  find  a feature  of  this  retributive  system  in  the  sublime  dr  ama  of  Prometheus  Chained,  which 
Potter  thus  translates : — 

“ Expect  no  pause,  no  respite,  till  some  god 
Conies  to  relieve  thy  pains,  willing  to  pass 
The  dreary  realms  of  ever-during  night. 

The  dark  descent  of  Erebus  profound.” 


“ The  scholiast  explains  this  passage  by  saying,  that  whoever  should  attempt  to  succour  Prometheus, 
and  deliver  him  from  his  pain,  should  himself  he  sent  to  tire  shades  of  Orcus,  and  the  dark  abyss  of 
Tartarus.  The  words  are  very  remarkable;  for  want  of  a better  explication  of  them,  we  must  take  up 
with  this.”  (Potter’s  Eschylus,  4to.  note,  p.  639.)  The  learned  translator  in  this  quotation  seems  puzzled 

with  *thTi,U5'  !D  a dTma  TP°Sed  Clearly  °"  the  SranJinavian  doctrine<  as  historic  tradition,  we  may  trace  a conformity 

with  th»  tenet,  wh.ch  rnns  throughout  this  kindred  system  with  the  spirit  of  Budhism.  contorm.ty 


“ Ghost.  My  hour  is  almost  come. 

When  I to  sulphurous  and  tormenting  flames 
Must  render  up  myself. 

I am  thy  father’s  spirit. 
Doom  d for  a certain  time  to  walk  the  night. 
And  for  the  day  confin'd  to  fast  in  fires; 
rill  the  foul  crimes  done  in  my, days  of  nature, 
Are  burnt  and  purg’d  away.” 


THE  HELLS. 


105 

to  clear  up  this  passage,  considering  it  a transcript  of  ancient  doctrine  from  the  East.  I should  deem  the 
crime  of  Prometheus  against  Jupiter  to  be  contumacy,  such  as  is  committed  by  the  impious  (Asiatic 
Researches,  vi.  218),  whose  doom  to  the  most  terrible  of  hells  is  made  eternal,  unless  (as  Mercury 
endeavours  to  persuade  Prometheus  to  do)  they  repent  and  acknowledge  their  superior;  then  the  deliver- 
ance takes  place,  on  which  this  passage  turns,  conformably  to  the  following  extract  from  a lludhist 
manuscript  of  doctrine  lhe  devils  who  die,  and  are  born  again  as  men,  and  commit  no  more  sin,  can 
(by  transmigration)  arrive  at  the  state  of  felicity”  (Nirwana),  the  change  offered  to  Prometheus  if  he 
will  yield  to  the  will  or  decree  of  Jupiter. 

Immediately  after  death  the  judgment  is  pronounced  by  Yaine-raja,  the  god  of  the  heaven  Wasse- 
warty-raja,  upon  such  mortal  beings,  as,  having  enthralled  their  souls  by  a mixture  of  good  and  evil,  yet 
entertain  a hope  to  come  into  the  Brahma  Loka ; but  the  thoroughly  wicked  go  to  the  hell  unheard,  and 
even  without  approaching  the  tribunal  of  the  judge. 

Before  the  gate  of  each  great  hell  sit  the  judges  who  condemn  the  guilty  according  to  the  weight 
of  their  evil  deeds.  These  judges  are  selected  from  the  Nat  Asura ; but  their  office  does  not  exclude 
either  them  or  their  assistants  from  enjoying  the  pleasures  of  their  happy  companions.  These  judges 
have  no  occasion  to  examine  into  crimes  of  a very  atrocious  nature;  the  weight  of  these  sink  the 
perpetrators  at  once  into  hell. 

The  worshippers  of  Budha,  when  bestowing  alms,  or  performing  other  good  deeds,  commonly  use 
the  action  of  pouring  forth  a little  water  on  the  ground,  as  emblematical  of  their  wishing  to  partake  of 
the  merit  of  good  actions  with  other  beings ; and  criminals  who,  during  life,  performed  this  ceremony,  the 
judge  will  raise  up,  assuage  their  fears,  and  exempt  from  the  torments  of  hell,  unless  they  have  been 
guilty  of  great  crimes.  To  those  who  neglect  this  performance,  he  will,  with  a horrible  countenance, 
declare  that  they  have  done  no  good  actions  ; the  criminal  all  trembling  will  not  dare  to  offer  any 
excuse,  and  the  demons  will  snatch  him  away  to  punishment.* 

It  is  declared  that  there  are  four  states  of  misery : — 1st.  That  of  animals,  whether  they  live  in  the 
water,  or  on  the  earth,  or  fly  in  the  air ; the  state  of  all  animals  inferior  to  man  is  a state  of  misery. 

The  2nd  miserable  state  is,  that  of  the  beings  called  Preitta,  who,  as  wandering  spirits  in  woods  and 
deserts,  are  wasted  by  hunger  and  nakedness,  and  pass  the  whole  duration  of  a world  in  howling  and 
groans.  In  a future  life  those  come  into  this  state,  who  give  no  daily  provisions  to  the  priests, f who  do 
not  supply  them  with  clothing,  corrupt  their  manners,  or  offer  violence  to  their  persons,  who  give  abusive 
language  to  the  observers  of  the  laws,  &c. 

3rd.  The  Assurighe,  the  same  miserable  species,  residing  in  woods  and  on  the  desert  coasts  of  the  sea. 


* See  Asiatic  Researches,  vi.  218. 

t It  is  very  curious  to  contrast  the  threatening  doctrine  of  this  dreadful  punishment  for  all  who  in  any  degree  neglect  the  sacerdotal 
class  with  the  following  practice.  The  Rhahans,  or  sacerdotal  class,  are  required  by  the  doctrine  to  eat  that  food  which  is  procured  by  the 
labour  and  motion  of  the  muscles  of  the  feet.  Every  morning,  as  soon  as  the  Rhahans  can  distinguish  the  veins  on  their  hands,  they  issue 
from  their  convent,  each  with  his  sabeit  under  his  arm.  They  spread  themselves  along  the  streets  and  villages,  and  as  they  pass  along, 
stop  a little  at  the  different  doors,  but  without  saying  a word.  Whatever  is  proffered  is  put  into  the  sabeit,  and  the  Rhahnn  goes  on  silent, 
and  without  returning  thanks,  nor  does  he  ever  solicit.  So  delicate  are  they  in  this  particular,  that  it  is  sinful  for  a Rhahanon  such 
occasions  to  cough,  or  make  any  signal,  by  which  he  might  be  supposed  to  put  the  laity  in  mind  of  their  duty.  Asiatic  Researches, 
vi.  284. 


P 


106 


THE  HELLS. 


Those  are  subject  to  this  punishment,  who,  in  their  quarrels,  strike  with  sticks  or  destructive  weapons. 
The  duration  of  these  three  Ape  is  not  fixed,  but  depends  on  the  lot  of  the  evil  actions. 

The  4th,  Niria,  is  properly  the  infernal  regions,  and  is  placed  beneath  the  depths  of  the  earth  in  the 
midst  of  the  great  rock  Sila-pathavy. 

In  the  lesser  hells,  which  are  called  by  one  common  name,  Ussautrek,  are  punished  those  who  do  not 
honour  their  parents,  the  magistrates,  and  old  age ; who  take  wine  and  inebriating  liquors ; who  corrupt 
wells ; who  destroy  highways ; who  are  fraudulent  and  deceitful ; who  speak  angrily  and  roughly  ; who 
use  personal  violence ; who  pay  little  attention  to  the  words  of  pious  men ; who  afflict  others ; who 
propagate  scandal ; who  chain,  bind,  or  fetter,  their  fellow-creatures ; who  admit  forbidden  things  into 
their  words,  actions,  or  desires;  and  who  do  not  solace  the  sick.  All  these  will  be  punished,  propor- 
tionably  to  the  atrocity  of  the  deed  and  the  frequency  of  its  repetition;  and  they  will  suffer  also  in 
another  hell,  compared  in  shape  to  a kettle  of  molten  brass,  where  they  are  three  thousand  years  in 
descending  to  the  bottom,  and  three  thousand  years  in  ascending. 

To  this  horrible  state  are  condemned  the  sensual,  the  corrupters  of  the  wives,  sons,  or  daughters,  of 
others ; or  those  who,  during  the  course  of  their  lives,  neglect  to  observe  the  holy  days,  and  to  give  alms, 
or  who  pass  their  time  in  feasting,  drunkenness,  or  lascivious  enjoyments. 

The  very  highest  of  the  beings  may,  on  account  of  bad  actions,  sink  into  the  infernal  regions,  or 
on  account  of  good  ones  be  raised  to  a higher  rank ; but  it  is  only  on  earth  that  Nirwana,  the 
most  perfect  of  states,  can  be  obtained.  To  arrive  at  Nirwana,  a person  must  see  a Budha,  and  hearken 
to  his  discourses  and  evidences,  and  it  is  only  in  the  human  world  that  Budhas  arise ; consequently  the 
earth  is  called  the  ford  of  Nirwana,  the  pass  and  the  ascent  to  Nirwana. 

The  Budhist  doctrine  declares,  that  “ the  hell  is  concealed  under  the  abyss  of  the  earth,  and  is  under 
the  hellish  water,  and  there  the  winds  blow  stronger  than  ever  a hurricane  can  do  upon  earth.” 

A very  curious  and  interesting  examination  and  comparison  arises  from  the  close  conformity  with 
Budhist  doctrines  which  may  be  traced  throughout  the  whole  extent  of  Dante’s  highly  figurative  vision 
of  the  Inferno , as  far  as  concerns  the  punishments.  Thus  the  following  extract  from  Carey’s  translation 
of  this  sublime  poet,  parallels  the  tempest  which  rages  in  the  pandemonium  of  the  Budhist  doctrine : 


“ Into  a place  I came 

Where  light  was  absent  all.  Bellowing  there  groan’d 
A noise,  as  of  a sea  in  tempest  torn 
By  warring  winds.  The  stormy  blast  of  hell 
With  restless  fury  drives  the  spirits  on, 

WThirl’d  round  and  dash'd  amain  with  sore  annoy.” 

Caret)  s Dante,  Canto  v.  29. 

The  Budhist  doctrine  teaches  that  there  are  eight  large  hells,  and  the  following  are  the  crimes  which 
doom  their  unhappy  inmates  to  such  terrible  inflictions. 

1.  The  hell  Sanga-waya  (plate  26),  for  cruelty,  quarrelsome  drunkenness,  dishonesty  in  thought, 
word,  or  deed,  or  lasciviousness. 

2.  Kale-soottraya  (plate  26),  for  those  who  ridicule  or  contemn  their  parents,  the  magistrates,  the 
Rhahans,  old  men,  or  the  studious  of  the  law,  or  who  entrap  fish  or  animals  with  nets  and  snares. 


THE  HELLS. 


107 


* 3.  Sanga-hattaya  (plate  26)*  for  sellers  of  oxen,  swine,  goats,  or  such  animals,  or  hunters  by 
profession,  warlike  kings,  ministers  or  governors  who  oppress  the  people. 

4.  ltaura-waya  (plate  26),  for  those  who  do  not  mutually  assist  their  neighbours,  but  deceive  them, 
who  kill  animals,  and  are  drunkards  and  indecent. 

5.  Maha-raurawaya  (plate  27), f for  those  who  are  guilty  of  fraud,  violence,  theft;  unjust  and  bribed 
magistrates;  officers,  who,  after  acquiring  an  enemy’s  country,  destroy  the  inhabitants;  those  who  use 
unjust  weights  and  measures,  and  unjust  appropriates  of  other  men’s  goods. 

6.  Taw-paya  (plate  27).  Killers  of  hogs,  deer,  or  such  animals,  or  those  who  make  arms,  bum  towns 
or  villages,  or  kill  men  by  poison  or  incantations,  or  animals  by  nets  or  gins. 

7.  Puttaw-paya  (plate  27)4  The  Deitti,  or  infidels  hereafter  named. 

8.  Awe-cheya  (plate  27).  Parricides,  matricides,  and  such  as  have  the  heavy  lot. 

Each  of  these  large  hells  has,  towards  the  four  cardinal  points,  four  gates  leading  to  as  many  smaller 
hells,  which  again  have  appertaining  to  them  what  is  usually  called  Oessidderane-kaddie,  making  together 
a hundred  and  twenty-eight  lesser  hells,  besides  the  eight  chief  regions  of  punishment. 

The  enclosures  to  these  places  of  penal  woe,  as  well  to  the  small  as  the  larger  ones,  are  said  to  be 
square,  and  made  of  iron,  § the  walls  being  thirty-six  miles  thick , and  the  ground  and  roof  also  of  the 
same  thickness. 


* The  twenty-sixth  canto  of  the  Inferno  shows  the  eighth  gulf,  wherein  are  punished  the  evil  counsellors. 

“As  the  peasant. 

Upon  some  cliff  reclined,  beneath  him  sees 
Fire-flies  innumerous  spangling  o’er  the  vale, 

Vineyard,  or  tilth,  where  his  day-labour  lies  ; 

With  flames  so  numberless  throughout  its  space 
Shone  the  eighth  chasm,  apparent,  when  the  depth 

Was  to  my  view  exposed."  Dante,  Canto  xxvi.  276. 

+ “ ' Within  these  rocks,'  he  thus  began, 

‘ Are  three  close  circles  in  gradation  placed, 

As  those  which  now  thou  leavest.  Each  one  is  full 
Of  spirits  accursed. 

Of  all  malicious  act  abhorr’d  in  heaven. 

The  end  is  injury ; and  all  such  end 
Either  by  fraud  or  force  works  others’  woe. 

Dissimulation,  witchcraft,  flatteries. 

Theft,  falsehood,  simony,  all  who  seduce 
To  lust,  or  set  their  honesty  at  yawn, 

With  such  vile  scum  as  these. 

But  in  another  path 

The  usurer  walks ; and  Nature  in  herself 
And  in  her  follower  thus  he  sets  at  nought. 

Placing  elsewhere  his  hope.’  " Dante,  Canto  xi.  118. 

+ “ Amidst  the  graves  were  scatter’d  flames, 

Wherewith  intensely  all  throughout  they  burn’d, 

That  iron  for  no  craft  there  hotter  needs. 

The  arch-heretics  are  here,  accompanied 

By  every  sect  their  followers.1’  Dante,  Canto  ix.  116. 

§ “ The  minarets  already 

There,  certes,  in  the  valley  I descry. 


108 


THE  HELLS. 


As  to  the  condemned,  the  torments  in  the  chief  hells  are  more  severe,  and  in  the  smaller  oneS  less 
so ; but  in  the  eighth,  Awichiya,  they  are  the  greatest  and  most  dreadful,  as  they  ought  to  be,  and  they 
are  inflicted  by  the  chief  demon,  the  god  Wassreusenne,  with  his  followers,  upon  the  condemned,  with 
tools  or  instruments  for  the  purpose,  namely,  bills,  sledge-hammers,  bone-breakers,  hammers,  pincers,  spits, 
and  so  forth,  whereby  the  skin  is  pulled  off  from  head  to  foot,  and  melted  lead  is  poured  upon  them. 

The  various  punishments  which  are  inflicted  are  also  particularly  applied  by  the  Greek  and  Italian 
poets  to  the  same  class  of  crimes.  Their  character  is  explained  from  the  twofold  source  of  an  original 
Budhist  manuscript,  and  from  Dr.  Buchanan’s  statement  in  the  Asiatic  Researches , vi. 

Of  the  eight  hells,  called  in  Singalese  Attamaha-narakawdi  — 

The  hell  called  Sajewaya  is  the  place  of  the  damned,  where  they  are  cut  in  pieces  by  several  sorts  of 
weapons,  and  brought  to  life  again.*  Here  they  will  be  torn  to  pieces  by  glowing  hot  irons,  and  then 
exposed  to  intense  cold ; after  a time  their  limbs  will  again  unite,  and  again  be  torn  asunder  and  exposed 
to  the  cold  ;f  and  this  alternation  of  misery  will  endure  for  five  hundred  infernal  years. — Asiatic 
Researches,  vi.  220. 

The  hell  called  Calla-soottraya  is  the  place  where  the  damned  are  hewn  with  red-hot  axes.  On  a 
bed  of  fire  they  will  be  extended,  and,  like  so  many  trunks  of  trees,  with  burning  iron  saws  and  hooks 
they  will  be  cut  into  eight  or  ten  pieces,  for  one  thousand  infernal  years. 

The  hell  called  Sangahataya  is  the  place  where  the  damned  are  squeezed  with  red-hot  iron  rocks,); 


Gleaming  vermilion,  as  if  they  from  fire 
Had  issued.  He  replied : ‘ Eternal  fire, 

That  inward  burns,  shows  them  with  ruddy  flame 
Illumed,  as  in  this  nether  hell  thou  seest. 

We  came  within  the  fosses  deep,  that  moat 
This  region  comfortless.  The  walls  appear’d 

As  they  were  framed  of  iron/”  Dante,  Canto  viii.  68. 


* “ If,  in  one  band 

Collected,  stood  the  people  all,  who  e’er 
Pour'd  on  Apulia's  happy  soil  their  blood  ; 

A spectacle  like  this 

Were  but  a thing  of  nought,  to  the  hideous  sight 
Of  the  ninth  chasm. 

A fiend  is  here  behind,  shivering  again 
Each  of  this  crowd,  for  first  our  gashes  close 

Ere  we  repose  before  him.”  Dante,  Canto  xxviii. 

t I come 

To  take  you  to  the  other  shore  across, 

Into  eternal  darkness,  there  to  dwell 

In  fiercest  heat  and  ice.”  Dante,  Canto  iii. 

<l  The  bitter  change 

Of  fierce  extremes,  extremes  by  change  more  fierce, 

From  beds  of  raging  fire  to  starve  in  ice 

Their  soft  ethereal  warmth.”  Milton,  Par.  Lost,  Book  ii.  601 . 

“ The  delighted  spirit 
To  bathe  in  fiery  floods,  or  to  reside 

In  thrilling  regions  of  thick-ribbed  ice.”  Shakspeare,  Measure  for  Measure 

X “ The  prodigal  and  avaricious— 

Even  as  a billow,  on  Charybdis  rising, 

Against  encountering  billow  dashing  breaks  ; 


THE  HELLS. 


100 

which  roll  from  the  four  sides  of  the  hell.  They  will  be  ground  between  four  burning  mountains  for 
two  thousand  years. 

The  hell  called  Raury  waya,  is  the  place  where  the  damned  are  tormented  by  the  flame  having  entered 
into  their  body  through  the  nine  openings  of  the  body.  They  will  have  their  hearts  consumed  by  fire 

entering  their  mouths,  &c.  for  four  thousand  years. 

# 

The  hell  called  Maha-raurawaya  is  the  place  where  the  damned  undergo  great  misery,  tears  red  as 
blood  and  hot  as  fire  proceeding  from  their  eyes.  Fire  and  smoke  will  enter  their  bodies  by  the  eyes, 
mouth,  and  other  openings,  and  waste  them  away  for  eight  thousand  years. 

The  hell  called  Taw-paya  is  the  place  where  the  damned  are  tormented  by  being  fixed  on  red-hot 
iron  pins,  which  are  fastened  to  the  red-hot  iron  floor,  without  allowing  them  to  stir.  They  will  be 
tumbled  down  headlong  from  a lofty  burning  mountain,  then  being  transfixed  on  an  iron  spit,  they  will 
be  cut  and  torn  by  the  demons  with  swords  and  spears  for  sixteen  thousand  years. 

The  hell  called  Prataw-paya  is  the  place  where  the  damned  are  tormented  as  aforesaid  by  dragging 
and  by  removing,  that  is  to  say,  they  are  placed  on  the  red-hot  iron  rocks,  and  being  unable  to  stand  on 
them,  they  fall  down  headlong  on  the  red-hot  iron  floor,  from  which  protrude  red-hot  iron  spikes  as 
large  as  palmeira  logs.  They  will  be  first  fixed  with  their  heads  downwards,  and  then  transfixed  with 
red-hot  spits  as  large  as  palm-trees.* 

The  hell  called  Maha-awicliiya  is  the  place  of  the  damned,  who  are  burnt  constantly  by  the  fire 
which  proceeds  in  an  immense  quantity  from  every  side  of  that  hell,  by  which  fire  the  extent  of  a 
hundred  yodoons  of  the  hell  is  filled  up.  They  will  be  punished  for  a whole  world  in  the  most  terrible 
of  all  hells,  the  pavement  of  which,  nine  juzana  in  thickness,  is  of  red-hot  iron,  and  emits  the  most  horrible 
smoke,  and  the  most  piercing  flame. 

The  duration  of  punishment  is  not  immutable,  nor  even  for  a fixed  period,  but  depends  upon  the  lot 
of  bad  actions : of  this  class  four  lots  are  heavy  and  three  are  light.  The  evil  deeds  which  after  death 
produce  the  heavy  lot,  are  chiefly  five : — 

1.  Matricide. 

2.  Parricide. 

3.  Slaying  a Rhahan. 


Such  is  the  dance  this  wretched  race  must  lead, 
Whom  more  than  elsewhere  numerous  here  I found. 
From  one  side  and  the  other,  with  loud  voice. 

Both  roll’d  on  weights,  by  main  force  of  their  breasts, 
Then  smote  together." 

• “ I saw  the  livid  stone,  throughout  the  sides, 

And  in  its  bottom  full  of  apertures. 

All  equal  in  their  width,  and  circular  each. 

From  out  the  mouth 
Of  every  one  emerged  a sinner’s  foot. 

And  of  the  legs  high  upward  as  the  calf. 

The  rest  beneath  was  hid.  On  either  foot 

The  soles  were  burning.  &c. As  flame, 

Feeding  on  unctuous  matter,  glides  along 
The  surface,  scarcely  touching  where  it  moves, 

So  here  from  heel  to  point  glided  the  flames 


Dante,  Canto  vii.  22. 


Dante , Canto  xix.  14. 


110 


TIIE  HELLS. 


4.  Striking  a god.  Thus  Devadat,* * * §  the  name  by  which  the  Rhahans  call  Jesus  Christ,  incurred  the 
heavy  lot  by  throwing  a stone  at  Gaudma .—Asiatic  Researches , vi.  268. 

5.  Those  who  excite  dissensions  among  the  Rhahans. 

These  suffer  for  the  duration  of  one  world  the  punishment  of  fire  in  the  great  hells. 

The  lot  of  the  impious  persons  called  Deitti  is  even  more  severe ; these  are^  they  w ho  have 
discredited  the  evidences  of  Gaudma  or  of  some  former  Budha ; who  deny  Nirwana,f  or  the  transmigration* 
of  men  into  animals,  or  into  superior  being's,  according  to  the  merit  of  their  actions ; who  teach  that 
there  is  no  merit  in  bestowing  alms,  or  performing  the  works  commanded  by  the  Budha ;§  or  who  adore 
the  Nat  gods  ||  of  the  woods  and  mountains.  All  such  persons,  if  they  persist  in  their  infidelity  and 
irreligion,  will  be  tormented,  not  for  the  duration  of  one  world,  but  to  all  eternity.  After  the  world  is 
destroyed,  they  will  pass  to  other  places,  or  be  eternally  punished  in  the  air. 

The  doctrine  contained  in  this  passage  on  the  punishments  of  the  Deitti,  compared  with  the  contents 
of  the  Kammuva,  or  book  of  ordination  for  admission  into  the  priesthood,  and  combined  with  the 
personal  attributes  of  the  Budha,  throws  a strong  light  upon  the  history  of  this  faith,  by  showing  its 
changes,  and  the  vast  importance  attached  to  their  repression.  The  Budha  is  uniformly  declared  to  have 
assumed  that  rank  by  his  own  free  will,  omniscience,  and  power;  a tenet,  indeed,  which  the  ambitious 
and  crafty  among  this  sect  have  not  been  backward  to  avail  themselves  of.  Almost  within  our  present 
era  a case  in  point  may  be  adduced,  in  the  founder  of  the  reigning  dynasty  of  Burmah,  now  of  about 
seventy  years  standing.  Alaoung,  or  Alaoung  Praw,  was  of  low  extraction,  a native  of  the  district  of 
Montzaboo,  on  the  upper  branch  of  the  Irrawady,  at  the  period  when  the  superior  forces  of  the  Pegu 
monarchy  defeated  his  countrymen,  subjugated  the  capital,  dragged  the  king  into  captivity,  and  fixed  the 


* To  any  one  who  is  desirous  of  tracing  the  aptitude  of  eastern  teachers  to  seize  any  imagery  in  any  faith  which  may  be  deemed 
beneficial  for  the  protection  of  their  own  ritual  and  the  exclusion  of  any  new  doctrine,  the  legend  of  Devadat,  in  La  Loubere’s  Siam,  will 
be  very  interesting : it  has  every  character  of  being  arranged  by  the  priests  after  the  arrival  and  settlement  of  the  Portuguese,  and 
is  calculated  to  neutralize  the  effects  of  the  splendid  services  and  ritual  of  the  Romish  Church,  established  in  great  magnificence  by  them 
in  India. — La  Loubere’s  Siam,  1663,  p.  148,  where  he  is  called  Tlievetat. 

+ This  alludes  to  the  heretical  doctrine,  that  all  living  beings  had  their  beginning  in  their  mother’s  womb,  and  will  have  their  end 
death ; and  that  there  is  no  other  N invan  a but  this  death.  This  heresy  pronounces  Nirwana  to  be  absolute  deatli  and  annihilation, 
which  the  doctrine  declares  altogether  to  be  false ; using  a singularly  strong  term — “ It  is  easy  with  your  nails,  or  with  megnap,  to  take 
a thorn  out  of  your  feet  or  hands,  but  it  is  very  difficult  to  pluck  forth  from  the  minds  of  men  the  doctrines  of  false  gods  or  teachers.” 

X The  notion  here  condemned,  that  after  death  men  are  not  changed  into  animals,  and  that  animals  on  being  slain  are  not  changed 
into  men,  but  that  after  death  men  are  always  born  men,  and  animals  born  animals,  impugns  altogether  the  doctrine  of  the  metempsychosis, 
and,  in  fact,  subverts  Budhism  ; but  as  this  doctrine,  so  introduced  and  followed  in  opposition  to  the  metempsychosis,  was  anterior  to 
Gaudma,  because  he  is  declared  to  have  fought  with  these  teachers  in  the  kingdom  Saultie,  near  the  Manche,  it  seems  to  manifest  the 
metempsychosis  to  be  the  older  of  the  two  doctrines,  which  had,  however,  in  time  been  attacked  by  other  teachers,  herein  described,  who 
had  been  generally  followed ; and  Gaudma  Budha  appeared  as  a teacher  or  reformer,  bringing  them  back  again  to  its  tenets.  The 
account  states,  that  Gaudma  attained  the  superiority,  and  the  ringleader  of  the  false  gods  was  so  ashamed,  that  tying  a pot  about  his 
neck,  he  threw  himself  into  the  river,  and  was  drowned.  The  Karayns,  however,  the  agriculturists  of  Burmah,  a rude  tribe,  still 
profess  these  tenets,  such  as  they  were  probably  held  before  the  appearance  of  Gaudma. 

§ That  all  things  have  neither  beginning  nor  end,  but  are  governed  by  fate  (Damata),  denying  the  lot  of  good  and  evil  deeds, 
which,  according  to  the  law  of  Gaudma,  is  the  efficient  cause  of  all  the  good  and  evil  that  happen  to  human  beings.  This  again  is 
reprobated,  as  Gaudma  teaches  all  good  and  evil  to  result  from  the  moral  acts  of  man. 

||  “ W ho  believe  that  the  cause  of  all  the  good  and  evil  which  happen  in  the  world  is  a certain  superior  Nat  of  the  woods,  who,  on  this 
account,  ought  to  be  worshipped.  The  jet  of  this  heresy  seems  to  consist  in  the  dispossessing  the  Budhas  of  their  supremacy,  to  confer  it 
on  the  gods  of  the  Jugandere,  or  the  region  of  enchantment  on  Mount  Mienmo.  The  servants  of  the  gods  of  Dewa  Loka,  who,  in  fact,  in 
becoming  Zian  (a  claim  we  have  just  found  so  strongly  interdicted),  from  their  active  and  powerful  intercourse  with  this  world  and  with 
man,  occupy  the  largest  portion  of  the  notice  of  the  common  votaries  of  Gaudma.” — Asiatic  Researches,  vi.  265. 


'S*>*iS&8 


THE  HELLS. 


Ill 


title  of  slaves  to  the  Peguans  upon  the  whole  population  of  Ava.  In  this  extremity  the  daring 
adventurer  raised  ins  standard  against  the  Peguans,  and  finding  himself  at  the  head  of  an  enraged  people 
he  boldly  denominated  himself  a Budha  (for  such  his  title  of  Alaoung  Fraw  implies),  and  so  skilfully  did 
he  avail  himself  of  the  religious  feeling  excited,  as  to  elevate  his  country  to  the  pinnacle  of  greatness. 
In  this  spirit  he  seems  to  have  dedicated  his  own  image  or  idol  at  rrome— a figure  of  extraordinary 
richness  and  great  value,  which  was  held  as  a palladium  in  the  pagoda,  and  esteemed  so  sacred,  that  on 
the  approach  of  the  British  forces  it  was*  borne  in  solemn  procession  around  the  city.  To  consider  the 
former  pretenders  to  the  Budhaship  as  similar  ambitious  personages  will  materially  assist  us  in  the 
appreciation  of  the  following  particulars. 

“ Whoever  is  admitted  into  the  priesthood  can  by  no  means  be  permitted  to  extol  himself  as  a saint, 
as  a person  endowed  with  any  preternatural  gifts,  such  as  the  gifts  called  Meipo,  or  Zian ; neither  is  it 
lawful  for  him  to  declare  himself  a hermit,  or  a person  that  loves  solitude.  The  priest  who,  prompted  bij 
ambition , falsely  and  impudently  pretends  to  have  obtained  the  extraordinary  gifts  of  Meipo  or  Zian,  or 
to  have  arrived  at  Nirwana,  is  no  longer  a priest  of  the  divine  order : to  what  can  he  be  compared  ? In 
the  same  manner  as  a palm-tree  cut  through  the  middle  can  never  be  rejoined  so  as  to  live ; in  such 
manner  shall  this  ambitious  priest  be  unworthy  of  being  esteemed  as  belonging  to  the  sacred  order ; 
wherefore,  O young  priest,  through  the  whole  of  your  life  avoid  such  criminal  excess.  The  young  priest 

shall  answer — Very  right,  my  lord,  I have  heard  all  that  even  till  now  you  have  said.” Asiatic 

Researches,  vi.  289- 

Nothing  can  more  strongly  show  the  dangers  attendant  on  the  claims  of  supernatural  gifts,  such  as 
qualified  ambitious  spirits  to  become  Budhas,  a state  opened  to  all  in  the  original  doctrine,  than  the  severe 
penalties  denounced  in  the  future  state  against  all  such  persons,  who  are  denominated  Deitti,  or  impious ; 
and  also  the  solemn  renunciation  required  of  every  individual  who  enters  the  priesthood,  of  pretending 
to  any  supernatural  gift,  such  as  the  gift  of  Zian  (which  means  the  privilege  of  Brahma  Loka,  exemption 
from  the  metempsychosis,  and  the  prospect  of  Nirwana),  the  gift  of  ]\Ieipo,  or  the  power  of  a state  of 
abstract  devotion,  whereby  the  hermit  becomes  a Rabat,  and  acquires  the  power  of  walking  in  the  air,  or 
of  working  miracles.  These  important  regulations  and  severe  denunciations  in  the  Kammuva  show  clearly 
that  each  innovator  assumed  the  privileges  of  a Budha,  or  of  omniscience,  as  well  as  of  Muni,  or  teacher. 

It  seems  extremely  probable,  from  these  and  a variety  of  other  passages,  that  the  doctrines  and 
metaphysics  of  Budhism  will  supply  the  data  for  its  history;  and  the  coincidence  existing  in  the 
ordinances  of  the  sacerdotal  class,  and  the  rigour  of  the  infernal  punishments,  is  very  important  in  this 
view.  Moreover,  in  the  award  of  the  duration  of  such  punishment  beyond  a calpe,  it  establishes 
the  long  sought  for  fact  of  a certain  principle  lurking  in  the  system  that  extends  itself  beyond  each  new 
creation ; and  thus  the  Nirwana,  or  Zian,  of  the  triumph  or  glory  heavens,  and  the  empyrean  of  the 
Budhas,  had  a permanent  duration.  In  the  punishment  of  the  Deitti  we  see  the  verification  of  a similar 
privilege  in  the  Asura  Loka,  or  abodes  of  torment. 


CHAPTER  X. 


THE  BALI. 


His  head 

Crested  aloft,  and  carbuncle  his  eyes ; 

With  burnish’d  neck  of  verdant  gold,  erect 
Amidst  his  circling  spires,  that  on  the  grass 
Floated  redundant : pleasing  was  his  shape. 

And  lovely;  never  since  of  serpent  kind 
Lovelier,  not  those  that  in  Illyria  changed 
Hermione  and  Cadmus;  or  the  god 
In  Epidaurus;  lior  to  which  transform’d 
Ammonian  Jove,  or  Capitoline  was  seen, 

He,  with  Olympias,  this  with  her  who  bore 
Scipio,  the  height  of  Rome. 

Paradise  Lost,  Book  ix. 


Every  one  conversant  with  Oriental  subjects  must  have  traced  at  the  roots  of  almost  all  the  systems  of 
Eastern  idolatry  a certain  vein  of  ideas  referable  to  another  species  of  worship,  originating  in  fear,  and 
paid  to  powers  superior  to  man,  beings  malignant  in  their  nature,  and  exercising  their  faculties  to  afflict 
and  terrify  the  human  race.  The  belief  in  and  fear  of  devils  or  demons,  and  of  dragons,  serpents,  and 
other  wild  chimeras,  is  interwoven  in  fact  with  the  whole  circle  of  pagan  idolatry  ; it  so  entwines  itself  with 
the  predominant  faith,  and  takes  such  powerful  hold  of  the  imagination,  that  no  new  system  of  doctrine, 
however  improved  in  its  practice,  or  elevated  in  its  precepts,  can  chase  the  doubt  and  fear  of  the  charmed 
delusion  from  the  mind.  To  no  system  of  faitli  can  we  appeal  for  stronger  evidence  of  this  truth  than  to 
Budhism,  for  its  history  and  doctrine  alike  demonstrate  that  each  Budha  endeavoured  by  every  possible 
means  to  effect  the  expulsion  of  the  Naga  idolatry,  which  existed  in  Ceylon  anterior  to  his  appearance; 
and  that,  notwithstanding  all  the  hints  of  both  force  and  persuasion,  incidentally  scattered  throughout 
the  legends  and  doctrine  of  Gaudma,  the  propitiation  of  demons,  and  the  belief  in  the  divine  power  of 
the  serpent  god,  were  too  closely  linked  with  the  springs  of  human  motives  to  be  overcome  by  another 
system,  which,  whatever  might  be  its  pretensions,  was  still  of  the  serpent  brood.  Thus  the  magicians  of 
pt  produced  their  serpents,  but  Aaron’s  rod  swallowed  them  up  ; a cheering  testimony  to  the  world 
that  the  divine  power  inherent  in  the  belief  in  the  true  God  is  the  only  remedy  for  these  delusions. 

* The  Agatho-demon,  and  Cneph,  the  good  genius  of  Egypt,  were  serpents,  and  the  Cobra-copile,  the  ornamental  frieze  of  the 
finest  temples,  similarly  adorns  the  throne  of  doctrine  or  power  on  which  the  Budha  sits.  In  Budha  belief  the  caves  of  the  high 
mountains  of  the  Imaus  are  the  abodes  of  snakes  and  dragons,  who  are  genii  and  enchanters,  and  Egypt  has  to  the  present  day  possessed 
her  race  of  Psylli,  or  charmers  of  serpents,  and  her  snake-god,  Haridi. 


THE  BALI. 


113 

The  object  of  Kappooism,  01  the  demon  worship  of  Ceylon,  is  not  the  same  principle  of  evil  as  we 
denominate  “ Satan,  the  great  foe  of  God  and  man.”*  This  point  has  been  illustrated  in  the  article  on 
the  metempsychosis : the  distinction  is  important  for  a right  understanding  of  the  nature  of  this  idolatry 
and  its  operation  on  the  natives.  The  idolatry  of  Kappooism,  in  common  with  that  of  every  land,  is  in 
fact  the  demonology  of  antiquity.  But  as  these  beings  are  represented  in  the  doctrine  as  often 
receiving  and  executing  the  commands  of  the  Budha,  and  they  are  moreover  associated  with  the  Budha 
scheme  by  being  constituted  the  servant*  of  the  gods  of  the  Dewa  Loka,  and  thereby  attached  to  the 
metempsychosis,  the  notions  of  a Singalese  as  to  the  demons  would  be  of  an  essentially  different 
character.  1 lie  ascendancy  of  this  faith  is  equally  opposed  to  virtue  and  goodness ; but  it  is  the  character 
of  the-  idolatry  which  is  here  sought  to  be  developed.  The  reverence  of  demons  is  most  extensively 
prevalent  in  Ceylon : it  has  temples,  established  deities,  and  a direct  worship,  part  of  which  is  recognised 
by  the  Budha  faith,  and  a portion  also  forbidden.  In  the  association  of  the  gods  of  the  hills  with  the 
Budha  we  trace  the  admission  of  the  primitive  demon  idolatry  of  Ceylon  into  his  system.  The  exclusion 
of  these  characters  from  all  worship,  and  the  prohibition  forbidding  priests  to  be  attached  to  the  Dewales, 
clearly  define  the  line  marked  out,  and  also  the  character  of  Budhism.  In  fact,  the  Budha  himself  aspires 
not  to  the  property  of  a god,  as  we  understand  the  word : he  is  denominated  a teacher,  a worker  of 
miracles,  who  is  to  be  served  by  attendance  on  his  bana,  and  reverence  of  his  doctrine.  As  he  is  identified 
with  his  priests,  so  the  demon-worship  was  altered  by  the  Budha  to  a mere  service  by  such  persons  being 
forbidden,  and  the  service  of  the  Dewales  and  their  gods  thereby  converted  into  another  mode  of  respect 
which  is  also  directed  not  to  be  even  the  species  of  honour  paid  to  the  inferior  gods  of  the  Dewa  Loka. 
To  render  even  this  tribute  of  homage  a tacit  admission  of  the  Budha’s  superiority,  Kandi-kumara  is 
described  in  the  doctrine  to  have  received  the  gift  of  healing  from  the  Budha,  who  thereby  declares 
himself  to  be  the  source  of  his  power.  The  link  between  these  beings  and  the  demons  to  whom  offerings 
are  made  will  be  shown  in  that  portion  of  the  subject. 

That  the  Naga  or  snake-worship,  anciently  predominated  throughout  Ceylon,  seems  established  from 
the  fact,  that  there  exists  no  legend  of  the  Budha  which  does  not  exhibit  him  as  converting  the  Cobra- 
copile  snakes,  also  the  Nagas ; sometimes  as  preaching  to  two  Cobra-copile  sovereigns  called  Koota-dara 
and  Mako-dara ; at  other  times  Gaudma  is  represented  as  visiting  Calany,f  at  the  express  invitation  of  a 


• This  line  of  remark  is  also  the  view  of  the  learned  Calmel  on  the  same  point. 

+ The  Budha  proceeded  to  the  devil,  who  was  on  Naijan-ginne,  in  the  palace  of  Nangewenodenneye,  where,  hovering  in  the  air.  he 
produced  a thick  darkness  over  the  whole  earth,  and  so  terrified  the  devils  that  they  all  retired,  and  he  thereby  obtained  an  opportunity 
of  treading  on  the  earth,  and  ascending  his  seat  of  power,  the  minny  phalange,  which  came  of  itself,  and  fire  issued  from  the  four  corners, 
which  still  more  frightened  the  devils;  but  he  comforted  them,  and  provided  a wood,  called  Jak-girri,  for  their  abode,  and  by  buna 
edified  the  gods,  who  were  assembled  at  Naijan-ginni,  and  liberated  them  from  hell,  and  giving  to  Samana-dewa  a handful  of  his  hair, 
pointed  out  this  island  for  the  habitation  of  men.  He  afterwards  proceeded  to  Oerroe-wedda-nuwe,  whereupon  Samana-dewa  enclosed 
the  hair  in  a chest  with  precious  stones,  and  kept  the  same  at  Naijan-ginni. 

Five  years  afterwards  he  came  forth  from  the  pagod  Talewanni,  and  put  an  end  to  the  battle  of  the  Naga  kings,  by  names 
Koota-dara  and  Mako-dara,  on  account  of  the  seat  of  precious  stones,  and  edified  them  by  his  doctrine,  whose  suite  (Koota-dara’s  at 
Waddoe-nagalle,  and  Mako-dara's  at  Calany)  were  converted  by  him;  after  which  both  the  snakes,  saying  that  if  either  of  them  had 
retained  the  seat  a contest  would  have  arisen,  offered-it  to  the  Budha,  with  offerings  of  meat  produced  by  their  power,  and  of  which 
having  eaten,  he  ascended  the  seat.  lie  delivered  the  palol-tree,  which  had  been  borne  by  the  god  Samana,  and  the  said  seat,  which 
were  both  used  in  his  service,  to  the  god  Wiebesana,  in  order  that,  by  worshipping  the  same,  salvation  might  be  obtained,  and 
afterwards  he  returned  to  the  pagoda. 

In  the  eighth  year  he  came  again  at  the  request  of  the  snake  Mannier-keyeram,  and  having  partaken  of  the  meat  brought  by  the 

U 


116 


TIIE  BALI. 


in  the  hopes*  or  fears  of  their  followers;  or  survived  in  the  humble  and  unobserved  daily  habits 
and  usages  of  ordinary  life.  These  are  as  light  planks  floating  at  random  on  the  ocean,  relics  of  the 
shipwreck  which  has  engulphed  the  vessel,  and  they  often  retain  some  slight  token  or  mark  whereby  the 
original  fabric  may  be  conjectured. 

In  the  very  first  step  we  shall  find  the  planetary  system  brought  in  contact  with  the  demons,  and 
sidereal  influences  as  all-powerful  and  influential  on  the  health  and  sickness  of  man. 

Planet  influence  is  styled  Bal-lee-ah,  which  may  bear  an  affinity  with  Baal.f  v 


* Legends  of  former  doctrine  are  often  embodied  in  the  strains  of  poetry  and  romance.  For  an  elaborate  treatise  on  this  point, 
Warton’s  History  of  English  Poetry  may  be  consulted  with  great  profit  and  pleasure  ; the  following  are  a few  extracts  from  the  numerous 
points  presented  — “ The  Gog  and  Magog  are  placed  amid  the  Caucasus,  and  are  represented  to  have  built  a wall  from  the  Caspian  to  the 
Black  Sea.  In  Merlin’s  prophecy,  Stonehenge  is  said  to  be  built  by  stones  conveyed  by  giants  from  the  furthest  parts  of  Africa.  An 
eagle  is  also  said  to  have  spoken  at  the  building  of  the  walls  of  the  city  of  Paladnr,  now  Shaftesbury.  Thus  dragons  are  a sure  test  of 
Orientalism,  and  our  romances  abound  with  them,  drawn  from  this  source.  M.  Mallet,  in  his  erudite  Inquiry  into  the  Genius  and  Antiquities 
of  the  Northern  Nations,  states  the  universality  of  their  belief  of  the  powers  of  magicians,  witches,  spirits,  and  genii,  concealed  under 
the  earth  and  in  the  waters.  The  walls  of  the  Goths  running  winding  around  their  castles  they  often  called  by  a name  which  signified 
serpents  or  dragons.  The  Pagan  founders  of  cities  and  castles  practised  judicial  astrology,  and  laid  the  first  stone  under  a lucky  position 
of  the  heavens,  and  also  the  presiding  gods  resided  in  rocks  and  caves;  hence  perhaps  arose  the  practice  of  writing  on  rocks,  which  is 
Asiatic,  while  Runic  inscriptions  are  found  even  in  Tartary.”  Nor  may  we  be  far  from  the  truth  when  we  ascribe  the  magnificent  hall  of 
Odin,  and  the  triumphant  feasting  and  inebriety  of  its  sacred  banquets,  to  the  eastern  doctrine  of  the  sacred  tree  and  its  inebriating 
festival  of  four  months  in  the  Taveteinza  heaven. 

t May  not  the  planet  worship  of  Palestine  have  been  the  same  as  what  prevails  in  Ceylon,  and  is  distinguished  from  devil  worship? 
And  may  not  the  images  burnt  by  David  and  his  men  (see  2nd  Samuel,  v.  25),  have  been  executed  in  relievo  on  frames,  to  propitiate  the 
planetary  powers  of  Baalim,  as  the  Singalese  construct  them  preparatory  to  their  offerings  and  dances?  Baal  it  should  seem  was  a 
personification  of  the  animating  power  of  nature,  as  Jaggernauth  is?  Has  the  Singalese  Bal-lee-ah,  meaning  “planetary  power," 
the  same  origin  with  the  great  solar  idol  of  antiquity?  It  appears  almost  probable,  that  the  worship  of  the  visible  heavens  by  the 
Phenicians  bore  a strong  resemblance  to  the  system  which  prevails  to  this  day  among  the  Singalese ; though  the  same  hands  are  engaged 
as  in  demon  worship,  the  system  appears  to  be  different.  Now,  “ supposing  the  worship  similar,  the  Philistines  might  make  an  extraordinary 
effort  at  propitiation  to  secure  the  defeat  of  a man  of  David’s  power;  and  their  images  not  being  of  metal,  but  of  materials  like  those  I 
have  described,  on  leaving  them  behind,  the}'  might  be  easily  consumed.  As  the  84th  Psalm  is  considered  as  written  first  after  this  defeat 
of  the  Phibstines,  it  has  struck  me  whether  David,  in  setting  fire  to  their  instruments  of  worship,  did  not  display  the  utmost  contempt 
of  their  adoration  of  the  sun,  in  particular,  as  the  source  of  fire ; and  that  from  an  emblem  of  the  material  sun,  his  superior  theology  led 
him  to  extol  Jehovah,  under  the  character  of  a sun  as  well  as  a shield.” — Callaway  s Illustrations  of  Scripture. 

That  the  sun,  moon,  and  planets,  were  the  Baalim  which  the  ancient  Hebrews  adored  there  can  be  little  doubt.  Of  Mnnusseh  it  is 
said,  that  he  built  the  high  places  of  Baal,  that  he  worshipped  all  the  host  of  heaven  and  served  them;"  but  it  is  singular  that  the  word 
Baal  is  used  in  reference  to  the  true  God,  a proof  that  the  Deity  was  often  worshipped  by  the  Israelites  under  the  form  and  figure  of  an 
idol.  Thus  Hosea— “ And  it  shall  be  at  that  day,  saith  the  Lord,  that  thou  shalt  cullme  Ishi,  and  shalt  call  me  no  more  Baali,  for  1 will 
take  away  the  names  of  Baalim  out  of  her  mouth,  and  they  shall  be  no  more  remembered  by  their  name.”  The  sun  is  the  greatest  object 
in  the  visible  heaven,  and  the  leader  or  prince  of  all  the  inferior  stars  or  Baalim.  Whether  the  magnificent  solar  god  be  represented  as 
giving  life  to  the  whole  animal  creation,  or  only  as  animating  and  destroying  flies;  whether  he  clothes  the  hills  and  valleys  with  abundance, 
or  gives  existence  to  a destructive  serpent ; he  is  still  the  same  acknowledged  sovereign  of  that  mighty  host  which  has  received  in  all  nations 
the  first  and  warmest  adoration  of  ignorant  fallen  man Russell,  ii.  363. 

In  the  vision  of  Ezekiel  we  see  the  full  particulars  of  the  zodiacal  symbolizations.  The  Baalim,  in  their  imagery,  combined  with 
the  idolatries  of  Egypt  and  Phenicia  the  adoration  of  the  solar  light.  Such  was  the  then  bold  exhibition  made  to  the  prophet  of 
“ the  forms  of  creeping  things  and  abominable  beasts,  and  all  the  idols  of  the  house  of  Israel  portrayed  upon  the  wall  round  about ;”  of 
the  second  vision  of  “ the  woman  weeping  for  Tammuz ;”  and  the  third  vision  of  " five-and-twenty  men  with  their  backs  towards  the 
temple  of  the  Lord,  and  their  faces  towards  the  east ; and  they  worshipped  the  sun  towards  the  east.” — Ezekiel,  viii.  8—16. 

I shall  subjoin  one  more  reference  in  elucidation  of  the  idolatrous  practices  traceable  among  the  Hebrews,  and  which  the  Bali  strikingly 
illustrate.  So  early  as  the  days  of  Moses,  it  was  found  requisite  to  threaten  with  the  severest  punishment  all  who  should  betake 
themselves  to  the  consulting  of  the  spirits  in  Sheol  or  IIades.-“  There  shall  not  be  found  among  you  any  one  that  usetk  divination,  or  an 
observer  of  times,  or  an  enchanter,  or  a witch,  or  a charmer , or  a consulter  with  familiar  spirits,  or  a wizard,  or  a necromancer f that  is,  one 
who  consulteth  the  dead. 

Now  the  whole  narration  of  the  witch  of  Endor,  and  the  apparition  coming  up  out  of  the  earth,  is  in  perfect  conformity  with  a 
great  number  of  Budhist  narratives  of  appearances  from  the  same  region,  appropriated  as  the  abode  of  spirits  after  death. 


THE  BALI. 


117 


•The  Bali  are  usually  figures  in  relief,  sometimes  as  large  as  the  human  form,  representing  the  planets, 
whose  influence  is  to  be  propitiated  or  averted ; they  are  neatly  formed  with  clay  on  a frame  of  split 
bamboo,  and  when  painted  have  an  imposing  appearance,  particularly  when  lighted  up  at  night  by  lamps, 
and  also  by  flambeaus  of  the  branches  of  cocoa-nut  trees.  Such  frames  may  be  frequently  seen,  especially 
in  time  of  sickness,  with  the  worshippers  and  dancers  before  them,  accompanied  by  chanting,  and  the 
beating  of  tom-toms : the  largest  usually  are  eighteen  feet  by  twelve.  After  the  ceremonies  are  over,  the 
frame  is  partly  broken  up,  or  left  to  be  destroyed  by  the  weather,  or  in  any  other  way. 

The  following  details  of  the  Bali  were  given  at  Galle,  December  2,  1817,  on  the  examination  of 
Kali  Singarkaregay  Gerrensoe,  second  Vidahn  of  the  tom-tom  Beaterero  or  Berewaya,  and  one  of  the 
chief  performers  in  their  invocations.  The  questions  and  answers  on  this  occasion  are  here  literally 
translated : — 

Question.  How  many  kinds  of  Bali  ? 

Answer.  There  are  nine  kinds  of  Bali  that  belong  to  the  nine  planets,  as  follows — (plate  28.) 


1.  For  the  planet  Sun,  or  Irru,  Santi-Mangale  Bali. 

2.  For  the  planet  Venus,  or  Sikura,  Giwe-Mangale  Bali. 

3.  For  the  planet  Mars,  or  Angaharu,  Kale-mortoo  Bali. 

4.  For  the  planet  Eclipse,  or  Raliu,  Assoere-Girray-rakse  Bali. 

5.  For  the  planet  Saturn,  or  Henahura,  Dasse-Crodie  Bali. 

6.  For  the  planet  Moon,  or  Kandu,  Some-Mangale  Bali. 

7.  For  the  planet  Mercury,  or  Budha,  Saroewe-roepe  Bali. 

8.  For  the  planet  Jupiter,  or  Braspaty,  Abeye-Kaleane  Bali. 

9.  For  the  planet  Ketu,  Krisne-rakse  Bali. 


Q.  What  are  the  sicknesses  which  each  Bali  cures  ? 

A.  After  ascertaining  in  what  planet  the  sick  person  was  born,  then  make  the  Bali  belonging  to  the 

planet.  /c 

Q.  What  Bali  have  you  for  those  persons  whose  planet  was  not  written  down  at  their  irt  i — (>  ee 

two  blank  Nekates,  plate  29-) 

A.  For  such,  there  is  a Bali  called  Caroemadie  Patie  Mangale. 

Q.  Besides  the  above-named  are  there  no  other  Bah  ? 

A.  I have  been  told  there  are,  but  do  not  know  them-I  only  learned  those  above  to  earn  my  bread 
by  making  them. 

Q.  How  many  figures  does  each  Bali  contain  ? 

A There  are'six  figures  in  the  first  Bali  (the  nine  planets  are  made  in  every  Bah),  and  go  round  i . 
and  also  a separate  four  figures  to  each,  called -Maha-dmawe,  Kale-tjakre,  Allootre , Tjandre-asteke  ; 
in  the  middle  is  the  figure  of  a woman  called  Unme-yoge-nave ; in  two  s.des  2 called  ; on 

the  sides  of  the  two  feet,  2,  called  Saraswatie ; and  under  the  feet  another,  called  Maha-kant, 
n What  som?s  do  you  sing  before  each  Bali? 

! r.  ,2.^ HhJL  fourteen  «*,  «.*.«.«  «»<***•  f 

Slh,  t,  6th,  S,  for  -he  «,  * f * «»  » « , » <>«  »'"•  » • ‘ ' 

besides  these  Mi  songs,  we  use  nine  song,  for  the  nine  firm...  for  ever,  lor. 

Q.  What  offerings  do  you  make  to  each  Bali  ? 


118 


THE  BALI. 


A.  There  are  not  different  offerings  for  each,  but  a similar  offering  to  every  one  of  them,  which 

consists  of: Two  cocoa-nut  flowers  in  two  pots ; boiled  rice ; seven  sorts  of  vegetable  curry  ; one  roasted 

hupper ; a cocoa-nut ; lime ; a sort  of  leaves  called  Tolle-boo-hirrese ; raw  rice ; also  on  a small  chair, 
covered  with  a white  cloth,  stand  two  areka-nut  flowers,  some  red  flowers,  betel-nuts,  and  white  sandal- 
wood. 

Q.  Who  are  the  people  that  sing  and  prepare  the  Bali  ? 

A.  There  are  only  two  castes — Berewaya  and  Olia.  * 

Q.  Who  are  the  people  who  dance  the  devil’s  dances  ? 

A.  I am  not  able  to  tell , as  the  Kappoerales  will  know  it. 

Q.  What  are  the  four  deities  who  act  as  priests  to  the  four  deities — and  who  worship  the  four  deities? 

A.  This  also  I am  not  able  to  say,  but  the  Kappoerales  will  know  it. 

Q.  For  what  sicknesses,  or  what  reasons,  are  the  devil  dances  ? 

A.  The  Kappoerales  are  the  people  who  make  them. 

Q.  Do  they  dance  the  devil  dances  for  the  same  purposes  as  they  make  the  Bali  ? 

A.  This  also  the  Kappoerales  will  know — I am  not  acquainted  with  the  devil  dances. 

The  following  colours  are  used  by  the  Singalese  to  paint  their  Balis — 

Goeroegale — Seemcal — a kind  of  cabock  stone-red  paint. 

Kahamalia — Mangelman— a kind  of  clay-yellow  paint. 

Makoolugal — Weleman — a kind  of  stone-white  paint. 

LTttucatu-angura — Chiretta-carry — cocoa-nut  shell  charcoal-black  paint. 

Erremudoo-colle-mulle-murke,  Erythrina  Indica  (see  Ainslie , page  208),  a kind  of  vegetable-green 
paint. 

The  figures  of  the  nine  planets,  which  accompany  these  charms,  are  nearly  similar  to  those  contained 
in  the  plates  14  and  19,  which  are  evidently  the  Bali.  The  fourteenth  plate,  in  fact,  is  named  from  a 
Bali,  Nawaggraha-yaw.  The  only  variation  is  Jupiter  or  Braspaty,  having  the  lion,  instead  of  being 
mounted  on  a man.  The  details  and  qualities  are  as  follows : — (See  plate  28.) 

1.  The  planet  Sun,  adorned  with  a royal  crown,  holding  in  one  hand  an  excellent  fan,  his  body  of  a 
gold  complexion,  mounted  on  a horse,  and  arrived  from  the  East,  bestows  blessings  on  mankind. 

2.  The  planet  Mercury,  dwelling  on  a tree  called  carandagahu,  in  a corner,  which  is  denominated 
Agny-conna,  between  the  South  and  East,  adorned  with  a crown,  holding  in  the  right  hand  a chank,  is 
of  white  complexion,  mounted  on  an  ox,  and  protects  the  sick. 

3.  The  planet  Mars,  of  red  complexion,  dwelling  in  the  East,  decorated  with  a royal  crown,  holding 
a gold  spear  in  the  right  hand,  with  much  joy,  and  mounted  on  a peacock,  continually  blesses. 

4.  The  planet  Rahu  (Eclipse),  of  white  complexion,  dwelling  in  a cave  called  Neritta-canna, 
between  the  South  and  West,  with  the  head  of  a serpent,  holding  a fish,  and  mounted  on  horseback, 
protects  the  sick. 

5.  The  planet  Saturn,  of  blue  complexion,  dwelling  in  the  West,  with  three  bunches  of  hair  on  the 
head,  holding  a warlike  instrument,  called  parra-wallalla,*  and  the  left  leg  lame  and  short,  mounted  on  a 
crow,  continually  blesses. 


The  warlike  weapon  or  chakkra  invented  by  Wisme-karma. 


HmJuupal/' 


Sir  urn 


Ttferruriut 


jRiu/a/ijj  i 1 


Jiffiret 


WUM/ri- 


Jtiuu/u/ 


JLfnaJturcc 


THE  BALI. 


119 


6.  The  planet  Moon,  of  white  complexion,  dwelling  in  a corner,  called  Wajabbawa,  between  the 
West  and  North,  crowned,  holding  a belt  in  the  right  hand,  mounted  on  a white  elephant,  protects 
mankind,  and  preserves  them  in  long  life. 

7.  The  planet  Venus,  of  white  complexion,  residing  in  the  North,  crowned,  and  holding  in  her  right 
hand  a musical  instrument  of  shell,  called  hackgedia,  mounted  on  a buffalo,  protects  all  mankind. 

8.  The  planet  Jupiter,  of  gold  complexion,  dwelling  in  the  corner  called  Issana-canna,  between  the 
North  and  East,  holding  in  the  right  hand  a pot  containing  flowers,  and  mounted  on  a man,  constantly 
blesses  mankind. 

9.  The  planet  Ivehettu,  dwelling  at  Mallawy-deessey,  of  white  complexion,  with  human  head,  and 
a body  recently  altered  into  the  shape  of  a serpent,  protects  and  blesses  mankind. 

Every  Bali  is  accompanied  by  four  figures,  called  Maha-dasawe,  Kale-tjakre,  Allootre,  and 
Tjandere-asteke.  As  there  are  four  gods  of  healing,  each  of  whom  is  associated  with  the  magic  and 
Ophite  portion  of  the  system,  and  also  four  classes  of  beings  superior  to  man,  invested  with  the  unlimited 
powers  of  the  metempsychosis  in  the  region  of  Jugandere,  so  there  are  four  rulers  of  the  Bali,  named  as 
above.  Their  attributes,  as  represented  in  plate  13,  may  serve  in  some  shape  to  throw  a light  on  their 
association  ; they,  moreover,  suggest  the  most  striking  analogy  between  the  conventional  signs  of  the  East, 
and  those  of  the  Southern  hemisphere.  In  the  Bali  we  recognise  the  fragments  of  the  ancient  idolatry, 
intermixing  itself  with  the  tenets  of  Budhism,  and  retaining  to  the  present  day  its  strong  hold  on  the 
minds  of  the  natives ; more  especially  as  connecting  itself  with  the  planetary  system,  incantations,  and 
the  magic  ceremonies  performed  for  the  heavenly  host  and  demons. 

The  hieroglyphic  of  the  Day  is  a circle  divided  into  four  parts,  determined  by  the  rising  of  the  sun, 
its  setting,  and  its  two  passages  across  the  meridian.  May  it  not,  therefore,  probably  be  one  part  of  the 
meaning  of  these  forms,  as  rulers  of  the  day,  to  indicate  the  place  of  the  sun,  or  house  wherein  he  is  to 
be  consulted  for  the  horoscope,  when  the  Bali  are  performed  in  the  day-time? 

Maha-dasawe  (plate  13),  seems  to  hold  a cane,  and  by  the  sign  of  the  elephant,  or  the  emblem  of 
the  rainy  path,  in  the  zodiac,  indicates  the  harvest. 

Tjandre-asteke  has  the  sign  of  the  rabbit,  precisely  answering  to  the  Mexican  deity. 

Kale-tjakre  I should  consider  the  cavern  deity  of  Jakre-girre  forest,  the  giant  demon  god,  whose 
residence  in  the  sphere  of  the  planets  is  marked  by  the  faces  of  the  radiated  back-ground,  also  by  the 
Cobra-copiles  on  his  head. 

Allootre  appertains  to  the  same  regions,  and  is  invested  with  the  same  planetary  back-ground,  and 
his  hieroglyphic  sign  is  the  garuda,  or  monstrous  fatidical  bird  of  Jugandere;  he  bears  on  his  head  the 
symbol  of  a house,  or  square,  such  as  is  attributed  to  the  Mexican  deity.*1  These  lour  figures,  associated 
with  the  magic  region  of  Jugandere,  and  representatives  of  its  four  classes  of  gifted  inhabitants,  are, 


* The  hieroglyphic  of  the  day  was  a circle  divided  into  four  parts;  each  Mexican  month  of  twenty  days  was  divided  into  four  small 
periods  of  five  days  ; the  days  of  the  week  owe  their  origin  to  the  number  of  the  planets.  M.  Builly  affirms,  that  by  a law  of  the  Inca 
Pachacutec,  the  people  were  to  work  not  seven  but  eight  consecutive  days,  and  rest  the  ninth.  Humboldts  Researches,  18-3. 

The  most  ancient  division  of  the  zodiac,  says  Albategne,  is  that  into  four  parts.  W e also  know,  from  the  notions  which  Sigucnca 
derived  from  the  works  of  Ixtlilxochitl,  that  the  four  folds  of  the  serpent,  and  the  four  asterisms  which  belong  to  them,  indicate  the  fonr 
seasons,  the  four  elements,  and  the  four  cardinal  points.  Earth  was  dedicated  to  the  rabbit,  and  water  to  the  cane,  and  Fepejol  othi. 


THE  BALI. 


120 

without  doubt,  the  Nat  gods  of  the  woods  and  mountains,  whose  service  had  become  so  universal,  tfhd  so 
deeply  rooted,  as  to  call  for  denunciations  of  the  severest  and  most  terrible  of  the  eternal  punishments 
against  all  its  followers. 

The  character  of  the  Bali,  namely,  that  they  consist  of  magical  ceremonies  to  the  demons,  as  well  us 
invocations  to  the  planetary  bodies,  is  fully  shown  in  the  foregoing  extracts,  as  well  as  their  universality 
and  influence  over  every  class  of  society,  and  in  every  imaginable  contingency.  This  deeply  fixed  and 
operative  principle  is  not  a vulgar  or  common  persuasion,  originating  in  weakness  or  ignorance,  for  its 
practice  and  persuasion  control  the  monarch  as  well  as  the  meanest  of  his  slaves.  How  wholly  are  the 
concerns  of  life  thereby  withdrawn  from  the  wholesome  exercise  of  judgment  and  intellectual  government, 
and  subjected  to  a power,  identified  with,  and  as  fickle  and  mutable  as  the  elements ! 

The  outlines  of  the  Bali,  and  their  scope  and  meaning,  are  quite  unknown,  excepting  that  they 
consist  of  idolatrous  practices  and  invocations;  yet  something  may  be  traced  of  their  elements  by 
endeavouring  to  compare  the  personal  character  of  the  figures  with  what  has  already  been  ascertained  of 
the  gods  of  the  superior  regions.  These  curious  illustrations  of  magical  incantations  are  all  to  be  traced 
in  unison  with  symbols  and  emblems,  which  show  that  their  region  is  in  the  Jugandere,  and  their  chief 
agents  are  its  enchanters,  giants,  and  fatidical  genii ; or  in  the  Asura  Loka  of  the  demons.  The  path  of  the 
sun,  moon,  and  planets  being  also  connected  with  the  ceremonies,  they  bind  in  one  chain  the  planetary 
system,  both  as  to  the  solar  and  lunar  system,  as  well  as  the  Nekates,  the  Jugandere  region  being  in 
four  divisions : — 1 st.  Koombandeo,  the  cavern  deities,  and  those  of  trees  and  woods ; 2d.  Yaksa  or  Gaksa^ 
the  giants  ; 3d.  The  fatidical  birds,  the  Garuda,  Simorg,  &c. ; 4th.  The  dragons,  Cobra-copiles,  and  snakes — 
the  centre  form  of  each  Bali  serves  to  denote  to  which  class  the  Bali  more  especially  belongs. 

The  figure,  Nawctggraha-mangale  Bali  (plate  28),  contains  nine  planets. 

The  planet  Jupiter  is  to  be  erected,  or  painted  on  the  top,  on  the  right  side,  and  under  that  the 
planets  Saturn,  Moon,  and  Venus;  on  the  left,  the  planets  Eclipse  (llalm),  Mercury,  and  Mars,  and  also 
the  ninth  planet  Kehettu ; the  planet  Sun  in  the  centre  mounted  on  a horse. 

This  figure,  thus  prepared,  will  cure  any  disease  occasioned  by  any  of  the  said  nine  planets.  The 
offerings  to  this  Bali  are  nine  pots  containing  flowers,  nine  lamps,  nine  different  sorts  of  flowers,  nine 
sorts  of  smell  (perfumes),  nine  sorts  of  curry,  and  nine  cush,  or  chillies,*  and  a sacrifice  of  nine 
animals. 

When  this  figure  is  thus  invoked  with  the  personage  called  Si rria-han tu iva,  wife  of  Wisme,  painted 
in  its  centre, j-  it  will  cure  all  these  maladies:  deafness,  dumbness,  blindness,  itch,  dropsy,  cramp, 
inflammation  of  joints,  and  other  disorders  which  arise  from  the  craft  of  devils.  The  figure  is  to  be 
invoked  in  a house, i to  be  erected  with  four  doors  towards  the  East,  four  fowls  to  be  tied  round,  after 


one  of  the  divinities  who  dwelt  in  caverns,  and  the  goddess  of  the  harvest,  accompany  the  diurnal  signs  of  the  rabbit  and  the  cane. — 
Humboldt,  i.  373. 

I lie  Mexicans  employ  for  the  cycle  of  years  the  four  following  sign3,  Tochtli,  a rabbit  or  hare  ; Acatl,  a cane;  Tecpatl,  a flint  or 
silex  ; Calli,  a house. 

• Chulies,  flambeaus,  formed  of  the  branches  of  the  cocoa-nut  tree. 

+ I his  person  is  the  wife  of  Wisme,  the  chief  god  of  the  Hills,  described  among  the  gods  of  healing,  and  residing  on  Adam’s  Peak, 
in  the  region  of  Jugandere.  '* 

+ A frame:  (See  the  description  of  the  erection  of  the  frame-work  and  moulds  in  the  foregoing  pages.) 


Tiyvy-  yojr  numpGuy* 


THE  BALI. 


121 


the  performance  of  magic.  The  maker  of  this  figure,  covering  himself  with  a red  cloth,  shall  offer  a 
sacrifice,  and  when  the  ceremony  is  thus  performed,  it  will  cure  such  diseases  as  may  have  been  caused 
by  devils. 

The  ceremonies  above-mentioned  were  witnessed  by  the  Rev.  Mr.  Fox,  during  his  residence  in 
Ceylon,  in  which  island  he  fulfilled  the  duties  of  a faithful  missionary  for  many  years  with  exemplary 
zeal.  They  are  so  well  described  in  his  narrative,  that  I shall  quote  it  without  alteration,  merely 
premising  that  the  sacrifice  of  the  cock  is  precisely  the  same  as  the  dying  act  of  Socrates,  already  quoted 
from  Plato’s  Pheedo. 

“ The  Nagas  are  the  lower  order  of  the  gods : they  are  supposed  to  give  the  power  to  some  men  to 
blight  all  the  fruit  they  look  at,  and  this  they  call  aes-wasa,  or  eye-poison.  I knew  a native,  of  whom 
his  countrymen  said,  that  if  he  looked  on  a tree  it  would  wither:  they  told  me  that  the  Naga-raja,  or 
king-serpent,  was  on  him.  Of  the  demons  I can  say  little  more  than  what  I have  been  eye-witness  of, 
and  being  at  that  time  but  imperfectly  acquainted  with  the  language,  I could  not  learn  all  I wished  to 
know.  Travelling  a little  after  midnight  on  foot,  with  only  one  native,  who  served  me  as  a <mide  I 
heard  the  sound  of  tom-toms  in  the  jungle;  I ordered  my  guide  to  lead  me  to  the  place ; he  durst  not 
refuse,  but  he  seemed  much  afraid,  though  I then  knew  not  why.  We  came  at  length  to  a temporary 
hut  (which  they  call  a maduwa),  adorned  in  front  with  cocoa-nut  leaves,  and  about  sixty  lamps,  made  of 
coarse  clay  ; I saw  some  shadows  of  men,  but  they  disappeared,  and  on  my  approach  I saw  only  the 
kappooa  dancing  before  the  place  with  hollow  bangles  on  his  arms,  filled  with  stones,  or  some  metallic 
substance,  to  make  a jingle;  in  his  hands  he  held  two  vessels  filled  with  perfumes,  in  which  mastic 
seemed  to  predominate ; these  in  appearance  somewhat  resembled  the  hour-glass.  He  was  singing 
something  in  Malabar  (which  I could  not  then  understand),  in  a tone  higher  than  is  common  with 
European  voices.  My  presence  did  not  interrupt  him,  and  my  attendant  could  use  no  language  I was 
acquainted  with  ; I therefore  entered  into  the  maduwa  to  learn  all  I could  from  observation.  Opposite 
to  the  front  of  the  maduwa  was  a clay  image  of  a yaksa,  or  demon,  on  a frame ; before  the  image  lay  a 
sick  man,  near  his  feet  was  a wicker  basket ; this  I lifted  up,  and  underneath  it  was  a black  fowl,  which 
had  been  made  blacker  by  soot,  or  some  black  ingredient.  This  I afterwards  understood  was  to  be 
slaughtered  at  the  dawn  of  day,  and  its  blood  sprinkled  on  the  image ; this  is  a very  common,  service  for 
the  sick,  and  is  usually  performed  before  a new  house  is  occupied,  lest  the  demons  should  injure  the 
inhabitants  : the  same  ceremony  is  usually  observed  after  the  birth  of  an  infant,  and  a charm  engraven 
on  a thin  plate  of  lead  is  given  : — this  is  deemed  a secure  defence  against  yaksas.” 

“ The  man  who  acts  the  part  of  the  devil  is  dressed  in  a garment  of  dried  grass  or  rushes,  which 
reaches  to  the  ground  ; his  arms  and  feet  are  concealed ; a white  country -cloth  covers  his  shoulders ; 
round  his  head,  and  tied  under  his  chin,  are  two  or  three  cotton  handkerchiefs;  the  face  is  frightful ; the 
mouth  and  nose  are  black  ; two  large  teeth  project  far  beyond  the  lips ; a row  of  coarse  shells  is  bound 
over  the  eyes  ; on  the  head  is  a red  cap,  which  reaches  four  or  five  feet  in  height,  and  is  surmounted  with 
a plume  of  feathers. 

“ The  natives  believe  in  the  existence  of  a supreme  god,  who  is  great  and  good,  but  indifferent  to  the 
affairs  of  men.  It  is  their  concern  to  secure  the  favour,  and  avert  the  displeasure  of  certain  malignant 
spirits,  whom  they  imagine  to  be  constantly  attendant  on  their  persons,  and  to  be  the  authors  of  all  their 
evils.  They  place  great  confidence  in  their  greegrees,  or  amulets,  and  have  sacred  groves,  trees,  and  huts. 


k 


122 


THE  BALI. 


They  occasionally  strew  fruits  about  their  towns,  or  spread  mats  by  the  public  paths,  as  offerings  to  the 
invisible  spirits.  They  sometimes  make  prayers  on  the  graves  of  their  fathers,  or  under  their  sacred 
trees.” — Missionary  Register  for  1820,  135,  165. 

EXPLANATION  OF  PLATE  XXIX. 

In  Santi-mangale  Bali,  the  house  of  the  Sun,  as  Irru  or  Hiru,  occupies  the  centre  compartment  at 
the  top.  He  is  seated  cross-legged  on  a white  horse,  holding  *a  sword.  That  Hiru,  the  Sun,  and  Budha, 
are  identically  the  same,  may  be  seen  in  Faber's  Illustration , ii.  208.  As  Sakia,  he  is  described  by  the 
Japanese  as  riding  on  a white  horse,  and  the  temple  of  the  Budha  is  also  called  the  temple  of  the  White 
Horse;*  he  is  also  the  sword  god  of  the  Scythians,  under  the  form  of  Kanda-kumara.f  The  centre 
figure  seems  by  the  Cobra-copile  to  refer  to  the  subterranean  portion  of  the  earth,  also  marked  by  the  cave 
in  the  upper  part  of  the  figure.  The  eight  planets  surround  the  form,  together  with  Sriea-kanta,  the 
wife  of  Wisme-karma,  to  whose  charge  Ceylon  was  confided. 

The  Saraswatie  has  doubtless  allusion  to  the  riches  and  treasures  of  the  regions  of  the  Hemavunta, 
where  the  Nat  king  of  the  Elephants  and  the  Nagas  reside. 

The  figure  of  the  centre  frame  stands  on  a hog : the  only  instance  of  its  appearance  as  an  asterism  is 
found,  according  to  M.  Humboldt,  in  a Tartarian  zodiac,  and  it  corresponds  with  the  sign  of  the  fishes  of 
the  Greek  sphere.  In  the  planisphere  of  the  temple  of  Tentyra,  a figure  holding  a hog  in  its  hand  is 
seen  twice  near  the  same  sign. 

EXPLANATION  OF  PLATE  XXX. 

e 

In  the  second  Bali,  the  figure  in  the  middle  is  called  Siewe,  and  in  the  four  corners  are  four  figures 
called  Yama-hinne,  Kala-hinne , JYay-hinne,  and  Murtoa-hinne. 

In  this  Bali  the  Sun,  with  his  sword-emblem,  has  the  bird  hieroglyphic,  which  probably  refers  to  the 
Garuda  portion  of  the  Jugandere.  The  four  hinn&s  again  recal  the  fourfold  hieroglyphics  of  this 
class,  referring  to  the  hours  of  the  day,  the  seasons,  and  the  elements,  as  well  as  Yam,  or  Yame,  the  god 
of  the  third  Dewa  Loka,  and  the  judge  of  those  who  aspire  to  transmigrate  into  the  Brahma  Loka. 

EXPLANATION  OF  PLATE  XXXI. 

In  the  third  Bali,  the  figure  in  the  centre  is  called  Dewa-rupa;  upon  its  head  is  one  called  Makere- 
terrene,  and  above  it  another  called  Maha-braluna:  and  beneath  the  middle  figure  stands  one  called 
Maha-kantawe. 

The  centre  house  or  sign,  at  the  top  of  the  plate,  is  the  god  Maha-brahma,  of  the  ninth  Brahma- 
kuki  heaven,  the  supreme  of  the  system  next  to  the  Budha.  Maha-brahma  holds  in  each  hand  the 
crown  of  flowers  and  chettra,  which  in  propitious  seasons  the  gods  shower  down  on  the  earth,  and  is 

* On  Hemavunta,  the  Imaus  of  the  ancients,  and  the  Himmaleh  of  the  moderns,  at  the  Zaddan  mount  resides  Zadda,  the  king  of  both 
Elephants  and  Horses,  whose  powers  are  similar  to  those  of  the  genii  of  these  regions  of  inexhaustible  riches.  Respecting  the  sign  of 
the  horse,  Mr.  Faber  observes — “ From  the  colour  of  the  horse  of  Woden  or  Budha,  as  it  is  still  emblazoned  in  the  arms  of  Saxony,  I 
conclude  that  in  the  west  as  well  as  in  the  east  it  was  thought  to  be  white.  A similar  inference  may  be  drawn  from  the  stupendous 
representation  of  the  same  mystic  animal  in  the  English  Vale  of  the  White  Horse  " — Faber  on  Pagan  Idolatry,  ii.  358. 

+ Kanda-kumara  is  a god  of  the  hills,  the  third  in  the  series,  and  residing  at  Katrigane,  whose  history  has  been  given,  delineating 
the  worship  of  the  sword,  with  very  peculiar  ceremonies. — See  also  Faber,  ii.  427. 


/ 


1 Sanle  JUfangcdU  Balt . 


' 


* 


> 


.11 


THE  BALI. 


123 


accompanied  on  either  hand  by  the  sun  and  the  moon.  The  centre  Makere-terrene,  the  sea-monster, 
answering  to  the  Mexican  Cipactli,  an  hieroglyphic  of  the  same  sign,  is  the  zodiacal  sign  of  Capricorn, 
a symbol,  considered  by  M.  Humboldt  as  proving  an  important  connexion  between  the  schemes  of  the 
Asiatic  and  American  calendars.  The  sign  of  Makere  is  defined  to  be  in  the  Dewa  Loka;  the  first 
heaven,  called  the  Tjaturum-maha-raja  (Zadu-maha  of  Dr.  Buchanan,  Asiatic  Researches , vi.  7),  being 
the  path  of  the  sun,  moon,  and  planets,  as  well  as  embracing  the  region  Jugandere,  seemingly  indicating 
that  the  region  of  the  Bali  is  there  situated., 

EXPLANATION  OF  PLATE  XXXII. 

In  the  fourth  Bali,  the  figure  in  the  middle,  called  Asura-su re-yak sa,  has  upon  his  head  Istrie-rupa, 
and  under  his  feet  two  Asuras.  The  Bali  therefore  is  manifestly  laid  in  the  Asura  Loka,  and  the  centre, 
a demon  giant,  or  yaksa,  has  the  emblems  of  the  elephant  and  snakes  of  the  Jugandere.  The  house 
above  the  centre  has  the  Sun,  or  Irru,  as  in  the  first  Bali,  with  the  eight  planets,  and  the  two  squares 
below  the  centre  is  occupied  by  the  two  Asuras. 

EXPLANATION  OF  PLATE  XXXIII. 

Dhasa-crodi,  the  figure  in  the  centre,  has  a demoniac  face,  ten  hands,  with  ten  musical  instruments 
of  shells  called  hackgeddie,  tied  to  their  wrists,  and  one  hand  holding  a branch  of  jambu  tree,  a hand 
holding  a compass,  a hand  holding  a spear,  another  holding  a bow,  another  holding  a ring,  four  right 
hands  each  holding  a serpent,  and  the  other  a sword ; the  neck  decorated  with  a chain  strung  with 
ornaments  in  the  shape  of  human  heads : he  is  dressed  in  tigers’  skins,  mounted  on  an  ox,  and  the 
nine  planets  are  erected  or  painted  round  the  said  figure  as  follows : — The  planet  Sun  on  the  top,  with 
Jupiter  and  Mars  on  each  side;  in  the  south  the  three  planets  Venus,  the  Moon,  and  Saturn;  and 
on  the  left  side  the  planets  Mercury,  Eclipse  (Rahu),  and  the  ninth  planet  Kehetta. 

This  figure  is  invoked  by  patients  who  are  influenced  by  the  planet  Saturn  ; the  disorders  to  which 
a person  governed  by  that  planet  is  liable  are — head-ache,  heat  in  the  whole  body,  insanity,  lameness, 
pain  in  the  joints,  swelled  body,  fainting.  A sacrifice  of  fowls,  and  an  offering  of  vegetable  curry-milk 
with  jaggery,  are  made  to  the  figure  on  a raised  place.  After  the  Ballia  is  thus  invoked,  it  is  taken 
towards  the  east,  where  it  is  fixed  on  a high  place. 

EXPLANATION  OF  PLATE  XXXIV. 

In  the  sixth  Bali  the  centre  figure  is  called  Sriea-kanta-rupa ; above  this  figure  is  another  named  Dewa- 
rupa  ; in  the  four  corners  are  the  four  hinn£s  of  the  second  Bali. 

The  centre  house  of  the  Sun  and  Moon  are  again  the  heaven  of  the  Dewa  Loka,  the  Tjaturum-maha- 
raja,  wherein  lie  the  courses  or  paths  of  these  planets.  The  centre  figure  represents  the  wife  of  Wisme- 
karma,  the  god  of  healing,  who  is  here  associated  with  the  white  horse  of  Budha. 

EXPLANATION  OF  PLATE  XXXV. 

The  middle  figure  is  called  Dewa-rupa,  and  in  the  four  corners  are  the  four  lnnnes.  In  this  singular 
Bali,  the  horse  is  only  shown  in  part,  being  the  upper  portion  of  the  back  ; lrru,  or  the  Sun,  is  in  the  usual 
position.  The  centre  compartment  contair  s the  same  figure  of  the  consort  of  YVisme-karma,  the  declared 

u 2 


124 


THE  BALI. 


favourite  of  the  god  Sekkraia,  and  also  chosen  by  him,  with  the  express  approval  of  the  Budha  Gaudma, 
at  the  peripd  of  his  death,  for  the  tutelary  protector  of  Ceylon ; hence  we  see  in  part  the  reason  of  her 
appearance  so  constantly  in  Bali,  or  invocations  for  gifts  and  protection. 

EXPLANATION  OF  PLATE  XXXVI. 

The  middle  figure  is  called  Singe-wali-rupa ; over  its  head  Makere-terrene,  and  in  the  two  sides  two 
Dewa-rupa.  The  planet  Sicura,  or  Venus,  is  joined  with  Irru,  the  Sun,  in  the  upper  central  compartment ; 
the  horse  again  appears  half  sunk  below  the  horizon.  The  centre  compartment  is  in  the  usual  Dewa 
region,  and  the  Makere,  or  Capricorn  zodiacal  sign.  It  is  impossible  to  look  at  the  bearded  figure 
which  occupies  the  centre  frame  without  being  reminded  of  the  following  interesting  passage  of 
Humboldt : — “ It  was  in  the  time  of  the  Tolteck  monarchy,  or  in  ages  anterior  to  it,  that  the  Mexican 
Budha,  Quetzalcohuatl,  appeared ; a white  man,  bearded , and  accompanied  by  other  strangers,  who  wore 
black  garments  in  the  form  of  cassocks.  Till  the  sixteenth  century,  the  people  wore  these  dresses  of 
Quetzalcohuatl  to  disguise  themselves  on  festivals.  He  ordained  sacrifices  of  flowers  and  fruits,  and 
stopped  his  ears  when  he  was  spoken  to  of  war.  It  is  no  doubt  interesting  to  treasure  up  the  most 
minute  circumstances  relative  to  the  life  of  this  mysterious  personage,  who,  belonging  to  the  heroic 
times,  was  probably  anterior  to  the  Toltecks.” — Humboldt's  Researches , ii.  249. 

EXPLANATION  OF  PLATE  XXXVII. 

The  middle  figure  is  Krisne-yaksa,  on  each  side  a Wisnoe-rupa. 

In  the  centre  compartment  at  the  top,  Irru,  on  the  horse,  is  in  a different  attitude,  and  of  a brown  or 
earthy,  instead  of  the  usual  yellow  or  golden  colour.  The  centre  figure  refers  to  the  yaksa-ludaia,  or 
the  second  region  of  Jugandere,  the  abode  of  the  giants.  The  emblems  are  the  same  as  mark  the 
Pattinee-dewa,  who  governs  the  Nekates,  and  in  the  Mexican  signs  the  rabbit  (which  here  is  given  to  a 
yaksa  giant  of  the  caves  of  the  Hemavunta  mountains),  accompanies  “ Tepeyellotli,  one  of  the  divinities 
who  dwell  in  caverns.” — Humboldts  Researches , i.  373.  He  stands  on  the  white  horse  of  Budha,  which  is 
represented  in  part,  and  in  a different  way  from  the  former  figures. 

EXPLANATION  OF  PLATE  XXXVIII. 

The  Caroenadie-ratie-mangale  does  not  belong  to  the  nine  planets : the  centre  figure  is  Dewa-rupa, 
and  in  the  four  corners  are  the  four  hinn&s. 

The  question  put  to  the  Berewaya,  or  astrologer — “ What  Bali  have  you  for  those  persons  whose 
names  are  not  written  down  at  their  birth  ?”  does  not  imply  the  supposition  of  an  omission  being  made, 
but  refers  to  the  intercalary  period,  and  to  those  who  may  be  born  during  the  complementary  days, 
whereby  they  are  deprived  of  the  necessary  sign  for  the  asterism.  This  interpretation  is  clearly  the 
import  of  the  above  phrase,  of  not  belonging  to  the  nine  planets,  which  a mere  negligence  of  recording 
the  date  would  not  justify,  as  the  planet  in  astrological  law  would  operate  as  clearly  upon  its  subject 
without  his  cognizance  of  its  ruling  ascendant  as  with  it.  In  fact,  many  of  the  most  striking 
incidents  of  this  nature  in  Eastern  narratives  are  written  to  the  very  point  of  a malignant  or  sinister 
aspect  being  concealed  from  its  object,  who  is  nevertheless  made  wonderfully  to  fulfil  the  augury ; 
for  such  persons  this  Bali  becomes  a channel  of  invoking  the  planets.  In  the  Mexican  year,  as  well 


OTASA  CROIDR 


■: 


37 


r 


Budukoo  I I Karu/u 


. 


JV‘°W,  Xanoeriadu  Hah  ^Uayujak 


\Kl  * 


THE  BALI. 


125 


as  in  the  Egyptian,  the  five  complementary  days,  the  epagomena,  were  denoted  by  the  name  of 
Nemontami,  or  voids.  The  children  born  during  them  were  regarded  as  unfortunate ; and  were 
called  Nemoquichtli,  or  Nencihuatl,  unhappy  men  or  women;  in  order,  as  it  is  stated  by  the  Mexican 
writers,  that  these  very  names  should  call  to  their  remembrance,  in  every  event  of  life,  how  little 
they  ought  to  trust  to  their  stars  ."—Humboldts  Researches , i.  287.  The  centre  house  of  Irru,  the 
Sun,  is  exhibited  with  the  mere  outline  of  the  back  of  the  white  horse ; the  centre  exhibits  the  Ratie- 
mangale,  or  divinity  of  the  earth,  associated  with  the  Naga  region  of  the  Jugandere,  as  appears  on  the  first 
Bali,  and  the  hog,  and  the  first  Dewa  heavens  of  Tjaturum-maha-raja.  The  character  of  the  emblems 
attached  to  these  figures,  their  singular  varieties,  and  the  position  of  the  planets,  no  doubt  indicate  the 
modes  of  their  application. 

The  ignorance  of  European  scholars  respecting  the  contents  of  the  astrological  works  of  the 
Orientals  causes  the  author  the  more  to  regret  that  such  imperfect  hints  as  the  preceding  are  all  that  can 
be  put  together;  they  are  merely  offered  as  proofs  that  these  schemes  are  not  a jumble  of  fictions,  or  the 
inventions  of  jugglers.  Whatever  there  may  be  of  idle  reverie  in  the  fantasies  of  astrology,  we  should 
reflect,  that  to  these  ideal  objects  we  owe  much  of  ancient  astronomy,  and  that  Sabeism,  or  planetary 
worship,  is  the  most  attractive  of  all  idolatrous  schemes.  It  is  fair  to  conclude,  that  the  mass  of  emblems 
which  these  incantations  exhibit  contain  a body  of  astronomical  calculations  on  different  juxta-positions 
of  the  planets.  A further  acquaintance  with  the  literature  of  the  Singalese,  guided  by  the  valuable  clue 
to  their  astrological  books,  may  fill  up  the  void  which  at  present  unfortunately  exists  in  the  astrological 
system. 


CHAPTER  XI 


THE  DEMONS. 


Others,  apart,  sat  on  a hill  retired. 

In  thoughts  more  elevate,  and  reason’d  high 
Of  providence,  fore- know  ledge,  will,  and  fate. 

Fix’d  fate,  free  will,  fore-knowledge  absolute, 

And  found  no  end,  in  wandering  mazes  lost. 

Of  good  and  evil,  much  they  argued  then. 

Of  happiness  and  final  misery, 

Passion  and  apathy,  and  glory  and  shame. 

Vain  wisdom  all,  and  false  philosophy. 

Milton's  Paradise  Lost. 


In  the  scheme  of  Budhism  there  are  to  be  found  traces  of  beings  superior  to  man,  to  whom  are  ascribed 
a rule  and  dominion  over  the  planets,  while  the  latter  are  also  considered  as  having  an  influence  on  the 
destiny  of  man.  That  these  demons  are  invested  with  the  faculty  of  surpassing  the  powers  of  nature,  is 
manifested  from  the  actions  ascribed  to  them;  such  as  looking  through  the  regions  of  the  different 
elements,  using  the  air  as  a medium  of  passing  from  region  to  region,  and,  in  fact,  exercising  the  powers 
of  the  elements.  These  beings,  therefore,  are  the  great  agents  of  magic,  and  although,  in  the  Budhist 
doctrine,  they  do  not  preside  over  the  elements,  they  appear  to  be  endowed  with  the  faculty  or  power  of 
using  them  at  will  to  fulfil  their  desires.  They  pervade  the  elements  of  earth,  air,  fire,  and  water,*  and 
severally  direct  their  properties  to  the  benefit  or  affliction  of  man. 

When  the  human  race  are  visited  by  diseases  and  sickness,  they  are  ascribed  to  the  demons,  or  such  as 
have  already  been  described  in  the  account  of  the  hill  gods  and  the  Bali.  These  cannot  be  ejected  but 
by  charms  and  incantations. 

*“In  the  system  of  Zoroaster,  as  there  are  good  demons,  so  are  there  those  of  darkness  and  immateriality.  These  consist  of  evil 
demons,  and  they  are  six  in  number.  The  first  of  these  inhabit  the  regions  more  immediately  sublunary  ; the  second,  the  regions  nearer 
to  the  earth,  dark,  stormy,  and  full  of  vapours;  the  third  are  those  malignant  and  unclean  spirits  that  range  the  earth;  the  fourth 
inhabit  the  depths  of  the  waters,  and  agitate  with  storms  and  whirlwinds  the  gloomy  abyss  of  the  ocean  ; the  fifth  are  subterraneous,  and 
delight  in  caverns  and  charnel-vaults  ; these  excite  earthquakes  and  all  other  internal  convulsions  in  the  bowels  of  the  harassed  globe ; 
the  sixth,  lucifugous,  and  hardly  sensible  of  animation,  or  capable  of  motion,  roam  through  the  profundities  of  darkness,  and  hold  their 
reign,  as  it  were,  in  the  very  centre  and  bosom  of  chaos.  All  these  obey  Ahriman  as  their  supreme  lord  and  captain." — Russell's 
Connexion , ii.  278. 


the  demons. 


127 


fn  the  aCC0UntS  of  Pythag0ras  we  are  able  t0  g“«>er  the  scope  and  doctrine  of  demon  worship  in  his 
time;  SmCe  P°rphyr-V  inf0™S  us  that  the  Pythagoreans  cured  diseases  of  the  mind  and  body  by  songs 
and  incantations,  affirming  that  Pythagoras  directed  certain  diseases,  which  lie  attributed  to  demons,  to 
be  cured  partly  by  incantations,  partly  by  magical  hymns,  and  partly  by  music.  This  sort  of  cure  was 
therefore  conducted  in  the  East,  at  that  remote  period,  on  much  the  same  principle  as  at  the  present  day 
“ U W3S  the  UniverSal  belief  of  the  Orientals,”  says  the  learned  Mosheim,  •<  that  certain  sounds  and  words, 
for  the  most  part  barbarous,  were  highly  grateful,  and  that  others  were  equally  disagreeable  to  those 
spirits.  Hence,  on  some  occasions,  the  magicians  composed  the  sacred  songs  of  the  words  which  were 
believed  to  be  agreeable  to  the  demons;  or,  if  for  the  purpose  of  their  expulsion,  in  strains  which  they 
deemed  that  the  demon  would  hear  with  horror.  From  the  same  persuasion,  they  suspended  from  the 
neck  of  a sick  person  an  amulet,  so  framed  as  to  become  influential  for  ejecting  the  demon  * 

In  Ceylon,  the  demon  faith  is  an  established  system.  The  boundary  line  between  worship  and 
offering  seems  to  the  mind  very  slender,  and  to  the  Christian,  as  far  as  concerns  the  heart,  it  is  indeed  a 
nonentity,  as  every  valuable  quality,  which  designates  the  service  of  a rational  creature,  is  as  much 
wanting  to  the  one  as  to  the  other.  In  the  view  of  the  scheme,  however,  it  becomes  very  material,  as 
identifying  the  class  of  doctrine,  because  demon  worship,  upon  the  basis  of  “ the  two  principles,”  wherein 
the  one  is  characterised  as  beneficent,  and  the  opposite  one  as  malignant,  is  the  primitive  demon  scheme, 
prevalent  throughout  the  pagan  world  in  the  earliest  ages,  and  antecedent  to  the  knowledge  of  “ a grand 
Adversary  to  God  and  Man.”  The  demon  service  of  Ceylon  still  retains  this  character;  it  has  its 
favourite  gods,  and  pays  them  homage  and  veneration  ;f  it  feeds  their  servants,  and  induces  long  and 
tedious  pilgrimages  to  their  sacred  high  places ; such  are  the  hills  celebrated  for  their  abode,  as  well  as 
the  chief  spots  of  the  Dewales, { which  are  shown  in  the  legends  of  Wisme-karma,  Kumara,  Sarnana-dewa, 
and  Wiebesene.  Every  misfortune  and  disease  has  its  presiding  demon,  and  monsters  are  represented, 
with  terrifying  forms,  inflicting  torments  upon  the  human  race ; and  yet  these  beings  are,  in  some  respect, 
made  servants  to  the  Budha.  Such  tenets  are  grafted  upon  the  same  stock  that  furnished  the  brilliant 
conceptions  of  the  Greeks,  and  mixed  with  legends,  which  it  would  leave  the  subject  imperfect  not  to 
touch  slightly  upon. 

There  are  a great  number  of  circumstances  recorded  in  pagan  writers,  corroborative  of  events, 


• For  the  groundwork  of  these  remarks,  see  the  excellent  article  on  Magic,  in  the  Encyclopcedia  Britannica,  whence  many  of  these 
ideas  were  taken. 

t “ The  Kappoerales,  though  by  no  means  respectable  for  rank  or  learning,  possess  unbounded  influence  over  the  lower  classes  of 
Singalese.  They  are  devoted  to  the  study  of  astrology,  and  the  people  have  recourse  to  them  on  every  emergency.  They  announce  the 
planet  under  which  the  child  is  born,  and  the  baneful  or  genial  influence  it  possesses.  The  Singalese,  who  are  attached  to  this  system, 
invariably  step  aside,  when  passing  a Dewale,  to  make  their  profound  obeisance  to  the  image  which  represents  the  presiding  demon  of  the 
spot,  and  to  deposit  an  offering  according  to  their  ability,  without  which  they  would  be  tormented  by  apprehension  of  some  calamity 
befalling  them." — Hanvard’s  Narrative,  preface,  li. 

| The  Dewales  of  Ceylon  are  perfectly  like  the  thatched  houses  for  the  demon  worship  of  Africa.  On  an  island,  at  the  mouth  of 
the  Rio  Pongas,  is  a small  town,  named  Debora,  inhabited  by  the  people  of  the  Bagoe  nation.  In  this  town  Mr.  Bickersteth  met  with 
more  marks  than  usual  of  superstition.  There  were  houses  for  the  worship  of  the  devil,  or  of  departed  spirits,  as  is  customary  in  the 
native  towns,  and  several  images  of  devils,  to  which  they  offer  sacrifices  Besides  these,  there  were  greegrees,  or  superstitious  charms,  on 
every  house.  The  house  of  spirits,  or  devil’s  house,  which  is  found  in  every  town,  consists  of  a small  hut,  three  or  four  feet  high,  raised 
on  posts  and  thatched  with  straw,  far  meaner  than  the  poorest  hovel.  Beneath  this  roof  is  a nest  of  termites,  or  large  ants ; or  there  are 
sticks  set  upright.  On  the  top  of  the  nest,  or  sticks,  are  placed  stones ; and  there  are  generally  by  the  side  a broken  plate,  and  a broken 
jug  or  bottle.  ° Before  these  houses,  the  blood  of  bulls,  goats,  or  cocks,  is  sprinkled;  and  a libation  of  palm  wine  is  poured  out,  and  an 
offering  of  fruits  or  rice  occasionally  made. 


12S 


THE  DEMONS. 


manifestly  transcending  the  powers  of  nature ; nor  can  we  otherwise  deal  with  them  than  by  denying,  in 
the  outset,  the  veracity  of  every  such  narrative,  or  of  admitting  a postulating  which  is  held  by  many 
well-regulated  and  reflecting  minds,  that  as  there  are  testimonies  of  the  highest  order  of  the  existence  of 
a class  of  beings  superior  to  man,  so  also  are  there  recorded  instances  of  their  intercourse  with  man.  AVe 
have  no  authoritative  statement  that  the  marked  visits,  so  delivered  down,  are  the  only  ones ; and  in  the 
former  ages  of  the  world,  evil  visitations,  as  well  as  good,  may  have  been  a part  of  the  permissions  of 
superior  wisdom.  The  prevalence  of  the  belief  gains  credence  for  the  strongly  attested  cases ; such,  for 
instance,  may  be  deemed  the  embassy  sent  by  Crcesus  to  the  famed  oracles  of  Greece,  and  the  mode 
whereby  he  determined  to  try  their  claim  to  supernatural  power,  recorded  by  Herodotus  (Clio  -IT);  and 
also  the  discomfiture  and  destruction  of  the  army  of  Brennus,  the  Gaul,  before  Athens.  Whatever  might 
be  the  origin  of  the  spirits  of  the  air,  as  here  recorded,  both  these  and  the  oracles,  so  celebrated,  fell  into 
contempt  and  disuse  in  the  reign  of  Tiberius,  for  which,  among  others,  we  have  the  testimony  of  Plutarch 
in  the  following  remarkable  narrative,  to  which  he  attaches  much  credit,  and  endeavours  thereby  to  account 
for  the  fact  of  the  cessation  of  oracles  in  his  time,  by  supposing  that  the  demons,  who  conducted  those 
oracles,  though  longer  lived  than  men,  were  then  dead. — “ In  the  time  of  Tiberius  (in  whose  reign  Christ 
was  crucified),  some  persons,  embarking  from  Asia  for  Italy,  towards  the  evening,  sailed  ) tie 
Echinades  (five  little  islands  in  the  Ionian  sea),  where,  being  becalmed,  they  heard  from  thence  a loud 
voice  calling  one  Thamus,  an  Egyptian  mariner,  among  them,  and  after  the  third  time,  commanding  him, 
when  he  came  to  the  Palodes,  to  declare  that  the  Greek  Pan  was  dead.  With  the  advice  of  his  company  he 
resolved,  that  if  they  had  a quick  gale  when  they  came  to  the  Palodes,  he  would  pass  by  silently  ; but  if 
they  should  find  themselves  becalmed  there,  he  would  then  perform  what  the  voice  had  commanded. 
But  when  the  ship  arrived  there,  there  was  neither  any  breeze  of  wind,  nor  any  agitation  of  water. 
Whereupon  Thamus,  looking  out  of  the  stern  toward  the  Palodes,  pronounced  these  words  with  a loud 
voice — ‘ The  great  Pan  is  dead,’  which  he  had  no  sooner  done,  than  he  was  answered  by  a chorus  of  many 
voices,  making  a great  howling  and  lamentation,  not  without  a mixture  of  admiration.”  Plutarch  says 
that  Tiberius  took  pains  to  ascertain  the  fact,  and  inquired  among  his  learned  men  who  this  Pan  could 
be.  Whether  this  story  be  true  or  not,  in  the  name  Pan,  and  the  aerial  demon’s  application  to  an 
Egyptian  mariner  alone,  of  all  the  crew,  there  seems  to  be  a marked  allusion  to  the  celebiated 
inscription  on  the  temple  of  Neith,  or  the  Goddess  of  Wisdom,  at  Sais,  in  Egypt.  Hales  Chi  analogy, 
xi.  766. 

Although  Budhism  favours,  in  many  portions  of  its  doctrine,  the  tenet  which  considers  the  demon 
gods  to  have  been,  in  process  of  their  existence,  the  soids  of  men  exalted  for  exemplary  conduct  to  the 
heavens,  and  therein,  as  gods  of  the  Dewa  Loka,  presiding  over  and  directing  the  affairs  of  men,  yet  this 
belief,  which  recals  to  our  minds  the  great  union  of  Sabeism  and  demon  idolatry,  is  not  developed  to  an) 
extent  in  modern  Budhism.  Its  ancient  dogmas  probably  partook  more  copiously  of  this  refined 
speculation,*  which  seems  warranted  by  the  clearer  views  and  accordance  with  patriarchal  events,  which 

* The  following  remark  on  this  subject  is  so  beautiful,  that  it  deserves  to  have  a place  in  every  comment  on  this  curious  point  of 
history. — “As  the  awful  history  of  the  deluge  is  written  in  the  sphere,  and  since  each  star  was  thought  to  be  animated  by  an  intelligence, 
whose  mortal  body  had  once  lived  upon  earth,  we  may  easily  perceive  whence  all  the  follies  of  judicial  astrology  have  originated. 

“Astronomy,  blended  with  hero  worship,  certainly  originated  at  Babylon,  agreeably  to  the  very  just  remark  of  Herodotus,  that  the 
Egyptians  received  it  from  the  Babylonians;  this  was  the  primeval  centre  whence  it  avus  carried  to  all  parts  of  the  world. 
Faber , i.  3y- 


THE  DEMONS. 


129 


characterise  the  earlier  chapters  of  its  theological  history.  The  Budha  doctrine  is  deemed  by  Sir.  Faber 
to  be  a more  consistent  one  than  the  Braminical  scheme,  as  it  displays  more  distinctly  the  character  of 
materialism,  and  therein  is  uniform  in  its  views.  That  it  cannot  be  sustained  in  its  claims  seems  to  be 
however,  by  its  votaries  (no  mean  reasoners),  when  pushed  hardly  upon  the  thesis  of  its 
reasonings.  Its  doctrine  ascribes  the  state  of  the  devils,  or  demons,*  to  the  falling  off  of  the  race  of  men 
from  their  original  felicity ; and  also  teaches  that  devils,  who  die  and  are  born  again  (namely,  who  are 
involved  in  the  pains  of  the  transmigration)*  may,  by  perseverance,  attain  to  the  felicity  that  is  the  highest 
state  of  Nil*  wan  a.  Now,  as  the  offenders  who  are  most  severely  punished,  and  most  harshly  accused  in 
the  Budha  s doctrine,  namely,  the  deitti,  or  impious  men,  who  deny  his  supremacy,  are  nevertheless 
declared  capable  of  repentance,  and  thereby,  in  a certain  time,  of  meliorating  their  condition,  and  again 
of  entering  into  the  probationary  stages,  it  is  clear  that  every  being,  however  degraded,  revolves  in  a 
prescribed  circle,  and  is  progressing  or  retrograding.  There  can  be  no  pause  in  the  rotary  scheme  of 
revolving  events.  While  this  tenet  holds  good  of  the  doctrine  of  Budhism,  there  is  much  of  magic 
mixed  up  with  it,  the  growth  of  another  and  older  system,  and  its  intermixture  is  strongly  stamped  with 
different  qualities : thus  the  inhabitants  of  a region  often  referred  to,  named  Jugandere,  do  not  appear 
ostensibly  to  progress  onward  to  the  regions  of  the  Brahma  Loka,  or  to  drop  down  into  the  regions  of 
humanity.  They  are  demons,  as  far  as  malignity  and  the  power  of  inflicting  disease  and  calamity  can 
merit  the  term  ; and  they  seem  to  be  permitted  to  exercise  at  will  these  odious  qualities,  without 
apparently  being  thereby  in  danger  of  forfeiture  of  their  station  and  great  power. 

There  can  be  no  stronger  proof  offered  that  the  doctrine  of  the  Gaudma  Budha  is  a reforming 
scheme,  which  was  obliged  to  bend  to  circumstances,  and  to  incorporate  parts  of  other  systems,  than  to 
present  a list  of  the  various  demons.  The  Budha  books  and  doctrine  seemingly  display  marks  of  at 
least  three  essentially  different  doctrines.  The  Nirwana  of  the  Budha,  and  the  Asura  I, oka,  or  eternal 
Zian,  seem  anterior  to  Gaudma.  The  serpent  and  demon  gods  also  represent  the  ancient  primitive 
idolatry ; and  the  metempsychosis,  the  scope  of  Gaudma’s  scheme,  concocts  together  these  relics  and 
fragments  of  extraneous  principles. 

The  classes  of  the  demons  alone  are  six  in  number — 1st.  the  infernal  demons  in  torments;  2nd.  the 
demons  also  in  punishment,  “ who  die  and  are  born  again,”  which  inferentially  excludes  the  former  from 
this  privilege ; 3rd.  the  demons  which  follow  the  Wassawarty-raja  or  rebel  chief  of  the  Dewa  Loka, 
but  are  also  among  the  Asuras,  as  their  appearance  testifies,  with  their  leader  rising  from  the  abyss  or 
the  centre  stone,  in  open  hostility  against  the  Budha;  4th.  the  Asuras  under  Wiebesana,  who  assist 
Sekkraia  against  his  enemy,  the  Asura-raja  of  the  Asura  Loka  or  hells.  These  Asura  inhabit  the 
Dewa  Loka,  and  attend  the  judge  of  mortals  after  death,  to  inflict  the  punishments  awarded.  The 
doctrine  affirms,  however,  that  such  sad  office  interferes  not  with  their  enjoying  the  same  felicity  as  their 
divine  companions.  5th.  The  divine  snakes  and  magic  giants,  evidently  a portion  of  the  idolatrous  faith 


• They  say  that  the  devils,  when  nature  produced  sun,  moon,  and  stars,  were  human  beings,  who,  on  account  of  their  horrible  sins^ 
fell  from  the  state  of  felicity  ; but  their  having  been  gods,  or  fallen  angels,  or  their  having  been  created,  or  having  existed  from  eternity, 
is  denied  ; and  they  say  further  that  devils,  who  commit  deeper  sins  than  those  which  they  suffer  for  already,  are  condemned  to  greater 
torments  ,■  and  that  even  condemned  men  are  reckoned  amongst  the  infernal  demons.  On  the  contrary,  the  devils,  who  die,  and  are  born 
again  as  men,  and  commit  no  more  sin,  can  come  to  the  state  of  felicity  ; and,  consequently,  angels  are  found,  who  are  superior  and 
inferior  in  rank,  in  proportion  to  the  sins  committed  by,  but  not  imputed  to,  them. 


130 


THE  DEMONS. 


of  Ceylon,  which  the  Budha  Gaudma  sought  to  reform  ; for  his  history  represents  his  descent  on  Ceylon 
as  being  accomplished  only  through  their  fright  occasioned  by  his  miracles,  and  his  banishing  or  placing 
them  in  the  sphere  of  the  elements  in  the  Jugandere  mountains  and  caves.  6th.  The  devils  of  the  island, 
the  subjects  of  the  Bali,  or  magical  incantations  and  songs,  and  of  the  following  details.  They  arc 
curious  transcripts  of  the  principal  actions  of  the  demons,  which  are  historically  recorded  by  the  followers 
of  the  Budha,  and  form  the  only  faithful  sources  whence  we  can  deduce  the  actual  tone  and  character  of 
their  influence. 


EXPLANATION  OF  PLATES  XXXIX.  TO  XLIII. 

The  first  demon  represented  in  these  plates  is  the  goddess  Pattinee,*  in  the  upper  compartment 
on  the  left.  She  belongs  to  the  Nekates,  and  lias  also  the  gift  of  healing.  In  the  appearance  of  this 
character  as  presiding  among  the  demons,  and  also  the  power  which  she  is  represented  oftentimes  to 
exercise  in  their  behalf,  we  have  the  strongest  evidence  how  much  the  system  of  magic  and  demon 
idolatry  has  been  interwoven  with  the  Budhist  system. 

Mr.  Harward  cites  Dr.  Davy  for  the  observation,  “ that  it  is  not  uncommon  to  see  a Dewale  and  a 
Wihari  (a  Budhist  temple)  contiguous,  or  even  under  the  same  roof and  Dr.  Davy  adds,  “ this  may  be 
considered  not  merely  tolerated,  but  quite  orthodox” — on  which  Mr.  Harward  observes,  “ that  neither  are 
the  Kapooistic  demons  consistent  with  pure  Budhism,  and  nothing  can  be  more  heterodox.”  The  doctrine 
evidently  denounces  the  worship  of  demons,  but  expressly  encourages  Dewales,  and  prescribes  the  service; 
and  moreover  the  Budha  countenanced  one  of  these  gods,  Samana-dewa,  by  the  delivery  of  his  seat  of 
power  and  sacred  tree,  to  reclaim  thereby  the  Nagas  or  serpent  worshippers  to  his  faith. 

The  demon  Maha-kalyaka,  or  great  black  devil  (plate  39,  lower  compartment  on  the  right),  who  is 
one  of  the  foreign  devils,  and  the  same  demon  as  Kale-kumara,  No.  4.  When  offerings  are  made  to  him 
the  magician  should  dance,  repeating  magical  words.  In  addition  to  his  figure,  as  represented  here  and  in 
No.  4,  he  is  seen  seizing  an  elephant  with  his  teeth,  drinking  the  blood,  and  the  bowels  hanging  down 
from  his  mouth,  and  having  white  and  black  cloths  on  his  body — he  is  always  mounted  on  a bull.  This 
history  appears  in  Kumara-pantiya. 

The  demon  Ayiraaha-yakseya  (plate  39),  also  called  Molangarrawah,  is  one  of  the  twelve 
Garrah-yaccahse  demons.  He  has  long  whiskers,  holds  a cock  in  his  hand,  and  his  face  is  like  that 
of  a man  having  a bloody  forehead.  His  figure  should  stand  at  the  corners  and  angles  of  places. 
He  inflicts  on  mankind  the  following  diseases — head-aches,  swellings,  and  fluxes.  When  rice  boiled 


* The  following  is  a literal  copy  of  a Singalese  account  of  this  personage: — “The  reason  that  the  people  are  frightened  in  swearing 
upon  the  Ilallamba  now  in  use  for  that  purpose,  is  a persuasion  that  vengeance  will  come  upon  those  who  are  falsely  sworn,  or  disregard 
the  said  Ilallamba,  it  being  an  ornament  which  was  worn  by  the  personage  named  Pattinee  Dewiyoo,  whom  they  believe  to  be  a goddess, 
and  the  author  of  pestilence  or  plagues  prevailing  in  the  world.  This  personage  is  said  to  have  been  formed  by  chance,  and  to  have 
preserved  her  virginity  during  her  existence  in  this  world,  although  a person  of  the  name  of  Palanga  Gurmonansey  was  denominated  her 
husband.  He  squandered  all  his  possessions  for  a woman  of  the  name  of  Perunkaly,  with  whom  he  lived  in  fornication ; at  last  he 
attempted  to  sell  the  Hallamba  which  the  Pattinee  had  worn,  and  being  discovered  in  the  act  by  a goldsmith,  he  was  taken  before  the 
king  named  Pandy-raja,  upon  the  supposition  that  the  Hallamba  which  he  was  thus  offering  for  sale  was  the  same  which  belonged  to  the 
queen,  and  was  then  sought  for  in  that  city,  it  having  been  unknowingly  swallowed  by  a peacock.  The  king,  not  knowing  what  had 
become  of  the  ornament  belonging  to  the  queen,  believed  that  this  was  the  same,  and  that  it  had  been  stolen  : he  therefore  thought  proper 
to  put  Palanga  Gurmonansey  to  death,  but  he  was  restored  to  life  again  by  his  wife,  who  also  recovered  the  queen's  ornament  from  the 
peacock.  She  performed  various  other  miracles,  and  has  been  acknowledged  from  that  period  as  a goddess. 


4(> 


The.  Devil  ccdUd  Coonwrn 


The  Demon.  called.  Jb.reu 


The  Demon  called  7)ewr/ 


The  Di  /nor.  called . 'ifaAa.tr  l an 


Tie  clief  §le  Devil. 
w7w  is  one  of  the  Foreign  Denis. 


f 


Tie  Devil  called  AY1MAPTE . 


THE  DEMONS. 


13  L 


with  milk,  and  the  cakes  called  Cabelloo  are  placed  at  the  foot  of  rocks  as  an  offering  to  this  demon, 
he  will  eat  them,  and  release  the  person  on  whom  he  may  have  inflicted  any  of  the  diseases.  He  always 
frequents  the  doors  and  corners  of  houses  in  quest  of  food  when  people  are  eating.  If  any  person 
happens  to  be  eating  what  the  demon  might  see  and  long  for,  that  person  would  be  seized  with  indigestion 
and  other  complaints  in  the  stomach.  To  obtain  relief  from  this  illness,  offerings  of  bran  are  made.— 
This  is  a poor  and  humble  demon. 

Huniyan-yakseya  demon  (plate  39)  -was  originally  called  Oddiyakseya.  He  has  the  power  of 
transforming  himself  into  three  different  shapes,  namely,  Huniyan-y,  Oddisa  (plate  43),  and  Sanny-y. 
When  one  person  does  an  injury  to  another  through  this  demon  by  means  of  magic,  the  demon  takes  the 
shape  of  Huniyan-y,  and  the  disease  which  he  inflicts  under  that  shape  is  called,  in  Singalese,  Huniyan 
Dosa.  When  he  inflicts  the  disease  called  Sanniyah  upon  mankind,  he  takes  the  shape  called  Sanny-y. 
His  dress  is  formed  of  twenty-eight  Cobra-copiles,  who  are  twisting  round  his  body  : his  eyes  are  blue, 
his  body  is  of  a gold  colour ; he  has  a fierce  face,  and  is  mounted  on  a horse,  having  about  him  a pot  of 
fire.  He  has  on  his  head  twenty  heads  of  Cobra-copiles,  holding  in  his  hands,  a set  of  beads  called  in 
Singalese  Laccawella,  and  a book. 

This  is  a most  fierce  and  cruel  demon,  through  whom  dangerous  diseases  are  inflicted  on  mankind 
by  magic,  such  as  swellings  and  stiffness  of  the  joints ; crookedness  in  the  mouth,  legs,  and  arms ; 
burning,  and  pain  in  the  body.  This  kind  of  Huniyan , or  evils,  are  to  be  cured  by  means  of  magic, 
and  by  making  offerings  and  sacrifices. 

Kale-kumara-yakseya  (plate  39)  is  a demon  of  a fierce  black  countenance,  with  four  arms: 
he  wears  three  Cobra-copiles  on  his  head,  and  a spotted  ocelot  or  tiger's  head  from  each  shoulder ; in  one 
hand  he  holds  a cock  or  sacrifice,  and  in  the  other  a naga  branch  ; on  his  girdle  appears  the  bird  or  garuda, 
as  worn  by  the  Pattinee  goddess. 

The  demon  Mahasona-yakseya  (plate  40)  has  four  names ; the  above  Mahasona,  Yayason-yakseya, 
Genie-sona,  and  Ley-sona.  He  transforms  himself  into  four  different  shapes,  and  inflicts  diseases  on  men. 
In  ancient  times  he  had  a battle  with  the  giant  Godimbere,  and  from  a blow  given  by  the  giant  he  lost 
his  head,  and  then  the  god  Genesura  brought  a head  of  a bear,  and  placed  it  on  the  body  of  the  devil ; 
since  which  time  he  is  called  Maha-sona,  and,  with  permission  of  the  god  Wese-munie,  he  now  watches 
in  burying-grounds,  and  makes  people  sick.  When  persons  are  affected  with  any  disease  by  means  of 
this  devil,  an  image  is  prepared,  and  offerings  made  to  him  for  their  recovery. 

This  figure  has  three  marks  on  the  forehead,  and  one  on  the  eye-brow,  two  on  the  middle  of  the 
belly,  and  another  on  the  thigh,  a lighted  candle  or  chule  (a  torch  or  flambeau  of  the  cocoa-nut  tree)  in 
his  hand,  and  a flower  in  one  side  of  the  belly.  The  face  is  that  of  a bear,  of  large  size,  with  long  hair 
all  about  the  body,  and  jaws  beset  with  formidable  teeth.  He  holds  a pike  in  the  right  hand,  and  an 
elephant  by  the  left,  squeezing  its  trunk,  and  sucking  out  its  blood.  This  devil  rides  on  a hog,  and 
knocks  out  the  brains  of  the  elephants  by  a single  blow  with  his  fist,  and  other  greater  gods  show  him 
much  favour.  This  Bali  figure  is  to  be  kept  in  a place  where  three  streets  meet  together. 

Riry-yakseya  (plate  40),  a female  demon,  so  called  as  being  born  of  blood.  She  lias  a monkey  face, 
her  body  the  colour  of  gold ; her  figure  is  to  be  made  of  mud,  having  on  the  breast  a pond  of  blood,  with 
a goat,  a cock,  and  a man ; it  must  be  placed  in  an  awitte  ground  or  field  in  the  evening,  at  which  time 
the  offerings  called  Tattu  are  to  be  placed  on  the  four  sides  of  it,  for  the  recovery  of  the  diseases  which 

s2 


132 


THE  DEMONS. 


she  inflicts  on  mankind,  which  are  those  proceeding  from  blood. — The  history  is  in  the  book  Baiegry 
Paliya. 

Kumara  (plate  40),  has  a red  body  shining  like  fire,  a sacrifice  in  the  right  hand  of  a fowl,  and  some  naga 
branches  in  the  left  hand,  a shining  black  cloth  round  the  body,  a green  face,  with  a red  cap  on  his  head : 
lie  stands  on  his  right  foot  upon  a rock  ; his  teeth  are  of  the  shape  of  a half-moon ; and  he  walks  about 
in  search  of  blood-offerings,  bloody  flesh,  and  human  flesh  ; he  glances  around,  often  pulling  his  whiskers. 
The  offering  should  be  made  to  him  called  Sameya-ballia  in  this  manner : A figure  made  of  mud  in 
the  shape  of  a woman,  the  hair  tied  towards  the  right  side  of  the  head,  having  golden  ear  ornaments  called 
todu,  the  rigid  arm  as  if  thrown  round  the  neck  of  her  husband,  who  appears  to  be  embracing  her ; her 
dress  of  flowers  and  garlands.  This  demon  can  inflict  evils  on  women  only,  causing  madness  and 
faintings,  and  destroying  conception  in  women. 

The  devil  Devol  (plate  40),  is  a god  lately  known  on  the  island  of  Ceylon.  Having  loaded  seven  vessels, 
he  was  coming  to  the  island  from  Bengal,  and  in  the  high  seas  the  ships  being  wrecked,  he  got  into  a stone 
raft  made  for  him  by  Manemake-lowe,  the  goddess  of  the  sea,  and  arrived  at  Ginigame,  in  Ceylon,  where 
he  came  on  the  island,  and  obtained  the  title  of  Devol  from  the  goddess  Pattinee,  and  since  that  time 
he  receives  offerings  in  the  same  modo  or  room  with  Pattinee.  He  is  not  a demon  that  does  harm  to  the 
people  as  the  other  devils ; but  if  any  offerings  usually  made  to  him  by  the  prosperous  of  the  world  are 
neglected,  he  does  mischief.  There  is  no  danger  from  him  for  people  that  do  not  worship  or  serve  him. — 
From  the  book  Panti  Col-murra. 

Gara-yakseya  (plates  41  and  43).  There  are  twelve  demons  called  Gara-yakseya ; but  the  most 
powerful  of  them  is  the  one  born  of  the  queen  Hanswetty,  and  begotten  by  the  seer  Somedanta.  This 
demon  is  called  also  Dalle-kumarayah  and  Dalle-rakseyah.  His  eyes  are  like  two  godaw  fruits ; his  two 
ears  are  like  two  fans  called  watapat,  and  he  has  two  Cobra-copiles  on  his  turban.  He  is  capable  of  eating 
at  a time  700,000  cocoa-nuts,  and  an  ammunam  of  rice,  and  drinking  a boatful  of  blood,  and  as  much  water 
as  half  the  sea;  and  as  he  was  very  cruel,  Saturn  (Budha)  sent  upon  him  a poisonous  smoke,  which  burned 
his  face;  whereupon  he  went  to  the  demon  Pattinee,  who  saved  him.  Since  that  time  he  has  been 
called  by  the  name  of  Gara-yakseya,  and  begun  to  save  men  from  the  evils  of  other  demons.  When  a 
person  suffers  from  a demon,  sacrifices  are  offered  to  Gara,  with  dancing,  by  the  devil-dancer  wearing  a 
mask  representing  the  features  of  this  demon. — This  history  appears  in  the  book  Garu-duta. 

Sanni-yakseya  (plate  41).  The  same  demon  as  Huniyan,  under  the  form  of  Sanni.  When  he 
inflicts  sickness,  sacrifices  must  be  offered  to  this  demon  for  the  disease. 

Ihe  demon  Amoo-sohan  (plate  41).  He  has  the  power  of  transforming  himself  into  two  different 
shapes,  as  Amoo-sohan  and  Lai-sohan.  He  commonly  frequents  burying-grounds.  The  evils  which  this 
demon  inflicts  on  man  are  swellings,  putrid  diseases,  fever,  head-ache,  &c.  To  obtain  a cure  his  figure 
must  be  made  of  mud,  and  sacrifices  offered.  The  shape  must  have  a fierce  countenance,  of  blue  and 
blood  colour,  having  under  his  foot  a dead  body,  on  the  bowels  of  which  he  is  feeding,  and  two  birds 
called  henza,  one  on  each  shoulder,  and  a lion  at  his  right  foot.  In  two  of  his  hands  he  holds  a cup,  and 
a weapon  called  colay  a. 

1 he  Great  Black  Devil,  who  is  one  of  the  foreign  demons  (plate  41),  has  the  boon  of  16,000  queens. 
His  figure  is  to  be  made  of  mud,  having  a cap  on  his  head,  four  hands  holding  two  swords,  a shield,  and 
a pointed  iron  ; besides  which,  four  buffaloes  are  to  be  made  round  about  him,  and  on  his  head,  breast. 


/ 


V 


• \ 


THE  DEMONS. 


133 

and  belly  sixteen  heads  of  tigers ; a Cobra-copile  twisting  round  his  waist,  and  also  having  on  his  crown 
a Cobra-copile.  This  demon  inflicts  diseases  upon  women  and  children  only ; for  the  recovery  of  such 
diseases,  devil-dancing  is  to  be  performed,  and  offerings  and  sacrifices  prepared. 

The  she-demon  Mahakale-kumara  (plate  42),  is  the  chief  demon  amongst  the  foreign  devils.  The 
diseases  which  she  causes  to  mankind  are  vomiting  of  blood,  bloody  flux  and  fainting  in  children,  also  the 
pains  which  cause  the  crying  of  infants,  &c. 

The  demon  Devol  (plate  42).  On  a Certain  boon  being  given  by  the  god  Iswara  to  Basmasura,  he 
happening  to  lay  his  hand  on  his  own  head,  it  was  burned  away ; from  these  flames  the  demon  Devol 
was  produced,  from  the  sparks  the  seven  demons  called  Koorumberra,  and  from  the  charcoal  the  black 
devil.  All  these  demonshad  gone  to  the  country  called  Mallela,  and  having  spoken  with  some  merchants 
of  the  town  called  Pooduppura,  to  come  to  the  island  of  Ceylon,  they  fitted  out  seven  ships,  and  at  a 
lucky  moment  they  sailed ; but  on  account  of  their  primitive  sin,  seven  days  after  they  had  sailed,  a 
tempest  arose,  accompanied  with  rain,  thunder,  and  lightning.  The  sea  was  so  agitated  and  foaming, 
that  the  ships  were  dashed  one  against  another,  and  wrecked.  At  this  juncture,  when  the  crews  were  in 
danger  of  perishing,  the  goddess  of  the  sea  called  Marriene-kali,  brought  some  rafts  of  stone,  which  by 
her  power  she  caused  to  float,  to  their  relief.  When  on  these  rafts  they  came  near  to  land,  the 
goddess  Pattinee  would  not  suffer  them  to  land  in  Ceylon  ; and  to  prevent  this,  by  her  power  she  made 
seven  different  rows  of  flaming  fire  along  the  sea-shore ; but  the  demon  called  Devol,  without  the  least 
fear,  passed  through  the  fire,  and  came  to  land  at  Sinigam-Moderra,  and  having  seen  the  village 
Weregodda,  Devol  obtained  permission  to  receive  sacrifices  at  eight  different  villages  ever  since  that 
time. 

Oddisa  (plate  43).  A personification  of  Huniyan,  who  has  the  power  of  transforming  himself  into 
three  forms. 

Mahason  demon  (plate  43).  The  same  as  the  demon  (plate  40). 

The  different  kinds  of  devil-dancing,  and  worshipping  of  demons,  are  the  following 


Yate-kawe,  offering  prayers  to  perform  certain  ceremonies. 

Eppe-kap,  the  same. 

Jatika-kap,  the  same. 

Devol-bage,  an  offering  to  the  demon  Devol. 

Devol-maduwe,  a great  ceremony  and  offering. 

Gam-maddu,  a very  great  sacrifice  and  offering. 

Gie-maddu,  a ceremony  above  all. 

Paan-maddu,  offering  lamps. 

Maboroe-maddu. 

Nooly-antra,  a ceremony  to  the  devils. 

Piede-anie,  offering  meats  to  them. 

Rattiya-rume,  a ceremony  to  the  devils. 

Maha-sammeyan,  the  same. 

Huniyan- reppume,  the  same. 

Kumare-sameyeme,  the  same. 

Kale-kumara-sameyeme,  the  same.  ^ 

Sumisoeniau,  the  same. 

Mangere,  the  same. 

Garrewa,  a ceremony  when  any  person’s  health  is  considered  to  be  affected  by  the  sight  of  another. 
Mall  Bali,  offering  to  the  planets  of  small  degree. 

Keendre-mall  Bali,  a greater  offering  to  the  same 


134 


THE  DEMONS. 


Maha-mall  Bali,  of  a great  degree. 
Att-mall  Bali,  of  a small  degree. 
Ken-kerieme,  a sympathetic  cure. 
Ralehamy-piedieme,  an  offering  of  meats. 


Sufficient  notice  has  been  taken  of  a system  of  service  so  derogatory  to  the  nature  and  character  of 
man  ; but  while  this  sentiment  would,  it  seems,  spring  up  spontaneously  in  the  heart  of  every  being 
who  enjoys  such  privileges  as  those  of  this  happy  land,  the  consideration  of  such  matters  comes  fraught 
with  eminent  utility  when  it  produces  the  conviction,  that  were  we  confined  to  the  bounds  to  which 
human  reason  alone  would  cany  us,  the  concurrent  testimony  of  all  history  would  declare  that  we  should 
be  no  better  than  these  votaries  of  the  demons.  The  scheme  of  the  Budha  Gaudma  revived  most 
probably  the  materialism  of  a former  period,  with  tenets  which  still  faintly  portray  a first  cause ; such  as 
the  Budha’s  gift  of  supreme  bliss,  and  other  subtle  distinctions  scattered  here  and  there  in  the  system,  of 
which,  as  yet,  we  know  but  little.  Setting  himself  up  as  a teacher,  he  attached  rewards  and  punishments 
to  the  due  observance  of  the  law  which  he  came  on  earth  to  declare,  and  building  up  the  system  upon  a 
basis  of  moral  precepts,  he  so  framed  their  graduatory  scale,  as  to  establish  upon  the  metempsychosis 
a sort  of  corrective  and  guiding  principle  for  his  proselytes.  There  is  much  of  contradiction  in  the  parts, 
which  may  be  explained  or  reconciled  by  further  discoveries ; such  for  instance  as  a positive  law  of 
necessity  leading  the  system  of  the  universe  through  its  regular  and  fixed  periods  of  destruction  and 
reproduction ; while  the  doctrine  also  teaches  that  men  may,  by  their  rigid  observance  of  the  Budha’s 
laws,  increase  the  wealth  and  riches  of  the  world,  and  bring  back  again  the  golden  age.  If  man  can,  by 
any  act  of  obedience,  alter  the  destiny  and  progress  of  the  world  (and  to  such  acts  the  gods  of  the  Dewa 
Loka  exhort  and  encourage  men  to  aspire),  then  there  is  no  existence  for  fatalism.  Such,  however,  is 
recognised  in  the  system,  which  turns  on  works  to  the  exclusion  of  all  worship.  The  Budha  is  not 
worshipped,  but  addressed,  or  propitiated ; the  whole  legend  of  Gaudma,  his  actions,  and  the  homage 
paid  to  him  by  his  followers,  and  ascribed  to  him  by  the  sacred  books,  indicate  the  character  of  a 
di\  ine  teacher,  01  Muni ; not  that  of  a supreme  God,  according  to  our  acceptation  of  the  term.  Nothing 
can  surpass  the  attention  paid  by  the  Singalese  to  the  bana  of  the  Budha:  while  engaged  in 
communicating  instruction  to  the  people  in  the  temporary  buildings  of  leaves,  erected  for  the  purpose, called 
Bana-mandooas,  the  priests  skreen  their  faces  from  their  auditors  by  a sort  of  fan.  As  many  priests  are 
in  attendance,  the  services  are  continued  for  several  successive  nights,  the  congregations  assembling 
after  sunset.  The  people  sit  during  the  service  on  their  heels,  and  with  admirable  patience  continue  in 
that  posture  several  hours,  occasionally  expressing  by  a kind  of  chorus,  which  may  be  heard  at  a 
considerable  distance,  their  admiration  of  the  doctrine. 

Thus  also  Mr.  Judson,  describing  a popular  Budhist  preacher,  observes — “ When  all  things  were 
propci  1)  adjusted,  the  preacher  closed  his  eyes,  and  commenced  the  exercise,  which  consisted  in  repeating 
a portion  from  the  sacred  writings.  His  subject  was  the  conversion  of  the  two  prime  disciples  of 
Gaudma,  and  their  subsequent  promotion  and  glory.  His  oratory  I found  to  be  entirely  different  from 
all  that  we  call  oratory ; at  first  he  seemed  dull  and  monotonous,  but  presently  his  soft  mellifluent  tones 
uon  their  way  into  the  heart,  and  lulled  the  soul  into  that  state  of  calmness  and  serenity  which,  to  the 
mind  of  a Budhist,  somewhat  resembles  the  boasted  perfection  of  their  saints  of  old.  His  discourse 


* 


THE  DEMONS.  135 

continued  about  half  an  hour,  and  at  the  close  the  whole  assembly  burst  out  into  a short  prayer,  after 
which  all  rose  and  retired.” 

So  softly  seductive  are  the  habits  wherewith  the  preachers  of  the  Budha  (jaudt.ia  enounce  his  mild 
and  blandly  tempered  doctrine.  If  the  morality  be  examined,  its  exhortations  to  guard  me  w.U,  to  curb 
the  thought,  to  exercise  kindness  to  others,  to  abstain  from  wrong  to  all,  propound  to  its  followers  a \ *ry 
high  standard  of  practice,  but — 

" though  it  seem’d 

For  dignity  composed,  and  high  exploit. 

Yet  all  was  false  and  hollow 

for  the  operation  of  the  law  is  frustrated  and  neutralized  by  its  own  innate  imperfections.  The  system 
of  the  Budha  Gaudma  now  established,  rests  upon  the  ruins  of  a former  edifice,  from  which  it  derives  no 
strength.  The  everlasting  fate,  and  the  doctrine  of  Nirwana,  are  altogether  too  subtle,  too  refined,  for 
the  check,  or  control,  of  the  hopes  and  fears  and  vices  of  man  ; the  distinguishing  tenets,  the 
substitution  of  an  incarnation  of  the  divine  energy,  in  some  deified  hero,  or  sage,  for  the  creator  of  all 
things,  leaving  the  Budha  in  Nirwana,  so  abstracted  in  his  essence,  that  he  is  scarcely  the  object  of  hope 
or  of  fear ; and  but  for  the  metempsychosis,  or  retributive  doctrine  of  transmigration,  his  influence  would 
be  lost  from  the  system.  The  reasoning  powers  of  the  Budhists  are  of  a very  high  class,  and  it  requires 
an  intimate  acquaintance  with  their  scope  of  argument  to  escape  being  misled  in  the  very  first  step,  and 
adjudging  the  whole  scheme  (as  it  often  has  been  erroneously  denominated)  “ an  atheology.”  Thus,  in  the 
pages  of  the  Journal  of  Mr.  Judson,  the  exemplary  Baptist  Missionary  to  the  Burmese  Empire,  he 
observes — “ Ooyan,  a teacher,  admitted  that  the  atheistic  system  of  the  Budha  was  not  tenable.”  Again — 
“ All  the  visitors  to-day,  and,  indeed,  all  the  semi-atheists,  are  despisers  of  Gaudma,  and  the  established 
religion  of  the  land.  Moung-shway-guang  has  disseminated  this  heresy  in  Rangoon  for  many  years. 
Again — “ Ooyan  is  of  a strong  mind,  capable  of  grasping  the  most  difficult  subjects.  His  words  are  as 
smooth  as  oil,  as  sweet  as  honey,  and  as  sharp  as  razors ; his  mode  of  reasoning  is  soft,  insinuating,  and 
acute,  and  so  adroitly  did  he  act  his  part,  that  Moung-shway-guang,  with  his  strong  arm,  and  I,  with  the 
strength  of  truth,  were  scarcely  able  to  keep  him  down.”  Yet,  after  all  these  conversations  with  the 
Budhist  teachers  themselves,  assisted  by  a knowledge  of  the  language,  Mr.  Judson  saw  reason  to 
determine  that  he  had  utterly  mistaken  the  doctrine  he  had  termed  semi-atheism,  and  remarks  at  a later 
period  of  his  mission — “ I begin  to  find  that  the  semi-atheism,  which  I have  sometimes  mentioned,  is 
nothing  but  a refined  Budkism , having  its  foundation  in  the  Budhist  scriptures This  is  the  point  to 
which  the  eye  and  attention  have  been  constantly  recalled,  by  the  feeling  which  every  step  in  the 
investigation  has  strengthened,  that  while  there  is  in  Budhism  - a generic  term  of  most  exalted  perfection 
actually  applied  to  numerous  individuals,  a Budha  superior  to  the  whole  host  of  subordinate  deities, 
there  are  also  lurking  in  the  system  “ the  glimmerings  of  an  anima  mundi , anterior  to,  and  even  superior 
to,  Budha. 

Budhism  has  a vein  of  doctrine  which  breathes  of  ambrosial  odours  and  ambrosial  flowers ; when 
both  its  services  and  altar  stood  side  by  side  with  those  of  the  Hindu  gods,  and  the  worshippers  of 
Brahma  were  delighted  to  honour  the  bright  star  of  the  Budha  in  the  planet  Mercury.  The  records  of 


For  uie  in  Library  only 


; -IT